Cma Inter Paper12
Cma Inter Paper12
Cma Inter Paper12
6
01
-2
US
AB
LL
SY
STUDY NOTES
Published by :
Directorate of Studies
The Institute of Cost Accountants of India (ICAI)
CMA Bhawan, 12, Sudder Street, Kolkata - 700 016
www.icmai.in
Printed at :
M/s. Sap Prints Solutions Pvt. Ltd.
28A, Lakshmi Industrial Estate
S. N. Path, Lower Parel (W)
Mumbai - 400 013, Maharashtra
Syllabus Structure
A A
50% 50%
ASSESSMENT STRATEGY
There will be written examination paper of three hours.
OBJECTIVES
To gain in depth knowledge of the professional standards, principles and procedures regarding preparation of
financial accounting statements. To provide basic knowledge of auditing
Learning Aims
The syllabus aims to test the student’s ability to:
nderstand the framework of financial statements various pronouncements of professional standards and their
U
applicability
Prepare financial statements as may be required under applicable statutes for fair representation, understanding
and reliability of stakeholders
Explain basic knowledge of auditing
Level B: Requiring the skill levels of knowledge, comprehension, application and analysis.
Note: Subjects related to applicable statutes shall be read with amendments made from time to time.
6. Auditing Concepts
(a) Nature, Scope and Significance of Auditing
(b) Audit Engagement, Audit Program, Audit Working Papers, Audit Note Book, Audit Evidence and Audit
Report
(c) Internal Check, Internal Control, Internal Audit - Industry Specific
1.1 Introduction 1
1.2 Issue of Share 3
1.3 Right Issue 24
1.4 Bonus Issue 26
1.5 Sweat Equity Shares 35
1.6 Forfeiture of Shares 36
1.7 Buy-back of Shares 44
1.8 Issue and Redemption of Preference Shares, Debentures 58
1.9 Under Writing of Shares and Debentures 101
SECTION – B : AUDITING
1.1 Introduction
1.2 Issue of Shares
1.3 Right Issue
1.4 Bonus Issue
1.5 Sweat Equity Shares
1.6 Forfeiture of Share
1.7 Buy-back of Shares
1.8 Issue and Redemption of Preference Shares, Debentures
1.9 Under Writing of Shares and Debentures
1.1 INTRODUCTION
A company is a voluntary and autonomous association of certain persons with capital divided into numerous
transferable shares formed to carry out a particular purpose in common. It is an artificial person created by
law to achieve the object for which it is formed. Section 2(20) of the Companies Act, 2013 defines a company
as “Company formed and registered under this Act or an existing company.” An existing company means a
company formed and registered under any of the former Companies Acts. Thus it is an abstract person, invisible,
intangible and existing only in contemplation of law. It can hold, purchase or sell both movable and immovable
property, incur and pay debts, open a bank account in its own name and sue and be sued in the same manner
as an individual. Law creates it and law only can dissolve it. Its existence is altogether independent of the life of its
members. Members may come and go but the company would go on forever. Transferability of shares has given
perpetual succession to a company. Death, insanity or insolvency of a member or any member will not affect the
existence of the company at all. A company is a legal entity quite distinct and separate from the persons who are
its members. A company cannot ordinarily buy its own shares. A shareholder is not the agent of the company. He
cannot incur any debt so as to bind the company. They cannot bind the company by their acts. The same person
can be a shareholder and a creditor of the company. The ownership is divorced from management because a
joint stock company is’ managed by a Board of Directors elected by the shareholders (i.e. owners).
Characteristics of a Company
The main characteristics of a company are:
(i) It is a distinct legal person existing independent of its members
(ii) Liability of the members is limited to the extent of the face value of shares held by them.
(iii) It has a perpetual succession, i.e, the members of the company may keep on changing from time to time
but this does not affect the company’s continuity.
(iv) The shares of a company are freely transferable except in case of a Private limited Company.
(v) A company being a legal person is capable of owing, enjoying and disposing of the property in its own
name.
(vi) A company, being a separate body can sue and be sued in its own name.
(vii) Though a company is an artificial person yet it acts through human beings who are called directors of the
company. There is a divorce between ownership and the management.
(viii) It is a voluntary association of persons usually for profit.
Statutory Books
Statutory books are those which a limited company is under statutory obligation to maintain at its registered office.
The main statutory books are:
(i) Register of Investments held and their names
(ii) Register of charges
(iii) Register of Members
(iv) Register of debenture holders
(v) Annual returns
(vi) Minutes books
(vii) Register of contracts
(viii) Register of Directors
(ix) Register of shareholdings of the directors
(x) Register of loans to companies under the same management
(xi) Register of Investment in the shares of other companies.
Books of Account
Every company is required to keep at its registered office books of account.
These books are to be maintained in such a way so as to disclose
(a) The sums of money received and expended by the company and the matter in respect of which the
receipt and expenditure has taken place.
(b) All sales and purchases of goods of the company.
(c) All assets and liabilities of the company.
Equity Preference
SHARE CAPITAL
No trading concern can run without capital. The divisions of share capital are:
(i) Nominal or Authorized Capital. The amount of capital with which the company intends to be registered is
called registered capital. It is the maximum amount which the company is authorized to raise by way of
public subscription. There is no legal limit on the extent of the amount of authorized capital.
(ii) Issued Capital. That part of the authorized capital which is offered to the public for subscription is called
issued capital.
(iii) Subscribed Capital. That part of the issued capital for which applications are received from the public is
called the subscribed capital.
(iv) Called up Capital. The amount on the shares which is actually demanded by the company to be paid is
known as called up capital.
(v) Paid up Capital. The part of the called up capital which is offered and is actually paid by the members is
known as paid up capital. The sum which is still to be paid is known as calls in arrears.
Publication of Authorized, Subscribed and Paid-Up Capital [Section 60]
(1) Where any notice, advertisement or other official publication, or any business letter, billhead or letter
paper of a company contains a statement of the amount of the authorised capital of the company, such
notice, advertisement or other official publication, or such letter, billhead or letter paper shall also contain
a statement, in an equally prominent position and in equally conspicuous characters, of the amount of the
capital which has been subscribed and the amount paid-up.
(2) If any default is made in complying with the requirements of sub-section (1), the company shall be liable
to pay a penalty of ten thousand rupees and every officer of the company who is in default shall be liable
to pay a penalty of five thousand rupees, for each default.
Issue of Application Forms for Securities [Section 33]
(1) No form of application for the purchase of any of the securities of a company shall be issued unless such
form is accompanied by an abridged prospectus.
(2) Provided that nothing in this sub-section shall apply if it is shown that the form of application was issued—
(3) in connection with a bona fide invitation to a person to enter into an underwriting agreement with respect
to such securities; or
(4) in relation to securities which were not offered to the public.
(5) A copy of the prospectus shall, on a request being made by any person before the closing of the
subscription list and the offer, be furnished to him.
(6) If a company makes any default in complying with the provisions of this section, it shall be liable to a
penalty of fifty thousand rupees for each default.
Refund of Application Money
(1) If the stated minimum amount has not been subscribed and the sum payable on application is not
received within the period specified therein, then the application money shall be repaid within a period
of fifteen days from the closure of the issue and if any such money is not so repaid within such period,
the directors of the company who are officers in default shall jointly and severally be liable to repay that
money with interest at the rate of fifteen percent per annum.
(2) The application money to be refunded shall be credited only to the bank account from which the
subscription was remitted.
Calls on Shares
Out of the face value of the shares, 5% is payable with application, some money will be paid on allotment and
rest money will be paid as and when calls are made by the company. Generally the prospectus gives the dates
of different calls along with the amount of the calls by shareholders. In case it is not given in the prospectus, the
directors have the discretion to call it in one call or more than one call. For this a resolution of the Board of Directors
must be passed and a notice is sent to the shareholders with a request to pay the amount of the call. As soon as
a call notice is sent, its particulars are entered in a separate book known as Share Call Book, a specimen of which
is given on the next page.
Illustration 1:
PK Ltd. made an issue of 10,00,000 equity shares of ` 10 each, payable ` 2 on application, ` 4 on allotment and
` 4 on call. All the shares are subscribed and amounts duly received. Pass journal entries to give effect to these.
Solution:
P K Ltd.
Journals
Dr. Cr.
Illustration 2:
AB & Co. Ltd. issued 5,00,00,000 Equity shares of ` 10 each at a premium of ` 4 per share payable ` 1 per share
on application, ` 6 per share on allotment (including premium), ` 3 on first call and the balance on final call. The
shares were all subscribed and all money due was received except the first call money on 1,00,000 shares and the
Final call money on 1,50,000 shares.
Give the Cash Book and Journal entries to record the above transactions.
Solution:
` in Lakh ` in Lakh
500
To Equity Share Application
3,000
To Equity Share Allotment 6,991
1,497 By Balance c/d
To Equity Share 1st Call
1,994
To Equity Share Final Call
6,991 6,991
Journals
Dr. Cr.
Particulars
` In Lakh ` In Lakh
Equity Share Application A/c Dr. 500
To Equity Share Capital A/c 500
Equity Share Allotment A/c Dr. 3,000
To Equity Share Capital A/c 1,000
To Securities Premium A/c 2,000
Illustration 3:
B Ltd issued 2,000 shares of ` 100 each at a premium of 10% payable as follows:
On application ` 20 (1st April 2014) . On allotment ` 40 (including premium) (1st June 2014) . On First Call ` 30 (1st
July 2014). On Second & Final call ` 20 (1st Aug 2014).
Applications were received for 1,800 shares and the directors made allotment in full. One shareholder to whom
40 shares were allotted paid the entire balance on his share holdings with allotment money and another share
holder did not pay allotment and 1st call money on his 60 shares but which he paid with final call. Interest should
be received @ 5% p.a. on calls-in-arrears and interest should be paid @ 6% p.a. on calls in Advance (as per Articles
of the company).
Required: Calculated the amount of interest paid and received on calls -in- advance and calls in arrears
respectively on 1st Aug.2014.
Solution:
Calculation of Interest on Calls-in-advance
On ` 1200 (i.e. 40 × ` 30) for 1 months @ 6% p.a. ` 6
On ` 800 (i.e. 40 × ` 20) for 2 months @ 6% p.a. ` 8
` 14
Calculation of Interest on Calls-in-arrears
On ` 2400 (i.e. 60 × ` 40) for 2 months @ 5% p.a. ` 20
On ` 1800 (i.e. 60 × ` 30) for 1 months @ 5% p.a. ` 7.5
` 27.5
Illustration 4:
A limited Company was registered with a capital of ` 5,00,000 in share of ` 100 each and issued 2,000 such shares
at a premium of ` 20 per share, payable as ` 20 per share on application, ` 50 per share on allotment (including
premium) and ` 20 per share on first call made three months later. All the money payable on application, and
allotment were duly received but when the first call was made, one shareholder paid the entire balance on his
holding of 30 shares, and another shareholder holding 100 shares failed to pay the first call money.
Required: Give Journal entries to record the above transactions.
Solution: Journal
Illustration 5:
B Ltd purchase the assets of ` 10,80,000 from C Ltd. The consideration was payable in fully paid equity shares of
` 100 each.
Required: Show the necessary journal entries in books of B Ltd. assuming that —
Solution:
Working Note:
Calculation of No. of Shares to be issued in different cases
At Par At a Premium
A. Amount to be paid (`) 10,80,000 10,80,000
B. Issue Price Per Share (`) 100 120
C. No. of Shares to be issued (A/B) 10,800 9,000
Illustration 6:
D Ltd. issued 2,000 shares of `100 each credited as fully paid to the promoters for their services and issued 1,000
shares of `100 each credited as fully paid to the underwriters for their underwriting services. Journalise these
transactions.
Solution:
Journal Dr. Cr.
Illustration 7:
On 1st May 2014 Superman Ltd. issued 5,000 Equity Shares of ` 100 each payable as follows:
` `
On application 20 On 1st Call 20 (Last date fixed for payment 31st July)
On allotment 30 On Final Call 30 (Last date fixed for payment 30th August)
Applications were received on 15th May 2014 for 6,000 shares and allotment was made on 1st June 2014.
Applicants for 2,500 shares were allotted in full, those for 3,000 shares were allotted 2,500 shares and applications
for 500 shares were rejected.
Balance of amount due on allotment was received on 15th June.
The calls were duly made on 1st July, 2014 and 1st August 2014 respectively. One shareholder did not pay the 1st
Call money on 150 shares which he paid with the final call together with interest at 5% p.a. Another shareholder
holding 100 shares did not pay the final call money till end of the accounting year which ends on 31st October.
Solution:
Journal Proper
Dr. Cr.
To Interest on calls-in-arrear 25
(Being the interest due on first call on ` 300 @ 5% for two months, assumed
payment made on 30.8.12
(Being the transfer to calls-in-Arrear A/c final call money on 100 equity
shares @ ` 30 per shares)
25
31.10.14 Shareholders A/c Dr.
25
To Interest on Calls-in-Arrears A/c
(Being the interest due on ` 3,000 @ 5% for two months)
Categories A B C
(c) Application money received [(a) × ` 20 per share] 50,000 60,000 10,000
Illustration 8:
Priyanka Industries Ltd. has an authorised capital ` 2,00,000 divided into shares of ` 100 each. Of these, 600 shares
were issued as fully paid for payment of machinery purchased from Z Ltd. 800 shares were subscribed for by the
public and during the first year ` 50 per share was called up payable ` 20 on application, ` 10 on allotment, ` 10
on the first call and ` 10 on second call.
The amounts received in respect of these shares were as follows:-
On 600 Shares Full amount called up
On 125 Shares ` 40 Per Share
On 50 Shares ` 30 Per Share
On 25 Shares ` 20 Per Share
The directors forfeited the 75 shares, on which less than ` 40 per share had been paid.
Required: Give Journal Entries recording the above transactions (including cash transactions) and show how
Share Capital would appear in the Balance-Sheet of the Company, in accordance with Part 1 of Schedule III to
the Companies Act.
Solution:
Journals Dr. Cr.
Particulars L.F. (`) (`)
Machinery A/c Dr. 60,000
To Z Ltd. A/c 60,000
(Being the purchase of machinery from Z Ltd. as per agreement dated...)
` `
I EQUITY AND LIABILITIES
1. Shareholders’ Funds
(a) Share capital 1 97,000
2 Share application money pending allotment Nil
3 Non-current liabilities Nil
4 Current Liabilities Nil
Total (1+2+3+4) 97,000
II ASSETS
1. Non-current assets
(a) Fixed assets
(i) Tangible assets 2 60,000
2 Current assets
(a) Cash and cash equivalents 3 37,000
Total (1+2) 97,000
Authorized Capital
2,000 Equity share of `100 each 2,00,000
Total 2,00,000
Issued Capital
1,400 shares of ` 100 each 1,40,000
Total 1,40,000
Subscribed Capital
600 Shares of ` 100 each 60,000
725 shares of ` 100 each out of ` 50 paid 36,250
96,250
Less. Calls Unpaid 1,250
95,000
Add: Forfeited Shares 2,000
Total 97,000
Machinery 60,000
Total 60,000
Total 37,000
Illustration 9:
SOS Limited issued a prospectus inviting applications for 6,000 shares of ` 10 each at a premium of ` 2 per share,
payable as follows;
On application ` 2 per share; On allotment ` 5 per share (including premium): On 1st call ` 3 per share; On Second
and Final Call ` 2 per share.,
Applications were receive for 9,000 shares and allotment was made prorate to the applicants of 7,500 shares, the
remaining applicants were refused allotment. Money overpaid on applications were applied towards sums due
on allotment.
D to whom 100 shares were allotted, failed to pay the allotment money and on his subsequent failure to pay
the first call, his shares were forfeited. Z, the holder of 200 shares, failed to pay both the calls, and his shares were
forfeited after the second and final call.
Of the shares forfeited 200 shares were sold to C credited as fully paid up for ` 8.50 per share, the whole of D’s
shares being included.
Solution:
Cash Book (Bank Column)
Dr. Cr.
Particulars ` Particulars `
74,750 74,750
Journals
Working Notes: (i)Calculation of the amount due but no paid on allotment in Case of D.
No. of applied Shares by Mr. D. (100 × 7500/6,000)125
** Alternatively:
Ratio of allotment = 6,000:7,500 = 4:5
5×2 - 4×2
Advance per share adjustable allotment = = `0.50 and due per share `4.50
4 Shares
** Profit on reissue:
On D’s Share = 100 (2.50 – 1.50) = ` 100
On Z’s share = 100 × (5-1.50) = ` 350
` 450
(ii) Calculation of allotment money received later on Total allotment money due ` 30,000
26,550
Illustration 10:
Alpha Ltd issued a prospectus inviting applications for 2,000 shares of ` 10 each at a premium of ` 2 per share,
payable as follows:
On Application ` 2, On Allotment ` 5 (including premium)
On First Call ` 3, On Second & Final Call ` 2
Applications were received for 3,000 shares and pro rata allotment was made on the applications for 2,400 shares.
It was decided to utilise excess application money towards the amount due on allotment.
Mohit, to whom 40 shares allotted, failed to pay the allotment money and on his subsequent failure to pay the first
call, his shares were forfeited.
Jagat, the holder of 60 shares failed to pay the two calls and on his such failure, his shares were forfeited. Of the
shares forfeited, 80 shares were sold to Rishav credited as fully paid for ` 9 per share, the whole of Mohit’s shares
being included.
Required: Give Journal Entries to record the above transactions (including cash transactions)
Working Notes:
(i) Calculation of the amount due but not paid on allotment in Case of Mohit
`
Total No. of shares applied by Mohit (40 × 2,400/2,000) 48
Illustration 11:
Hero Limited issued 10,000 equity shares of ` 100 each at premium of ` 25 per share. Under the terms of the isue,
the shares were to be paid for as follows: `
February 1, on allotment 50
April 1, balance of 25
The issue was oversubscribed. The applications received are summarised below:
A B C
One of the conditions of the issue was that amounts over-paid on application were to be retained by the
company and used in reduction of further sums due on shares allotted. All surplus contributions were refunded on
1st February, 2014.
Ramesh who had subscribed 100 on an application for 200 shares was unable to meet the claim due on April 1. On
May 5, the directors forfeited his shares. All other shareholders paid the sums requested on the due dates. On June
10, 2014 the directors re-issued the forfeited shares as fully paid to Mohan, on receiving a payment of ` 10,500.
To prepare a statement as on February 1, 2014, showing the over-payment, under-payment to in respect of
category of applicants: and
To show how the above transactions would appear in the journal of the company.
Solution:
(a) Hero Ltd.
Statement of Shares Applied, Allotted and Amounts Adjusted
Particulars Categories
A B C
(a) Applied (Nos.) 8,000 40,000 8,000
(b) Allotted (Nos.) 4,000 4,000 2,000
` ` `
(c) Application money Received (Applied 4,00,000 20,00,000 4,00,000
(Application per share)
(d) Application Money required 2,00,000 2,00,000 1,00,000
(Alloted × Application per share)
(e) Excess Application Money to be Adjusted with 2,00,000 18,00,000 3,00,000
Allotment [c-d]
(f) Allotment Money Due 2,00,000 2,00,000 1,00,000
(Alloted × Allotment per share)
(g) Balance of Excess Application Money for Nil 16,00,000 2,00,000
Adjustment with calls [e-f]
(h) Call Money Due 1,00,000 1,00,000 50,000
(Allotment × Call per share)
(i) Excess/(Shortage) (1,00,000) 15,00,000 1,50,000
In case of shortage, the shareholders will deposit the dues.
(b) Journals
Illustration 12.
JK Ltd is a company with an authorized capital of `10 lacs in equity shares of `10 each, of which 600000 shares had
been issued and fully paid on 30th June, 2018. The company proposed to make a further issue of 100000 of these
` 10 shares at a price of `14 each the arrangements for payment being:
` 2 per share payable on application, to be received by 1st July 2018.
Allotment to be made on 10th July and a further `5 per shares (including the premium) to be payable.
The final call for the balance to be made, and the money received by 31st January 2019.
Applications were received for 355000 shares and were dealt with as follows:
Applicants for 5000 shares received allotment in full.
Applicants for 30000 shares received an allotment of one share for every 2 applied for, no money was returned to
the applicant, the surplus on application being used to reduce the amount due on allotment.
Applicants for 320000 shares received an allotment of one share for every four applied for, the money due on
allotment was retained by the company, the excess being returned to the applicant.
The money due on final call was received on the due date.
You are required to record these transactions in the journal of JK Limited.
Solution:
Working note:
Where at any time, a company having a share capital proposes to increase its subscribed capital by the issue of
further shares, such shares shall be offered to persons who, at the date of the offer, are
holders of equity shares of the company in proportion, as nearly as circumstances admit, to the paid-up share
capital on those shares by sending a letter of offer subject to the following conditions, namely:—
a. the offer shall be made by notice specifying the number of shares offered and limiting a time not being
less than fifteen days and not exceeding thirty days from the date of the offer within which the offer, if not
accepted, shall be deemed to have been declined;
b. unless the articles of the company otherwise provide, the offer aforesaid shall be deemed to include a right
exercisable by the person concerned to renounce the shares offered to him or any of them in favour of any
other person; and the notice referred to in clause (i) shall contain a statement of this right;
c. after the expiry of the time specified in the notice aforesaid, or on receipt of earlier intimation from the person
to whom such notice is given that he declines to accept the shares offered, the Board of Directors may
dispose of them in such manner which is not dis-advantageous to the shareholders and the company.
Valuation of Rights
Usually a company offers rights issue at a price which is lower than the market price of the shares so that existing
(i.e., old) shareholders may get the monetary benefit of being associated with the company for a long time.
Existing shareholders who have been offered right shares and do not want to purchase these offered shares may
renounce their right shares in favour of some other persons within the specified period as mentioned earlier. In
such a case, the existing shareholders can make a profit by selling his right to such other person. This right can be
valued in terms of money as below:
(a) Calculate the market value of shares which an existing shareholder is required to have in order to get fresh
shares.
(b) Add to the above price paid for the fresh shares.
(c) Find out the average price of existing shares and fresh shares.
(d) The average price of the share should be deducted from the market price and the difference thus ascertained
is value of right.
Illustration 13.
NT Limited has an issued capital of 20000 equity shares of `10 each fully called up.
To forfeit 100 shares on which `5 per share has been paid up and to be issue at `15 per share as fully paid up.
To issue right shares in the ratio of 1 fully paid up shares for every 4 existing shares held, at ` 15 per share.
Assuming that the company has sufficient to general reserve, the above through journal entries.
Solution:
Dr. Cr.
Date Particulars (`) (`)
Equity Share Capital (100 × 10)A/c Dr. 1000
To Calls in Arrear A/c 500
To Forfeited Shares A/c 500
Bank A/c Dr. 1500
To Equity Share Capital A/c 1000
To Securities Premium A/c 500
Forfeited Shares A/c Dr. 500
To Capital Reserve A/c 500
Bank A/c Dr. 75000
To Equity Share Application A/c 75000
Equity Share Application A/c Dr. 75000
To Equity Share Capital A/c 50000
To Securities Premium 25000
Illustration 14.
A Company is planning to raise funds by making rights issue of equity shares to finance its expansion. The existing
equity share capital of the company is ` 50,00,000. The market value of its share is ` 42. The company offers to its
shareholders the right to buy 2 shares at ` 11 each for every 5 shares held. You are required to calculate:
(i) Theoretical market price after rights issue;
(ii) The value of rights; and
(iii) Percentage increase in share capital.
Solution:
`
Market value of 5 shares already held by a shareholder @ ` 42 210
Add: Price to be paid by him for acquiring 2 more shares @ ` 11 per share 22
Total price of 7 shares after rights issue 232
(i) Therefore, theoretical market price of one share, (i.e., 232/7) = 33.14
(ii) Value of Rights = Market Price - Theoretical Market Price = ` 42 - ` 33.14. = ` 8.86
(iii) Percentage Increase in Share Capital
Capitalisation:
Capitalisation of profits is the process of converting profits or reserves into paid up capital.
Bonus Shares:
A bonus share is a free share issued without any consideration to an existing shareholder in the ratio of number of
shares held by that shareholder.
Issue of Bonus share —
• decreases the Reserve & Surplus;
• Increases the issued capital but does not bring any change in cash flow and net worth.
Way to capitalize profits or reserves:
(a) by paying up amounts unpaid on existing partly paid shares so as to make them fully paid up shares, or
(b) by issuing fully paid bonus shares to the existing members.
Sources for fully paid-up bonus shares [Sec 63]
As per Sec 63(1), a company may issue fully paid-up bonus shares to its members out of-
• Its Free Reserves
• Its Secutiries Premium Account; or
• Its Capital Redemption Reserve Account
Restrictions —
• No issue of bonus shares shall be made by capitalising reserves created by the Revaluation of Assets i.e.
Revaluation Reserves.
Meaning of Free Reserves: As per Sec 2(43) of the Companies Act, 2013, “Free Reserves” mean such reserves
which, as per the latest audited balance sheet of a company, are available for distribution as dividend.
Exclusions from Free Reserves:
• Any amount representing unrealised gains, notional gains or revaluation of assets, where shown as a reserve
or otherwise, or
• Any change in carrying amount of an asset or of a liability recognised in equity, including surplus in Profit and
Loss Account on measurement of the Asset or the Liability at Fair Value.
Conditions for issue of fully paid-up bonus shares [SEC 63(2)]
(i) A company can issue bonus shares if its Articles expressly authorise to do so.
(ii) A resolution is required to be passed by the Board of Directors recommending its decision to issue bonus
shares.
(iii) A resolution is required to be passed by the members in the general meeting to approve the Board’s
resolution recommending the issue of bonus shares.
Members’ resolution —
• Must have an intention to capitalize the profits or reserves, and
• Must mention the amount of profits or reserves to be capitalized.
(iv) The company has not defaulted in payment of interest or principal in respect of fixed deposits or debt
securities issued by it.
(v) The Company has not defaulted in respect of payment of statutory dues of the employees such as
contribution to provident fund, gratuity and bonus.
(vi) The partly-paid shares, if any, outstanding on the date of allotment are made fully paid-up.
(vii) A Company must comply with Prescribed Conditions.
The bonus shares shall not be issued in lieu of dividend.
1. On giving Bonus by converting partly paid shares into fully paid shares
Capital Reserve A/c (realised in cash only) Dr.
General reserve A/c Dr.
Profit & Loss A/c Dr.
To Bonus to Shareholders A/c
Illustration 15.
Following items appear in the Trial Balance of M Ltd. as at 31st March, 2015:
The company decided to issue bonus shares to its shareholders at the rate of one share for every four shares held.
Required: Pass the necessary journal entries. It is desired that there should be minimum reduction in free reserves.
Solution:
Journal
Notes:
(i) Plant Revaluation Reserve cannot be utilized to issue bonus shares.
(ii) Capital Reserve realised in cash can be utilized for bonus issue.
Illustration 16:
Following is the extract of the Balance Sheet of YY Ltd. as at 31st March, 2015:
`
Authorised Capital
15,000 12% Preference shares of ` 10 each 1,50,000
1,50,000 Equity shares of ` 10 each 15,00,000
16,50,000
Issued and Subscribed Capital:
12,000 12% Preference Shares of `10 each fully paid 1,20,000
1,35,000 Equity shares of ` 10 each, ` 8 paid up 10,80,000
Reserves and Surplus:
Capital Redemption Reserve 30,000
General Reserve 1,80,000
Capital Reserve 1,12,500
Securities Premium 37,500
Profit and Loss Account 2,70,000
Secured Loans:
12% Partly Convertible Debentures @ ` 100 each 7,50,000
On 1st April, 2015 the Company has made final call @ 2 each on 1,35,000 equity shares. The call money was
received by 20th April, 2015. Thereafter the company decided to capitalise its reserves by way of bonus at the rate
of one share for every four shares held. Securities premium of ` 37,500 includes a premium of ` 7,500 for shares
issued to vendors pursuant to a scheme of amalgamation. Capital reserves include ` 60,0000, being profit on sales
of plant and machinery. 20% of 12% Debentures are convertible into equity shares of ` 10 each fully paid on 1st
June 2015.
Required: Show necessary entries in the books of the company and prepare the extract of the Balance Sheet
immediately after bonus issue but before conversion of debentures. Are the convertible debenture holders entitled
to bonus shares?
Solution:
Journal of Y Y Ltd.
Notes to Accounts:
Particulars `
1. Share Capital
Authorised Share Capital
1,87,500 Equity Shares of ` 10 each 18,07,500
15,000,12% Preference Shares of ` 10 each 1,50,000
19,57,500
Issued, Subscribed and fully paid Share Capital
1,68,750 Equity Shares of ` 10 each, fully paid 16,87,500
(Out of above, 33,750 equity shares @ ` 10 each were issued by way of bonus)
12,000 12% Preference Shares of ` 10 each 1,20,000
Total 18,07,500
2. Reserves and Surplus
Capital Reserves [1,12,500 - 60,000] 52,500
Securities Premium Reserves [37,500 - 30,000] 7,500
Surplus (Profit & Loss Account) [2,70,000 – 37,500] 2,32,500
Total 2,92,500
3. Long-term borrowings
Secured
Secured 12% Convertible Debentures @ `100 each 7,50,000
(Out of above 1,50,000 Debentures @ `100 each to be converted into 15,000 Equity Shares
@ `10 each 1st July,2015
Total 7,50,000
Working Notes:
1. Capital Reserve realised in cash can be utilised for issue of fully paid bonus shares.
2. As per SEBI guidelines, securities premium collected in cash can only be utilised for bonus issue.
3. As per pare (ii) of SEBI guidelines, no-company can issue bonus shares to its shareholders without extending
similar benefit to convertible debentures holders. Pending such conversion, necessary number of shares
should be earmarked for convertible debentures holders. Therefore, convertible debenture holders are also
entitled to the bonus shares in the same ratio as the equity shareholders.
4. It is assumed that the company will pass necessary resolution at its general body meeting for increasing the
authorised capital by ` 2,50,000.
Issue of Bonus Shares to equity shareholders [22,500 × ` 10] 2,25,000
Issue of Bonus Shares to be issued to Debenture holders after conversion 25,000
[(20% of 5,00,000)/` 10]× 1/4 × ` 10 2,50,000
Illustration 17.
The following is the balance sheet of reliance company ltd as on 31.12.2018
Liabilities: (`)
Issued and paid up capital:
225000 equity shares of `10 each fully called up 22,50,000
Less: Calls in arrear 50,000
(25000 shares of `2 each)
100000 equity shares of `10 each, ` 4 paid up 4,00,000
Total 6,15,0000
Assets: (`)
Non current assets
Fixed assets 30,00,000
61,50,000
The board of directors of the company took the following decisions.
a. To forfeit the shares on which final call of ` 2 each is due.
b. To issue fully paid bonus shares @ 1 fully paid up share for every 2 fully paid shares held.
c. to pay bonus to the partly paid shares at an equivalent rate as in (b)above without collecting any amount
from the related shareholders.
d. to reissue the forfeited shares @ ` 12 each fully fed up.
e. To pay dividend equivalent to 10% on share capital including bonus shares.
f. To issue right shares in the ratio of 1 fully paid up share for every four existing fully paid up shares held after
bonus issue at `15 per share.
g. To use minimum balance of profit and loss account.
Note:
1. All Capital Reserve are realised in cash.
2. One fifth of the development rebate reserve is free.
Pass necessary journal entries in the books of the company including cash transaction after the above decisions
are implemented.
Solution:
In The Books of ………………………….
Journal Dr. Cr.
Illustration 18.
MG Limited was registered on 1st January 2017 with an authorised capital of `3,00,000 divided into 30000 equity
shares of `10 each. During the next 12 months to 31st November 2017 following events occurred which related to
the share capital of the company.
On 1st January 2017 the company offered for subscription of 10,000 equity shares at a price of rupees 19 each, to
be paid as follows:
On 30th June 2017 the company made right issue on 1 for 2 basis at ` 22.50 per share, payable in full on 10th July
2017.
Only 80% of the issue was subscribed for by the shareholders with a payment being made on the due date.
On 30th November 2017 Company decided to make a bonus issue of shares at par by utilising the entire balance
of securities premium account.
Prepare the equity share capital account and the securities premium account of the company for the year
ended 31st December 2017.
A share holder who had subscribed initially for 140 shares had subsequently taken up 80% of the right issue and
then received the bonus shares to which he was entitled.
Calculate the ultimate number of shares owned by him and the total price paid by him for those shares.
Solution:
Equity Share Capital Account
Dr. Cr.
Working notes:
a. Securities premium per share on original issue = `(19-10) = 9. Securities premium per share on right issue =
`(22.50 -10) = `12.50.
Number of right shares issued = 80% (1/2×10000) = 4000 shares.
Total securities premium available =(10000×9)+(4000×12.50) = `(90,000+50,000) = `1,40,000.
b. So number of bonus share to be issued at par = `1,40,000 / `10 = 14000, i.e , rate of bonus issue is 14000 : 14000
= 1:1, i.e. , 1 bonus share issued for every share held after right issue.
c. Number of right shares purchased by the shareholder = 80% x (1/2 × 140) = 56 shares. So number of bonus
shares to be received by him @ 1:1 = (140+56)= 196 shares.
d. It is remembered that no amount is payable by the shareholders against bonus issue of shares.
e. Calculation of ultimate number of equity shares owned by :
2,660
For right issue @1:2 (80% of 140 shares x1/2 x 22.50) 56 1,260
For bonus issue of shares @ 1:1 for total 196 shares held 196 nil
392 3,920
Accounting treatment:
Case 1.
Tinku Ltd. allotted 500 sweat equity shares of `100 each to its Directors at a discount of 6%.
Case 2.
800 sweat equity shares of `100 allotted to employees at par in consideration of technical know-how.
Forfeiture of Shares
When a shareholder fails to pay calls, the company, if empowered by its articles, may forfeit the shares. If a
shareholder has not paid any call on the day fixed for payment thereof and fails to pay it even after his attention
is drawn to it by the secretary by registered notice, the Board of Directors pass a resolution to the effect that
such shares be forfeited. Shares once forfeited become the property of the company and may be sold on such
terms as directors think fit. Upon forfeiture, the original shareholder ceases to be a member and his name must be
removed from the register of members.
Surrender of Shares
After the allotment of shares, sometimes a shareholder is not able to pay the further calls and returns his shares to
the company for cancellation. Such voluntary return of shares to the company by the shareholder himself is called
surrender of shares. Surrender of shares has no separate accounting treatment but it will be like that of forfeiture of
shares. The same entries (as are passed in case of forfeiture of shares) will be passed in case of surrender of shares.
Reissue of Forfeited Shares
Forfeited shares may be reissued by the company directors for any amount but if such shares are issued at a
discount then the amount of discount should not exceed the actual amount received on forfeited shares. The
purchaser of forfeited reissued shares is liable for payment of all future calls duly made by the Company.
When all Forfeited Shares are not Issued
When all forfeited shares are not issued, i.e., only a part of such shares is issued, it is desirable to spread the amount
of shares forfeited account on all such forfeited shares and of the amount relating to that part of forfeited shares
which has been reissued, discount on reissue of shares should be deducted from such amount and the balance
is transferred to capital reserve being capital profit. The amount relating to that part of shares forfeited account
which has not been reissued should be shown on the liabilities side of Balance Sheet as Shares Forfeited Account.
(1) For forfeiture of shares :
Share Capital A/c Dr. (No. of shares forfeited × Called up value per share)
Securities Premium A/c Dr. (if issued at a premium and premium not received)
To Calls-in-Arrear A/c (amount not received on forfeited shares)
To Shares Forfeited A/c (Capital received on forfeited shares)
(2) For reissue of forfeited shares
Bank A/c Dr. (No. of Shares Reissued × Reissue Price/Share)
Shares Forfeited A/c Dr. (No. of shares × Further discount on reissue)
To Share Capital A/c (No. of shares Reissued × Paid up value per share)
To Securities Premium A/c (if reissued at a premium)
(3) For transferring profit on reissue of forfeited shares
To, Shares Forfeited A/c Dr.. (Profit on Forfeiture— Further discount on reissue of such forfeited
share)
To Capital Reserve
Note:
If part of the forfeited shares are reissued, then profit shall have to be calculated proportionately as follows :
Profit on Reissue of Forfeited Shares:
Example:
ICC Ltd. forfeited 200 equity shares of rupees 10 each fully called up for nonpayment of final call @ ` 2 per share.
These shares were originally issued at the discount of 10%. Application, allotment and first call money per share
@ ` 2, @ ` 3 and ` 2 respectively were received in time. Give journal entry for the forfeiture.
Solution:
Journals
Working:
1. On 3,00,000 forfeited shares, the total amount forfeited is ` 24,000.
For 2,00,000 such shares the amount will be ` ’000
(2,00,000/3,00,000) x 24,000 = 16,000
Less: Discount on Reissue 3,000
Transferred to Capital Reserve 13,000**
Balance of Forfeited share account will be shown in balance sheet as ‘Forfeited Share Account” in liability side.
** Alternatively, 2,00,000 × (amount forfeited – discounted on reissue)
= 2,00,000 × `(80-15) = `130,00,000
Illustration 20:
Give journal entries for the following:
(1) PK Ltd. forfeited 10,000 equity shares of ` 10 each for nonpayment of first call of ` 2 and final call of ` 3 per
share. These shares were reissued at a discount of ` 3.50 per share.
(2) KP Ltd. forfeited 20,000 equity shares of `15 each (including ` 5 per share as premium), for non-payment of
final call of ` 3 per share. Out of these 10,000 shares were reissued at a discount of ` 4 per share.
(3) KP Ltd. forfeited 15,000 equity shares of `15 each (including ` 5 per share as premium), for non-payment of
allotment money ` 8 (including premium money) and first & final call of ` 5 per share. Out of these 10,000
shares were reissued at ` 14 per share.
Solution:
Journal Entries Dr. Cr.
Particulars ` `
a) Equity Share Capital A/c Dr. 100,000
To Calls in Arrear A/c 50,000
To Forfeited Share A/c 50,000
(10,000 shares forfeited for non-payment of first and final call money)
65,000
Bank A/c Dr.
35,000 100,000
Forfeited Share A/c Dr.
To Equity Share Capital Account (Reissue of 10,000 sh. @ ` 6.50 each)
15,000
Forfeited Share A/c Dr. 15,000
To Capital Reserve A/c
(Balance of Forfeited share Account transferred) 200,000
b) Equity Share Capital A/c Dr.
To Calls in Arrear A/c 60,000
To Forfeited share A/c 140,000
(20,000 shares forfeited for non-payment of final call money) 60,000
40,000
Bank A/c Dr.
Forfeited Share A/c Dr.
30,000 100,000
To Equity Share Capital A/c (Reissue of 10,000 sh. @ ` 6 each)
Illustration 20:
X Ltd. issued 10,000 Equity shares of ` 10 each at a premium of ` 2 per share, payable : ` 3 on application (including
premium of ` 1); ` 4 on allotment (including the balance of premium) and the balance in a call. Public subscribed
for 12,000 shares. Excess application money was refunded. One shareholder Mr. A holding 50 shares paid the call
money along with allotment. Another Mr. B failed to pay allotment & call on 30 shares.
These shares were forfeited after the call and 25 of those were reissued at ` 9 each.
Pass Journals Entries.
Solution: X Ltd.
Journal Entries (without narration) Dr. Cr.
Particulars ` `
(1) Application Money Received:
Bank A/c Dr. 36,000
To Equity Shares Application A/c (12000×3) 36,000
(2) Refund of excess application money:
Equity Share Application A/c (2000×3) Dr. 6,000
To Bank A/c 6,000
(3) Transfer of share application to Share Capital:
Equity Shares Application A/c (10,000 ×3) Dr. 30,000
To Equity Shares Capital A/c (10000×2) 20,000
To Securities Premium A/c (10,000×1) 10,000
(4) Allotment Money Due:
Equity Shares allotment A/c (10000×4) Dr. 40,000
To Equity Share Capital A/c (10000×3) 30,000
To Securities Premium A/c (10000×1) 10,000
(5) Allotment Money Received:
Bank A/c (9,970×4) Dr. 39,880
Calls-in-Arear A/c (30×4) Dr. 120
To Equity Share Allotment A/c 40,000
(6) Bank A/c Dr. 250
To Calls in Arrear A/c 250
(7) Share Call Money Due:
Equity Share First & Final call A/c (10,000 × 5) Dr. 50,000
50,000
To Equity Share Capital A/c
(8) Call Money Received, Adjustment of Calls-in-Advance:
Bank A/c (9,920 × 5) Dr. 49,600
Calls-in-Arrear A/c (30 × 5) Dr. 150
Calls-in-Advance A/c Dr. 250
50,000
To Equity Shares First & Final Call A/c
(Received with Allotment, now adjusted)
(9) Forfeiture of Shares:
300
Equity Share Capital A/c (30×10) Dr.
30
Securities Premium A/c (30×1) Dr. 270
To Calls-in-Arrear A/c 60
To Shares Forfeited A/c
(10) Reissue of Forfeited Shares:
225
Bank A/c (25×9) Dr.
25
Share Forfeited A/c Dr. 250
To Equity Shares Capital A/c (25×10)
(11) Transfer of Profit on Reissue of Forfeited shares 25
Shares Forfeited A/c Dr. 25
To Capital Reserve A/c [25 × (2 - 1)]
Illustration 21:
JB Ltd. issued 60000 equity shares of `10 each at a premium of `2.50 per share. The amount payable on application
is ` 4.50 (including premium). The amount payable on allotment was fixed at ` 4 per share and an equivalent sum
was due on a call to be made.
Total applications received were for 110000 shares and after consulting the stock exchange, the following scheme
for allotment was decided upon:
Category A B C
Grouping of shares 1 to 100 101 to 500 Over 500
No of applications received 1200 175 5
No of shares applied for 70000 35000 5000
No of shares allotted 42000 14000 4000
It was decided that the excess amount received on applications would be utilised in payment of allotment money
and surplus if any would be refunded to the applicant. Sanjay who was one of the applicants belonging to
category A and had applied for 100 shares defaulted in payment of allotment money. Vivek, who belonged
to category c, and who had been allotted 800 shares failed to pay the call money. Their shares were forfeited,
after the respective calls were made and re-issued as fully paid up for `8 and `6 per share respectively. Show the
necessary journal entries in the books of the company to record the above transactions.
Solution:
Workings:
Category application Allotment Money Amount Amount Refund. Amount due Amount
received on required on adjusted on 3-(4+5) on allotment receivable on
application application allotment allotment
(`) (`) (`) (`) (`) (`) 7-5 (`)
1 70,000 42,000 3,15,000 1,89,000 1,26,000 0 1,68,000 42,000
2 35,000 14,000 1,57,500 63,000 56,000 38,500 56,000
3 5,000 4,000 22,500 18,000 4,500 0 16,000 11,500
Total 1,10,000 60,000 4,95,000 2,70,000 1,86,500 38,500 2,40,000 53,500
Restrictions on Purchase by Company or giving of Loans by it for Purchase of its Shares [Section 67]
(i) No company limited by shares or by guarantee and having a share capital shall have power to buy its own
shares unless the consequent reduction of share capital is effected under the provisions of this Act.
(ii) No public company shall give, whether directly or indirectly and whether by means of a loan, guarantee,
the provision of security or otherwise, any financial assistance for the purpose of, or in connection with, a
purchase or subscription made or to be made, by any person of or for any shares in the company or in its
holding company.
(iii) Nothing in sub-section (2) shall apply to—
(a) the lending of money by a banking company in the ordinary course of its business;
(b) the provision by a company of money in accordance with any scheme approved by company through
special resolution and in accordance with such requirements as may be prescribed, for the purchase
of, or subscription for, fully paid-up shares in the company or its holding company, if the purchase of, or
the subscription for, the shares held by trustees for the benefit of the employees or such shares held by
the employee of the company;
(c) the giving of loans by a company to persons in the employment of the company other than its directors
or key managerial personnel, for an amount not exceeding their salary or wages for a period of six
months with a view to enabling them to purchase or subscribe for fully paid- up shares in the company
or its holding company to be held by them by way of beneficial ownership.
Provided that disclosures in respect of voting rights not exercised directly by the employees in respect
of shares to which the scheme relates shall be made in the Board’s report in such manner as may be
prescribed.
(iv) Nothing in this section shall affect the right of a company to redeem any preference shares issued by it
under this Act or under any previous company law.
(v) If a company contravenes the provisions of this section, it shall be punishable with fine which shall not
be less than one lakh rupees but which may extend to twenty-five lakh rupees and every officer of the
company who is in default shall be punishable with imprisonment for a term which may extend to three
years and with fine which shall not be less than one lakh rupees but which may extend to twenty-five lakh
rupees.
Power of Company to Purchase its Own Securities [Section 68]
(1) Notwithstanding anything contained in this Act, but subject to the provisions of sub-section (2), a company
may purchase its own shares or other specified securities hereinafter referred to as buy- back) out of—
(a) its free reserves;
(b) the securities premium account; or
(c) the proceeds of the issue of any shares or other specified securities:
Provided that no buy-back of any kind of shares or other specified securities shall be made out of the
proceeds of an earlier issue of the same kind of shares or same kind of other specified securities.
(2) No company shall purchase its own shares or other specified securities under sub-section (1), unless—
(a) the buy-back is authorised by its articles;
(b) a special resolution has been passed at a general meeting of the company authorising the buy-back.
Provided that nothing contained in this clause shall apply to a case where—
(i) the buy-back is, ten per cent. or less of the total paid-up equity capital and free reserves of the
company; and
(ii) such buy-back has been authorised by the Board by means of a resolution passed at its meeting;
(c) the buy-back is twenty-five per cent. or less of the aggregate of paid-up capital and free reserves of the
company:
Provided that in respect of the buy-back of equity shares in any financial year, the reference to twenty-
five per cent. in this clause shall be construed with respect to its total paid-up equity capital in that
financial year;
(d) the ratio of the aggregate of secured and unsecured debts owed by the company after buy-back is
not more than twice the paid-up capital and its free reserves:
Provided that the Central Government may, by order, notify a higher ratio of the debt to capital and
free reserves for a class or classes of companies;
(e) all the shares or other specified securities for buy-back are fully paid-up;
(f) the buy-back of the shares or other specified securities listed on any recognized stock exchange is in
accordance with the regulations made by the Securities and Exchange Board in this behalf; and
(g) the buy-back in respect of shares or other specified securities other than those specified in clause (f) is
in accordance with such rules as may be prescribed.
Provided that no offer of buy-back under this sub-section shall be made within a period of one year
reckoned from the date of the closure of the preceding offer of buy-back, if any.
(3) The notice of the meeting at which the special resolution is proposed to be passed under clause (b) of
sub-section (2) shall be accompanied by an explanatory statement stating—
(a) a full and complete disclosure of all material facts;
(b) the necessity for the buy-back;
(c) the class of shares or securities intended to be purchased under the buy-back;
(d) the amount to be invested under the buy-back; and
(e) the time-limit for completion of buy-back.
(4) Every buy-back shall be completed within a period of one year from the date of passing of the special
resolution, or as the case may be, the resolution passed by the Board under clause (b) of sub-section (2).
(5) The buy-back under sub-section (1) may be—
(a) from the existing shareholders or security holders on a proportionate basis;
(b) from the open market;
(c) by purchasing the securities issued to employees of the company pursuant to a scheme of stock option
or sweat equity.
(6) Where a company proposes to buy-back its own shares or other specified securities under this section
in pursuance of a special resolution under clause (b) of sub-section (2) or a resolution under item (ii ) of
the proviso thereto, it shall, before making such buy-back, file with the Registrar and the Securities and
Exchange Board, a declaration of solvency signed by at least two directors of the company, one of whom
shall be the managing director, if any, in such form as may be prescribed and verified by an affidavit
to the effect that the Board of Directors of the company has made a full inquiry into the affairs of the
company as a result of which they have formed an opinion that it is capable of meeting its liabilities and
will not be rendered insolvent within a period of one year from the date of declaration adopted by the
Board.
Provided that no declaration of solvency shall be filed with the Securities and Exchange Board by a
company whose shares are not listed on any recognised stock exchange.
(7) Where a company buys back its own shares or other specified securities, it shall extinguish and physically
destroy the shares or securities so bought back within seven days of the last date of completion of buy-
back.
(8) Where a company completes a buy-back of its shares or other specified securities under this section, it
shall not make a further issue of the same kind of shares or other securities including allotment of new
shares under clause (a) of sub-section (1) of section 62 or other specified securities within a period of six
months except by way of a bonus issue or in the discharge of subsisting obligations such as conversion of
warrants, stock option schemes, sweat equity or conversion of preference shares or debentures into equity
shares.
(9) Where a company buys back its shares or other specified securities under this section, it shall maintain
a register of the shares or securities so bought, the consideration paid for the shares or securities bought
back, the date of cancellation of shares or securities, the date of extinguishing and physically destroying
the shares or securities and such other particulars as may be prescribed.
(10) A company shall, after the completion of the buy-back under this section, file with the Registrar and the
Securities and Exchange Board a return containing such particulars relating to the buy- back within thirty
days of such completion, as may be prescribed.
Provided that no return shall be filed with the Securities and Exchange Board by a company whose shares
are not listed on any recognised stock exchange.
(11) If a company makes any default in complying with the provisions of this section or any regulation made
by the Securities and Exchange Board, for the purposes of clause (f) of sub-section (2), the company shall
be punishable with fine which shall not be less than one lakh rupees but which may extend to three lakh
rupees and every officer of the company who is in default shall be punishable with imprisonment for a term
which may extend to three years or with fine which shall not be less than one lakh rupees but which may
extend to three lakh rupees, or with both.
Disclosure Requirements relating to Buy-Back of Shares or Other Securities in Explanatory Statement to be
Annexed to the Notice of the General Meeting
The explanatory statement to be annexed to the notice of the general meeting pursuant to section 102 in
relation to buy-back of shares or other securities by the private companies and unlisted public companies
shall contain the following disclosures, namely:-
(a) the date of the board meeting at which the proposal for buy-back was approved by the board of
directors of the company;
(b) the objective of the buy-back;
(c) the class of shares or other securities intended to be purchased under the buy-back;
(d) the number of securities that the company proposes to buy-back;
(e) the method to be adopted for the buy-back;
(f) the price at which the buy-back of shares or other securities shall be made;
(g) the basis of arriving at the buy-back price;
(h) the maximum amount to be paid for the buy-back and the sources of funds from which the buy-
back would be financed;
(i) the time-limit for the completion of buy-back;
(j) (i) the aggregate shareholding of the promoters and of the directors of the promoter, where the
promoter is a company and of the directors and key managerial personnel as on the date of the
notice convening the general meeting;
(ii) the aggregate number of equity shares purchased or sold by persons mentioned in sub- clause (i)
during a period of twelve months preceding the date of the board meeting at which the buy-back was
approved and from that date till the date of notice convening the general meeting;
(iii) the maximum and minimum price at which purchases and sales referred to in sub-clause (ii) were
made along with the relevant date;
(k) if the persons mentioned in sub-clause (i) of clause (j) intend to tender their shares for buy- back –
(a) the quantum of shares proposed to be tendered;
(b) the details of their transactions and their holdings for the last twelve months prior to the date of the
board meeting at which the buy-back was approved including information of number of shares
acquired, the price and the date of acquisition;
(l) a confirmation that there are no defaults subsisting in repayment of deposits, interest payment thereon,
redemption of debentures or payment of interest thereon or redemption of preference shares or
payment of dividend due to any shareholder, or repayment of any term loans or interest payable
thereon to any financial institution or banking company;
(m) a confirmation that the Board of directors have made a full enquiry into the affairs and prospects of the
company and that they have formed the opinion-
(i) that immediately following the date on which the general meeting is convened there shall be no
grounds on which the company could be found unable to pay its debts;
(ii) as regards its prospects for the year immediately following that date, that, having regard to their
intentions with respect to the management of the company’s business during that year and to
the amount and character of the financial resources which will in their view be available to the
company during that year, the company shall be able to meet its liabilities as and when they fall
due and shall not be rendered insolvent within a period of one year from that date; and
(iii) the directors have taken into account the liabilities(including prospective and contingent liabilities),
as if the company were being wound up under the provisions of the Companies Act, 2013.
(n) a report addressed to the Board of directors by the company’s auditors stating that-
(i) they have inquired into the company’s state of affairs;
(ii) the amount of the permissible capital payment for the securities in question is in their view properly
determined;
(iii) that the audited accounts on the basis of which calculation with reference to buy back is done is
not more than six months old from the date of offer document; and
(iv) the Board of directors have formed the opinion as specified in clause (m) on reasonable grounds
and that the company, having regard to its state of affairs, shall not be rendered insolvent within a
period of one year from that date.
Prohibition for Buy-Back in Certain Circumstances [Section 70]
1. No company shall directly or indirectly purchase its own shares or other specified securities –
(a) through any subsidiary company including its own subsidiary companies;
(b) through any investment company or group of investment companies; or
(c) if a default, is made by the company, in the repayment of deposits accepted either before or after the
commencement of this Act, interest payment thereon, redemption of debentures or preference shares
or payment of dividend to any shareholder, or repayment of any term loan or interest payable thereon
to any financial institution or banking company.
Provided that the buy-back is not prohibited, if the default is remedied and a period of three years has
lapsed after such default ceased to subsist.
2. No company shall, directly or indirectly, purchase its own shares or other specified securities in case such
company has not complied with the provisions of sections 92, 123, 127 and section 129.
SEBI Guidelines:
The Securities and Exchange Board of India, has issued the following guidelines with regard to buy- back of shares
or other specified securities by companies, having been empowered to do so by the Companies (Amendment)
Act, 1999. These guidelines came into effect from 14-11-1998.
Modes of Buy-Back:
Buy-back is permissible:
(a) from the existing security holders on a proportionate basis through the tender offer; or
(b) from the open market through
i. Book-building process,
ii. stock exchange;
(c) from odd lots, that is to say, where the lot of securities of a public company whose shares are listed
on a recognized stock exchange is smaller than such marketable lot as may be specified by the stock
exchange: or
(d) by purchasing the securities issued to employees of the company pursuant to a scheme of stock option or
sweat equity.
Where a company proposes to buy-back its own shares. It shall after passing the special resolution or resolution of
its Board of Directors make a public announcement in at least one English National Daily one Hindi National Daily
and Regional Language Daily with wide circulation at the place where the registered office of the company is
located.
The public announcement shall specify a date which shall be the ‘specified date’ for the purposes of determining
the names of the shareholders to whom the letter of offer shall be sent. The specified date cannot be earlier
than 30 days and not later than 42 days from the date of such public announcement. The letter of offer shall
be despatched not earlier than 21 days from the submission of its draft with SEBI through the merchant banker.
The date of opening of the offer shall not be earlier than 7 days or later than 30 days after the specified date.
Companies buying back through the tender offer have to open an escrow account.
A company cannot buy-back its shares from any person:
a. through negotiated deals whether on or off the stock exchange; or
b. through spot transactions; or
c. through any private arrangements.
Price at which shares shall be bought back has to be determined by shareholders through a special resolution.
A copy of their resolution has to be filed with the SEBI as well as the stock exchanges where the shares of the
company are listed, within 7 days from the date of passing the resolution. Companies buying back through stock
exchanges should disclose purchases daily. Buy-back offer shall remain open for not less than 15 days and not
more than 30 days. The verification of shares bought back has to be completed within 15 days of the closure of the
offer and payments made within 7 days. The onus of complying with the SEBI guidelines is on the merchant banker
who has to file a ‘due diligence certificate’ with the SEBI.
Escrow Account
Regulation 10(1) of the Securities and Exchange Board of India provides that a company shall, as and by way
of security for performance of its obligations on or before the opening of the offer of re- purchase, deposit in an
escrow account such sum as is specified in 10(2), that is:
(a) If the consideration payable does not exceed ` 100 crores, 25% of the consid eration;
(b) If the consideration payable exceeds ` 100 crores, 25% up to ` 100 crores, and 10% thereafter.
Escrow account means an account in which money is held until a specified duty is performed, i.e., till the
consideration for buy-back of shares is paid to the shareholders. This account consists of cash deposited with a
scheduled commercial bank, or bank guarantee in favour of the merchant banker, or deposit of acceptable
securities with appropriate margin, with the merchant banker, or combination of these.
Advantages of buy-back
Buy-back have the following advantages:
(a) A company with capital, which cannot be profitably employed, may get rid of it by resorting to buy-back,
and re-structure its capital.
(b) Free reserves which are utilized for buy-back instead of dividend enhance the value of the company’s
shares and improve earnings per share.
(c) Surplus cash may be utilized by the company for buy-back and avoid the payment of dividend tax.
(d) Buy-back may be used as a weapon to frustrate any hostile take-over of the company by undesirable
persons.
Accounting for buy-back
Buy-back of shares is just the opposite of issue of shares. Just as shares may be issued at par, at a premium, even
buy-back may be at par, at a premium or at a discount. The basis of accounting for buy-back is Section 68 of the
Amended Companies Act. This Section not only permits a company to buy-back or redeem its equity shares, but
also specifies the sources from out of which re-purchase is to be effected.
According to this Section, a company may buy-back its shares or other specified securities from out of
1. Its free reserves, or
2. The securities premium account, or
3. The proceeds of any shares or other specified securities like employees’ stock option.
However, no buy-back of shares shall be made out of the proceeds of an earlier issue of the same kind of shares.
This Section also lays down that all the shares or other specified securities for buy-back are fully paid up.
As per to Section 69, when a company purchases its own shares out of free reserves. Then a sum equal to the
nominal value of the shares so purchased shall be transferred to the capital redemption reserve account and
details of such transfer should be disclosed in the balance sheet.
Determination of quantum for buy-back. Sec. 68 of Company Act, 2013
The maximum number of shares to be bought back is determined as the least number of shares arrived by
performing the following tests :
(1) Share outstanding test
(2) Resource test
(3) Debt-Equity Ratio test.
(1) Share Outstanding test :
(a) Ascertain the number of shares
(b) 25% of the number of shares is eligible for buy back with the approval of shareholders.
(2) Resource test :
(a) Ascertain sharehooders fund (Capital + Free Reserves)
(b) No. of shares held for buyback
Shareholders funds
=
Buy back price
Illustration 23:
(Where shares are partly paid up)
The BCG Co. Ltd. resolved by a special resolution to buy-back 2,00,000 of its equity shares of the face value of `
10 each on which ` 8 has been paid up. The general reserve balance of the company stood at ` 50,00,000 and
no fresh issue of shares was made.
Journalize the transactions.
Solution:
In the Books of BCG Co. Ltd.
Journal Entries
Illustration 24:
(Where shares are bought-back at a premium)
The share capital of Beta Co. Ltd consists of 1,00,000 equity shares of ` 10 each, and 25,000 preference shares
of `100 each, fully called up. Its securities premium account shows a balance of `40,000 and general reserve of
` 7,00,000. The company decides to buy-back 20,000 equity shares of ` 12 each.
Pass the necessary journal entries.
Solution:
In the Books of Beta Co. Ltd.
Journal Entries
Date Particulars Debit Credit
(`) (`)
Equity Share Capital A/c Dr. 2,00,000
Securities Premium A/c Dr. 40,000
To Equity Shareholders A/c 2,40,000
(Amount due to equity shareholders for buying-back of 20,000
equity shares)
Equity Shareholders A/c Dr. 2,40,000
To Bank A/c 2,40,000
(Payment to shareholders on account of buy-back)
2,00,000
General Reserve A/c Dr.
2,00,000
To Capital Redemption Reserve A/c
(Transfer of nominal amount of equity shares Bought back.)
Illustration 25:
(Where shares are bought-back at a discount)
The PTC Co. Ltd. has a share capital of ` 15,00,000, comprising 1,00,000 equity shares of ` 10 each and 50,000 8%
preference shares of ` 10 each, both of which fully called up and paid up. The company has sufficient general
reserve to its credit to enable it to comply with the legal formalities connected with buy-back of shares. It decides
to buy-back 20% of its equity share capital at ` 9 per share. Record the transactions in the books of the company.
Solution: In the Books PTC Co. Ltd.
Journal Entries
Illustration 26:
(Fresh issue of shares for purposes of buy-back).
Alpha Co. Ltd. has a paid up equity share capital of ` 20,00,000 in 2,00,000 shares of ` 10 each. It resolved to buy-
back 50,000 equity shares at ` 15 per share. For this purpose. it issued 20,000 12% preference shares of ` 10 each, at
par, payable along with application. The company has to its credit ` 2,50,000 in securities premium account and
` 10,00,000 in the general reserve account. The company utilized the general reserve. Pass the necessary journal
entries.
Solution:
In the Books of Alpha Co. Ltd.
Journal Entries
Illustration 27:
The following was the balance sheet of Diamond Ltd. as at 31st March, 2015.
Liabilities ` in lakhs
10% Redeemable Preference Shares of ` 10 each, fully paid up 2,500
Equity Shares of ` 10 each fully paid up 8,000
Capital Redemption Reserve 1,000
Securities Premium 800
General Reserve 6,000
Profit and Loss Account 300
9% Debentures 5,000
Sundry creditors 2,300
Sundry Provisions 1,000
26,900
Assets
Fixed assets 14,000
Investments 3,000
Cash at Bank 1,650
Other Current assets 8,250
26,900
On 1st April, 2015 the company redeemed all of its preference shares at a premium of 10% and bought back 25%
of its equity shares @ ` 15 per share. In order to make cash available, the company sold all the investments for
` 3,150 lakh and raised a bank loan amounting to ` 2,000 lakhs on the security of the company’s plant.
Pass journal entries for all the above mentioned transactions including cash transactions and prepare the
company’s balance sheet immediately thereafter.
Solution :
Journal Entries
Total 6,000
Total 7,000
Illustration 28:
XYZ Ltd. has the following capital structure on of 31st March 2015.
Particulars ` in Crores
a. Equity Share capital (Shares of ` 10 each) 300
b. Reserves :
General reserve 270
Security Premium 100
Profit and Loss A/c 50
Export Reserve (Statutory reserve) 80
c. Loan Funds 800
The shareholders have on recommendation of Board of Directors approved vide special resolution at their meeting
on 10th April 2015 a proposal to buy back maximum permissible equity shares considering the huge cash surplus
following A/c of one of its divisions.
The market price was hovering in the range of `25 and in order to induce existing shareholders to offer their shares
for buy back, it was decided to offer a price of 20% above market.
Advice the company on maximum number of shares that can be bought back and record journal entries for the
same assuming the buy back has been completed in full within the next 3 months.
If borrowed funds were `1200 crores, and 1500 crores respectively would your answer change?
Solution:
Maximum shares that can be bought back
Situation I Situation II
Particulars
Debit Credit Debit Credit
a. Shares bought back A/c Dr. 180 90
To Bank A/c 180 90
[Being purchase of shares from public]
b. Share capital A/c Dr. 60 30
Security premium A/c Dr. 100 60
General reserve A/c (balancing figure) Dr. 20 —
To Shares bought back A/c 180 90
[Being cancellation of shares bought on buy back]
c. General reserves A/c Dr. 60 30
To Capital redemption reserve A/c 60 30
[Being transfer of reserves to capital redemption reserve
to the extent capital is redeemed]
Note: Under situation III, the company does not qualify the debt equity ratio test. Therefore the company cannot
perform the buyback of shares
Working Notes :
WN # 1: Shares outstanding test
Particulars Amount
a. No. of shares outstanding 30 crores
b. 25% of shares outstanding 7.5 crores
Particulars Amount
a. Paid up capital 300
b. Free reserves [270+100+50] 420
c. Shareholders fund (a+b) 720
d. 25% of shareholders fund 180
e. Buyback price per share ` 30
f. Number of shares that can be bought back 6 Crores
Preference shares that can be redeemed by the company in accordance with the terms of issue are called
Redeemable Preference shares. However the Articles of the company must have the provision in this regard.
The terms of issue generally stipulate the time of redemption and whether the redemption will be at par or premium.
Irredeemable preference shares, on the other hand, are those preference shares which cannot be redeemed
except the event of the company being wound up.
(2) A company limited by shares may, if so authorised by its articles, issue preference shares which are liable
to be redeemed within a period not exceeding twenty years from the date of their issue subject to such
conditions as may be prescribed.
Provided that a company may issue preference shares for a period exceeding twenty years for infrastructure
projects, subject to the redemption of such percentage of shares as may be prescribed on an annual
basis at the option of such preferential shareholders.
(a) Out of the profits of the company or out of the proceeds of a fresh issue of shares made for the purposes
of such redemption;
(c) If redeemed out of the profits of the company, then a sum equal to the nominal amount of the shares
to be redeemed, transfer to the Capital Redemption Reserve Account; and
(d) (i) in case of class of companies on which provision of section 133 is apply, the premium, if any, payable
on redemption shall be provided for out of the profits of the company, before the shares are redeemed.
If premium is payable on redemption of any preference shares issued on or before the commencement
of this Act by any such company shall be provided for out of the profits of the company or out of the
company’s securities premium account, before such shares are redeemed.
(ii) in a case not falling under sub-clause (i) above, if the premium is payable on redemption shall be
provided for out of the profits of the company or out of the company’s securities premium account,
before such shares are redeemed.
(3) Where a company is not in a position to redeem any preference shares or to pay dividend, if any, on
such shares in accordance with the terms of issue (such shares hereinafter referred to as unredeemed
preference shares), it may, with the consent of the holders of three-fourths in value of such preference
shares and with the approval of the Tribunal on a petition made by it in this behalf, issue further redeemable
preference shares equal to the amount due, including the dividend thereon, in respect of the unredeemed
preference shares, and on the issue of such further redeemable preference shares, the unredeemed
preference shares shall be deemed to have been redeemed.
Provided that the Tribunal shall, while giving approval under this sub-section, order the redemption forthwith
of preference shares held by such persons who have not consented to the issue of further redeemable
preference shares.
(4) The capital redemption reserve account may be applied by the company for issue of fully paid bonus
shares to be issued to members of the company.
The company redeemed preference shares on 1st April 2015 at a premium of 10%. You are required to pass journal
entries to record the above.
Solution :
Part I - Journal entries in the books of T Ltd (` in Lakhs)
Sec. 55 was intended to cover the period of transition and will have no significance after the companies fulfill the
requirements stated therein.
1. General reserve
2. Reserve fund
4. Insurance fund
B. Transfer to capital redemption reserve account is not allowed from these profits.
4. Capital reserve
Illustration 30:
Find out in each case what amount shall be transferred to capital redemption reserve account:
Solution:
Explanation:
Amount utilized from the existing sources towards the nominal value of the preference shares redeemed, should
be transferred to Capital Redemption Reserve Account. So, in the above case, the difference of nominal value of
shares redeemed and amount received from nominal value of fresh issue is the transferable amount.
In cases of (b), (c) and (d): `10,00,000 – ` 8,00,000 (from nominal value of fresh issue) i.e. ` 2,00,000.
Illustration 31:
The Balance Sheet of Pixel Ltd. as on 31.12.2014 is given below:
On 1st Jan 2015, fixed assets costing `40 Lakh were sold for `32 Lakh. It was decided that on 1st Feb 2015, company
issued sufficient number of equity shares at par so as to finance redemption and to leaving a balance of `10 Lakh
in the reserve. All the payments were made except to a holder of 10,000 shares who could not be traced. The
company also made bonus issue to the existing equity shareholders in the ratio of 1: 10 as on 31.12.2014. You are
required to pass the necessary journal entries.
Solution:
Workings: Requirement of Fund for Redemption
Requirement 80 16 96
Securities Prem. A/c 15 15
P/L A/c 6 1 7
General Reserve 20 20
Balance fund requirement 60 60
(From fresh issue)
New Issue 60
Actual payment made = (80,000-10,000)*120 = ` 84 Lakh
**Bonus Shares = 10,00,000 × 1/10 = 1,00,000 @ `10 = `10 Lakhs.
Illustration 32:
The balance sheet of G ltd as on 31.12.2018
5,00,000
Assets
Non Current Assets 4,00,000
Current Assets(including Bank balance ` 10,000) 1,00,000
5,00,000
The board of directors decided to redeem the preference shares on 1st January 2019 on the following
conditions.
Issue 4000 equity shares and rupees 50,000 10% debentures.
Redeem preference shares at a premium of 10%.
Raise necessary bank loan to provide funds for redemption and to have rupees 15,000 as balance.
Admit claim of rupees 40,00 for workmen compensation.
Utilise rupees 10,000 out of development rebate reserve for the purpose.
Necessary journal entries assuming that holders of 100 reference shares could not be traced by the company.
Solution:
IN THE BOOKS OF……………
JOURNAL
Note:
Amount to be transferred to CRR:
Nominal value of shares to be redeemed ` 1,00,000
Less : Fresh issue of equity shares ` 40,000
CRR ` 60,000
Illustration 33:
Books of M Limited show the following balances on 31st December 2018
500 8% redeemable preference shares pop ups ` 108, what is ` 70 paid up ` 35,000
Investment ` 1,20,000
On 1st January 2019 the board of directors decided to redeem the preference shares at a premium of 8%. In order
to pay of preference shareholders the company also decided to sell the Investments and use companies fund
and to raise the balance by issue of sufficient number of equity shares of ` 10 each at a premium of rupee 1 per
share subject to leaving a minimum bank balance of ` 9,000 after search Redemption.
Investments web sold at ` 1,08,000
Show the necessary journal entries to record the transactions.
Solution:
IN THE BOOKS OF ………………
JOURNAL
Note :
Amount of cash to be collected from new issue of equity shares = amount payable in redemption + minimum
closing cash balance – (opening bank balance + sale of investment) = ` [2,70,000 + 9,600 - (39,600 + 1,08,000)] =
` (2,79,600 - 1,47,600) = ` 1,32,000.
Therefore, number of shares to be issued will be = 132000/ (10+1) = 1200
Value per share = 10 +1 (including premium of Re.1)
Requirement
The long-term requirements of capital are raised by any company primarily through issue of shares and debentures.
While the shareholders are essentially the owners of the enterprise, those who buy debentures are creditors for
long-term funds and do not enjoy voting rights. In brief all securities other than shares issued by a company will
come under the term debentures.
According to the guidelines issued by the Controller of Capital Issues, the objects of the issue can be among other
things:
1. Setting up of new projects;
2. Expansion or diversification of existing projects;
3. Normal capital expenditure for modernization;
4. To augment long-term resources of the company for working capital requirements;
5. Merger /Amalgamation of companies in pursuance of schemes approved by banks, financial institutions
and/or any legal authority;
Differences between Shares and Debentures
SHARES DEBENTURES
Status A shareholder is the owner and a member of the A debenture holder is not a member but
company. a creditor.
Return A shareholder may receive dividend only when a A debenture holder has a right to interest
company makes a profit. even if the company does not make profit.
Rate of return Dividend rate can vary depending on the profit Debenture carries a fixed rate of interest.
position.
Accounting Dividend is given out of appropriable profit and Debenture interest is chargeable to Profit
treatment not chargeable to Profit and Loss account. and Loss account.
Redemption In the case of shares, the concept of redemption Debentures are normally redeemable
does not apply. However as per the recent although a company can issue perpetual
change in the companies Act, a company can debentures
buy back shares in accordance with the provisions
in the Act.
Voting rights A shareholder has voting rights. A debenture holder cannot have voting
rights.
Status at the At the time of winding up share holders have At the time of winding up debenture holders
time of wind- the least priority regarding the return of amount have a priority over the share holders
ing up due to them. regarding the return of amount due to them
ISSUE OF DEBENTURES
Debenture [Section 71]
1. A company may issue debentures with an option to convert such debentures into shares, either wholly or
partly at the time of redemption.
Provided that the issue of debentures with an option to convert such debentures into shares, wholly or partly,
shall be approved by a special resolution passed at a general meeting.
Provided that the following classes of companies may issue secured debentures for a period exceeding ten
years but not exceeding thirty years,
(i) Companies engaged in setting up of infrastructure projects;
(ii) ‘Infrastructure Finance Companies’ as defined in clause (viia) of sub-direction (1) of direction 2 of Non-
Banking Financial (Non-deposit accepting or holding) Companies Prudential Norms (Reserve Bank)
Directions, 2007;
(iii) ‘Infrastructure Debt Fund Non-Banking Financial companies’ as defined in clause (b) of direction 3 of
Infrastructure Debt Fund Non-Banking Financial Companies (Reserve Bank) Directions, 2011.
b. such an issue of debentures shall be secured by the creation of a charge, on the properties or assets of the
company, having a value which is sufficient for the due repayment of the amount of debentures and interest
thereon;
c. the company shall appoint a debenture trustee before the issue of prospectus or letter of offer for subscription
of its debentures and not later than sixty days after the allotment of the debentures, execute a debenture
trust deed to protect the interest of the debenture holders ; and
d. the security for the debentures by way of a charge or mortgage shall be created in favour of the debenture
trustee on-
a. any specific movable property of the company (not being in the nature of pledge); or
b. any specific immovable property wherever situate, or any interest therein.
SEBI Regulations on Issue of Debentures
1. Credit rating. It is compulsory in the case of all issues of debenture. If a company has obtained more than one
rating, all such ratings must be disclosed. If the issue exceeds ` 200 crores, rating must be obtained from two
agencies.
2. Put and call options. If FCDs are to be converted before 18 months, they are considered as quasi- equity. If
conversion is after 18 months but before 36 months, it is treated as deferred equity. In the case of deferred
equity, the conversion will be optional in the hands of debenture holder. In the case of conversion beyond
36 months, it must be made optional with both put and call options.
3. Security for debentures. If secure debentures are issued, a company must obtain certificate from the bankers
that the assets are free from encumbrances or no objection certificate from the bank/financial institution for
creating a second charge or pari passu charge as per terms of offer of debentures. Normally security must
be created within 6 months. If security is not created, within 12 months, a penal interest at 2% is payable to
debenture holders. If the security is not created, within 18 months, a meeting of the debenture holders must
be called with 21 days notice to explain the reasons for delay in creating the security and the expected date
by which security will be created.
Trustees to debentures will supervise the creation of security. If security is not created, the debentures will be
unsecured. As stated earlier in such a situation, the debentures will be treated as fixed deposits which makes
it incumbent to satisfy the requirements of Sec. 73 & 74.
4. Debenture trustees. If the maturity of debentures is more than 18 months, the company has to appoint
debenture trustees to safeguard the interests of the debenture holders. The trustees should have requisite
powers for protecting the interests of the debenture holders including their rights to nominate a director on
the board in consultation with institutional debenture holders.
The debenture trustees must also ensure the compliance of the following:
a. Lead financial institutions / investment institutions should monitor the progress in respect of debentures raised
for project finance/modernization/ expansion/ diversification/ normal capital expenditure.
b. The lead bank must monitor debentures raised for working capital funds.
c. Obtain a certificate from the company’s auditors during the implementation period of the projects and in
the case of debentures for working capital at the end of each accounting year.
d. Debenture issues by companies belonging to the groups for financing replenishing of funds or acquiring
shares in other companies should not be permitted.
e. The trustees must supervise the implementation of the conditions regarding creation of security for the
debentures and debenture redemption reserve.
Accounting Aspects of Issue
Accounting aspects of issue of debenture may be studied from three different sides.
1. What would be the consideration?
a. Issued for cash
b. Issued for consideration other than cash
c. Issued as collateral security
2. What would be the issue price?
a. Issued at par
b. Issued at premium
c. Issued at discount
3. How the redemption be made.
a. Redeemed at par
b. Redeemed at premium
c. Redeemed at discount
Combining (2) and (3), the following are the options of issue:
a. Issued at par and redeemable at par
b. Issued at discount and redeemable at par
c. Issued at premium and redeemable at par
d. Issued at premium and redeemable at premium
e. Issued at par and redeemable at premium
f. Issued at discount and redeemable at premium
The accounting entries for the above six combinations are given in the table below.
Transaction Account
Debited Credited
A. Issued at par and redeemable at Par Bank Debentures
B. Issued at discount and redeemable Bank Debentures
at par Discount on issue of debentures
C. Issued at premium and redeemable Bank Debentures
at par Security Premium
D. Issued at premium and redeemable Bank Debentures A/c
at premium Loss on issue of debenture Security Premium
Prem. On redemption of
debentures.
Illustration 34:
Journalize the following transactions. Narration is not required:
Issue of 12% 1,00,000 debentures of ` 100 each
1. at par and redeemable at par.
2. at 10% discount and redeemable at par.
3. at 10% premium and redeemable at par.
4. at 10% premium and redeemable at a premium of 5%.
5. at par and redeemable at a premium of 5%.
6. at 10% discount and redeemable at a premium of 5%.
Solution:
Journal
Illustration 35:
(For consideration other than cash).
The XYZ Company Ltd. took over assets of ` 230 Lakh and liabilities of ` 30 Lakh of PQR Company Ltd. for the
purchase consideration of ` 220 Lakh. The XYZ Company Ltd. paid the purchase consideration issuing debentures
of ` 100 each at 10% premium. Give journal entries in the books of the XYZ Company Ltd.
Solution:
Journal of XYZ Company Ltd.
a. First Method
No entry is made in the books. On the liability side of the balance sheet below the item of loan a note that it
has been secured by the issue of debentures is to be given. This is shown in the balance sheet as follows:
b. Second method
Sometimes issue of debentures as collateral security is recorded by making a journal entry as follows:
Debenture Suspense Account Dr. (This appears on the assets side)
To Debenture Account (This appears on the liabilities side)
When the loan is paid the above entry is cancelled by means of a reverse entry.
REDEMPTION OF DEBENTURES
Meaning
Redemption of debentures is the process of discharging the liability on account of debentures in accordance
with the terms of redemption stated in the debenture trust deed. Discharge of debenture liability is usually by
paying cash to the debenture holders. But this can take other forms such as conversion or rollover. In the case of
conversion debentures are converted into preference shares or equity shares. Rollover refers to the issue of new
debentures, in exchange for the old ones. Both conversion and rollover are subject to detailed SEBI guidelines.
When a company issues debentures it must also plan the resources required for such redemption. This can be
done by setting aside profits every year and investing them wisely in investments outside, so that there will be no
liquidity problem at the time of redemption. Alternatively the company can take an insurance policy by paying
regular premium, so that the policy matures coinciding with the time of redemption. With the amount received
on the maturity of policy the company faces no problem in carrying out the redemption. These are the two
ways in which a company can make provisioning for redemption of debentures. The question of provisioning was
earlier left to the discretion of company and many companies did provisioning routinely, as a matter of financial
prudence. Now under the SEBI guidelines, the matter is no more a matter of discretion or financial prudence. SEBI
guidelines provide for compulsory provisioning and also restrictions on the payment of dividends till debentures
are redeemed. We will first deal with SEBI guidelines before proceeding with the accounting aspects of creating
sinking fund for redemption of debentures.
SEBI on Creation of Debenture Redemption Reserve (DRR)
1. A company has to create DRR in case of issue of debentures with maturity of more than 18 months.
2. The issuer must create DRR in accordance with the provisions given below.
a. If debentures are issued for project finance DRR can be created upto the date of commercial production.
b. The DRR in respect of debentures issued for project finance may be created either in equal installments or
higher amounts if profits so permit.
c. In the case of PCDs, DRR must be created for the non-convertible portion of debenture issues on the same
lines as applicable for fully non-convertible debenture issue.
d. In respect of convertible issues by new companies, the creation of DRR must commence from the year the
company earns profits for the remaining life of debentures.
e. DRR shall be treated as part of general reserve for consideration of bonus issue proposals and for price
fixation related to post-tax return.
f. Company must create DRR equivalent to 50% of the amount of debenture issue before debenture
redemption commences. Only after the company has actually redeemed 10% of the debenture liability,
drawl from DRR is permissible only after the company has actually redeemed 10% of the debenture
liability. The requirement of creation of DRR is not applicable to issue of debt instruments by infrastructure
companies.
DEBENTURE REDEMPTION RESERVE [DRR] [RULE 18 (7)]
• DRR is the reserve created out of profits for the purpose of redemption of debentures.
• As per Rule 18(7) of The Companies Act, 2013, a company is required to transfer adequate amounts out of its
profits every year to the Debenture Redemption Reserve until such debentures are redeemed.
• This reserve must be created before the redemption starts.
• Debenture Redemption Reserve Account must have a credit balance of at least an amount equal to 25% (as
per MCA Circular no. 04/2013 dated 11.02.2013) of the value of Debentures issued at the time of redemption
of debentures.
Example: Vividha Ltd issued Debentures of `5 crores with the condition to start redemption in the third year.
In such a case, before the debenture redemption begins in 3rd year, the Debenture Redemption Reserve
Account must have a balance of at least `5 crores x 25% = `1.25 crore.
• This reserve is required to be created only in case of Non-convertible Debentures (NCD) and Non-convertible
portion of Partly Convertible Debentures (PCD).
• Debenture Redemption Reserve Account appears under the head “Shareholders’ Funds” and Sub-head
‘Reserves & Surplus’ in the Balance Sheet. After completion of redemption of all the debentures, DRR account
is closed by transferring it to the General Reserve.
• As per Rule 18 (7) Creation of Debenture Redemption Reserve is not mandatory for:
Fully Convertible Debentures
Debentures issued by All India Financial Institutions regulated by RBI.
Debentures of Banking Companies
Debentures issued by NBFCs registered with RBI on private placement basis.
• Creation of Debenture Redemption Reserve is also not mandatory for
Debentures with a maturity period of 18 months or less.
Infrastructure Companies (i.e., companies engaged in the business of developing, maintaining and
operating infrastructure facilities)
Example.
Mahan Ltd. issued 20,000 10% Debentures of `100 each at a premium of 8% on 1st April, 2016 redeemable on
31st August, 2017. How much amount of Debenture Redemption Reserve is to be created before redemption of
debentures?
Solution:
As per SEBI Guidelines, No Debenture Redemption Reserve is required to be created since maturity period of
debentures does not exceed 18 months but as per Rule 18(7) of The Companies Act, 2013, at least `5,00,000 (i.e.,
25% of ` 20,00,000) must be transferred to Debenture Redemption Reserve.
Example.
Bilton Ltd. (An infrastructure Company) has outstanding 20,000, 12% Debentures of `100 each issued on 1st Oct.,
2015 due for redemption on 31st March, 2017 at 10% Premium.
(a) How much minimum amount of Debenture Redemption Reserve should be created as per MCA clarification?
(b) State the amount required to be deposited/invested in the year of redemption.
(c) Pass the Journal Entries during the years of issue and redemption of Debentures without providing for the
Interest and Loss on issue of Debentures.
Solution:
As per SEBI Guidelines, infrastructure companies are exempted from creating Debenture Redemption Reserve
(DRR).
(a) As per Rule 18(7), the minimum amount to be transferred to Debenture Redemption Reserve will be `5,00,000
(i.e. 25% of `20,00,000).
(b) As per Rule 18(7), the minimum amount to be invested will be ` 3,00,000 (i.e. 15% of `20,00,000).
(c) Journal Entries —
Restrictions on Dividends
a. In the case of new company, distribution of dividends shall require the approval of trustees to the issue of
debentures and lead institution, if any.
b. In the case of existing companies prior permission-of the lead institution for declaring dividend exceeding
20% or as per the loan covenants is necessary if the company does not comply with institutional condition
regarding interest and debt coverage ratio.
c. Dividends may be distributed out of profits of particular year only after transfer of requisite amount in DRR. If
residual profits are inadequate to distribute reasonable dividends, company may distribute dividend out of
general reserve.
As mentioned already the two modes of provisioning are (1) the sinking fund method, and (2) the insurance policy
method.
It is always prudent for a company to save money for redeeming debentures on the due date. In the absence of
such a provision it becomes difficult for the company to find lumpsum amount to repay the debt. This can be done
by adopting any of the two methods explained below:
The methods of redemption of Debentures are as follows:
Payment in Lumpsum
As per this method, the payment of entire debt is made in one lot on expiry of a specified period (i.e., at maturity)
or before the expiry of the specified period after passing the necessary resolution at the meeting of debenture-
holders.
Example: Shiva Petroleum has made the payment of its convertible debentures (i.e., Triple Option Convertible
Debentures) before the expiry of the specified period.
Payment in Installments
As per this method, the payment of specified portion of debt is made in installments at specified dates.
Example: A Debenture of `100 may be discharged as given below:
30% on 1.1.2012, 30% or `30 on 1.1.2014, 20% or `20 on 1.1.2016, 20% or `20 on 1.1.2018
Conversion
The conversion of debentures means the debentures are converted into preference shares or equity shares.
For the purpose of conversion debentures are to be classified as fully convertible debentures (FCDs), partly
convertible debentures (PCDs), and non-convertible debentures (NCDs). A company cannot issue FCDs having
a conversion period of more than 36 months, unless the conversion is made optional with a put and call option.
If conversion takes place 18 months after the date of allotment but before 36th months, any conversion in part or
whole of the debenture is optional in the hands of the debenture holder. If he does not exercise the option it will
effectively become an NCD. FCDs with conversion period less than 12th months are treated as quasi-equity and
are treated at par with equity.
FCDs are fully convertible into equity shares either at par or premium. The premium to be charged at conversion
must be predetermined and announced in the prospectus. In the case of PCDs it comprises two parts, namely the
convertible portion and the non-convertible portion.. It is only the convertible portion that would be converted
into shares.
In the case of NCDs the liability will be discharged by payment of cash or rollover. A company can also convert
NCDs at a later date into equity shares but it should be at the option of debenture holder.
Rollover
Rollover means the issue of new debentures in the place of old ones. Rollover must be with the written consent of
the debenture holder. If he does not given written consent, his claim must be settled in cash. Also whenever the
debenture liability is rolled over company must obtain fresh credit rating. Fresh trust must be executed at the time
of rollover. Also fresh security must be created in respect of rolled over debentures. Subject to the conditions listed
rollover can be done without change in the’ interest rate if the non-convertible portion of PCDs/ NCDs of a listed
company exceeds ` 50 lakhs.
Sources of redemption
From the point of view of sources redemption may be carried out with the help of any of the following sources:
1. Out of capital,
2. Out of profits,
3. Conversion or rollover
Last year
1. Bank A/c Dr.
To Sinking fund interest A/c
(Interest on sinking fund investment received.)
2. Sinking fund interest A/c Dr.
To Sinking fund A/c
(Transfer of interest account to sinking fund.)
3. Profit and loss appropriation A/c Dr.
To Sinking fund A/c
(Setting aside the required amount based on sinking fund table)
It may be noted that in the final year the amount appropriated from the profits of the company and the amount
received as interest on sinking fund investment are not invested, as the amount would be needed on the following
day for the redemption of debenture.
On Redemption of Debentures
14% Debentures A/c Dr. 1,90,000
Premium on Redemption of Debentures A/c Dr. 19,000
To Debenture-holders’ A/c
(Being the amount due on redemption)
2,09,000
Debenture –holders A/c Dr. 2,09,000
To Equity Share Capital A/c 2,09,000
(Being the issue of 20,900 equity shares of `10 each at par on conversion
of 1900 Debentures
Illustration 36:
A company issued 100,000 15% debentures of ` 100 each at par redeemable at a premium of 15%. After 8 years
the company served notice of redemption and redeemed all debentures as per the terms of issue. You are
required to make entries at the time of issue and at the time of redemption.
Solution:
Journal
Illustration 37:
A Company issued 100,000 debentures of ` 100 each redeemable at the end of 10th year, but reserves the right to
redeem earlier from the end of 5th year. The company decides at the end of 5th year to redeem 20,000 debentures
out of profits it has made.
Pass necessary journal entries relating to redemption.
Solution:
Conversion or rollover
In the case of conversion debentures are converted into equity or preference shares. In the case of rollover old
debentures or replaced by the issue of new debentures. The new shares may be issued at par or premium.
Additional accounting entries for conversion or rollover are as below:
Conversion into shares at par Deb. redemption/ Deb. Holders a/c Equity/ Preference share capital
Illustration 38:
On April 1, 2011 PT Ltd. issued 25,00,000 12% fully convertible debentures of ` 100 each at par. The debenture
holders were given the call option to convert the debentures into ` 10 equity shares at a premium of ` 40 per share
on or after July 1, 2015. On April 1, 2016, debenture holders holding 10,00,000 debentures exercised their option.
Pass the necessary journal entries.
Solution:
Illustration 39:
Beta Ltd. had issued 11% 5,00,000 debentures of ` 100 each redeemable on 31st March 2015 at a premium of 5%.
The company offered three options to debenture holders as under:
(i) 13% Preference shares of ` 10 each at ` 10.50
(ii) 14% debentures of ` 100 at par.
(iii) Redemption in cash.
The options were accepted as under.
Option (i) by holders of 1,00,000 debentures.
Option (ii) by holders of 1,00,000 debentures.
Option (iii) by holders of 3,00,000 debentures.
The company carried out the redemption. Pass the necessary journal entries.
Solution:
When to be redeemed?
Time of redemption can be classified in the following three ways:
1. Redemption by annual drawings even before the maturity of debentures.
2. Purchases of debentures from the open market and canceling them immediately or later.
3. Redemption only on maturity.
Redemption by Annual Drawings
SEBI guidelines state that the issuing company shall redeem the debentures as per the offer document. A company
at the time of issue may provide for staggered redemption. This can be done in two ways. The redemption may
be certain amount of each debenture with a schedule so that redemption may be completed over a time frame.
The other way is to select certain number of debentures every year and redeem them fully. The debentures to be
redeemed are selected by drawing a lot annually. This method is known as ‘Redemption by Annual Dr. awings’.
Again whether the redemption is at par, premium or discount, depend on the terms of offer. nowadays it is also
common for companies to have a call option which gives them the right to redeem the debentures at a pre-
determined price. This gives them the right to cancel but not the obligation to cancel.
Purchase and Cancellation of Own Debentures
Debentures may also be cancelled before the expiry of the period by purchasing them from the open market
at market price, which may be at premium or discount to the book value. It is certainly advantageous to buy
when they are selling in the market at a discount. Cancellation of debentures may be done immediately or later.
In some cases such debentures may also be reissued. This method of redemption is known as ‘purchase and
cancellation of own debentures’.
For purchase and cancellation of own debentures, the company have to consider the following parameters.
1. The company may cancel such debentures immediately or carry them as an investment and cancel at a later
date.
2. Where they are immediately cancelled, a debenture liability is extinguished to the extent of par value of the
debentures cancelled. From the date of cancellation, interest is not payable on cancelled debentures.
3. Since the debenture liability cancelled is more than the amount paid for such debentures, profit on cancellation
of debentures should be recorded. If there is a Sinking Fund, such profit is transferred to the Sinking Fund.
4. When debentures are carried as an investment, debenture liability is shown as before and at the same time,
‘Investment in own Debentures’ or simply ‘Own Debentures’ appears on the assets side of the balance sheet,
till they are cancelled.
5. In the case of own debentures, interest on own debentures must be reckoned as income or set-off against the
gross interest payable on the whole of debentures.
6. If debentures are purchased between two interest dates, and not immediately after payment of interest, then
the price paid for debentures depends on the quotation.
Accounting Entries
Transaction DR CR
(8) Interest on own debentures Profit and Loss A/c Sinking Fund
Illustration 40:
On 1st April, 2014 A Ltd. made an issue of 10,00,000 14% debentures of ` 100 each at ` 98 per debenture. According
to the terms of issue, commencing from 2016, the company should redeem 10000 debentures either by purchasing
them from the open market or by drawing lots at par at the company’s option. Profit, if any, on redemption is to
be transferred to capital reserve. The company’s accounting year ends on 31st March. Interest is payable on 30th
Sep and 31st March.
During 2014-15, the company wrote off 20% of debenture discount account.
During 2017-18, the company purchased and cancelled the debentures as given below:
Give the journal entries in the books of A Ltd. for both the years, i.e., 2014-15 and 2017-18.
Solution:
17-18
30-9-17 Debentures interest A/c Dr. 70
70
To Bank A/c
30-9-17 Own debentures A/c Dr. 190
To Bank A/c 190
30-9-17 14 % Debentures A/c Dr.
200
To Own debentures A/c 190
To Capital Reserve A/c 10
31-3-18 Debentures interest A/c Dr. 56
To Bank A/c 56
Illustration 42:
Z Ltd. issued 2,500, 10% Debentures of ` 100 each a premium of 10% payable ` 20 on application, ` 50 on allotment
(including premium) and the balance on first & final call. The public applied for 3,500 debentures. Applications
for 2,250 debentures were accepted in full, application for 500 were allotted 250 debentures and remaining
applications were rejected. All moneys were duly received.
Required: Journalise these transactions.
Working Notes:
(i) The amount by which the purchase consideration exceeds the value of the net assets (i.e. the difference
between the agreed value of the assets taken over and the agreed amount of liabilities taken over) has
been debited to Goodwill Account.
(ii) Calculation of No. of Debentures to be issued in each case.
Illustration 45:
C Ltd. secured a loan of ` 8,00,000 from the Axis Bank by issuing 1,000, 12% Debentures of ` 1000 each as collateral
security.
Required: How will you treat the issue of such debentures?
Solution:
1. First Method
An Extract of Balance Sheet of C Ltd. as at...
Liabilities ` Assets `
Non-Current Liabilities:
Loan from Axis Bank 8,00,000
Liabilities ` Assets `
Non-current Liabilities:
Loan from Axis Bank
(Secured by the issue of 1,000, 12% debentures of `1,000
each as collateral security) 8,00,000
Illustration 46:
Give Journal entries in each of the following alternative cases assuming the face value of a debenture being `
100.
(a) A debenture issued at ` 100 repayable at ` 100
(b) A debenture issued at ` 95 repayable at ` 100
(c) A debenture issued at ` 105 repayable at ` 100
(d) A debenture issued at ` 100 repayable at ` 105
(e) A debenture issued at ` 95 repayable at ` 105
(f) A debenture issued at ` 90 repayable at ` 95
Solution:
Journal
Illustration 47:
On 01.04.14, P Ltd. issued 1,000, 15% Debentures of ` 100 each at a discount of 10% redeemable at par.
Required: Show the Discount on Issue of Debentures A/c if (a) such debentures are redeemable after 4 years,
and (b) such debentures are redeemable by equal annual drawings in 4 years. A Ltd. follows financial year as its
accounting year.
Solution:
(a) When such debentures are redeemable after 4 years:
(b) When such debentures are redeemable by equal annual drawings in 4 years:
Total 10
10,000 10,000
6,000 6,000
1,000 1,000
Illustration 48:
Y Ltd. issued 500, 15% Debentures of ` 1000 each at 8% discount repayable asunder:
2 ` 50,000
3 ` 1,00,000
4 ` 1,50,000
5 ` 2,00,000
Required: Calculate the amount of discount to be written off each year assuming that the company closes its
accounts on calendar year basis.
Solution:
Statement Showing the Debenture Discount to be Written off Each Year
Year Face Value of Deb. Period of Use Product Ratio Amount of Discount
(in lakhs) (Month) D = B×C E to be w/o
A B C ` 40,000 × E/40
Total 40
Illustration 49:
On 01.01.2015 E Ltd. issued 500, 10% Debentures of ` 100 each, at a discount of 10% redeemable at a premium of
10%.
Required: Show the ‘Loss on Issue of Debentures A/c’, if (i) such debentures are redeemable after 4 years, and
(ii) such debentures are redeemable by equal annual drawings in 4 years. E Ltd. follows calendar year as it
accounting year.
Solution:
Loss on Issue at Discount = 10%; Loss on Redemption at premium = 10%
∴ Total Loss = 20%
Year ended on Face Value of Deb. Period of Use Product D = B Ratio Amount of Discount to
A used B (Month) C × C, D E be w/o 10,000 × E/10
2,10,000 2,10,000
3,31,000 3,31,000
3,40,000 3,40,000
Working Note:
(i) Calculation of the amount of profit set aside `
Year a Opening Balance b Interest c= b×10/100 Saving d Investments Closing Balance f=b+e
e=c+d
2014-15 — — 1,00,000 1,00,000 1,00,000
2015-16 1,00,000 10,000 1,00,000 1,10,000 2,10,000
2016-17 2,10,000 21,000 1,00,000 1,21,000 3,31,000
2017-18 3,31,000 33,100 1,00,000 — —
Illustration 51:
On 01.01.2015, Hello Ltd. issued 500, 15% Debentures of ` 300 each at a discount of 10%, redemable at a premium of
10% after 4 years. It was decided to take out an Insurance Policy to provide the necessary funds for the redemption
of the debentures. The annual premium for the policy, payable on 1st January every year, was ` 40,000. The sum
assured of the policy was ` 1,65,000.
Required: Give the necessary journal entries. [Ignore Debenture Interest]
Solution: Journal
REDEMPTION BY CONVERSION
Illustration 52:
On 1st January, 2015, CARGO Ltd. issued 2,000, 10% Debentures of ` 250 each at ` 225 each. Debenture- holders
were given an option to get their debentures converted into equity shares of ` 50 each at a premium of ` 25 per
share. On 31st December, 2015, one year’s interest had accrued on these debentures which was not paid. A
holder of 200 debentures informed that he wanted to exercise the option for conversion of debenures into equity
shares. The company, therefore, accepted his request and redeemed these 200 debentures by issuing him equity
shares. The interest, however, on these 200 debentures was paid to the debenture holder. Pass the necessary
journal entries.
Solution: Journal
Illustration 53:
On 01.01.2015, Hudco Ltd. issued 1,000, 15% Convertible Debentures of ` 200 each at a discount of 5% redeemable
at par after 4 years by converting their holdings into equity shares of ` 100 each at a premium of 25%. As per terms
of issue, the holders of these Debentures also have an option to convert their holdings as aforesaid at any time
after 6 months but within 3 years. On 31.12.2015, a holder of 250 Debentures notified his intention to exercise the
option.
Requirements: (a) Give Journal entries as on 01.01.2015 and 31.12.2015 and on 31.12.2016 (ignoring interest), and
(b) Prepare the Balance Sheet as on 31.12.2016 (showing related items only).
Solution: Journal
Liabilities ` Assets `
Shareholders Fund:
Equity Shares of ` 100 each fully paid up 38,000
Reserves & Surplus:** 2,000
Non-current Liabilities:
750, 15% Debentures of ` 200 each 1,50,000
New Shares have been issued exactly equal to be amount actually received (i.e., Net of discount) at the time of
issue of Debentures, otherwise it would amount to an issue of shares at discount indirectly without complying with
the provision of Sec. 53 of the Companies Act, 2013.
Journal of X Ltd.
Underwriting is an agreement, with or without conditions, to subscribe to the securities of a body corporate when
existing shareholders of the corporate or the public do not subscribe to the securities offered to them.
When a company goes in for an Initial Public Offer (IPO), it may face certain uncertainty about whether its Offer
of shares or other securities will be subscribed in full or not. If the public issue does not get fully subscribed, the
project for which the funds are being raised cannot be implemented. As per law, it is required that if the company
is not able to collect 90% of the offer amount, then it needs to compulsorily return the money to those who have
subscribed to the shares.
To avoid the risk of under-subscription companies may seek the help of a specialized group of risk- redeemers
called Underwriters. The function of the Underwriters is to arrange subscription of floated shares.
If the whole or a certain portion of the shares or debentures of the company are not applied for by the public,
the underwriters themselves apply or persuade others to apply for those shares or debentures. The underwriters, as
risk-takers, are entitled to get commission at prescribed rates.
It can be easily comprehended that when the floated shares are likely to be under-subscribed, the underwriters
come to the forefront. In other cases they remain in the background, acting as catalysts arranger of sale to the
investing public.
Before entering into an agreement with the company, the underwriters assess the following:
(a) worth of the public issue;
(b) Market response to the issue; and
(c) Their own ability to get the issue fully subscribed.
Depending upon the risk assessment of the issue, the underwriters decide on their amount of commission. Owing
to under-subscription, if the issue devalues upon them, the underwriters pay up the required amount and deduct
their commission from that.
From the viewpoint of the issuer company, the following are generally observed:
(a) While selecting underwriters and finalizing underwriting arrangements, lead merchant bankers shall ensure
that the underwriters do not overexpose themselves so that it may become difficult to fulfill underwriting
commitments.
(b) The overall exposure of underwriter(s) belonging to the same group or management in an issue shall be
assessed carefully by the lead merchant banker.
(c) The lead merchant banker shall satisfy themselves about the ability of the underwriters o discharge their
underwriting obligations.
(d) The lead merchant banker shall:
(i) incorporate a statement in the offer document to the effect that in the opinion of the lead merchant
banker, the underwriters’ assets are adequate to meet their underwriting obligations;
(ii) Obtain underwriters’ written consent before including their names as underwriters in the final offer
document.
(e) In respect of every underwritten issue, the lead merchant banker(s) shall undertake a minimum underwriting
obligation of 5% of the total underwriting commitment or ` 25 lacs whichever is less.
(f) The outstanding underwriting commitments of a merchant banker shall not exceed 20 times its Net worth any
point of time.
(g) In respect of an underwritten issue, the lead merchant banker shall ensure that the relevant details of
underwriters are included in the offer document.
It should be noted that as per the latest SEBI Guidelines underwriting is not mandatory.
Under the SEBI rules, no person other than a share broker or merchant banker can act as underwrite unless he
holds a certificate granted by SEBI.
Regarding underwriting, the following disclosures should be made in the Offer Document:
(a) Names and addresses of the underwriters and the amount underwritten by them.
(b) Declaration by board of directors of the issuer company that the underwriters have sufficient resources to
discharge their respective obligations.
Underwriting Agreement
After the determination of the Issue Price and allocation of our Equity Shares but prior to filing of the Prospectus
with ROC, our Company will entered into an Underwriting Agreement with the Underwriters for the Equity Shares
proposed to be offered through this Issue. It is proposed that pursuant to the terms of the Underwriting Agreement,
the BRLMs shall be responsible for bringing in the amount devolved in the event that the Syndicate Members (other
than ESL) do not fulfill their underwriting obligations. Pursuant to the tem1s of the Underwriting Agreement, the
obligations of the Underwriters are several and are subject to certain conditions precedent to closing, as specified
therein.
The Underwriters have indicated their intention to underwrite the following number of Equity Shares: (This portion
has been intentionally left blank and will be filled in before filing of the Prospectus with RoC)
Name and Address of the Underwriter Indicative Number of Equity Amount Underwritten
shares to be underwritten (` in millions)
Running Lead Manager: Kotak Mahindra Capital
Company Ltd. 229,Nariman point, Mumbai-400021, India 27,95,283 2306.1
Citi Group Global India Market Private Ltd 27,95,382 2,306.2
12th Fklhtawar, Nariman Point, Mumbai-400021, India.
Lehman Brothers Securities Private Ltd. 27,95,382 2,306.2
Gee jay House, 11th Level, Plot F Shivsagar Estate Old
Annie Besant Road, Worli Mumbai – 400018, India.
Sub-Underwriters
In order to spread the risk of under-subscription , the principal underwriters may enter into subsidiary agreements
with sub-underwriters. Such agreements are made between the underwriters alone, with the company not being a
party thereto. As per agreement, the company pays commission at a prescribed rate to the principal underwriters,
who in turn, disburse commission to the sub- underwriters. Sometimes an additional commission is paid to the
principal underwriters to encourage sub-underwriting. This is known as over-riding commission. The payment of an
over-riding commission enables the company to deal with one or two underwriters instead of a number of them.
Underwriting Commission
It may be paid in cash or in fully paid-up shares or debentures or a combination of all these. It is paid on the issue
price of the shares or debentures so underwritten. As per the provision of Section 40 of the Companies Act, 2013,
commission is payable if the following conditions are satisfied:
(i) The payment of the commission is authorized by the articles;
(ii) The commission paid or agreed to be paid does not exceed in the case of shares, five per cent of the price
at which the shares are issued or the amount or rate authorized by the articles, whichever is less, and in the
case of debentures, two and a half per cent of the price at which the debentures are issued or the amount
or rate authorized by the articles, whichever is less;
(iii) The amount or rate per cent of the commission paid or agreed to be paid is -
in the case of shares or debentures offered to the public for subscription, disclosed in the prospectus, and in
the case of shares or debentures not offered to the public for subscription, disclosed in the statement in lieu of
prospectus, or in a statement in the prescribed form signed in like manner as a statement in lieu of prospectus
and filled in before the payment of the commission with the Registrar and, where a circular or notices not
being a prospectus inviting subscription for the shares or debentures, is issued, also disclosed in that circular or
notice:
(iv) The number of shares or debentures which persons have agreed for a commission to subscribe absolutely or
conditionally is disclosed in the manner aforesaid; and
(v) A copy ‘If the contract for the payment of the commission is delivered to the Registrar at the time of delivery
of the prospectus or the statement in lieu of prospectus for registration.
(ii) Underwriting commission will not be payable on amounts taken up by the promoters group, employees,
directors, their friends and business associates.
The company while fixing the underwriting commission should ensure that the commission is within the limits
specified by the Central Government as stated in the above table.
Underwriting Agreement
There are two types of underwriting agreement: (a) conditional; and (b) firm.
Conditional underwriting: Under this type of agreement, the underwriter agrees to take up agreed proportion of
shares, not taken up by the public. If the shares are fully subscribed by the public, the underwriter does not take
up any share.
Firm underwriting: Under this type of agreement, the underwriter agrees to take up a specified number of shares
irrespective of the number of shares subscribed for by the public. Unless it has otherwise agreed, the Underwriters’
liability is determined without considering the number of shares taken up ‘firm’ by him.
Accounting Entries
To Underwriter A/c
To Broker A/c
Under Written
Method 1
Under this method, all unmarked applications are divided between the underwriters in the ratio of gross liability of
individual underwriter. For determining the liability of individual underwriter, the following steps are followed:
Step 1 Compute gross liability (if it has not been given) of individual underwriter on the basis of agreed ratio. For
example, X Ltd. issued 1,00,000 Equity shares of ` 10 each. The issue was underwritten as:
A-30%; B -40% and C-30%. Here the gross liability will be: A-30% of 1,00,000 = 30,000 Shares; B-40% of 1,00,000 =
40,000 shares C-30% of 1,00,000 = 30,000 shares.
Step 3 Determine the number of unmarked applications. (Unmarked application = Total applications received less
marked applications). Divide unmarked applications between different underw1iters in the ratio of gross liability
, as per our example, in the ratio of 3:4:3. If the resultant figures are all positive or zero, then stop here. Now these
figures represents the net liability of each underwriter.
If some of the resultant figures are negative, then continue to Step 4.
Step 4 Add all negative figures and divide the resultant between the underwriters having positive figures in the ratio
of gross liability inter se (for details see Illustration 3).
Repeat Step 4 unless all figures are non-negative. Now these figures represent the net liability of each underwriter.
Method 2
Under this method, all unmarked applications are divided between the underwriters in the ratio of gross liability less
marked applications. For determining the liability of individual underwriter, following steps are followed:
Step 1 Compute gross liability in the usual manner (if it has not been given).
Step 2 Subtract marked applications from gross liability of respective underwriters. If some of the resultant figures
are negative, then add all negative figures and divide their sum in the ratio of gross liability inter se (for details, See
Illustration 3 alternative solution).
Step 3 Determine the number of unmarked applications. Divide unmarked applications between different
underwriters in the ratio of gross liability less marked applications, i.e., the resultant figures of Step 2. If the resultant
figures of Step 3 are all positive or zero, then stop here. Now these figures represent the net liability of each
underwriter.
If some of the resultant figures are negative, then continue to Step 4.
Step 4 Add all negative figures and divide their sum between the underwriters having positive figures in the same
ratio of Step 3. Repeat Step 4 unless all figures are non-negative. Now these figures represents the net liability .
Illustration 55:
N Ltd. issued 80,000 Equity Shares which were underwritten as follows:
A 48,000 Equity Shares
B 20,000 Equity Shares
C 12,000 Eqiuty Shares
The above mentioned underwriters made applications for ‘firm’ underwritings as follows:
A 6,400 Equity Shares
B 8,000 Equity Shares
C 2,400 Equity Shares
The total applications excluding ‘firm’ underwriting, but including marked applications were for 40,000 Equity
Shares.
The marked Applications were as under:
A 8,000 Equity Shares
B 10,000 Equity Shares
C 4,000 Equity Shares
(The underwriting contracts provide that underwriters be given credit for ‘firm’ applications and that credit for
unmarked applications be given in proportion to the shares underwritten)
You are required to show the allocation of liability. Workings will be considered as a part of your answer.
Solution:
N Ltd.
Statement showing Liability of Underwriters
Particulars A B C Total
Gross Liability
(No. of shares) 48,000 20,000 12,000 80,000
Unmarked Applications*
(Ratio 48:20:12) 10,800 4,500 2,700 18,000
37,200 15,500 9,300 62,000
Alternatively:
Particulars A B C Total
Working Note:
* Total Applications 40,000 Shares
Marked Applications 22,000 Shares
Unmarked applications 18,000 Shares
Illustration 56:
A joint stock company resolved to issue 10 lakh equity shares of ` 10 each at a premium of ` 1 per share. One lakh
of these shares were taken up by the directors of the company, their relatives, associates and friends, the entire
amount being received forthwith. The remaining shares were offered to the public, the entire amount being asked
for with applications.
The issue was underwritten by P, Q and R for a commission @2% of the issue price, 65% of the issue was underwritten
by P, while Q’s and R’s shares were 25% and 10% respectively. Their firm underwriting was as follows:
P 30,000 shares, Q 20,000 shares and R 10,000 shares. The underwriters were to submit unmarked applications for
shares underwritten firm with full application money along with members of the general public.
Marked applications were as follows:
P 1,19,500 shares, Q 57,500 shares and R 10,500 shares.
Unmarked applications totaled 7,00,000 shares. Accounts with the underwriters were promptly settled. You are
required to:
1. Prepare a statements calculating underwriters’ liability for shares other than shares underwritten firm.
2. Pass journal entries for all the transactions including cash transactions.
Solution:
(i) Statement showing underwriters’ liability for shares other than shares underwritten firm
Particulars P Q R Total
Gross liability 5,85,000 2,25,000 90,000 9,00,000
(9,00,000 shares in the ratio of (65: 25:10)
Less: Allocation of marked application 1,19,500 57,500 10,500 1,87,500
4,65,500 1,67,500 79,500 7,12,500
Less: Unmarked application 4,55,000 1,75,000 70,000 7,00,000
10,500 (7,500) 9,500 12,500
Surplus of Q allocated to P and
R in the ratio 65: 10 (6,500) 7,500 (1,000) –
4,000 – 8,500 12,500
` ` `
Liability amount @ ` 11 44,000 – 93,500
Underwriting commission payable
(Gross liability × ` 11 × 2%) 1,28,700 49,500 19,800
Net Amount payable 84,700 49,500
Net Amount receivable 73,700
Illustration 57:
Maruti Ltd. came out with an issue of 45,00,000 equity shares of ` 10 each at a premium of ` 2 per share. The
promoters took 20% of the issue and the balance was offered to the public. The issue was equally underwritten by
A; B and C
Each underwriter took firm underwriting of 1,00,000 shares each. Subscriptions for 31,00,000 equity shares were
received with marked forms for the underwriters as given below:
A 7,25,000 shares
B 8,40,000 shares
C 13,10,000 shares
Total 28,75,000 shares
The underwriters are eligible for a commission of 5%. The entire amount towards shares subscription has to be paid
along with application. You are required to:
(a) Compute the underwriters liability (number of shares)
(b) Compute the amounts payable or due to underwriters; and
(c) Pass necessary journal entries in the books of Maruti Ltd. relating to underwriting.
Solution:
(a) Computation of liabilities of underwriters (No. of shares):
Particulars A B C
Gross liability 12,00,000 12,00,000 12,00,000
Less: Firm underwriting 1,00,000 1,00,000 1,00,000
11,00,000 11,00,000 11,00,000
Less: Marked applications 7,25,000 8,40,000 13,10,000
3,75,000 2,60,000 (2,10,000)
Less: Unmarked applications distributed to A and B in equal ratio 1,12,500 1,12,500 Nil*
*Alternatively, 2,25,000 unmarked applications may be distributed to all equity and thereafter, O’s surplus can be
transferred to A & B. Result will be the same.
Particulars A B C
Liability towards shares to be subscribed @12 per share 30,90,000 17,10,000 12,00,000
Less: Commission (5% on 12 lakhs shares @12 each) 7,20,000 7,20,000 7,20,000
Net amount to be paid by underwriters 23,70,000 9,90,000 4,80,000
Illustration 58:
H Ltd issued 20,000 Shares which are underwritten as follows: A - 12,000 Shares; B - 5,000 Shares and C - 3,000 Shares.
The Underwriters made applications for firm underwriting as under: A - 1,600 Shares; B - 600 Shares; and C - 2,000
Shares.
The total subscriptions excluding Firm Underwriting but including marked applications were for 10,000 Shares. The
marked applications were: A - 2,000 Shares; B- 4,000 Shares and C - 1,000 Shares.
You are required to show the allocation of liability of the underwriters.
Particulars A B C Total
Less: Unmarked Applications In the ratio of Gross Liability (1,800) (750) (450) (3,000)
Note: Unmarked Applications = 3,000 i.e. Total Applications 10,000 – Marked Applications (2,000+4,000+1,000)
= 7,000. These are distributed in the ratio of Gross Liability i.e.12:5:3.
Illustration 59:
B Limited issued to public 1,80,000 Equity Shares of ` 100 each at par. ` 50 per Share was payable along with
Application and the balance on Allotment. The issue was underwritten equally by L, M and N for a commission of
3%. They agreed for a Firm Underwriting of 10,000 Shares each.
Applications for 1,40,000 Shares excluding Underwriters’ Firm Underwriting were received as below:
Solution:
Statement of Underwriters Liability (Figures in No. of shares)
Particulars L M N Total
Less: Unmarked Applications in the ratio of Gross Liability (4,000) (4,000) (4,000) (12,000)
Amount due to co. at ` 50 per Share (`) 5,00,000 6,37,500 8,62,500 20,00,000
Net amount Due from Underwriters (`) 3,20,000 4,57,500 6,82,500 14,60,000
Note: Unmarked Applications = 12,000 i.e. Total Applications 1,80,000 – Marked Applications (47,500+42,500+38,000)=
1,28,000. These are distributed in the ratio of Gross Liability i.e.1:1:1
Illustrations 60:
A Ltd. with a Capital of ` 10 Lakhs divided into Equity Shares of ` 10 each places its entire issue on the market and
the whole issue has been underwritten as follows
Name of Underwriter S P G M N SA
Number of Shares 30,000 35,000 10,000 15,000 2,000 8,000
All marked forms are to go in relief of the liabilities of the underwriter whose name they bear. The share underwritten
“Firm” are also to be set off against the liabilities of the underwriters. The application received in Marked Forms is
as follows:
Name of Underwriter S P G M N SA
Number of Shares 25,000 23,500 5,500 1,000 1,000 2,000
Applications for 20,000 Equity Shares are received on Unmarked Forms. In addition, there is a Firm Underwriting by
the Underwriters as under
Name of Underwriter S P G M N SA
Number of Shares 500 1,500 7,000 3,000 1,000 4,000
Solution:
Particulars S P G M N SA Total
Gross Liability (given) 30,000 35,000 10,000 15,000 2,000 8,000 1,00,000
Less: Unmarked Applications In 6,000 7,000 2,000 3,000 400 1,600 20,000
the ratio of Gross Liability
Less: Marked Applications (25,000) (23,500) (5,500) (1,000) (1,000) (2,000) (58,000)
Less: Firm underwriting (500) (1,500) (7,000) (3,000) (1,000) (4,000) (17,000)
Add: Firm Underwriting 500 1,500 7,000 3,000 1,000 4,000 17,000
Illustration 61:
L Limited came up with an issue of 20,00,000 Equity Shares of ` 10 each, at par. 5,00,000 equity shares were issued to
the promoters and the balance offered to the public was underwritten by three underwriters P, G and K - equally.
Excluding Firm Underwriting of 50,000 Shares each, subscriptions totaled 12,97,000 Shares including Marked Forms,
which were as under: P-4,25,000 Shares; G-4,50,000 Shares; and K -3,50,000 Shares.
Each of the underwriters had applied for the number of shares covered by Firm Underwriting. The amounts payable
on application and allotment were ` 2.50 and ` 2 respectively. The agreed commission was 5%.
Pass Summary Journal Entries for (1) Allotment of Shares to the Underwriters; (2) Commission due to each of them
d (3) Net Cash Paid and/or Received. (Unmarked application is to be credited to the underwriters equally.)
Solution:
1. Statement of Underwriters Liability (Figures in No. of shares)
Particulars P G K Total
Gross Liability (given) 5,00,000 5,00,000 5,00,000 15,00,000
Less: Unmarked Applications In the ratio of Gross (24,000) (24,000) (24,000) (72,000)
Liability (see note below)
4,76,000 4,76,000 4,76,000 14,28,000
Less: Marked Applications (4,25,000) (4,50,000) (3,50,000) (12,25,000)
51,000 26,000 1,26,000 2,03,000
Less: Firm underwriting (Given) (50,000) (50,000) (50,000) (1,50,000)
1,000 (24,000) 76,000 53,000
Adjustment: Surplus of G transferred to P and K in (12,000) 24,000 (12,000) -
Gross Liability Ratio (equally)
(11,000) - 64,000 53,000
Adjustment: Surplus of P transferred to K 11,000 - (11,000) -
Net Liability - - 53,000 53,000
Add: Firm Underwriting 50,000 50,000 50,000 1,50,000
Note: Unmarked Applications = 72,000 i.e. Total Applications 12,97,000 – Marked Applications (4,25,000 +
4,50,000 + 3,50,000) = 12,25,000. These are distributed in the ratio of Gross Liability.
Illustration 62:
P Limited planned to set up a unit for manufacture of bulk drugs. For the purpose of financing the, unit, the Board
of Directors have issued 15,00,000 Equity Shares of `10 each. 30% of the issue was reserved for Promoters and the
balance was offered to the public. A, B and C have come forward to underwrite the public issue in the ratio of 3:1:1
and also agreed for Firm Underwriting of 30,000, 20,000, 10,000 Shares, respectively. The Underwriting Commission
was fixed at 4%. The amount payable on application was ` 2.50 per share. The details of subscriptions are:
Unmarked Forms were received for 50,000 Shares. From the above, you are required to show the allocation of
liability among underwriters with workings. Also, pass Journal Entries in the books of the Company for:
1. Underwriters’ net liability and the receipt or payment of cash to or from underwriters
2. Determining the liability towards the payment of commission to the Underwriters.
Solution:
Shares offered to public = 15,00,000 – 30% for promoters = 10,50,000 ; to be apportioned as 3:1:1.
1. Statement of Underwriters Liability (Figures in No. of shares)
Particulars A B C Total
Gross Liability (3:1:1) 6,30,000 2,10,000 2,10,000 1,80,000
Less: Unmarked Applications In the ratio of Gross (30,000) (10,000) (10,000) (50,000)
Liability (3:1:1)
6,00,000 2,00,000 2,00,000 10,00,000
Less: Marked Applications (5,50,500) (2,00,000) (1,50,000) (9,00,000)
50,000 - 50,000 1,00,000
Less: Firm underwriting (30,000) (20,000) (10,000) (60,000)
20,000 (20,000) 40,000 40,000
Adjustment: Surplus of B transferred to A and C in 3:1 (15,000) 20,000 (5,000) -
Net Liability 5,000 - 35,000 40,000
Add: Firm Underwriting 30,000 20,000 10,000 60,000
Total Liability (Shares to be subscribe) 35,000 20,000 45,000 1,00,000
Particulars A B C Total
a. Total Liability (incl. Firm underwriting) (Shares) 35,000 20,000 45,000 1,00,000
b. Amount due at 2.50 per share (a × 2.50) 87,500 50,000 1,12,500 2,50,000
c. Amount paid for firm Underwriting at 2.50 pershare (75,000) (50,000) (25,000) (1,50,000)
d. Balance due from Underwriters (b – c) 12,500 Nil 87,500 1,00,000
e. Underwriting Commission payable by company 6,30,000 × 10 2,10,000 × 10 2,10,000 × 10 4,20,000
x 4% = × 4% = × 4%
2,52,000 84,000 = 84,000
f. Amt Due to/(payable by) co. (d – e) (2,39,500) (84,000) 3,500
(ii) ___________ ____________ is that part of the authorized capital which is offered to the public for subscription
is called issued capital.
(iii) The application money to be refunded shall be credited only to the bank account from which the
______________ was remitted.
(iv) When a share is issued at a value greater than its face value it is said to be issued at a _____________.
(v) Except as provided in section 54, a company shall not issue shares at a ______________.
(vii) ___________________ share is permissible from the existing security holders on a proportionate basis through
the tender offer.
Answer:
(x) independent.
(i) As per Sec 2(43) of the Companies Act, 2013, “Free Reserves” mean such reserves which, as per the latest
audited balance sheet of a company, are available for distribution as dividend.
(ii) After the allotment of shares, sometimes a shareholder is not able to pay the further calls and returns
his shares to the company for cancellation. Such voluntary return of shares to the company by the
shareholder himself is called Forfeiture of Shares.
(iii) A Company cannot buy-back its shares from any person through a negotiated deals whether on or off
the stock exchange.
(iv) A company with capital, which cannot be profitably employed, may get rid of it by resorting to buy-
back, and re-structure its capital and it is a disadvantage.
(v) Issue of debentures as a collateral security means issue of debentures as a main security, that is, a security
in addition to the prime security.
(vii) ‘Unmarked’ applications are those applications which bear the stamp of an underwriter.
(viii) The sum which is still to be paid to the Company for a share is known as calls in arrears.
(ix) One of the conditions for issue of sweat equity shares is — not less than one year has, at the date of such
issue, elapsed since the date on which the company had commenced business.
(x) A company limited by shares shall issue any preference shares which are irredeemable.
Answer:
2.1 INTRODUCTION
Financial Statements
Financial
Statement
FRAME WORK
The conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting issued by the IASB has stated the following uses of the general
purpose financial statements by the cross-section of users:
(a) to decide when to buy , hold or sell any equity investment,
(b) to assess the accountability of management,
(c) to assess the ability of the entity to pay and provide other benefits to its employees,
(d) to assess the security for amounts lent to the entity,
(e) to determine taxation policies,
(f) to determine distributable profits and dividends,
(g) to prepare and use national income statistics,
Important shortcoming of financial statements is that they are prepared to meet the common information needs
of a wide range of users. They may fall short of specific information needs of the users.
To meet the above – stated uses, financial statements provide information about an entity’s assets, liabilities, equity,
and income and expenses, including gains and losses, other changes in equity and cash flows. That information,
along with other information in the notes, assists users of financial statements in predicting amount, timing and
degree of certainty of the entity’s future cash flows.
Applicability: As per Section 129 of the company Act,2013, the Schedule III is applicable from 01.04.2014.
Schedule III
Part I Part II
Form of Balance Sheet Form of Statement of profit and Loss
Balance Sheet
Share Application
Shareholders’ Money Pending Non- Current Current Liabilities Non- Current
Current Assets
Funds allotment Liabilities Assets
Break-up of Assets
Assets
(d) In the case of a Company, which falls under more than one of the categories mentioned in (a), (b)
and (c) above, it shall be sufficient compliance with the requirements herein if Purchases, Sales and
Consumption of Raw Material and the Gross Income from Services rendered is shown under broad
head.
(e) In the case of Other Companies, Gross Income derived under broad heads.
(iii) In the case of all concerns having Works-in-Progress, Works-in-Progress under broad heads.
(iv) Reserves – Creation & Utilisation:
(a) The aggregate, if materials, of any amounts set aside or proposed to be set aside, to Reserve, but not
including Provisions made to meet any Specific Liability, Contingency or Commitment known to exist at
the date as to which the Balance – Sheet is made up.
(b) The aggregate, if material, of any amounts withdrawn from such Reserves.
(v) Provision – Creation & Utilisation:
(a) The aggregate, if material, of the amounts set aside to Provisions made for meeting Specific Liabilities,
Contingencies or Commitments.
(b) The aggregate, if material, of the amounts withdrawn from such provisions, as no longer required.
(vI) Expenses, etc: Expenditure incurred on each of the following items, separately for each item:
(a) Consumption of Stores and Spare Parts,
(b) Power and Fuel,
(c) Rent,
(d) Repairs to Buildings,
(e) Repairs to Machinery,
(f) Repairs to Machinery,
(g) Insurance,
(h) Rates and Taxes, excluding, Taxes on Income,
(i) Miscellaneous Expenses.
(vii) Subsidiaries Information:
(a) Dividends from Subsidiary Compani0es.
(b) Provisions for Losses of Subsidiary Companies.
(viii) FOREX Information: The P&L A/c shall also contain by way of a Note the following Information, namely –
(a) Value of Imports Calculated on CIF basis by the Company during the Financial Year in respect of – (I)
Raw Materials, (II) Components and Spare Parts, (III) Capital Goods,
(b) Expenditure in Foreign Currency during the Financial Year on account of Royalty, Know-How, Professional
and Consultation Fees, Interest, and Other Matters,
(c) Total Value if all Imported Raw Materials, Spare Parts and Components consumed during the Financial
Year and the Total Value of all Indigenous Raw Materials, Spare Parts and Components similarly
consumed and the Percentage of each to the Total Consumption,
(d) Amount remitted during the year in Foreign Currencies on account of Dividends with a specific mention
of the total number of Non-Resident Shareholders, the Total Number of Shares held by them on which
the Dividends were due and the year to which the Dividends related.
(e) Earnings in Foreign Exchange classified under the following heads, namely-
• Export of Goods calculated on FOB Basis,
• Royalty, Know-How, Professional & Consultation Fees,
• Interest and Dividend,
• Other Income, indicating the nature thereof.
Note: Broad heads shall be decided taking into account the concept of Materiality and Presentation of True and
Fair view of Financial Statements.
` `
I. EQUITY AND LIABILITIES
For the purpose of this Schedule, the terms used herein shall be as per the applicable Accounting Standards.
Notes to Balance Sheet A Company shall disclose the following in the Notes to Accounts- Details provided
Disclosure Requirement: Schedules Forming Part of Financial Statements/Annual Report
(h) Shares Reserved for issue • Shares under Options generally arise under Promoters or
under Options and Contracts/ Collaboration Agreements, Loan Agreements or Debenture Deeds
commitments for the sale of (including Convertible Debentures), agreement to convert
shares/ Disinvestment, including Preference Shares into Equity Shares, ESOPs or Contracts for supply of
the Terms and Amounts Capital Goods, etc.
• Disclosure is required for the Number of Shares, Amounts and Other
Terms for Shares so reserved. Such options are in respect of Unissued
Portion of Share Capital
(i) For the period of 5 years Disclose only if such event has occurred during a period of 5 years
immediately preceding the date immediately preceding the Current Year Balance Sheet date
as at which the Balance Sheet is • The aggregate number of shares allotted or bought back
prepared- • If the company is in operation for a period of less than 5 years, then
• Aggregate Number & Class disclosure should cover all such earlier financial years
of Shares allotted as Fully PaidNot to disclose the following allotments:
and Up Pursuant t o Contracts • The following allotments are considered as Shares allotted for payment
(s) without payment being being received in cash, and hence should not be disclosed under this
received in Cash Clause – (a) If the subscription amount is adjusted against a bonafide
• Aggregate No. and Class of debt payable in money at once by the Company, (b) Conversion of
Shares allotted as fully Paid up Loan into Shares in the event of default in repayment
by way of Bonus Shares
• Aggregate Number & Class of
Shares bought back
(j) Terms of any Securities Convertible • In case of Compulsorily Convertible Securities, where conversion is done
into Equity/ Preference Shares in fixed tranches, all the dates of conversion have to be considered.
issued along with the earliest • In case of Convertible Debentures/Bonds, etc. for the purpose of
date of conversion in descending simplification, reference may also be made to the terms disclosed
order starting from the farthest under the note on Long-Term Borrowings where these are required to
such date be classified in the Balance Sheet, rather than disclosing the same
against under this Clause.
(k) Calls Unpaid (showing aggregate • Unpaid Amount towards Shares subscribed by the Subscribers of
value of Calls Unpaid by Directors Memorandum of Association should be considered as ‘Subscribed
and Officers) and paid-Up Capital’ in the Balance Sheet and the Debts due from the
Subscribers should be appropriately disclosed as an Asset in the B/Sheet.
Example: Reporting Authorised, Issued, Subscribed, Called up and Paid up Capital including Forfeited Shares:
Authorised Capital: Equity Share 1,00,000 Shares @ ` 100 each = ` 1,00,00,000. Preference Share Capital: 15%
Redeemable Preference Shares, 50,000 Shares @ ` 100 each = ` 50,00,000. 18%, Convertible Preference Shares,
30,000 shares @ ` 100 each = ` 30,00,000
Issued Capital: Equity Share 30,000 Shares @ ` 100 each, fully paid up = ` 30,00,000; 19,800 Equity Shares of `
100 each, ` 80 called up and paid up = ` 15,84,000. Amount received on 200 shares forfeited for non-payment
of allotment and first call of ` 30 and ` 40 each, final call was not made on those shares. Amount payable on
application ` 10 per share. Preference Share Capital: 15% Redeemable Preference Shares, 10,000 Shares @ ` 100
each = ` 10,00,000. 18%, Convertible Preference Shares, 20,000 shares @ ` 100 each = ` 20,00,000
How will this shown in the Workings/Schedules, assuming first year of operation?
Solution:
Share Capital
A. Authorised Capital
B. Issued Capital
Reserves & Surplus shall be classified • Capital Reserve is a Reserve of a Corporate Enterprise which is not
as – available for distribution as Dividend.
(a) Capital Reserves • Profit on Re-issue of Forfeited Shares is basically profit of a Capital
Nature and, hence, it should be credited to Capital Reserve.
(b) Capital Redemption Reserve Capital Redemption Reserve (CRR) is required to be created u/s 55 and
68 (for redemption of PSC and buyback of ESC), subject to conditions
specified in the respective Sections.
(c) Securities Premium Reserve Sch III uses the term “Securities Premium Reserve” but the Act uses the
term “Securities Premium Account”. Hence, the term used in the Act
should be used.
(d) Debenture redemption Reserve Debenture redemption Reserve (DRR) is required to be created u/s 71,
and maintained until such Debentures are redeemed. On redemption of
the Debentures, the amounts no longer necessary to be retained in this
Account should be transferred to the General Reserve.
(e) Revaluation Reserve Revaluation Reserve is a Reserve created on the revaluation of Assets or
Net Assets of an Enterprise represented by the surplus of the estimated
Replacement Cost or estimated market values over the Book Values
thereof.
(f) Share Options Outstanding As per ICAI Guidance Note on ESOP, Share Options Outstanding should
Account be shown as separate line item. Under Sch III, this line item should be
shown separately under Reserves & Surplus.
(g) Other Reserves (specify the nature This includes any other Statutory Reserves, e.g. Tonnage Tax reserve to be
& purpose of each Reserve and created under the Income Tax Act, 1961.
the amount in respect thereof)
(h) Surplus, i.e. balance in Statement Appropriations to the Profit for the year (including carried forward
of P&L disclosing allocations & balance) is to be presented under the main head ‘Reserves and
appropriations such as Dividend, Surplus’. Under Sch III, the Statement of P&L will no longer reflect any
Bonus Shares and Transfer to/from appropriations, like Dividends transferred to Reserves, Bonus Shares, etc.
Reserves etc.
(Additions & Deductions since last
Balance Sheet to be shown under
each of specified heads)
Notes:
1. Fund: A Reserve specifically represented by Earmarked Investments shall be termed as a ‘Fund’.
2. Profit and Loss Account (Dr.): Debit balance Statement of P&L shall be shown as a Negative Figure under
the head ‘Surplus’. Similar, the balance of ‘Reserves & Surplus’, after adjusting Negative balance of Surplus,
if any, shall be shown under the head ‘Reserves & Surplus’ even if the resulting figure is in the negative.
Note: The following details relating to Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises shall be disclosed in the notes:
(a) The principal amount and the interest due thereon (to be shown separately) remaining unpaid to any supplier
at the end of each accounting year;
(b) The amount of interest paid by the buyer in terms of section 16 of the Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises
Development Act, 2006, along with the amount of the payment made to the supplier beyond the appointed
day during each accounting year;
(c) The amount of interest due and payable for the period of delay in making payment (which have been paid
but beyond the appointed day during the year) but without adding the interest specified under the Micro,
Small and Medium Enterprises Development Act, 2006;
(d) The amount of interest accrued and remaining unpaid at the end of each accounting year; and
(e) The amount of further interest remaining due and payable even in the succeeding years, until such date
when the interest dues above are actually paid to the small enterprise, for the purpose of disallowance of a
deductible expenditure under section 23 of the Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises Development Act, 2006.
(f) Explanation – the terms ‘appointed day’, ‘buyer’, ’enterprise’, ‘micro enterprise’, ‘small enterprise’ and
‘supplier’ shall have the same meaning assigned to those under (b),(d),(e),(h),(m) and (n) respectively of
section 2 of the Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises Development Act, 2006.
1. Classification shall be given as –(a) Land, AS-19 excludes Land Leases from its scope. Leasehold Land
(b) Buildings, (c) Plant and Equipment, (d) should be presented as a separate assets class under Tangible
Furniture & Fixtures, (e) Vehicles, (f) Office Assets. Also, Freehold Land should be presented as a separate
Equipment, (g) Others (Specify Nature). asset class.
2. Assets under Lease shall be separately • The term “under lease” should mean – (a) Assets given on
specified under each class of Asset. Operating Lease in the case of Lessor, and (b) Assets held
under Finance Lease in the case of Lessee.
• Leasehold Improvements should continue to be shown as
a separate asset class.
3. Revaluation: Where sums have been written • AS-10 requires disclosure of details such as Gross Book
off on a Reduction of Capital or Revaluation Value of Revalued Assets, Method adopted to compute
of Assets of where sums have been added revalued amounts, Nature of indices used, Year of
on Revaluation of Assets, every Balance appraisal, Involvement of External Valuer, etc. as long as
Sheet subsequent to date of such write- the concerned assets are held by the Enterprise. [but only
off, of addition shall show the Reduced or 5 years period is specified in Sch III]
Increased figures as applicable and shall • AS-10 requirements will prevail.
be way of a Note also show the amount [Note:AS-26 does not permit revaluation of Intangible
of the Reduction or Increase as applicable Assets.]
together with the date thereof for the first
5 years subsequent to the dare of such
Reduction or Increase.
4. Reconciliation: A Reconciliation of the (a) Since reconciliation of Gross and Net Carrying Amounts
Gross and Net Carrying Amounts of each of Fixed assets is required, the Depreciation / Amounts of
Class of Assets at the Beginning and End fixed assets is required, the Depreciation/ Amortization for
of the Reporting period showing Additions, each class of asset should be disclosed in terms of –
Disposals, Acquisitions through Business • Opening Accumulated Depreciation.
Combinations and other Adjustments and • Depreciation/Amortization for the year,
the related Depreciation and Impairment • Deductions/Other Adjustments, and
Losses / Reversals shall be disclosed
• Closing Accumulated Depreciation/ Amortization
separately.
(b) Similar disclosures should also be made for Impairment, if
any, as applicable.
Note: Points 3 and 4 of Tangible Assets is also applicable for Intangible Assets.
To be shown as a separate line item on the face of Capital Advances should be included under Long-Term
Balance Sheet Loans and Advances and hence, cannot be included
under Capital WIP.
To be shown as a separate line item on the face of Intangible Assets under development should be
Balance Sheet disclosed under this head provided they can be
recognized based on the criteria laid down in AS-26.
2. In regard to Investments in the capital of Partnership (a) LP: A LLP is a Body Corporate, and not a Partnership
Firms, the Names of the Firms (with the names of all Firm as envisaged under the Partnership Act, 1932.
their Partners, Total Capital and the Shares of each Hence, disclosures pertaining to Investments, in
Partner) shall be given. Firms will not include LLPs. Investments in LLPs will be
disclosed separately under “Other Investments”.
(b) Change in Constitution: In case of change in
constitution of the Firm during the year, the names
of the Other Partners should be disclosed based on
the position existing as on the date of Company’s
B/s.
(c) Capital:
• The Total Capital of the Firm, to be disclosed,
should be with reference to the Amount of
Capital on the date of the Company’s Balance
Sheet.
• If the Partnership Firm has separate accounts for
Partner’s Capital, Drawings or Current, Loans to
or from Partners, etc. disclosure must be made
with regard to the Total of Capital Accounts
alone, since this is what constitutes the capital
of the Partnership Firm.
3. Investments carried at other than at Cost should be Basis of Valuation: Disclosure for basis of valuation of
separately stated specifying the basis for valuation Non-Current Investments may be either of – (a) Cost,
thereof or (b) Cost less Provision for other than temporary
diminution, or (c) Lower of Cost and Fair Value.
Notes to Accounts:
Contingent liabilities and commitments (to the extent not provided for)
(i) Contingent liabilities shall be classified as:
(a) Claims against the company not acknowledged as debt;
(b) Guarantees;
(c) Other money for which the company is contingently liable.
Additional Information:
1. The stock at 31st March, 2015 (valued at the lower of cost or net realizable value) was estimated to be worth
` 2,00,000.
2. Fixtures, fittings, tools and equipment all related to administration. Depreciation is charged at a rate of 20% per
annum on cost. A full year’s depreciation is charged in the year of acquisition, but no depreciation is charged
in the year of disposal.
3. During the year to 31st March, 2015, the Company purchased equipment of ` 1,20,000. It also sold some fittings
(which had originally cost ` 60,000) for ` 10,000 and for which depreciation of ` 30,000 had been set aside.
4. The average Income tax for the Company is 50%. Factory closure cost is to be presumed as an allowable
expenditure for Income tax purpose.
5. The company proposes to pay a dividend of 20% per Equity Share.
Prepare Hero Ltd.’s Profit and Loss Account for the year to 31st March, 2015 and balance Sheet as at that date in
accordance with the Companies Act, 2013 in the Vertical Form along with the Notes on Accounts containing only
the significant accounting policies.
Solution:
Name of the Company: Hero Ltd.
Balance Sheet as at: 31st March, 2015
Note - Relevant items of Assets/ Liabilities are reflected in Balance Sheet and Schedule III. Hence sub- item not
having any value for the given illustration is not shown/ represented in Balance Sheet.
Name of the Company: Hero Ltd.
Profit and Loss Statement for the year ended: 31st March, 2015 (` in ……..)
IV EXPENSES:
(a) Cost of material consumed
(b) Purchase of products for sale 1,710
(c) changes in inventories of finished goods, work- in- (60)
progress and products for sale (140-200)
(d) Employees cost/ benefits expenses
(e) Finance cost
(f) Depreciation and amortization expenses 148
(g) Product development expenses/Engineering
expenses
(h) Other expenses 12 602
(i) Expenditure transfer to capital and other account
TOTAL EXPENSES 2,400
V PROFIT BEFORE EXCEPTIONAL AND EXTRAORDINARY ITEMS 600
AND TAX ( III-IV)
VI EXCEPTIONAL ITEMS
VII PROFIT BEFORE EXTRAORDINARY ITEMS AND TAX (V-VI) 600
VIII EXTRAORDINARY ITEMS 60
IX PROFIT BEFORE TAX FRON CONTINUING OPERATIONS (VII- 540
VIII)
X Tax expenses:
(1) Current Tax 270
(2) deferred tax
XI PROFIT AFTER TAX FOR THE YEAR FROM CONTINUING 270
OPERATION(IX-X)
XII Profit (loss) from discontinuing operations
XIII Tax expenses from discontinuing operations
XIV Profit(loss) from discontinuing operations (after tax)(XII-
XIII)
XV PROFIT (LOSS) FOR THE PERIOD (XI+XIV) 270
Balance brought forward from previous year
Profit available for appropriation 80
350
Appropriation:
Proposed dividend 200
Transfer to General Reserve 30 230
Balance carried forward 120
XVI Earning per equity share:
(1) Basic
(2) Diluted
(` In ‘000)
Note 2. Reserve & Surplus As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
General Reserve 30
Profit and loss A/c 120
Total 150
Note 3. Long term borrowings As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Long term loan 70
Total 70
Note 5. Short- term provisions As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Proposed dividend (20% on R 10,00,000) 200
Provision for Taxation 270
Total 470
Note 7. Non Current Investments As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Investments 200
Total 200
Note 10. Cash and cash equivalents As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Cash at Bank and on hand 228
Total 228
Note 11. Revenue from operation As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Sales ( net of Excise Duty) 3,000
Total 3,000
Note 12. Other Expenses As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Administrative Expenses 480
Distribution Expenses 102
Loss on sale of Fixed Assets 20
Total 602
Notes:
1. The rate of interest on long term loan is not given in the question. Reasonable assumption may be made
regarding the rate of interest and accordingly it may be accounted for.
2. As per Companies (Transfer of Profits to Reserve) Rules, the amount to be transferred to the reserves shall not
be less than 7.5% of the current profits since proposed dividend exceeds 15% but does not exceed 20% of the
paid up capital. In this answer, it has been assumed that `. 30,000 have been transferred to General Reserve.
The students may transfer any amount based on a suitable percentage not less than 7.5%.
3. In the absence of details regarding factory closure costs, there costs are treated as extraordinary items in the
above solution assuming that the factory is permanently closed. However, the factory may close for a short
span of time on account of strikes, lockouts etc. and such type of factory closure costs should be treated as
loss from ordinary activities. In that case also, a separate disclosure regarding the factory closure costs will be
required as per para 12 of AS 5 (Revised) ‘Net Profit or Loss for the Period, Prior Period Items and Changes in
Accounting Policies.’
Working Notes:
Particulars (` in
‘000)
(1) Tangible Asset
Furniture and Fixtures
Gross Block
As on 1.4.2014 680
Add: Additions during the year 120
800
Less: Deductions during the year 60
As on 31.3.2015 740
Depreciation 260
As on 1.4.2014 148
For the year (20% on 740) 408
30
Less: Deduction during the year 378
As on 31.3.2015 362
Net block as on 31.3.2015
540
(2) Provision for taxation
20
Profit as per Profit and Loss Account 148
Add back: Loss on sale of asset (short term capital loss) 68
Depreciation
708
168
Less: Depreciation under Income-tax Act 540
Provision for tax @ 50% 270
It has been assumed that depreciation calculated under Income-tax Act amounts to (` 1,68,000)
Illustration 2:
The following balances are extracted from the books of Supreme Ltd., a real estate company, on 31st March, 2015:
(` ’000)
Dr. Cr.
Sales 13,800
Creditors 2,315
Debtors 3,675
Wages 555
Office Salaries 90
19,160 19,160
a. On 31st March, 2015, stock on hand including the land acquired during the year, is valued at `7,10,000. Work
in progress at that date is valued at `7,00,000.
b. On 1st October, 2014 the company moved to new premises. The premises are on a 12 years lease and the
lease premium paid amounted to ` 2,10,000. The company used sub-contract labour of ` 2,00,000 and
materials at cost of ` 1,90,000 in the refurbishment of the premises. These are to be considered as part of the
cost of leasehold premises.
c. A review of the debtors reveals specific doubtful debts of ` 1,75,000 and the directors wish to provide for
these together with a general provision based on 2% of the balance.
d. Depreciation on equipment, fixtures and fittings is provided at 15% on the written down value.
e. Supreme Ltd. sued Shallow Ltd. for supplying defective materials which has been written off as valueless. The
Directors are confident that Shallow Ltd. will agree for a settlement of `2,50,000.
h. The company will provide 10% of the pre-tax profit as bonus to employees in the accounts before charging
the bonus.
Solution:
Name of the Company: Supreme Ltd.
Balance Sheet as at: 31st March, 2015 (` in ‘000)
Note: Relevant items of Assets/ Liabilities are reflected in Balance Sheet and Schedule III. Hence sub- item not
having any value for the given illustration is not shown/ represented in Balance Sheet.
Name of the Company : Supreme Ltd.
Profit and Loss Statement for the year ended: 31st March, 2015 (` in ……..)
(` In ‘000)
Note 2. Reserve & Surplus As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
General Reserve 45
Profit and loss A/c 900
Total 945
Note 3. Long term borrowings As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Secured Loan 560
Total 560
Note 6. Other Current Liabilities As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Audit fees 100
Total 100
Note 7. Short- term provisions As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Proposed dividend 125
Provision for Taxation 650
Provision for bonus 120
Total 895
Note 11. Revenue from operation As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Sales ( net of Excise Duty) 13,800
Total 13,800
Note 12. Cost of materials Consumed As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Manufacturing expenses- Opening Stock (FG) 295
Opening WIP 1,050 1,345
Purchase of materials (6,090-190) 5,900
Purchase of land as stock 365
Wages 555
Sub-contract Cost (4,470-200) 4,270
Less: Closing Stock- Finished goods 710
Work in progress 700 (1,410)
Total 11,025
Note 13. Employees benefit expenses As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Salary- office staff (90+195) 285
Bonus 120
Total 405
Note 14. Other Expenses As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Administrative Expenses 735
Provision for doubtful debts 245
Auditors remuneration 100
Total 1,080
1. Other Matters:
a. The cost of leasehold premises includes the cost of refurbishment to the extent of ` 3,90,000 (Materials
` 1,90,000 + Labour ` 2,00,000).
b. Shallow Ltd. has been sued for supplying defective materials. Settlement of ` 2,50,000 is hopeful however
it has not been recognized in the accounts as it represents contingent gain.
Illustration 3:
On 1st November, 2014 Squash Ltd. was incorporated with an authorized capital of ` 200 crores. It issued to its
promoters equity capital of ` 10 crores which was paid for in full. On that day it purchased the running business of
Jam Ltd. for ` 40 crores and allotted at par equity capital of ` 40 crores in discharge of the consideration. The net
assets taken over from Jam Ltd. were valued as follows: Fixed Assets ` 30 crores, Inventory ` 2 crores, Customers’
dues ` 14 crores and Creditors ` 6 crores. Squash Ltd. carried on business and the following information is furnished
to you:
(a) Summary of cash/bank transactions (for year ended 31st October, 2015).
(` in Crores)
Solution:
Name of the Company: Squash Ltd
Balance Sheet as at: 31st October, 2015 (` in Crores)
Note: Relevant items of Assets/ Liabilities are reflected in Balance Sheet and Schedule III. Hence sub-item not
having any value for the given illustration is not shown/ represented in Balance Sheet.
IV EXPENSES:
(a) Cost of material consumed 14 437
(b) Purchase of products for sale
(c) changes in inventories of finished goods, work-in-prog-
ress and products for sale
(d) Employees cost/ benefits expenses 140
(e) Finance cost 10
(f) Depreciation and amortization expenses 36
(g) Other expenses 15 104
TOTAL EXPENSES 727
V PROFIT BEFORE EXCEPTIONAL AND EXTRAORDINARY 139
ITEMS AND TAX ( III-IV)
VI EXCEPTIONAL ITEMS
VII PROFIT BEFORE EXTRAORDINARY ITEMS AND TAX (V-VI) 139
VIII EXTRAORDINARY ITEMS 0.4
IX PROFIT BEFORE TAX FRON CONTINUING OPERATIONS (VII- 139.40
VIII)
X Tax expenses:
(1) Current Tax 52
(2) deferred tax
XI PROFIT AFTER TAX FOR THE YEAR FROM CONTINU- 87.4
ING OPERATION(IX-X)
XII Profit (loss) from discontinuing operations
XIII Tax expenses from discontinuing operations
XIV Profit(loss) from discontinuing operations (after tax)(XII-
XIII)
XV PROFIT (LOSS) FOR THE PERIOD (XI+XIV) 87.4
Balance brought forward from previous year
Profit available for appropriation 87.4
Appropriation:
Proposed dividend 10
Balance carried forward 77.40
XVI Earning per equity share:
(1) Basic
(2) Diluted
Note 8. Long term loans and advances As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Advance Tax 54
Total 54
Note 10. Trade receivables As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Customer’s Due 80
Total 80
Note 11.Cash and cash equivalents As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Cash/bank balance 10
Total 10
Note 12. Short-term loans and advances As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Advance to suppliers 8
Prepaid expenses 2
Total 10
Note 13. Revenue from operation As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Sales ( net of Excise Duty) 866
Total 866
Note 14. Cost of materials Consumed As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Stock taken over 2
Purchase 438
440
Less: Closing Stock 3
Total 437
Note 15. Other Expenses As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Payment for expenses 100
Add: Outstanding expenses 6
Less: Prepaid expenses (2)
Total 104
Working Notes:
1. Net assets of Jam Ltd. taken over: (` in crores)
Fixed Assets 30
Inventory 2
Customers’ dues 14
46
Less: Creditors 6
40
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Business Purchase A/c 14 By Bank A/c 800
To Sales A/c (Balancing figure) 866 By Balance c/d 80
880 880
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Bank A/c (400 – 8) 392 By Business Purchase A/c 6
To Balance c/d 52 By Purchases A/c 438
(Balancing figure)
444 444
Suppliers’ (Fixed Assets) A/c, Fixed Assets A/c, Expensess A/c, and calculation of tax provision should be included
in the working notes.
Illustration 4:
The following balances are extracted from the books of K Ltd.
1,35,67,600 1,35,67,600
Additional information:
1. Closing stock was valued at ` 10,82,000 at cost, but market value of which was ` 12,10,000
2. Provision for doubtful debts to be created @ 5%.
3. Depreciation on all assets was calculated for the amount of ` 2,86,400 for the year 2017-18.
4. Trade expenses include ` 10,000 for audit fees and ` 2,000 paid to the auditor for attending taxation matters
of the company.
5. Calls on arrear includes ` 4,000 due from directors.
6. Directors declared an interim dividend @ 2.5% and recommended dividend for the amount of ` 1,46,260.
7. Assume dividend tax rate is 17%.
8. Provide for income tax of ` 70,000 for the year 2017-18.
Prepare the company’s balance sheet as on 31.03.2017 and its statement of profit and loss for the year ended
31.03.2017.
Solution :
Statement of Profit and loss for the year ended 31.03.2018
Note `
Revenue from operations 1 60,16,000
Other income 10,000
Total 60,26,000
Expenses
Cost of materials consumed Nil
Purchase of stock in trade 2 47,74,000
Changes in inventories 3 (1,30,000)
Employee benefit expenses 4 4,64,000
Finance cost 5 1,20,000
Depreciation and amortization 2,86,400
Other expense 6 2,90,800
Total 58,05,200
Profit before exceptional, extraordinary items and tax 2,20,800
Exceptional items -
Profit before extraordinary items and tax 2,20,800
Extraordinary items -
Profit before tax 2,20,800
Tax
NOTES ON ACCOUNTS :
Answer:
1. Finance;
2. Non-current Investments;
3. Current Liabilities;
4. 12;
5. Inventories.
4. The aggregate amount of the balance of ‘Reserve and Surplus’, is to be shown after adjusting negative
balance of surplus/ Loss, if any.
5. 2,00,000 8% Preference Shares of `100 each will come under : Equity and Liabilities –Shareholders’ funds
- Share Capital (Schedul III).
Answer:
1. FALSE.
2. TRUE.
3. TRUE.
4. TRUE.
5. TRUE
3.1 INTRODUCTION
Introduction
Cash flow statement is additional information to user of financial statement. This statement exhibits the flow of
incoming and outgoing cash and cash equivalent. It assesses the ability of the enterprise to generate cash and
utilize cash. Cash Flow Statement is one of the tools for assessing the liquidity and solvency of the enterprise.
Statement of Cash Flow
“The information provided in a statement of cash flows, if used with related disclosures and information in the other
financial statements, should help investors, creditors, and others to (a) assess the enterprise’s ability to generate
positive future net cash flows; (b) assess the enterprise’s ability to meet its obligations, its ability to pay dividends,
and its needs for external financing; (c) assess the reasons for differences between net income and associated
cash receipts and payments; and (d) assess the effects on an enterprise’s financial position of both its cash and
non-cash investing and financing transactions during the period.” - SFAS 95 Statement of Cash Flows, Financial
Accounting Standards Board, US
Why Cash Flow Statement is Prepared?
Cash Flow Statement is considered to be a summarized statement showing sources of Cash Inflows and application
of cash outflows of an enterprise during a particular period of time. It is prepared on the basis of the published
data as disclosed by the Financial Statement of two different financial periods. It is an essential tool for managerial
decision-making. Cash Flow reports the management Net Cash Flow (i.e. cash inflow less cash outflow or vice
versa) from each activity of the enterprise as well as of the overall business of the enterprise. The management of
the enterprise gets a picture of movement of cash resources from the Cash Flow Statement and can assess the
stronger and weaker area of movement of cash for different activities of the business for drawing up the future
planning.
Importance of Cash flows
Cash flows are crucial to business decisions. Cash is invested in the business and the rationality of such investment
is evaluated taking into account the future cash flows it is expected to generate. Economic value of an asset is
derived on the basis of its ability to generate future cash flows. Economic value of an asset is given by the present
value of future cash flows expected to be derived from the asset.
Profit is an accounting concept. Profit is derived on accrual assumption. Profit and cash flows from operational
activities are not the same. Dividend decision is taken on the basis of profit, although it is to be paid in cash. Similarly,
debt servicing capacity of a company is determined on the basis of cash flows from operations before interest.
Ploughing back of profit is a much talked about source of financing modernisation, expansion and diversification.
Unless retained profit is supported by cash, ploughing back is not possible. Thus cash flows analysis is an important
basis for making several management decisions.
A cash flow statement explains the reasons for change in the cash and cash equivalent between two financial
statement dates. Before we introduce the technique of cash flow analysis, let us learn the meaning of the term
‘cash and cash equivalent’.
Cash means cash in hand and balance of foreign currency. Cash equivalent implies bank balance and other
risk-free short term investments, and advances which are readily encashable. Cash equivalent means short term
highly liquid investments that are readily convertible into known amounts of cash and which are subject to an
insignificant risk of changes in value. An investment of short maturity, say three months or less from the date of
acquisition is generally considered as cash equivalent. Equity investments are not considered as cash equivalent
because of high market risk. Investments in call money market, money market mutual funds, repo transactions,
badla transactions, etc., are usually classified as cash equivalents.
Cash Flow Statement explains cash movements under three different heads, namely
1. Cash flow from operating activities;
2. Cash flow from investing activities;
3. Cash flow from financing activities.
Sum of these three types of cash flow reflects net increase or decrease of cash and cash equivalents.
Operating activities are the principal revenue - producing activities of the enterprise and other activities that
are not investing and financing. Operating activities include all transactions that are not defined as investing or
financing. Operating activities generally involve producing and delivering goods and providing services.
Investment activities are the acquisition and disposal of long term assets and other investments not included in
cash equivalents.
Financing activities are activities that result in changes in the size and composition of the owners’ capital (including
preference share capital in the case of a company) and borrowings of the enterprise.
Elements of operating cash flow
Given below are elements of operating cash flow:
3. Cash payments to acquire shares, warrants or debt instruments of other enterprises and interests in joint
venture.
This does not include an item covered in cash equivalents and items held for dealing or trading purposes.
4. Cash receipts from disposal of shares, warrants or debt instruments of other enterprises and interests in joint
venture.
This does not include an item covered in cash equivalents and items held for dealing or trading purposes.
This does not include loans and advances made by financial institutions as these fall under operating cash
flow.
6. Cash receipts from repayments of advances and loans made to third parties. This does not include loans
and advances made by financial institutions as these fall under operating cash flow.
This does not include contracts held for dealing or trading purposes or contracts which are classified as
financing activities.
This does not include contracts held for dealing or trading purposes or contracts which are classified as
financing activities.
3. Cash proceeds from issuing debentures, loans, notes, bonds, mortgages, and other short term and long
term borrowings.
5. Cash payments by a lease for the reduction of the outstanding liability relating to a finance lease.
Direct Method:
Particulars ` ` `
A. Cash Flows from Operating Activities:
Cash receipts from Customers ––
Less: Cash paid to Suppliers and Employees ––
Cash Generated from Operation ––
Less: Income Tax Paid ––
Cash Flows from Operation before Extraordinary Items ––
Add: Proceeds from any Disaster Settlement ––
Net Cash Flow from Operating Activities ––
B. Cash Flows from Investing Activities:
Proceeds from Sale of Fixed assets including Investments ––
Less: Purchase of Fixed assets including Investments ––
––
Add: Interest Received ––
Dividends Received ––
Net Cash Flow from Investing Activities ––
C. Cash Flows from Financing Activities:
Proceeds from issuance of share capital ––
Proceeds from Long-term Borrowings ––
––
Less: Repayment of Long-term Borrowings including Redemption of ––
Preference Shares
––
Less: Interest Paid ––
Dividend Paid –– ––
Net Cash Flow from Financing Activity ––
Net Increase in Cash and cash Equivalents ––
Add: Cash and Cash Equivalents at the beginning of the period ––
Cash and Cash Equivalents at the end of the period ––
Notes:
(1) Figures of cash sales may be directly available from cash book. Then Cash collection can be derived taking
Credit sales + Opening balance of debtors - closing balance of debtors.
(2) Similarly figures of cash purchases can also be obtained from cash books.
(3) Interest and dividend are investment cash inflow and, therefore, to be excluded.
(4) Interest expense is financing cash outflow.
(5) Tax provision is not cash expense, advance tax paid should be treated as tax cash outflow.
Indirect method:
Proforma of Cash Flow Statement under Indirect Method
Cash Flow Statement of for the period ended
Particulars ` ` `
A. Cash Flows from Operating Activities:
Net Profit for the Period before Taxation & Extraordinary Items ––
Add: Adjustment for Non-current and Non-operating Items charged to Profit & ––
Loss A/c
Depreciation ––
Interest paid ––
Foreign Exchange Loss ––
Loss on Sale of Fixed Assets & Investments –– ––
Less: Adjustment for Non-current and Non-operating Items ––
Charged to Profit & Loss A/c ––
Interest Earned ––
Dividend Earned ––
Profit on Sale of Fixed Assets & Investments ––
Operating Profit before ––
Working Capital Changes –– ––
Add: Increase in Current Liabilities –– ––
Decrease in Current Assets ––
Less: Increase in Operating Current Assets ––
Decrease in Operating Current Liabilities ––
Cash Generated from Operation –– ––
––
Less: Income Tax Paid ––
Add: Proceeds from any Disaster Settlement ––
Net Cash Flow from Operating Activities ––
B. Cash Flows from Investing Activities:
Proceeds from Sale Fixed assets including Investments ––
Less: Purchase from Sale Fixed assets including Investments ––
––
Add: Interest Received ––
Dividends Received ––
Net Cash Flow from Investing Activities ––
C. Cash Flows from Financing Activities:
Proceeds from issuance of Share Capital ––
Proceeds from Long-term Borrowings ––
––
Less: Repayment of Long-term Borrowings including Redemption of Preference ––
Shares
––
Less: Interest Paid ––
Dividend Paid –– ––
Net Cash Flow from Financing Activity ––
Net Increase in Cash and cash Equivalents ––
Add: Cash and Cash Equivalents at the beginning of the period ––
Cash and Cash Equivalents at the end of the period ––
Illustration 1.
Given below is Profit and Loss Account of ABC Ltd. and relevant Balance Sheet information :
Profit and Loss Statement for the year ended 31st March, 2015 (` in lakhs)
Direct Method
(` in lakhs)
Indirect Method
Profit before tax 710
Add : Non-cash items : Depreciation 100
Add : Interest : Financing cash outflow 60
Less : Interest and Dividend : Investment 100
Cash inflow 770
Less : Tax paid 195
Working Capital Adjustments 575
Debtors (250 - 400) (150)
Inventories (180 - 200) (20)
Creditors (250 - 230) 20
Outstanding wages (50 - 40) 10
Outstanding expenses (20 -10) 10
Cash Flow from Operating Activities 445
Illustration 2.
Name of the Company: MZ Ltd.
Profit and Loss Statement for the year ended 31st March, 2015
4. Changes in stock of Finished Goods As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Closing stock 4,000
Less: Opening Stock 3,000
Total 1,000
9. Long Term Loans and Advances As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Advance tax 150 100
150 100
10. Short Term Provisions As at 31st March, 2015 As at 31st March, 2014
Tax Provision 150 100
Other Provisions 150 150
Propose dividends 450 600
750 850
Consider the above Profit and Loss account and Balance Sheet and derive Cash flows from operating activities
using direct and indirect method.
Solution:
Computation of cash flows from operating activities by direct method:
` in lakh ` in lakh
Cash inflows (a)
Sales 10,000
Add : Opening S/Debtors 1,500
11,500
Less : Closing S/Debtors 2,000 9,500
Cash outflows (b)
Creditors :
Opening balance 4,650
Add : Purchases 5,000
Less : Closing balance 4,200 5,450
Salaries and Contributions to retirement Benefit Schemes 2,500
Other Expenses 2,000
9,950
Cash flow from operating activities (a-b) (450)
Less : Advance tax paid (100)
Cash flow from after tax operating activities (550)
- Figures within bracket indicate cash outflows.
Notes :
1. Cash inflows from sale of goods and services are given by cash sales plus collection from debtors.
2. Cash outflows on account of purchase of materials are given by cash purchases plus payment to creditors.
3. It may be noted that income from investments is classified as cash flows from investment activities and interest
payment on long term loans is classified as cash flows for financing activities. Dividend payment also falls
under the category of cash flows for financing activities.
Computation of Operating Cash Flow using Indirect Method
` in lakh
Increase in General Reserve 250
Decrease in P & L A/c (50)
Tax provision 100
Proposed Dividend 600
Interest 800
Depreciation 500
2,200
Less : Income from Investments 1,200
1,000
Working Capital Adjustments :
Inventories (500)
Sundry Debtors (500)
Sundry Creditors (450) (1,450)
Cash from operating activities (450)
Less : Advance tax paid (100)
Cash flow from after tax operating activities (550)
Working Capital Adjustments: Increase in current assets like inventories, debtors, prepayments blocks the cash
flows, whereas decrease in current assets releases cash. Although there was profit before interest and depreciation
amounting to `1,000 lakhs, such profit was not represented by cash since it was blocked in inventories and debtors.
Similarly, any increase in current liabilities means withholding cash payments. In other words, increase in current
liabilities means increase in cash flows from opening activities. On the other hand, decrease in current liabilities
means additional cash outflows which further reduces cash flows from operating activities.
After the working capital adjustments, it appears that there was net cash outflows from operating activities.
However, under both the direct and indirect methods cash flows from operating activities can be derived at a
same level.
Reconciliation : In case indirect method is followed, it is better to have a reconciliation of cash flows and PAT
` in lakh
Cash flows from operating activities (450)
Add : Working Capital adjustments 1450
1000
Less : Depreciation (500)
Less : Interest (800)
(300)
Add : Income from investments 1200
PBT 900
Less : Tax Provision 100
PAT 800
Illustration 2 (a): Taking the data given in Illustration 2, and using the following additional information derive cash
flow from investment activities:
Take 10% of the investments given in the Balance Sheets as risk-free and readily encashable and remaining of the
investments as long term investments.
Particulars ` In lakhs
31-03-2014 31-03-2015
1,000 1,500
(2,450)
Illustration 2 (b) : Take the information given in Illustration 2. & 2.(a) and derive cash flow from financing activities :
Illustration 2 (c): Use the data given in Illustration 2 & 2.(a) and find out change in cash and cash equivalents:
Cash flows statement is largely used for management decisions. However, there is global trend in favour of
inclusion of cash flows statement as a part of corporate financial statements. In India, the SEBI has already issued
a notification requiring the listed companies to include a cash flow statement in the annual report. The Institute of
Chartered Accountants of India has also issued Accounting Standard 3 (AS-3) Cash Flow Statement. It has now
become part of the financial statements of the listed companies.
Illustration 3:
Given below are summarised Balance Sheets of Harsh Chemicals Ltd. as at 31-03-14 and 31-03-15. The company
issued one bonus share for every 4 shares held. The company also acquired machinery amounting to `30,00,000
from Levenz of France on deferred credit basis. You are required to prepare the cash flow statement.
(` in thousand)
Ref Note
Particulars As at 31.03.15 As at 31.03.14
No. No.
I EQUITY AND LIABILITIES
1 Shareholders’ fund
(a) Share capital 8,500 4,000
(b) Reserves and surplus- 9,700 9,350
2 Share application money pending allotment NIL
3 Non-current liabilities
Note - Relevant items of Assets/ Liabilities are reflected in Balance Sheet and Schedule III. Hence sub-item not
having any value for the given illustration is not shown/ represented in Balance Sheet.
Illustration 4:
The following is the income statement XYZ Company for the year 2014 – 15:
(`)
Sale 1,62,700
Add: Equity in ABC company’s earning 6,000
1,68,700
Expenses
Cost of goods sold 89,300
Salaries 34,400
Depreciation 7,450
Insurance 500
Research and development 1,250
Patent amortisation 900
Interest 10,650
Bad debts 2,050
Income tax:
Current 6,600
Deferred 1,550
Total expenses 8,150 1,54,650
Net income 14,050
Increase
(Decrease)
`
Cash 500
Marketable securities 1,600
Accounts receivable (7,150)
Allowance for bad debt (1,900)
Inventory 2,700
Prepaid insurance 700
Accounts payable (for merchandise) 5,650
Salaries payable (2,050)
Dividends payable (3,000)
Notes:
(1)
(2) Dividends earned `6,000 on equity of ABC Company has not been considered as it has not been received in
cash.
(3)
Payment to suppliers `
Cost of goods sold 89,300
Add: Increase in inventory 2,700
Purchases 92,000
Less: increase in accounts payable 5,650
Payment to suppliers 86,350
(4)
(5)
Insurance payments `
Insurance 500
Add : increase in prepaid insurance 700
Payment for insurance 1,200
(6)
Interest payment `
Interest expenses 10,650
Add : Amortisation of bond premium 1,350
Interest payments 12,000
(7)
Illustration 5:
From the information contained in Income Statement and Balance Sheet of ‘A’ Ltd., prepare Cash Flow Statement:
Income statement for the year ended march 31,2015
II ASSETS
1 Non-current assets
(a) Fixed assets
(i) Tangible assets 54,00,000 28,80,000
2 Current assets
(a) Inventories 9,60,000 26,40,000
(b) Trade receivables 18,60,000 16,80,000
(c) Cash and cash equivalents 7,20,000 6,00,000
(d) Short-term loans and advances 90,000 78,000
Total 90,30,000 78,78,000
Note - Relevant items of Assets/ Liabilities are reflected in Balance Sheet and Schedule III. Hence sub-item not
having any value for the given illustration is not shown/ represented in Balance Sheet.
Note on Accounts
The original cost of equipment sold during the year 2014-15 was ` 7,20,000.
Solution:
Cash Flow Statement of Company A Ltd. for the year ending March 31,2015
Cash flows from Operating Activities
`
Net Profits before Tax and Extra-ordinary Item 16,00,000
Add: Depreciation 6,00,000
Operating Profits before Working Capital Changes 22,00,000
Increase in Debtors (1,80,000)
`
Purchase of Land (4,80,000)
Purchase of Buildings and Equipment (28,80,000)
Sale of Equipment 3,60,000
Net Cash used in Investment Activities (B) (30,00,000)
`
Issue of Share Capital 8,40,000
Dividends Paid (7,20,000)
Net Cash from Financing Activities (c) 1,20,000
Net increase in Cash and Cash Equivalents (A+B+C) 1,20,000
Cash and Cash Equivalents at the beginning 6,00,000
Cash and Cash Equivalents at the end 7,20,000
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Balance b/d 36,00,000 By Sale of Asset 7,20,000
To Cash/Bank (purchase) 28,80,000 By Balance c/d 57,60,000
(Balancing figure)
64,80,000 64,80,000
` `
To Sale of Asset (Accumulated deprecia- 4,80,000 By Balance b/d 12,00,000
tion)
13,20,000 By Profit and Loss (Provisional) 6,00,000
To Balance c/d
18,00,000 18,00,000
`
Original Cost 7,20,000
Less: Accumulated Depreciation 4,80,000
Net Cost 2,40,000
Profit on Sale of Asset 1,20,000
Sale Proceeds from Asset Sales 3,60,000
Illustration 6:
From the following information prepare cash flow statement:
Name of the Company:
Balance Sheet as at 31-12-2014 and 31- 12- 2015 (` in thousands)
Ref Note
Particulars 31.12.2015 31.12.2014
No. No.
I EQUITY AND LIABILITIES
1 Shareholders’ fund
(a) Share capital 1,500 1,250
(b) Reserves and surplus 3,410 1,380
2 Share application money pending allotment NIL
3 Non-current liabilities NIL
(a) Long-term borrowings 1,110 1,040
4 Current Liabilities
(a) Trade payables 150 1,890
(b )Other current liabilities 230 100
(c) Short-term provisions 400 1,000
Total 6,800 6,660
II ASSETS
1 Non-current assets
(a) Fixed assets
(i) Tangible assets 730 850
(b) Non-current investments 2,500 2,500
2 Current assets
(a)Current investments 670 135
(b) Inventories 900 1,950
(c) Trade receivables 1,700 1,200
(d) Cash and cash equivalents 200 25
Total 6,800 6,660
Note - Relevant items of Assets/ Liabilities are reflected in Balance Sheet and Schedule III. Hence sub-item not
having any value for the given illustration is not shown/ represented in Balance Sheet.
(` in thousands)
(` in thousands)
Sales 30,650
Cost of sales (26,000)
Gross profit 4,650
Depreciation (450)
Administration and selling expenses (910)
Interest expenses (400)
Interest income 300
Dividend income 200
Foreign exchange loss (40)
Net profit before taxation and extraordinary item 3,350
Extraordinary item - Insurance proceeds from earthquake disaster settlement 180
Net profit after extraordinary item 3,530
Income-tax (300)
Net profit 3,230
e. Plant with original cost of ` 80 and accumulated depreciation of ` 60 was sold for ` 20.
f. Foreign exchange loss of ` 40 represents reduction in the carrying amount of a short-term investment in
foreign currency designated bonds arising out of a change in exchange rate between the date of acquisition
of the investments and the balance sheet date.
g. Sundry debtors and sundry creditors include amounts relating to credit sales and credit purchases only.
Solution:
Cash flow Statement (Direct Method) (` In thousands)
` `
Cash flows from Operating Activities
Net profit before taxation, and extraordinary item 3,350
Adjustments for:
Depreciation 450
Foreign exchange loss 40
Interest income (300)
Dividend income (200)
Interest expenses 400
Operating profit before working capital changes 3,740
Increase in sundry debtors (500)
Decrease in inventories 1,050
Decrease in sundry creditors (1,740)
Cash generated from operations 2,550
Income taxes paid (860)
Working Notes:
1. Cash and cash Equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents consist of cash on hand and balance with banks, and investments in money-
market instruments. Cash and cash equivalents included in the cash flow statement comprise the following
balance sheet amounts :
Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the period include deposits with banks of 100 held by a branch
which are not freely remissible to the company because of currency exchange restrictions. The company has
undrawn borrowing facilities of 2,000 of which 700 may be used only for future expansion.
2. Total tax paid during the year (including tax deducted at source on dividends received) amounted to 900.
Sales 30,650
26,910
29,700
27,600
5. Income taxes paid (including tax deducted at source from dividends received)
1,300
Less : Income tax liability at the end of the year 400
900
Out of 900, tax deducted at source on dividends received (amounting to 40) is included in cash flows from
investing activities and the balance of 860 is included in cash flows from operating activities.
6. Repayment of long-term borrowing
180
7. Interest Paid
500
Less : Interest payable at the end of the year 230
270
Illustration 7:
Sumangal Ltd. finds on 31st December, 2014 that it is short of funds with which to implement its branch expansion
programme. On 1st January, 2014, it had a bank balance of `1,80,000 in its current account. From the following
information, prepare a statement of Cash Flow to show how the overdraft of `58,750 at 31st December, 2015 has
arisen:
Figures as per Balance Sheet
(as on 31st December)
The profit for the year ended 31st December, 2014 before charging depreciation and taxation amounted to
`2,50,000. The 5,000 shares were issued on 1st January, 2014 at a premium of `5 per share. `1,37,500 was paid in
March 2014 by way of income tax including tax on distribution of dividend. Dividend was paid as follows for 2014
(final) on the capital on 31-12-2013 @ 10% less tax 25%. For 2014 (interim) 5% on capital on 31st March, 2014 free of
tax.
Solution:
Sumangal Ltd.
Cash Flow Statement
For the period 1 January 2014 to 31st December 2014
st
Particulars ` `
1. Cash Flows from Operating Activities:
Operating profit before dep. and tax 2,50,000
Adjustment for:
Increase in creditors 80,000
Decrease in debtors 15,000
Increase in stock (1,10,000)
Increase in B/R (7,500)
Income tax paid (1,37,500)
Net Cash from Operating Activities (A) 90,000
2. Cash Flow from Investing Activities:
Purchase of fixed assets (3,50,000)
Net Cash used in Investing Activities(2) (3,50,000)
3. Cash Flows from Financing Activities:
Issue of shares at premium 75,000
Payment of final dividend(2013) (18,750)
Payment of interim dividend (2014) (15,000)
Net Cash from Financing Activities(3) 41,250
Net increase in Cash and Cash Equivalents (2,18,750)
Cash and Cash Equivalents at the beginning 1,70,000
Cash and Cash Equivalents at the end (48,750)
Objective
1. Information about the cash flows of an entity is useful in providing users of financial statements with a basis to
assess the ability of the entity to generate cash and cash equivalents ,the needs of the entity to utilise those
cash flows and the timing and certainty of their generation.
2. The objective of this Standard is to require the provision of information about the historical changes in cash
and cash equivalents of an entity by means of a statement of cash flows which classifies cash flows during the
period from operating, investing and financing activities.
Definitions
The following terms are used in this Standard with the meanings specified:
1. Cash comprises cash in hand and demand deposits.
2. Cash equivalents are short-term, highly liquid investments that are readily convertible to known amounts of
cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value.
3. Cash flows are inflows and outflows of cash and cash equivalents.
4. Operating activities are the principal revenue-producing activities of the entity and other activities that are
not investing or financing activities.
5. Investing activities are the acquisition and disposal of long-term assets and other investments not included in
cash equivalents.
6. Financing activities are activities that result in changes in the size and composition of the contributed equity
and borrowings of the entity.
Cash and cash equivalents
1. Cash equivalents are held for the purpose of meeting short-term cash commitments.
2. For an investment to qualify as a cash equivalent it must be readily convertible to a known amount of cash and
be subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value. An investment normally qualifies as a cash equivalent
when it has a short maturity of, say, three months or less from the date of acquisition.
3. Equity investments are excluded unless they are, in substance, cash equivalents.
4. Bank borrowings are generally considered to be financing activities. However, where bank overdrafts which
are repayable on demand form an integral part of an entity’s cash management, bank overdrafts are
included as a component of cash and cash equivalents. A characteristic of such banking arrangements is
that the bank balance often fluctuates from being positive to overdrawn.
5. Cash flows exclude movements between items that constitute cash or cash equivalents because these
components are part of the cash management of an entity rather than part of its operating, investing and
financing activities.
Illustration 8:
M Ltd. had a cash balance of `1,50,000 as on 30.09.2015. On 15.10.2015, M Ltd. Used the cash balance to purchase
a short-term bank deposit with a maturity of three months. How should this be shown in the statement of cash flow
to be prepared for the quarter ended 31.12.2015?
Answer:
As per this Ind AS 7, cash flows exclude movements between items that constitute cash or cash equivalents as
these components are part of cash management of an entity, rather than part of its operating, investing and
financing activities.
The purchase of short-term bank deposit is therefore not shown in the statement of cash flows.
Presentation of a statement of cash flows
The statement of cash flows shall report cash flows during the period classified by operating, investing and financing
activities. An entity presents its cash flows from operating, investing and financing activities in a manner which is
most appropriate to its business.
Operating activities
Cash flows from operating activities are primarily derived from the principal revenue-producing activities of the
entity. Therefore, they generally result from the transactions and other events that enter into the determination of
profit or loss.
Examples of cash flows from operating activities are:
a. cash receipts from the sale of goods and the rendering of services;
b. cash receipts from royalties, fees, commissions and other revenue;
c. cash payments to suppliers for goods and services;
d. cash payments to and on behalf of employees;
e. cash receipts and cash payments of an insurance entity for premiums and claims, annuities and other policy
benefits;
f. cash payments or refunds of income taxes unless they can be specifically identified with financing and
investing activities;
g. cash receipts and payments from contracts held for dealing or trading purposes.
Companies in specific industries have different operating cash flows, such as cash flows from purchase and sale
of dealings or trading securities. Such cash flows are classified as operating activities. Similarly, cash advances
and loans made by financial institutions are classified as operating activities since they relate to the main revenue
generating activity of that entity.
Investing Activities
The separate disclosure of cash flows arising from investing activities is important because the cash flows represent
the extent to which expenditures have been made from resources intended to generate future income and cash
flows. Only expenditures that result from a recognized asset in the balance sheet are eligible for classification as
investing activities.
Examples of cash flows arising from investing activities are:
a. Cash payments to acquire property, plant and equipment, intangibles and other long-term assets. These
payments include those relating to capitalised development costs and self-constructed property, plant and
equipment;
b. Cash receipts from items in (a);
c. Cash payments to acquire equity or debt instruments of other entities and interests in joints ventures excluding
investments in cash equivalents instruments or held for trading purpose;
d. Cash receipts from sales of items in (c);
e. Cash advances and loans made to other parties;
f. Cash receipts from the repayment of advances and loans made to other parties;
g. Cash payments and receipts for futures contracts, forward contracts, option contracts and swap contracts
except when the contracts are held trading purposes, or are classified as financing activities.
Financing Activities
These represent claims on future cash flows by providers of capital and include:
a. Cash proceeds from issuing shares;
b. Cash payments to owners to acquire or redeem the entity’s shares;
c. Cash proceeds from issuing debentures, loans, etc;
d. Cash repayments of amounts borrowed; and
e. Cash payments by a lessee for principle repayments relating to a finance lease.
Entities are encouraged to report cash flows from operating activities using the direct method. The direct
method provides information which may be useful in estimating future cash flows and which is not available
under the indirect method.
Under the direct method, information about major classes of gross cash receipts and gross cash payments
may be obtained either:
• from the accounting records of the entity; or
• by adjusting sales, cost of sales (interest and similar income and interest expense and similar charges for
a financial institution) and other items in the statement of profit and loss for:
• changes during the period in inventories and operating receivables and payables;
• other non-cash items; and
• other items for which the cash effects are investing or financing cash flows.
Under the indirect method, the net cash flow from operating activities is determined by adjusting profit or loss
for the effects of:
• changes during the period in inventories and operating receivables and payables;
• non-cash items such as depreciation, provisions, deferred taxes etc.
• all other items for which the cash effects are investing or financing cash flows.
Bank Overdraft and Cash Credit
Bank overdraft facility is granted by bank for a short period to accommodate short-term fund requirement. It is
linked with the operations in current account.
Cash credit is a fund-based facility granted by a bank to its customer to finance working capital requirements.
Ind AS 7 provides that bank borrowings are usually considered part of financing activities.
Bank overdrafts, repayable on demand form an integral part of an entity’s cash management, and are included
as a component of cash and cash equivalents.
Cash credit from bank, on a continuous basis, is considered as a part of financing activity.
Illustration 9:
AMM Ltd has a foreign currency balance of USD 1,000 as on 31.3.2015. This foreign currency was purchased when
the exchange rate was $1= ` 50. As on 31.3.2015, the exchange rate is $1= ` 55. How would you consider this
change in the statement of cash flow for the period ended 31.3.2015?
Solution:
As per Ind AS 7, unrealised gains and losses arising from changes in foreign currency exchange rates are not
cash flows. However, the effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents held or due in a
foreign currency is reported in the statement of cash flows in order to reconcile cash and cash equivalents at the
beginning and end of the period. This amount is presented separately from cash flows from operating, investing
and financing activities.
Taxes on income
Cash flows arising from taxes on income shall be separately disclosed and shall be classified as cash flows
from operating activities unless they can be specifically identified with financing and investing activities.
Investments in subsidiaries, associates and joint ventures
Between an investor entity and an associate, a joint venture or a subsidiary, only cash flows accounted for
using equity or cost method such as dividends and advances are reported in the statement of cash flows.
Illustration 10:
BB Ltd is a parent company of CC Ltd and holds 75% of the voting power of CC Ltd. During the year ended
31.3.2015, BB Ltd sold 15% of its stake in CC Ltd, thereby reducing its holding in CC Ltd to 60%.
a. How will the proceeds received be classified in the cash flow statement of BB Ltd for the period ended
31.3.2015?
b. Would your answer be different if CC Ltd sold 30% of its stake in CC Ltd (instead of 15%), thereby reducing its
holding in CC Ltd to 45%?
Solution:
a. As per Paras 42A and 42B of Ind AS 7, changes in the cash flows that do not result in a loss of control, such as
a subsequent purchase or sale by a parent of the subsidiary’s equity instruments, are accounted for as equity
transactions. Accordingly, the resultant cash flows are classified in the same way as other transactions with
owners as financing activities.
Hence, cash proceeds received from sale of 15% stake in subsidiary CC Ltd, not leading to loss of control, shall
be classified as financing activities in the statement of cash flows prepared by BB Ltd for the period ending
31.3.2015.
b. As per Para 39 of the Standard, the aggregate cash flows arising from obtaining or losing control of subsidiaries
or other business shall be presented separately and classified as investing activities.
Hence, cash proceeds received, from sale of 30% stake in subsidiary CC Ltd leading to loss of control, shall
be classified as investing activities in the statement of cash flows prepared by BB Ltd for the period ending
31.3.2015.
Non-cash transactions
Investing and financing transactions that do not require the use of cash or cash equivalents shall be excluded from
a statement of cash flows. Examples are acquisition of assets by assuming related liabilities, acquisition of an entity
by equity issue, and conversion of debt to equity.
Components of cash and cash equivalents
An entity shall disclose the components of cash and cash equivalents and shall present a reconciliation of the
amounts in its statement of cash flows with the equivalent items reported in the balance sheet.
In view of the variety of cash management practices and banking arrangements around the world and in order
to comply with Ind AS 1, Presentation of Financial Statements, an entity discloses the policy which it adopts in
determining the composition of cash and cash equivalents.
The effect of any change in the policy for determining components of cash and cash equivalents, for example,
a change in the classification of financial instruments previously considered to be part of an entity’s investment
portfolio, is reported in accordance with Ind AS 8, Accounting Policies, Changes in Accounting Estimates and
Errors.
Other disclosures
An entity should disclose the amount of significant cash and cash equivalent balances that are not available for
use.
Disclosure of additional relevant information and its explanation may include:
(a) Undrawn borrowing facilities;
(b) Identifying cash flows that increases operating capacity separately from those required to maintain operating
capacity; and
(c) Cash flows of each reportable segment.
Illustration 11:
From the following figures of LK Ltd. prepare a Cash Flow Statement:
6. Company decided to value stock at cost, whereas previously, the practice was to Value stock at cost less
10%. The stock according to book on 31st March 2017 was ` 2,16,000. The stock as on 31st March 2018 was
correctly valued at ` 3,00,000.
Solution :
Depreciation 3,60,000
Workings:
A. Upto 31.03.2017 company valued stock at cost less 10 %. Revised value of stock on 31.03.2017 willl be
2,16,000 x100/90 = 2,40,000
40,56,000 40,56,000
12,80,000 12,80,000
2,00,000 2,00,000
56,000 56,000
(i) For a finance company interest income it of Cash Flow from __________ __________.
(ii) Investing and financing transactions that _____ _____ require the use of cash or cash equivalents shall be
excluded from a statement of cash flows.
(iv) For a company other than a finance company payment of interest is a ____________ activity.
(v) ________ ___________ are short-term, highly liquid investments that are readily convertible to known amounts
of cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value.
Answer:
(ii) do not;
(iv) Financing
A bank is a commercial institution, licensed to accept deposits and acts as a safe custodian of the spendable funds
of its customers. Banks are concerned mainly with the functions of banking, i.e., receiving, collecting, transferring,
buying, lending, investing, dealing, exchanging and servicing (safe deposit, custodianship, agency, trusteeship)
money and claims to money both domestically and internationally. The principal activities of a bank are operating
current accounts, receiving deposits, taking in and paying out notes and coins, and making loans.
Banking activities undertaken by banks include personal banking (non-business customers), commercial Banking
(small and medium-sized business customers) and corporate banking (large international and multinational
corporations).
According to Charles J. Woelfel:
A complete banking service would comprehend a variety of functions, including any of the following:
1. Receive demand deposits and pay customers’ cheques drawn against them, and operate Automated Teller
Machines (ATM);
2. Receive time and savings deposits, issue negotiable orders of withdrawal, and pay interest thereon, as well
as provide Automatic Transfer Service (ATS) for funds from serving accounts to cover cheques;
3. Discount notes, acceptances and bills of exchange;
4. Supply credit to business firms with or without security, issue letters of credit and accept bills drawn thereunder;
5. Transfer money at home and abroad;
6. Make collections and facilitate exchanges;
7. Issue drafts, cashier’s cheques, money orders, and certify cheques;
8. Furnish safe deposit vault service;
9. Provide custodianship for securities and other valuables;
10. Provide personal loans, credit and services to individuals, and lend or discount customer instalment receivables
of vendors;
11. Act in a fiduciary capacity for individuals, as well as establish common trust funds;
12. Provide corporate trust services (stock transfer agent, registrar, paying agent, escrow agent, and indenture
trustee);
13. Act as factors and engage in equipment leasing;
14. Deal in Government securities and underwrite general obligations of state and municipal securities;
This is in addition to the average daily balance which a scheduled bank is required to maintain under Section
42 of the Reserve Bank of India Act, and in case of other banking companies, the cash reserve required to be
maintained under Section 18 of the Banking Regulation Act.
Unclaimed deposits
Every banking company is required to submit a return in the prescribed form and manner to the Reserve Bank of
India at the end of each calendar year of all accounts in India which could not be operated for 10 years.
This report is to be submitted within 30 days after the close of each calendar year.
In case of fixed deposit, such 10 years are to be reckoned from the date of expiry of the fixed period.
Bank’s Book-Keeping System
Entering transactions in the ledger directly from vouchers Under bank’s Bookkeeping system, every transaction
particularly concerning the customers is entered in the personal ledger directly from vouchers as soon as it takes
place.
The objective of the system is
(a) to keep up-to-date detailed ledgers,
(b) to balance the trial balance every day,
(c) to keep all control accounts in agreement with the detailed ledgers.
Main Characteristics of a Bank’s Book-Keeping System
The main characteristics of a bank’s system of book-keeping are as follows:
Voucher Posting Entries in the personal ledger are made directly from vouchers instead of being posted
from the books of prime entry.
Voucher Summary The vouchers entered into different personal ledgers each day are summarised on
Sheets summary sheets, totals of which are posted to the control accounts in the general ledger.
Daily Trial Balance The general ledger trial balance is extracted and agreed every day.
Continuous Checks All entries in the detailed personal ledgers and summary sheets are checked by persons
other than those who have made the entries. A considerable force of such check is
employed, with the general result that most clerical mistakes are detected before
another day begins.
Control Accounts A trial balance of the detailed personal ledgers is prepared periodically, usually every
two weeks, agreed with general ledger control accounts.
Double Voucher Two vouchers are prepared for every transaction not involving cash-one debit voucher
System and another credit voucher.
Book of Accounts
Subsidiary Registers
1. Demand Drafts, Telegraphic Transfers and Mail Transfers issued on Branches and Agencies.
2. Demand Drafts, Telegraphic Transfers and Mail Transfers received from Branches and Agencies.
3. Letters of Credit.
4. Letters of Guarantee
Memoranda Books
1. Departmental Journals Maintain a record of all the transfer entries originated by each department
2. Cash Department’s (a) Receiving Cashiers’ Cash Book (pay-in-slips are vouchers).
(b) Paying Cashiers’ Cash Book (Bearer Cheques/drafts etc. are vouchers).
(c) Main Cash Book (by person other than cashier).
(d) Cash Balance Book.
3. Clearing Department’s (a) Outward Clearing (for cheques received from customers):
(i) Clearing Cheques Received Book.
(ii) Bank wise List of above Cheques (one copy of which is sent to the
clearing house together with cheques).
(b) Inward Clearing (for cheques issued by customers received from other
Banks).
4. Loans and Overdraft (i) Registers for shares and other securities held on behalf of each
Departments’ customer.
(ii) Summary Books of Securities giving details of Government securities,
shares of individual companies etc.
(iii) Godown registers maintained by the godown-keeper of the bank.
(iv) Price register giving the wholesale price of the commodities pledged
with the bank.
(v) Overdraft Sanction register.
(vi) Drawing Power book.
(vii) Delivery Order books.
(viii) Storage books.
Statistical Books
(a) To record Average Balance in Loan and Advances etc.
(b) To record Deposits received and amount paid out each month in the various departments.
(c) Number of Cheques paid.
(d) Number of Cheques, Drafts, Bills etc. collected.
1. Form ‘B’
FROM OF PROFIT & LOSS ACCOUNT FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31ST MARCH
8. Investments: Investment in Government securities, other approved securities, shares, debentures and
bonds, subsidiaries and /or joint ventures, others, gold etc., are shown under this item.
9. Advances: Bills purchased and discounted, cash credit, overdrafts and loans payable on demand; and
term loans etc. are shown under this item.
10. Fixed Assets: Premises, other fixed assets (including furniture and fixtures) are shown under this item.
11. Other Assets: Inter-office adjustments, interest accrued, tax paid in advance, stationery and stamps, non-
banking assets acquired in satisfaction of claims are shown under this item.
12. Contingent Liabilities: It is shown by way of a footnote. It represents liabilities not provided in the Balance
Sheet.
I. Income:
The schedules of Income are:
13. Interest Earned. It includes interest/discount on advances/bills, income on investments, interest on
balances with RBI etc. It should be noted that according to the new form, bad debts and provision for
bad debts, other provisions are not to be deducted from the interest earned. For greater transparency in
accounts, these items are shown as separate items in the Profit and Loss Account.
14. Other income. It includes commission, exchange and brokerage, profit on sale of investments, profit
on revaluation of investments, profit on sale of land, building and other assets, profit on exchange
transaction, and income earned by way of dividends from subsidiaries, etc.
II. Expenditure
15. Interest expended. Interest paid on deposits, interest on RBI borrowings; interest on inter- bank borrowings,
etc., are shown under this item.
16. Operating expenses. Salaries and wages of staff; rent, rates and taxes; printing and stationery;
advertisement; depreciation on banks’ properties; director’s fees; auditor’s fees; law charges; postage;
repairs; insurance; etc., are shown under this item.
17. Third item of this section is provisions and contingencies. Provision for bad debts, provision for taxation
and other provisions are shown under this item.
III. Profit/Loss
In this section, profit/loss for the current year (difference between income and expenditure explained above)
and brought forward profit/loss are shown.
IV. Appropriations
In this section, amount transferred to statutory reserve as per Section 17; amount transferred to other reserve;
proposed dividend, etc., are shown. The balance is transferred to the Balance Sheet.
FORM OF SCHEDULES
SCHEDULE 1 – CAPITAL
As on 31.3. As on 31.3.
Particulars
(Current Year) (Previous Year)
I. For Nationalised Banks
Capital (Fully owned by Central Government)
II. For Banks Incorporated Outside India
Capital
(i) (The amount brought in by banks by way of start-up capital as
prescribed by RBI should be shown under this head)
(ii) Amount of deposit kept with the RBI under Section 11(2) of Banking
Regulation Act, 1949
Total
As on 31.3. As on 31.3.
Particulars
(Current Year) (Previous Year)
I. Statutory Reserves
Opening Balance
Additions during the year
Deductions during the year
II. Capital Reserves
1. Opening Balance
2. Additions during the year
3. Deductions during the year
III. Securities Premium
Opening Balance
Additions during the year
Deductions during the year
IV. Revenue and other Reserves
Opening Balance
Additions during the year
Deductions during the year
V. Balance in Profit and Loss Account
Total (I + II + III + IV + V)
SCHEDULE 3 - DEPOSITS
As on 31.3.
As on 31.3.
Particulars (Previous
(Current Year)
Year)
A. I. Demand Deposits
(i) From banks
(ii) From otners
II. Savings Bank Deposits
III. Term Deposits
(i) From banks
(ii) From others
Total (I + II + III)
B. (i) Deposits of branches in India
(ii)Deposits of branches outside India
Total
SCHEDULE 4 - BORROWINGS
As on 31.3. As on 31.3.
Particulars
(Current Year) (Previous Year)
I. Borrowings in India
SCHEDULE 7 - BALANCES WITH BANKS AND MONEY AT CALL & SHORT NOTICE
Total (i + ii)
II. Outside India
(i) in Current Accounts
(ii) in Other Deposit Accounts
(iii) Money at Call and Short Notice
Total (i, ii, iii)
Grand Total (I + II)
SCHEDULE 8 - INVESTMENTS
SCHEDULE 9 – ADVANCES
As on 31.3. As on 31.3.
Particulars
(Current Year) (Previous Year)
A. (i) Bills Purchased and Discounted
(ii) Cash Credits, Overdrafts and Loans Payable on Demand
(iii) Term Loans
Total
B. (i) Secured by Tangible Assets
(i) Covered by Bank/Government Guarantees
(iii) Unsecured
Total
C. I. Advances in India
(i) Priority Sectors
(ii) Public Sector
(iii) Banks
(iv) Others
Total
II. Advances Outside India
(i) Due from Banks
(ii) Due from others
(a) Bills Purchased and Discounted
(b) Syndicated Loans
(c) Others
Total
Grand Total ( I + II)
SCHEDULE 10 - FIXED ASSETS
Particulars As on 31.3. As on 31.3.
(Current Year) (Previous Year)
I. Premises
At cost as on 31st March of the preceding year
Additions during the year
Deductions during the year
Depreciation to date
II. Other Fixed Assets (including Furniture and Fixtures)
At cost as on 31st March of the preceding year
Additions during the year
Deductions during the year
Depreciation to date
Total (I + II)
As on 31.3. As on 31.3.
Particulars
(Current Year) (Previous Year)
I. Claims against the bank not acknowledged as debts
II. Liability for partially paid investments
III. Liability on account of outstanding forward exchange contracts
IV. Guarantees given on behalf of constituents
(a) In India
(b) Outside India
V. Acceptances, endorsements and, other obligations
VI. Other items for which the bank is contingently liable
Total
As on 31.3. As on 31.3.
Particulars
(Current Year) (Previous Year)
I. Interest /discount on advances /bills
II. Income on investments
III. Interest on balances with Reserve Bank of India and other inter-bank
funds
IV. Others
Total
As on 31.3. As on 31.3.
Particulars
(Current Year) (Previous Year)
I. Commission, exchange and brokerage
II. Profit on sale of investments
Less: Loss on sale of investments
III. Profit on revaluation of investments
Less: Loss on revaluation of investments
IV. Profit on sale of land, buildings and other assets
Less: Loss on sale of land, buildings and other assets
V. Profit on exchange transactions
Less: Loss on exchange transactions
VI. Income earned by way of dividends etc., from subsidiaries/ companies
and/or joint ventures abroad / in India
VII. Miscellaneous Income
Total
As on 31.3. As on 31.3.
Particulars
(Current Year) (Previous Year)
I. Interest on deposits
II. Interest on Reserve Bank of India / inter-bank borrowings
III. Others
Total
As on 31.3. As on 31.3.
Particulars
(Current Year) (Previous Year)
I. Payments to and provisions for employees
II. Rent, taxes and lighting
III. Printing and stationery
IV. Advertisement and publicity
V. Depreciation on Bank’s property
VI. Directors’ fees, allowances and expenses
VII. Auditors’ fees and expenses (including branch auditors fees and
expenses)
VIII. Law Charges
IX. Postages, Telegrams, Telephones, etc.
X. Repairs and maintenance
XI. Insurance
XII. Other expenditure
Total
@ In case there is any unadjusted balance of loss, the same may be shown under this item with appropriate foot-
note.
Disclosure of Accounting Policies
In order to show that the financial position of banks represent a true and fair view, the Reserve Bank of India has
directed the banks to disclose the accounting policies regarding the key areas of operations along with the notes
of account in their financial statements for the accounting year ending 31.3.1991 and onwards, on a regular basis.
The accounting policies disclosed may contain the following aspects subject to modification by individual banks:
1. General
The accompanying financial statements have been prepared on the historical cost and con- form to the
statutory provisions and practices prevailing in the country.
2. Transactions involving Foreign Exchange
a. Monetary assets and liabilities have been translated at the exchange rates, prevailing at the close of the
year. Non-monetary assets have been carried in the books at the historical cost.
b. Income and expenditure items in respect of Indian branches have been translated at the exchange
rates, ruling on the date of the transaction and in respect of overseas branches at the exchange rates
prevailing at the close of the year.
c. Profit or loss on pending forward contracts has been accounted for.
3. Investments
a. Investments in Governments and other approved securities in India are valued at the lower of cost or
market value.
b. Investments in subsidiary companies and associate companies (i.e., companies in which the bank holds
at least 25 per cent of the share capital) have been accounted for on the historical cost basis.
c. All other investments are valued at the lower of cost or market value.
4. Advances
a. Provisions for doubtful advances have been made to the satisfaction of the auditors:
i. In respect of identified advances, based on a periodic review of advances and after taking into
account the portion of advance guaranteed by the Deposit Insurance and Credit Guarantee
Corporation, the Export Credit and Guarantee Corporation and similar statutory bodies.
ii. In respect of general advances, as a percentage of total advances taking into account the
guidelines issued by the Government of India and the Reserve Bank of India.
b. Provisions in respect of doubtful advances have been deducted from the advances to the extent
necessary and the excess have been included under “Other Liabilities and Provisions”.
c. Provisions have been made on a gross basis. Tax relief, which will be available when the advance is
written-off, will be accounted for in the year of write-off.
5. Fixed Assets
a. Premises and other fixed assets have been accounted for at their historical cost. Premises which have
been revalued are accounted for at the value determined on the basis of such revaluation made by the
professional values, profit arising on revaluation has been credited to Capital Reserve.
b. Depreciation has been provided for on the straight line/diminishing balance method.
c. In respect of revalued assets, depreciation is provided for on the revalued figures and an amount equal
to the additional depreciation consequent of revaluation is transferred annually from the Capital
Reserve to the General Reserve/Profit and Loss Account.
6. Staff Benefits
Provisions for gratuity/pension benefits to staff have been made on an accrual/casual basis. Separate funds
for gratuity/pension have been created.
7. Net Profit
a. The net profit disclosed in the Profit and Loss Account is after:
i. Provisions for taxes on income, in accordance with the statutory requirements.
ii. Provisions for doubtful advances.
iii. Adjustments to the value of “current investments” in Government and other approved securities in
India, valued at lower of cost or market value.
iv. Transfers to contingency funds.
v. Other usual or necessary provisions.
b. Contingency funds have been grouped in the Balance Sheet under the head “Other Liabilities and
Provisions”.
Illustration 1:
When closing the books of a bank on 31.12.2012 you find in the loan ledger an unsecured balance of ` 2,00,000 in
the account of a merchant whose financial condition is reported to you as bad and doubtful. Interest on the same
account amounted to ` 20,000 during the year.
How would you deal with this item of interest in 2012 account?
During the year 2013, the bank accepts 75 paise in the rupee on account of the total debt due up to 31.12.2012.
Show the entries and the necessary accounts showing the ultimate effect of the transactions in 2013 books of
account under Interest Suspense Method.
Solution:
Under Interest Suspense Method
When preparing the 2012 accounts the sum of ` 20,000 due from the merchant on account of interest should not
be carried to Profit and Loss Account, because its recovery was doubtful. It should, therefore, be transferred to an
Interest Suspense Account which would appear as a liability in Balance Sheet on 31.12.2012.
In the Books of Bank Journal
2,20,000 2,20,000
trouble which may appear in future. In addition to that bank also takes adequate securities. These items are shown
under the head Contingent Liabilities in Schedule – 12. These items include: Bills accepted by the bank on behalf
of its customers, letter of credit etc.
Illustration 2:
From the following details prepare “Acceptances, Endorsements and other Obligation A/c” as would appear in
the general ledger.
On 1.4.12 Acceptances not yet satisfied stood at ` 33,45,000. Out of which ` 30 lacs were subsequently paid off by
clients and bank had to honour the rest. A scrutiny of the Acceptance Register revealed the following:
(`)
T 7,50,000 -do-
X 4,05,000 -do-
Total 64,05,000
Amount Amount
Date Particulars Date Particulars
(`) (`)
2012-13 To Constituents’ liabilities for acceptanc- 3,000 1.4.12 By, Balance b/d 3,345
es/guarantees etc. (Paid off by clients)
Days after 31
` Due Date Discount Rate `
December, 2013
50,000 18/03/2012 31+ 29 +18 = 78 8% 852.46
30,000 13/03/2012 31+29+13 = 73 7% 418.85
40,000 28/03/2012 31+29+28 = 88 7% 673.22
60,000 23/03/2012 31+29+23 = 83 9% 1,224.59
Total 3,169.12
unsecured advance. It is needless to mention here that when an advance is granted by a bank to its customers
against any tangible security, bank can dispose of the said security for the realization of principle and interest
in case of default. The status of securities and the value of such securities must be mentioned by every bank is
Schedule 9. Before granting credit every bank must compare with the market value of securities so pledged to the
bank and the amount of advance granted by the bank together with the amount of interest.
Illustration 5:
The books of a bank include a loan of `5,00,000 advanced on 30.09.2012, interest changeable @ 16% p.a.
compounded quarterly. The security for the loan being 7,000 shares of `100 each in a public limited company
valued @ `90 each. There is no repayment till 31.12.2013. On 31.12.2013, the value of shares declined to ` 80 per
share.
How would you classify the loan as secured or unsecured in the Balance Sheet?
Solution:
16 3
31.03.2013 20,800 (` 5,20,000 × × ) 5,40,800
100 12
30.06.2013 21,632 5,62,432
30.09.2013 22,497 Do 5,84,929
31.12.2013 23,397 6,08,326
1,08,326
RBI’s Prudential Accounting Norms
Just to control the lending activities, the recommendation of Narasimhan Committee was accepted by RBI. As per
the recommendation, RBI’s Prudential Accounting Norms are:
(a) Recognition of Income;
(b) Classification of Assets; and
(c) Provision for Loans and Advances
A. Recognition of Income:
As per RBI’s norms, every bank must recognize its income
Classification of Assets
Assets are classified as:
Assets
Restructured Advances:
• Restructured accounts classified as standard advances will attract a provision (as prescribed from time to
time) in the first two years from the date of restructuring. In cases of moratorium on payment of interest/
principal after restructuring, such advances will attract a provision for the period covering moratorium and
two years thereafter;
• Restructured accounts classified as non-performing advances, when upgraded to standard category will
attract a provision (as prescribed from time to time) in the first year from the date of upgradation.
Banks will hold provision against the restructured advances as per the extant provisioning norms.
The above-mentioned higher provision on restructured standard advances (2.75 per cent as prescribed vide
circular dated November 26, 2012) would increase to 5 per cent in respect of new restructured standard accounts
(flow) with effect from June 1, 2013 and increase in a phased manner for the stock of restructured standard
accounts as on May 31, 2013 as under:
• 3.50 per cent - with effect from March 31, 2014 (spread over the four quarters of 2013-14)
• 4.25 per cent - with effect from March 31, 2015 (spread over the four quarters of 2014-15)
• 5.00 per cent - with effect from March 31, 2016 (spread over the four quarters of 2015-16)
1. Sub-Standard Advances:
Advances classified as “sub-standard” will attract a provision of 15 per cent as against the 10 per cent.
The “unsecured exposures” classified as sub-standard assets will attract an additional provision of 10 per
cent, i.e., a total of 25 per cent as against the 20 per cent. However, “unsecured exposures” in respect
of Infrastructure loan accounts classified as sub-standard, in case of which certain safeguards such as
escrow accounts are available, will attract an additional provision of 5 per cent only i.e. a total of 20 per
cent as against 15 per cent.
2. Doubtful Advances:
Doubtful Advances will continue to attract 100% provision to the extent the advance is not covered by
the realisable value of the security to which the bank has a valid recourse and the realisable value is
estimated on a realistic basis.
However, in respect of the secured portion, following provisioning requirements will be applicable: The
secured portion of advances which have remained in “doubtful” category up to one year will attract a
provision of 25 per cent (as against 20 per cent);
The secured portion of advances which have remained in “doubtful” category for more than one year
but upto 3 years will attract a provision of 40 per cent (as against 30 per cent); and
The secured portion of advances which have remained in “doubtful” category for more than 3 years will
continue to attract a provision of 100%.
Rates of Provisioning for Non-Performing Assets and Restructured Advances
Category of Advances Rate (%)
Standard Advances
(a) Direct advances to agricultural and SME 0.25
(b) Advances to Commercial Real Estate (CRE) Sector 1.00
(c) All other loans 0.40
Sub-standard Advances
Secured Exposures 15
Unsecured Exposures in respect of Infrastructure loan accounts where certain safeguards such as 20
escrow accounts are available.
Unsecured other loans 25
Doubtful Advances – Unsecured Portion 100
Doubtful Advances – Secured Portion
For Doubtful upto 1 year 25
For Doubtful > 1 year and upto 3 years 40
For Doubtful > 3 years 100
`
A. Amount Outstanding xxx
B. Less: Realizable value of Security (if any held) (xxx)
xxx
C. Less: ECGC/DICGC cover (% limited to ….) (xxx)
D. Unsecured Portion [A-B-C] xxx
E. Provision required for unsecured portion of Doubtful Asset @100% xxx
F. Provision required for secured portion of Doubtful Asset @ 25%,/40%/100% Xxx
G. Total Provision required [E+F] Xxx
Illustration 7:
From the following information of details of advances of X Bank Limited calculate the amount of provisions to be
made in Profit and Loss Account for the year ended 31.3.2012:
Solution:
Statement showing provisions on various performing and non-performing assets
Illustration 8:
From the particulars given below, ascertain the amount of provision to be made against the advances of SBI,
Kolkata. (` in ’00,000)
Solution:
Statement Showing the Ascertainment of Provisions (` in ’00,000)
Illustration 9.
Rajatapeeta Bank Ltd. had extended the following credit lines to a Small Scale Industry, which had not paid any
Interest since March, 2006:
Compute necessary provisions to be made for the year ended 31st March, 2012.
Solution:
Required Provision:
(`) (`)
Amount outstanding (packing credit) 90.00
Less : Realisable value of securities 22.50
67.50
Less : ECGC cover (50%) 33.75
Note : Doubtful advances have been taken as fully secured. However, in case, the students assume that no
security cover is available for these advances, provision will be made for 100%.
* As per the Master Circular issued by RBI.
Illustration 11.
The following are the figures extracted from the books of Y Bank Ltd. [Scheduled Commercial Bank] as on 31.3.2013.
Other information: (Amount in `)
Interest and Discount received 20,30,000 Directors’ fees and allowance 12,000
Interest paid on Deposits 12,02,000 Rent and taxes paid 54,000
Issued and Subscribed Capital 5,00,000 Stationery and printing 12,000
Reserve under Section 17 3,50,000 Postage and Telegram 25,000
Commission, Exchange and Brokerage 90,000 Other expenses 12,000
Rent received 30,000 Audit fees 4,000
Profit on sale of investment 95,000 Depreciation on Bank’s properties 12,500
Salaries and Allowances 1,05,000
i. Provision for bad and doubtful debts necessary ` 2,00,000.
ii. Rebate on bills discounted as on 31.3.2013 ` 7,500.
iii. Provide ` 3,50,000 fo income tax.
iv. The directors desire to declare 10% dividend.
Make the necessary assumption and prepare the Profit and Loss Account in accordance with the law.
` `
I. Interest and Discount received 20,30,000
Less: Rebate on bill discounted as on 31.3.2013 7,500 20,22,500
II. Income on Investments
III. Interest on balances with RBI and other inter-bank fund
IV. Others
Total 20,22,500
`
I. Commission, exchange and brokerage 90,000
II. Rent received 30,000
III. Net Profit on sale of investments 95,000
IV. Net Profit on revaluation of investments —
Less : Net Loss on revaluation of investments —
V. Net Profit on sale of land, buildings & other assets —
VI. Net Profit on exchange transactions —
VII. Income earned by way of dividends etc from subsidiaries/joint ventures setpu —
abroad/in India
VIII. Miscellaneous Income —
Total 2,15,000
`
I. Interest on Deposits 12,02,000
II. Interest on RBI / Inter-bank borrowings —
III. Others —
Total 12,02,000
Schedule 16 : Operating Expenses
`
I. Payment to and provision for employees 1,05,000
II. Rent, taxes and lighting 54,000
III. Printing and stationery 12,000
IV. Advertisement and publicity —
V. Depreciation on Bank’s property 12,500
VI. Directors’ fees and allowances 12,000
VII. Auditor’s fees and expenses 4,000
VIII. Law charges —
IX. Postage and telegram 25,000
X. Repairs and maintenane —
XI. Insurance —
XII. Other expenditure 12,000
Total 2,36,500
Schedule Amount
Details
No. (` in Lakhs)
Advances 9 2,407.47
Fixed Assets 10 228.73
Total 3,882.33
Contingent Liabilities 12 14.67
Bills for Collection 18.10
Schedules Schedule 1 - Capital
` (in lakh)
Issued, Subscribed and Called – up Capital 297.00
(29,70,000 @` 10)
Schedule 2 - Reserves and Surplus
` (in lakh)
1. Demand Deposits 780.18
2. Savings Bank Deposits 675.00
3. Term Deposit 775.50
2,230.68
Schedule 4 - Borrowings
` (in lakh)
Borrowings from other Banks 165.00
Schedule 5 - Other Liabilities
` (in lakh)
Bills Payable 0.15
Schedule 6 - Cash and Balances with RBI
` (in lakh)
Cash in Hand 240.23
Balances with RBI 67.82
308.05
Schedule 7 - Balances with Banks and Money at Call and Short Notice
` (in lakh)
Cash with other Banks 132.81
Money at Call and short Notice 315.18
Schedule 8 – Investment
` (in lakh)
Government securities 365.25
Gold 82.84
4,48.09
Schedule 9 – Advances
` (in lakh)
Cash Credit 1,218.15
Term Loans 1,189.32
2,407.47
Schedule 10 - Fixed Assets
= Load × Load Factor of the category in which the consumer falls x (Billing cycle + 45 days) ×
Current tariff.
ii. The historical capital cost of the asset shall include additional capitalisation on accout of Foreign Exchange
Rate Variation up to 31.3.2004 already allowed by the Central Government Commission.
iii. Land other than the land held under lease and the land for reservoir in case of hydro generating station shall
not be a depreciable asset and its cost shall be excluded from the capital cost while computing depreciable
value of the asset.
iv. Depreciation shall be calculated annually, based on Straight Line Method over the useful life of the asset and
at the rates prescribed in Appendix III to these regulations.
v. The Residual Life of the asset shall be considered as 10 years.
vi. The Salvage Value of the Asset shall be considered as 10%.
vii. Depreciation shall be allowed upto maximum of 90% of the historical cost of the asset.
viii. On repayment of entire loan, the remaining depreciable value shall be spread over the balance useful life of
the asset.
ix. Depreciation shall be chargeable from the first year of operation. In case of operation of the asset for part of
the year, depreciation shall be charged on pro rata basis.
Step 3: Calculate Total Capital Cost of All Assets (other than Freehold Land).
Step 4: Calculate Weighted Average Rate of Depreciation.
Total Depreciationon all Assets(other thanFreehold land)
× 100
Total capital cost of All Assets (other than Freehold Land)
Illustration 13.
From the following calculate Weighted Average Rate of Depreciation considering the rates as per Appendix-III
Closing Balance
Assets
at Cost
1. Land under full ownership 14,30,000
2. Land under Lease 4,30,000
3. (a) Building & Civil Engineering Works other than Kutcha Roads 33,00,000
(b) Railways Sidings 40,00,000
(c) Temporary Erections such as Wooden Structures 10,00,000
4. IT Equipments 20,00,000
5. Self Propelled Vehicles 30,00,000
6. Portable Air Conditioning Plants 25,00,000
7. (a) Apparatus other than Motors let on hire 15,00,000
(b) Motors let on hire 2,00,000
8. Communication Equipments 5,00,000
9. Office Furniture, Furnishing, Equipments ,Fittings & Apparatus 5,00,000
10. Plants & Machinery in generating stations 2,52,00,000
11. Cooling Towers & Circulating Water Systems 10,00,000
12. Hydraulic Works Forming part of the Hydro-dams, etc. 20,00,000
13. Transformers & Switchgear 2,05,00,000
14. Lighting Arrestor, Batteries, Overhead lines including cable support 42,00,000
15. Meters 20,00,000
16. Static Air Conditioning Plants 1,00,00,000
17. Street Light Fittings 47,85,000
18. Vehicles other than Self Propelled Vehicles 2,15,000
Solution:
WEIGHTED AVERAGE RATE OF DEPRECIATION
59,89,862
= × 100 = 6.4731%
8,88,30,000
Illustration 14.
Calculate depreciation as per 2009 regulations from the following information of an Electricity generation
project
i. Date of commercial operation i.e. 1.9.2010.
iii. The details of actual expenditure incurred up to the date of commercial operation i.e 1.9.2010 and projected
expenditure to be incurred from the date of commercial operation up to 31.3.2014 for the assets under
Transmission system.The details of apportioned approved cost as on the date of commercial operation and
projected expenditure to be incurred for the above mentioned assets is summarized below:
[` in lakh]
(iii)
Additional capital expenditure of 20,000 lakh has been considered out of 1,00,000 lakh for the year 2010-11 and
no further additional capital expenditure has been considered as capital cost has been restricted to apportioned
approved cost in the absence of revised capital expenditure.
Solution:
Computation of Depreciation
Illustration 15.
Calculate depreciation upto 2013-14 as per 2009 regulations from the following information of XYZ Power
generation Project
Date of commercial operation/Work Completed Date 11-Jan-1996
Beginning of Current year 1-Apr-2011
Useful life 35 years
(Figures in ` Crores)
1. Capital Cost at beginning of the year 2011-12 222.00
2. Additional Capltiisation during the year: 2012-13 10.56
2013-14 29.44
3. Value of Freehold Land 12.00
4. Depreciation recovered up to 2009-10 48.60
5. Depreciation recovered in 2010-11 5.40
Note: Capital Cost and Accumulated Depreciation at the beginning of the year are as per tariff order FY 2011-12
Solution:
Name of the Power Station: XYZ Power Generation Project
Date of commercial operation/Work Completed Date: 11-Jan-1996
Beginning of Current year: 1-Apr-2011
Useful life: 35 years
Remaining Useful life: 20 years
Statement showing the Calculation of Depreciation
Particulars 2011-12 2012-13 2013-14
A. Opening Capital Cost 222.00 222.00 232.56
B. Additional Capital Cost 0.00 10.56 29.44
C Closing Capital Cost 222.00 232.56 262.00
D. Average Capital Cost [(A + C)/2] 222.00 227.28 247.28
E. Less: Cost of Freehold Land 12.00 12.00 12.00
F. Average Capital Cost for Depreciation (D - E) 210.00 215.28 235.28
G. Depreciable value (90% of F) 189.00 193.75 211.75
H. Depreciation recovered upto prev. year *(48.6 + 5.4) *54.00 60.75 67.75
I. Balance Depreciation to be recovered (G - H) 135.00 133.00 144
J. Balance useful life out of 35 years 20.00 19.00 18.00
How to calculate Advance Against Depreciation (AAD) for the purpose of tariff as per Regulation 21
Illustration 16.
From the following information Calculate Depreciation and Advance against Depreciation as per Regulation 21
of the Central Electricity Regulatory Commission (Terms and Conditions of Tariff) Regulations, 2004.
• Date of Commercial Operation of COD = 1st April 2010
• Approved opening Capital cost as on 1st April 2010 = 1,50,000
• Weighted Average Rate of Depreciation: 3.5%
• Details of allowed Additional Capital Expenditure. Repayment of Loan and Weighted Average Rate of
Interest on Loan is as follows:
Solution:
1. COMPUTATION OF DEPRECIATION
How to calculate Return on Equity for the Purpose of Tariff as per Regulation 21
1. Return on Equity shall be computed on the Equity base (as per Regulation 20) @ 14% p.a.
2. Statement showing the Calculation of Return on Equity
Illustration 17.
From the following information Calculate Return on Equity as per Regulation 21 of the Central Electricity Regulatory
Commission (Terms and Conditons of Tariff) Regulations, 2004:
1. Date of Commercial Operation of COD = 1st April 2010
2. Approved Opening Capital Cost as on 1st April 2010 = ` 15,00,000
3. Details of allowed Additional Capital Expenditure. Repayment of Loan and Weighted Average
Solution:
Computation of Return of Equity
Particulars 1st year 2nd year 3rd year 4th year
A. Opening Equity (30%) 4,50,000 4,80,000 4,89,000 4,95,000
B. Additional Equity (30%) 30,000 9,000 6,000 3,000
c. Closing Equity (A + B) 4,80,000 4,89,000 4,95,000 4,98,000
D. Average Equity [(A + C)/2] 4,65,000 4,84,500 4,92,000 4,96,500
E. Return on Equity (D × 14%) 65,100 67,830 68,880 69,510
Illustration 18.
The trial balance of MM Electric Supply Ltd. For the year ended 31st March, 2013 is as below:
Dr. Cr.
Particulars Amount (` in ‘000) Amount (` in ‘000)
Share Capital:
Equity Shares of `10 each 50,000
14% Preference Shares of `100 each 15,000
Patents and trade mark 2,504
15% Debentures 24,700
16% term loan 15,300
Land (additons during the year 20,50) 12,450
Building (additions during the year 50,80) 35,134
Plant & Machinery 57,058
Mains 4,524
Meters 3,150
Electrical Instruments 1,530
Office Rurniture 2,450
During 2012-13 1,00,000, 14% Preference Shares were redeemed at a premium of 10% out of proceeds of fresh issue
of equity shares of necessary amounts at a premium of 10%
Required prepare for the above period general balance sheet as on 31st March, 2013 as per the schedule III:
Adjustments:
1. Transfer to Contingency Reserve ` 1,70,000 & to General Reserve ` 2,00,000
2. Loss on Contingency Reserve Investment ` 10,000
3. Make a Provision for debts considered doubtful of ` 1,014,000.
Solution:
MM Electric Supply Ltd.
Balance Sheet as at 31st March, 2013
Particulars Note No. (` in ’000)
I. EQUITYANDLIABILITIES
(1) Shareholders’ Funds
(a) Share Capital 1 65,000
(b) Reserves and Surplus 2 21,376
(2) Non-Current Liabilities
(a) Long-term Borrowings 3 40,000
(3) Current Liabilities
(a) Trade Payables 6,524
(b) Short-Term Provisions 4 12,100
Total
Notes to Accounts:
1. Share Capital
Authorised Capital
50,00,000 shares of 10 each 50,000
2,50,000 14% Pref. Shares of 100 each 25,000
75,000
3. Long-term Borrowings
15% Debentures 24,700
16% Term Loan 15,300
40,000
4. Short-term Provisions
6. Non-Current Investments
7. Trade Receivables
INTRODUCTION
Several people exposed to a particular type of risk contribute small amounts called premiums to an insurance fund
from which the unfortunates who actually suffer the risk are compensated. Insurance business is essentially a way
of averaging the risks.
A policy is a contract entered into between the insurance companies called the ‘insurer’ and the person insuring
his risk called the ‘insured’.
Policy specifies all the conditions subject to which the policy is issued. These conditions bind both the parties.
The policy is in the form of a document which the insurance company issues after receiving the premium. Thus
Insurance is essentially a method of averaging risks.
Types of Policies
Depending on the type of risk, there are several types of insurance policies.
Risks of fire are covered by fire policies.
Marine risks of goods, vessels and freights of goods are covered by marine insurance policies.
Losses of theft are covered by Burglary insurance.
There are miscellaneous policies to insure accidents, fidelity of employees, loss of profits in the event of fire and
accidents and deaths to employees at work spots.
Life insurance takes primarily two forms. In the case of endowment policy, the insured obtains a specified sum
in the event of the insured obtaining a specified age or to the family in case the insured dies before attaining
specified age. They may be again with or without profit policies. Whereas in the case of whole life policies the
family of the insured (to be exact the nominee mentioned in the policy) receives a specified sum on the death of
insured.
The premiums would be less in the case of whole life policies compared to endowment policies for the insured of
the same age.
Principles of Insurance
There are several principles governing insurance business, the important of which are discussed below.
Principle of indemnity. Insurance is a contract of indemnity. The insurer is called indemnifier and the insured is the
indemnified. In a contract of indemnity, only those who suffer loss are compensated to the extent of actual loss
suffered by them. One cannot make profit by insuring his risks.
Insurable interest. All and sundry cannot enter into contracts of insurance. For example, A cannot insure the life of
B who is a total stranger. But if B, happens to be his wife or his debtor or business manager, A has insurable interest
and therefore he can insure the life of B. For every type of policy insurable interest is insisted upon. In the absence
of such interest the contract will amount to a wagering contract.
Principle of uberrimae fidei. Under ordinary law of contract there is no positive duty to tell the whole truth in
relation to the subject-matter of the contract. There is only the negative obligation to tell nothing but the truth. In
a contract of insurance, however there is an implied condition that each party must disclose every material fact
known to him. This is because all contracts of insurance are contracts of uberrimea fidei, i.e., contracts of utmost
good faith. This is because the assessment of the risk and the determination of the premium by the insurer depends
on the full and frank disclosure of all material facts in the proposal form.
Distinction between Life and Non-life Insurance
There are certain basic differences between life policies and other types of policies. These are listed below:
(1) Human life cannot be valued exactly. Therefore each insured is permitted to insure his life for a specified
sum, depending on his capacity to pay premiums. This is also one form of investment and the policy amount
depends on his investment decision. In the event of the policy maturing the insurer must pay the policy
amount as actual loss cannot be determined. This is not the case with other policies. Other policies are
contracts of indemnity. Therefore not withstanding the amount for which the policy is taken, the insurer would
pay (reimburse) only the actual loss suffered or the liability incurred.
(2) Life insurance contracts are long-term contracts. Once a policy is taken premiums have to be paid for number
of years till maturity and the policy amount is paid on maturity. Of course, a life policy can be surrendered
after certain number of years and the insured is paid a proportion of the premiums paid known as surrender
value. In the case of other policies they are for a short period of one year although the policy can be renewed
year after year.
(3) Life insurance is known also by another term ‘assurance’ since the insured gets an assured sum. Other policies
are known as insurance.
(4) The determination of profit is by different methods for life and general insurance business. In the case of life
business periodically actuaries estimate the liability under existing policies.
On that basis a valuation Balance Sheet is prepared to determine the profit. In the case of general insurance
business a portion of the premium is carried forward as a provision for unexpired liability and the balance net of
claims and expenses is taken as profit (or loss).
2. The register of claims. This book should contain the following particulars in respect of each claim:
(a) The date of claim;
(b) The name and address of the claimant;
(c) The date on which the claim was discharged; and
(d) In the case of a claim which is rejected, the date of rejection and the ground for rejection.
3. The register of licensed insurance agents. This book should contain the following particulars in respect of each
agent:
(a) Name and address of every insurance agent appointed;
(b) The date of appointment; and
(c) The date on which appointment ceased, if any.
In addition to the statutory books mentioned above, insurance companies also maintain the following
subsidiary books for recording the transactions:
Some of the important provisions of the Life Insurance Corporation Act, 1956 which are worth noting are stated
below:
(1) Section 30. Except to the extent otherwise expressly provided in this Act, on and from the appointed day he
Corporation shall have the exclusive privilege of carrying on life insurance business in India; and on and from
the said day any certificate to registration under the Insurance Act held by any insurer immediately before
the said day shall cease to have effect in so far as it authorises him to carry on life insurance business in India.
(2) Section 37. The sums assured by all policies issued by the Corporation including any bonuses declared in
respect thereof and, subject to the provisions contained in section 14 the amounts assured by all policies
issued by any insurer the liabilities under which have vested in the Corporation under this Act, and all bonuses
declared in respect thereof, whether before or after the appointed, day shall be guaranteed as to payment
in cash by the Central Government.
(3) Section 6. Functions of the Corporation.
(a) The general duty of the Corporation is to carry on life insurance business whether in or outside India and
to develop the life insurance business to the best advantage of the community.
(b) In addition the Corporation has the power:
(i) To carry on capital redemption business, annuity certain business or re-insurance business,
(ii) To invest the funds of the Corporation,
(iii) To acquire, hold and dispose of any property for the purpose of its business, and
(iv) To advance or lend money upon the security of any movable or immovable property or otherwise.
(v) Sections 18 and 19. The central office is located at Mumbai and has zonal offices at Mumbai,
Kolkata, Delhi, Kanpur and Chennai.
There may be established as many divisional offices and branches in each zone as may be decided by
the Corporation in accordance with the guidelines issued by the Insurance Regulatory and Development
Authority established under the Insurance Regulatory and Development Authority Act, 1999 in this regard.
The general superintendence and direction of the Corporation affairs is carried on by an executive
committee consisting of not more than 5 members. The investment committee advises the Corporation in
matters relating to investment of funds. This committee can have a maximum of 8 members of which 4 must
be members of the Corporation.
As per Section 4 the Corporation consists of not more than 15 members appointed by the Central Government
and one of them nominated will act as the Chairman.
(4) Sections 20. The Corporation may appoint one or more persons to be the Managing Director or Directors of
the Corporation, and every Managing Director shall be a whole-time officer of the Corporation and shall
exercise such powers and perform such duties as may be entrusted or delegated to him by the Executive
Committee or the Corporation
(5) Section 24. The Corporation has its own fund and all the receipts are credited to such fund and all payments
are made there from.
(6) Section 25. The accounts of the Corporation shall be audited by auditors duly qualified to act as auditors
of companies under the law for the time being in force relating to companies, and the auditors shall be
appointed by the Corporation with the previous approval of the Central Government and shall receive such
remuneration from the Corporation as the Central Government may fix.
Every auditor in the performance of his duties shall have at all reasonable times access to the books, accounts
and other documents of the Corporation.
The auditors shall submit their report to the Corporation and shall also forward a copy of their report to the
Central Government.
(7) Section 26. There must be an actuarial valuation at least once in every year and the Corporation must submit
the report to the Central Government.
(8) Section 27. At the end of each financial year the Corporation is required to prepare and submit a report to
the Central Government giving an account of its activities during the previous financial year and also an
account of the planned activities for the next financial year.
(9) Section 28. Ninety-five percent (or a higher percentage approved by the Central Government) from actuarial
valuation made under Section 26 shall be allocated to or reserved for the policyholders of the Corporation
and the remainder either paid to the Central Government or utilized for such purposes and in such manner
as the Government may determine.
(10) Section 28A. If for any financial year profits accrue from any business (other than life insurance business)
carried on by the Corporation, then, after making provision for reserves and other matters for which provision
is necessary or expedient, the balance of such profits shall be paid to the Central Government.
(11) Section 29. The Central Government shall cause the report of the auditors under section 25, the report of
the actuaries under section 26 and the report giving an account of the activities of the Corporation under
section 27 to be laid before both Houses of Parliament as soon as may be after each such report is received
by the Central Government.
Types of Policies:
As stated earlier, under a contract of life insurance an insurance company guarantees to pay a fixed sum of
money to the insured on his attaining a certain age or to his nominees or legal heirs on his death. The contract in
its written form is called a policy and broadly there are two types of policies. They are
(2) Endowment policy. Under whole life policy the insured does not get the amount during his life time. The
amount is paid only to his nominees or heirs on his death. In the case of Endowment policy the amount is paid
to the insured on his attainment of a specified age or if he dies before, the amount is paid to his nominees or
heirs. As explained later life insurance company ascertains the profits once in two years. 95% of such profits
are distributed to policyholders as bonus. Such bonus is to be credited only to ‘with profit policies’. The holders
of ‘without profit policies’ have no right to the bonus. Naturally the premium is comparatively less in the case
of ‘without profit policies’ than in the case of ‘with profit policies’. In recent years the reversionary bonus has
been around ` 20 per thousand sum assured per annum on Endowment policies and ` 25 per thousand sum
assured per annum on whole life policies.
Annuity Business:
Life insurance companies also do annuity business. Annuity refers to fixed annual payment made by the insurance
company to the insured on his attaining a specified age. The insured deposits lump sum amount by way of
consideration for the annuity granted. This is a method under which the person purchasing the annuity receives
back his money with interest. Annuity paid represents an expenditure of the life insurance business and the
consideration received for annuities is an item of income.
Surrender Value:
In the case of life policy, the policy normally has value only when it matures. But to facilitate the promotion of
business, insurance companies assign value to the policy on the basis of the premiums paid. Insurance companies
will be prepared to pay such value on the surrender of the policy by a needy policy holder desiring to realize the
policy. Therefore the value is referred to as ‘surrender value’. Surrender value is usually nil until at least two annual
premiums are paid. Amount paid as surrender value is an expenditure and is similar to claims paid.
Paid-up Policy:
A policy holder, who has difficulty in paying the premium, may be allowed an option to get the policy paid-up. In
such a case, the policyholder is relieved from the obligation of paying off the rest of premium, but he will not get
the full value of policy which is calculated as follows:
At the starting of the next period a reverse entry is passed, so that when these claims intimated are paid, they may
not influence the claims account of next year. However, if company rejects any claim, such amount should be
transferred to the insurance fund account and not to the claims account.
Commission: Generally, Insurance Companies get business through agents; these agents receive commission on
the basis of the amount of premium they generate for the Insurance Company. Commission paid to Agents is
shown as a debit (expense) in the Revenue Accounts.
Re-insurance:
Re-insurance means the transfer of a part of risk by the insurer. This is particularly done when the amount of
insurance is very high and when it is very difficult to bear the entire risk by a single insurer, a part of the risk is to be
insured with some other insurance companies.
Double Insurance: When the same risk and the same subject matter is insured with more than one insurer, i.e., more
than one insurance company, the same is called Double Insurance.
Ceding Company: An insurance company that shifts part or all of a risk it has assumed to another insurance
company. The Ceding company shares the premium amount it has received to cover the risk, with the second
insurance company called the Reinsurer. In return the Reinsurer company pays commission to the Ceding
company for getting the business.
Life Assurance Fund.
This represents the excess of revenue receipts over revenue expenditure relating to life business. The fund is
available to meet the aggregate liability on all policies outstanding. Revenue Account is prepared every year to
ascertain the balance of life insurance fund at the end of the year. In the preparation of Revenue Account, the
opening balance of the life insurance fund is the starting point. Other items of revenue income are credited to the
fund and revenue items of expense are debited. The resulting figure is the closing balance of the revenue fund.
Illustration 19.
The Revenue Account of a life insurance company shows the life assurance fund on 31st March, 2013 at ` 62,21,310
before taking into account the following items:
(i) Claims covered under re-insurance ` 12,000.
(ii) Bonus utilized in reduction of life insurance premium ` 4,500.
(iii) Interest accrued on securities ` 8,260.
(iv) Outstanding premium ` 5,410.
(v) Claims intimated but not admitted ` 26,500.
What is the life assurance fund after taking into account the above omissions?
Solution:
Statement showing Life Assurance Fund
Add:
62,34,980
Less:
To Net liability as per actuary’s valuation By Life Assurance Fund as per Balance Sheet
To Surplus (Net Profit) By Deficiency (Net loss)
Illustration 20:
The life insurance fund of Prakash Life Insurance Co. Ltd. was ` 34,00,000 on 31st March, 2013. Its actuarial valuation
on 31st March, 2013 disclosed a net liability of ` 28,80,000. An interim bonus of ` 40,000 was paid to the policyholders
during the previous two years. It is now proposed to carry forward ` 1,10,000 and to divide the balance between
the policyholders and the shareholders. Show (a) the Valuation Balance Sheet, (b) the net profit for the two-year
period, and (c) the distribution of the profits.
Solution:
In the Books of Prakash Life Insurance Co. Ltd. Valuation Balance Sheet as on 31st March, 2013
Illustration 21:
From the following figures of Well Life assurance Co. Ltd. prepare a Valuation Balance Sheet and Profit Distribution
Statement for the year ended 31st March 2014. Also pass necessary journal entries to record the above transactions
with narrations:
Workings:
2. Revisionary Bonus
@ `185 per ` 1,000
2 2,40,00,000
On 2,40,00,000 (` 6,00,00,000 × )=` × 185
5 1,000
= ` 44,40,000
A and B as well. The report deals with compliance of certain requirements of the regulations, provision of
solvency margins, disclosure with regard to the overall risk exposure and the strategy adopted to mitigate the
same. It also includes ageing of claims indicating the average period taken to settle the claims, computing
market value of investments, its impact on balance sheet and a review of asset quality performance of
investments in terms of portfolios such as real estate, loans, investments, etc. Finally, the report includes a
responsibility statement indicating the compliance with the accounting standards, financial statements
reflecting a true and fair view, maintenance of adequate accounting records, preparation of accounts on
a going-concern basis and the existence of an internal audit system consistent with the size and nature of
business.
(6) The financial statements should disclose the contingent liabilities, the accounting policies and the departures
from such policies with reasons therefore.
(7) Premium recognition. Premium is the main revenue for insurance business. In the case of life business premium
is to be recognized on due basis. In the case of general insurance premium is to be recognized as income
over the contract period or the period of risk whichever is appropriate.
Unearned premium and premium received in advance both of which represent income not relating to
the accounting period must be disclosed separately in the financial statements. Unearned premium is the
premium for the period of unexpired risk. Premium received in advance represents the premium received
prior to the commencement of risk. In other words, the premium relates entirely to subsequent accounting
periods. A provision should be made for unearned premium. Both premium received in advance and
unearned premium are shown separately in the balance sheet under the heading ‘Current Liabilities’.
(8) Premium Deficiency. It is the sum of expected claim costs, related expenses and maintenance costs
exceeding the related unearned premium.
(9) Actuarial Valuation of claims liability-in some cases. Previously there was no need for actuarial valuation in
general insurance. Now the regulations require estimation of claims made in respect of contracts exceeding
four years, must be recognized on actuarial basis, subject to the regulations of the Authority.
(10) Catastrophe reserve. Such a reserve should be created by the insurers towards losses which might arise due
to entirely unexpected set of events and not for any specific known purpose. Investment of the funds of this
reserve must be made in accordance with the prescription of Authority.
(11) Valuation of investments must be made in the manner prescribed by the Authority.
(12) Loans must be measured on historical cost subject to impairment provisions.
The Regulations issued by IRDA regarding the preparation of Financial Statements and Auditors’ Report of
Insurance Companies on 14th August, 2000 are given in Appendix. The student is advised to familiarize with
new forms of Revenue Accounts and Final Accounts and the connected Schedule.
(c) All words and expressions used herein ‘and not defined but defined in the Insurance Act, 1938 (4
of 1938), or in the Insurance Regulatory and Development Authority Act, 1999 (41 of 1999), or in the
Companies Act, 1956 (1 of 1956), shall have the meanings respectively assigned to them in those
Acts.
3. Preparation of financial statements, management report and auditor’s report
(1) An insurer carrying on life insurance business, after the commencement of these Regulations, shall
comply with the requirements of Schedule A.
(2) An insurer carrying on general insurance business, after the commencement of these Regulations,
shall comply with the requirements of Schedule B:Provided that this sub-regulation shall apply, mutatis
mutandis, to reinsurers, until separate regulations are made.
(3) The report of the auditors on the financial statements of every insurer and reinsurer, shall be in conformity
with the requirements of Schedule C, or as near as thereto as the circumstances permit.
(4) The Authority may, from time to time, issue separate guidelines in the matter of appointment, continuance
or removal of auditors of an insurer or reinsurer, as the case may be, and such guidelines may include
prescriptions regarding qualifications and experience of auditors, their rotation, period of appointment,
etc.
SCHEDULE A
(See Regulation 3)
PART I
Accounting principles for preparation of financial statements:
1. Applicability of Accounting Standards: Every Balance Sheet, Revenue Account [Policyholders’ Account],
Receipts and Payments Account [Cash Flow Statement] and Profit and Loss Account [Shareholders’
Account] of an insurer shall be in conformity with the Accounting Standards (AS) issued by the ICAI, to the
extent applicable to insurers carrying on life insurance business, except that:
(i) Accounting Standard 3 (AS 3)-Cash Flow Statements-Cash Flow Statement shall be prepared only under
the Direct Method.
(ii) Accounting Standard 17 (AS 17)-Segment Reporting-shall apply irrespective of whether the securities of
the insurer are traded publicly or not.
2. Premium: Premium shall be recognized as income when due. For linked business the due date for payment
may be taken as the date when the associated units are created.
3. Premium Deficiency: Premium deficiency shall be recognized if the sum of expected claim costs, related
expenses and maintenance costs exceeds related unearned premiums.
4. Acquisition Costs: Acquisition costs, if any, shall be expensed in the period in which they are incurred.
Acquisition costs are those costs that vary with and are primarily related to the acquisition of new and renewal
insurance contracts. The most essential test is the obligatory relationship between costs and the execution of
insurance contracts (i.e., commencement of risk).
5. Claims Cost: The ultimate cost of claims shall comprise the policy benefit amount and claims settlement
costs, wherever applicable.
6. Actuarial Valuation: The estimation of liability against life policies in force shall be determined by the
appointed actuary of the insurer pursuant to his annual investigation of the life insurance business. Actuarial
assumptions are to be disclosed by way of notes to the account.
The liability shall be so calculated that together with future premium payments and investment income, the
insurer can meet all future claims (including bonus entitlements to policyholders) and expenses.
7. Procedure to determine the Values of Investments: An insurer shall determine the values of investments in the
following manner:
(a) Real Estate-Investment Property: The value of investment property shall be determined at historical cost,
subject to revaluation at least once in every three years. The change in the carrying amount of the
investment property shall be taken to Revaluation Reserve.
The insurer shall assess at each balance sheet date whether any impairment of the investment property
has occurred.
Gains/losses arising due to changes in the carrying amount of real estate shall be taken to Equity under
‘Revaluation Reserve’. The ‘Profit on sale of investments’ or ‘Loss on sale of investments’, as the case
may be, shall include accumulated changes in the carrying amount previously recognized in Equity
under the heading ‘Revaluation Reserve’ in respect of a particular property and being recycled to the
relevant Revenue Account or Profit and Loss Account on sale of that property.
The bases for revaluation shall be disclosed in the notes to account. The Authority (IRDA) may issue
directions specifying the amount to be released from the revaluation reserve for declaring bonus to
the policyholders. For the removal of doubt, it is clarified that except for the amount that is released to
policyholders as per the authority’s direction, no other amount shall be distributed to shareholders out
of Revaluation Reserve Account.
An impairment loss shall be recognized as an expense in the Revenue/Profit and Loss Account
immediately, unless the asset is carried at revalued amount. Any impairment loss of a revalued asset
shall be treated as a revaluation decrease of that asset and if the impairment loss exceeds the
corresponding Revaluation Reserve, such excess shall be recognized as an expense in the Revenue/
Profit and Loss Account.
(b) Debt Securities. Debt securities, including Government Securities and Redeemable Preference Shares,
shall be considered as “held to maturity” securities and shall be measured at historical cost subject to
amortisation.
(c) Equity Securities and Derivative Instruments that are traded in active markets: Listed equity securities
and derivative instruments that are traded in active markets shall be measured at fair value on the
balance sheet date. For the purpose of calculation of fair value, the lowest of the last quoted closing
price at the stock exchanges where the securities are listed shall be taken.
The insurer shall assess on each balance sheet date whether any impairment of listed equity security
(ies) /derivative(s) instruments has occurred.
An active market shall mean a market, where the securities traded are homogeneous, availability of
willing buyers and willing sellers is normal and the prices are publicly available.
Unrealised gains/losses arising due to changes in the fair value of listed equity shares and derivative
instruments shall be taken to equity under the head “Fair Value Change Account”. The ‘Profit on sale of
investments’ or ‘Loss on sale of investments’, as the case may be, shall include accumulated changes in
the fair value previously recognized in equity under the heading ‘Fair Vale Change Account’, in respect
of a particular security and being recycled to the relevant Revenue Account or Profit and Loss Account
on actual sale of that listed security.
The Authority may issue directions specifying the amount to be released from the Fair Value Change
Account for declaring bonus to the policyholders. For the removal of doubt, it is clarified that except for
the amount that is released to policyholders as per the Authority’s prescription, no other amount shall
be distributed to shareholders out of Fair Value Change Account. Also, any debit balance in Fair Value
Change Account shall be reduced from Profit/Free Reserves while declaring dividends.
The insurer shall assess, on each balance sheet date, whether any impairment has occurred. An
impairment loss shall be recognized as an expense in Revenue/Profit and Loss Account to the extent
of the difference between the remeasured fair value of the security/investment and its acquisition
cost as reduced by any previous impairment loss recognized as expense in Revenue/ Profit and Loss
Account. Any reversal of impairment loss, earlier recognized in Revenue/ Profit and Loss Account shall
be recognized in Revenue/Profit and Loss Account.
(d) Unlisted and other than actively traded Equity Securities and Derivative Instruments:
Unlisted equity securities and derivative instruments and listed equity securities and derivative instruments
that are not regularly traded in active markets shall be measured at historical cost. Provision shall be
made for diminution in value of such investments. The provision so made shall be reversed in subsequent
periods if estimates based on external evidence show an increase in the value of the investment over its
carrying amount. The increased carrying amount of the investment due to the reversal of the provision
shall not exceed the historical cost.
For the purposes of this regulation, a security shall be considered as being not actively traded, if its
trading volume does not exceed ten thousand units in any trading session during the last twelve months.
8. Loans: Loans shall be measured at historical cost subject to impairment provisions. The insurer shall assess the
quality of its loan assets and shall provide for impairment. The impairment provision shall not be less than the
aggregate amount of loans which are subject to defaults of the nature mentioned below:
(i) interest remaining unpaid for over a period of six months; and
(ii) installment(s) of loan falling due and remaining unpaid during the last six months.
9. Linked Business: The accounting principles used for valuation of investments are to be consistent with
principles enumerated above. A separate set of financial statements, for each segregated fund of the linked
businesses, shall be annexed.
Segregated funds represent funds maintained in accounts to meet specific investment objectives of
policyholders who bear the investment risk. Investment income/gains and losses generally accrue directly to
the policyholders. The assets of each account are segregated and are not subject to claims that arise out of
any other business of the insurer.
10. Funds for Future Appropriation: The funds for future appropriation shall be presented separately.
The funds for future appropriation represent all funds, the allocation of which, either to the policyholders or to
the shareholders, has not been determined by the end of the financial year.
PART II
Disclosures forming part of Financial Statements
A. The following shall be disclosed by way of notes to the Balance Sheet:
1. Contingent Liabilities:
(a) Partly paid-up investments
(b) Underwriting commitments outstanding
(c) Claims, other than those under policies, not acknowledged as debts
(d) Guarantees given by or on behalf of the company
(e) Statutory demands/liabilities in dispute, not provided for
(f) Re-insurance obligations
(g) Others (to be specified).
2. Actuarial assumptions for valuation of liabilities for life policies in force.
3. Encumbrances to assets of the company in and outside India.
4. Commitments made and outstanding for Loans, Investments and Fixed Assets.
5. Basis of amortisation of debt securities.
6. Claims settled and remaining outstanding for a period of more than six months on balance sheet date.
7. Value of contracts in relation to investments, for:
(a) Purchases where deliveries are pending; and
(b) Sales where payments are overdue.
8. Operating expenses relating to insurance business: basis of allocation of expenditure to various segments
of business.
9. Computation of managerial remuneration.
10. Historical costs of those investments valued on fair value basis.
11. Basis of revaluation of investment property.
B. The following accounting policies shall form an integral part of the financial statements:
1. All significant accounting policies in terms of the accounting standards issued by the ICAI and significant
principles and policies given in Part I of Accounting Principles. Any other accounting policies, followed
by the insurer, shall be stated in the manner required under Accounting Standard (AS-1) issued by ICAI.
2. Any departure from the accounting policies shall be separately disclosed with reasons such departure.
C. The following information shall also be disclosed:
1. Investments made in accordance with any statutory requirement should be disclosed separately
together with its amount, nature, security and any special rights in and outside India;
2. Segregation into performing/non-performing investments for purpose of income recognition as per the
directions, if any, issued by the Authority;
3. Assets to the extent required to be deposited under local laws or otherwise encumbered in or outside
India;
4. Percentage of business sector-wise;
5. A summary of financial statements for the last five years, in the manner as may be prescribed by the
Authority;
6. Bases of allocation of investments and income thereon between Policyholders’ Account and
Shareholders’ Account; and
7. Accounting Ratios as may be prescribed by the Authority.
PART III
General instructions for preparation of Financial Statements
1. The corresponding amounts for the immediately preceding financial year for all items shown in the Balance
Sheet, Revenue Account, Profit and Loss Account and Receipts and Payments Account shall be given.
2. The figures in the financial statements may be rounded off to the nearest thousands.
3. Interest, dividends and rentals receivable in connection with an investment should be stated at gross amount,
the amount of Income Tax Deducted at Source should be included under Advance Taxes paid and Taxes
Deducted at Source.
4. (I) For the purposes of financial statements, unless the context otherwise requires
(a) the expression ‘Provision’ shall, subject to (II) below mean any amount written off or retained by way of
providing for depreciation, renewals or diminution in value of assets, or retained by way of providing for
any known liability or loss of which the amount cannot be determined with substantial accuracy;
(b) the expression ‘Reserve’ shall not, subject to as aforesaid, include any amount written off or retained
by way of providing for depreciation, renewal or diminution in value of assets or retained by way of
providing for any known liability or loss;
(c) The expression ‘Capital Reserve’ shall not include any amount regarded as free for distribution through
the Profit and Loss Account; and the expression ‘Revenue Reserve’ shall mean any reserve other than
a Capital Reserve;
(d) the expression “liability” shall include all liabilities in respect of expenditure contracted for and all
disputed or contingent liabilities.
(II) Where:
(a) any amount written off or retained by way of providing for depreciation renewals or diminution in value
of assets, or
(b) any amount retained by way of providing for any known liability or loss is in excess of the amount which
in the opinion of the Directors is reasonably necessary for the purpose, the excess shall be treated as a
Reserve and not Provision.
5. The company shall make provisions for damages under lawsuits where the management is of the opinion
that the award may go against the insurer.
6. Risks assumed in excess of the statutory provisions, if any, shall be separately disclosed indicating the amount
of premiums involved and the amount of risks covered.
7. Any Debit Balance of the Profit and Loss Account shall be shown as deduction from uncommitted Reserves
and the balance, if any, shall be shown separately.
PART IV
Contents of Management Report
There shall be attached to the financial statements, a management report containing, inter alia, the following duly
authenticated by the management:
1. Confirmation regarding the continued validity of the registration granted by the Authority;
2. Certification that all the dues payable to the Statutory Authorities have been duly paid;
3. Confirmation to the effect that the Shareholding Pattern and any transfer of shares during the year are in
accordance with the statutory or regulatory requirements;
4. Declaration that the management has not directly or indirectly invested outside India the funds of the holders
of policies issued in India;
5. Confirmation that the required Solvency Margins have been maintained;
6. Certification to the effect that the values of all the assets have been reviewed on the date of Balance Sheet
and that in his (Insurer’s) belief the assets set forth in the Balance Sheets are shown in the aggregate at
amounts not exceeding their realisable or market value under the several headings “Loans”, “Investments”,
“Agents Balances”, “Outstanding Premiums”, “Interest, Dividends and Rents outstanding”, “Interest, Dividends
and Rents accruing but not due”, “Amount due from other persons or Bodies carrying on insurance business”,
“Sundry Debtors”, “Bills Receivable”, “Cash” and the several items specified under “Other Accounts”;
7. Certification to the effect that no part of the life insurance fund has been directly or indirectly applied in
contravention of the provisions of the Insurance Act, 1938, relating to the application and investment of the
life insurance funds;
8. Disclosure with regard to the overall risk exposure and strategy adopted to mitigate the same;
9. Operations in other countries, if any, with a separate statement giving the management’s estimate of country
risk and exposure risk and the hedging strategy adopted;
10. Ageing of claims indicating the trends in average claim settlement time during the preceding five years;
11. Certification to the effect as to how the values, as shown in the Balance Sheet, of the investments and stocks
and shares have been arrived at, and how the Market Value thereof has been ascertained for the purpose
of comparison with the values so shown;
12. Review of asset quality and performance of investment in terms of Portfolios, i.e., separately in terms of Real
Estate, Loans, Investments, etc.; and,
(a) In the preparation of Financial Statements, the applicable accountings tender principles and policies
have been followed along with proper explanations relating to material departures, if any,
(b) The management has adopted accounting policies and applied them consistently and made
judgments and estimates that are reasonable and prudent so as to give true and fair view of the state
of affairs of the company at the end of the financial year and of the Operating Profit or Loss and of the
Profit or Loss of the company for the year,
(c) The management has taken proper and sufficient care for the maintenance of adequate accounting
records in accordance with the applicable provisions of the Insurance Act, 1938/ Companies Act,
1956, for safeguarding the assets of the company and for preventing and detectingfraud and other
irregularities,
(d) The management has prepared the financial statements on a Going Concern Basis, and
(e) The management has ensured that an Internal Audit System commensurate with the size and nature of
the business exists and is operating effectively.
PART V
(1) An insurer shall prepare the Revenue Account [Policyholders’ Account], Profit and Loss Account [Shareholders’
Account] and the Balance Sheet in Form A-RA, Form A-PL and Form A-BS, as prescribed in this Part, or as near
thereto as the circumstances permit.
Provided that an insurer shall prepare Revenue Account for the under mentioned businesses separately and
to that extent the application of AS-17 shall stand modified:
(2) An insurer shall prepare separate Receipts and Payments Account in accordance with the Direct Method
prescribed in AS 3-”Cash Flow Statement” issued by the ICAI.
The new format of Revenue Account (Policyholders’ Account Form A-RA), Profit and Loss Account
(Shareholders’ Account Form A-PL) and Balance Sheet (Form A-BS) are given below :
(g) Under the sub-head “Others” shall be included items like foreign exchange gains or losses and other items.
(h) Interest, dividends and rentals receivable in connection with an investment should be stated as gross
amount, the amount of income tax deducted at source being included under ‘Advance Taxes paid and
Taxes Deducted at Source’.
(i) Income from rent shall include only the Realised Rent. It shall not include any Notional Rent.
Contingent Liabilities
Total
Schedules Forming Part of Financial Statements
Schedule 1- Premium
Notes. Re-insurance premiums whether on business ceded or accepted are to be brought into account, before
deducting commission, under the head of Re-insurance premiums.
Schedule 2 -
Commission Expenses
Note. The profits/commissions if any, are to be combined with the Re-insurance accepted or
Re- insurance ceded figures.
Note. Additions to and deductions from the Reserves should be disclosed under each of the specified heads.
The Reserves and Surplus (Shareholders) as above shall be further segregated and disclosed as Reserves and
Surplus — (1) In India, and (2) Outside India
Schedule 6A may be prepared for Insurance Reserves of Policyholders.
Schedule 7 – Borrowings
– Preference
(b) Mutual Funds
(c) Derivative Instruments
(d) Debentures/Bonds
(e) Other Securities (to be specified)
(f) Subsidiaries
(g) Investment Properties-Real Estate
4. Investments in Infrastructure and Social Sector
5. Other than Approved Investments
Total
Investments
1 . In India
2 . Outside India
Total
(a) Investments in subsidiary/holding companies, joint ventures and associates shall be separately disclosed, at
cost.
(i) Holding company and subsidiary shall be construed as defined in the Companies Act, 1956.
(ii) Joint Venture is a contractual arrangement whereby two or more parties undertake an economic
activity, which is subject to joint contro1.
(iii) Joint control is the contractually agreed sharing of power to govern the financial and operating policies
of an economic activity to obtain benefits from it.
(iv) Associate is an enterprise in which the company has significant influence and which is neither a
subsidiary nor a joint venture of the company.
(v) Significant influence (for the purpose of this Schedule) means participation in t h e financial and
operating policy decisions of a company, but not control of those policies. Significant influence may
be exercised in several ways, for examples, by representation on the board of directors, participation in
the policy-making process, material inter-company transactions, interchange of managerial personnel
or dependence on technical information. Significant influence may be gained by share ownership,
statute or agreement. As regards share ownership, if an investor holds, directly or indirectly through
subsidiaries, 20 per cent or more of the voting power of the investee, it is presumed that the investor does
have significant influence, unless it can be clearly demon started that this is not the case. Conversely, if
the investor holds, directly or indirectly through subsidiaries, less than 20 per cent of the voting power of
the investee, it is presumed that the investor does not have significant influence, unless such influence
is clearly demonstrated. A substantial or majority ownership by another investor does not necessarily
preclude an investor from having significant influence.
(b) Aggregate amount of company’s investments other than listed equity securities and derivative instruments
and also the market value thereof shall be disclosed.
(d) Debt securities will be considered as “held to maturity” securities and will be measured at historical costs
subject to amortization
(e) Investment property means a property [land or building or part of a building or both) held to earn rental
income or for capital appreciation or for both, rather than for use in services or for administrative purposes.
Schedule 9 – Loans
2. Borrower-wise classification
(a) Central and State Governments
(b) Banks and Financial Institutions
(c) Subsidiaries
(d) Companies
(e) Loans against policies
(f) Others (to be specified)
Total
3. Performance-wise classification
(a) Loans classified as standard
– In India
– Outside India
(b) Non-standard loans less provisions
– In India
– Outside India
Total
4. Maturity-wise classification
(a) Short-term
(b) Long-term
Total
Notes:
(a) Short-term loans shall include those, which are repayable within 12 months from the date of Balance Sheet.
Long-term loans shall be the loans other than short-term loans.
(b) Provisions against Non-Performing loans shall be shown separately.
(c) The nature of the Security in case of all Long-Term Secured Loans shall be specified in each case. Secured
Loans for the purposes of this schedule, means Loans Secured wholly or partly against an asset of the
Company.
(d) Loans considered doubtful and the amount of provision created against such Loans shall be is closed.
Intangibles (specify)
Land Freehold
Leasehold Property
Buildings
Furniture and Fittings
Information Technology
Equipment
Vehicles
Office Equipment
Note:
Assets included in land, property and building above exclude Investment Properties as defined in Note
(d) to Schedule 8.
Schedule 14 – Provisions
Particulars ` Particulars `
Claims less reassurance paid during the year Life Assurance Fund at the beginning
By death 4,400 of the year 1,00,000
By maturity 3,000 Premium less Re-assurances 30,000
Annuities 12 Claims less reassurances outstanding
Furniture and Office Equipment at cost 500 At the beginning of the year:
(including `80 lakh bought during theyear) By death 1,800
Printing and Stationery 154 By maturity 1,200
Cash with Bank in current account 2,700 Credit balances pending adjustments 120
Cash and stamp in hand 60 Consideration for annuities granted
Surrenders less Reassurances 80 Interest, dividends and rents 4
Commission 500 Registration and other Fees 3,600
Expenses of Management 6,200 Sundry Deposits 4
Sundry Deposits with Electricity 2 Taxation Provision 200
Companies Premium Deposits 600
Advance Payment of Tax 100 Sundry Creditors 2,300
Sundry Debtors 100 Contingency Reserve 700
Agents Balances 200 Furniture and Office Equipment 300
Income Tax 900 Depreciation Account 80
Income Tax on Interest, Dividend and Rents 1,000 Building Depreciation Account 600
From the foregoing balances and the following information, prepare the Balance Sheet of Happy Mutual Life
Assurance Society Ltd. as on 31st March 2014 and its Revenue Account for the year ended on that date:
(i) Claims less reassurance outstanding at the end of the year: By death ` 1,200 lakh, By maturity ` 800 lakh.
(ii) Expenses outstanding ` 120 lakh and prepaid ` 30 lakh.
(iii) Provide ` 90 lakh for depreciation on buildings,` 30 lakh for depreciation on furniture and office equipment
and ` 220 lakh for taxation.
(iv) Premiums outstanding `4056 lakh, commission thereon ` 130 lakhs.
(v) Interests, dividends and rents outstanding (net) ` 60 lakh and interests and rents accrued (net) ` 700 lakh.
Solution:
Happy Mutual Life Assurance Society Ltd.
Form A-RA
Revenue Account for the Year Ended 31 st March 2014
Application of Funds
Investment:
Shareholders’ 8 1,13,610
Loans 9 6,800
Fixed Assets 10 390
Total 1,20,800
Current Assets:
Cash and Bank Balance 11 2,760
Advances and Other Assets 12 5,748
Sub-Total (A) 8,508
Current Liabilities 13 3,070
Provisions 14 220
Sub-Total (B) 3,290
Net Current Assets = Sub-Total (A) - Sub-Total (B) 1,26,018
Note: Since the question is silent about the preparation of Profit & Loss Account, as such (From A-PL) is not prepared.
Thus Provision for Taxation and adjustments are shown in Revenue Account.
Schedules forming parts of Financial Statements
Workings:
Schedule 2: Commission `
Commission Paid 500
Add: Commission on Re-Insurance Accepted 130
630
5,600
Less: Outstanding at the beginning 1,800 3,800
By Maturity-
Paid 3,000
Add: Outstanding at the end 800
3,800
Less: Outstanding at beginning 1,200 2,600
Annuities 12
Surrender, less Re-insurance 80
6,492
Schedule 7: Borrowings `
Premium Deposit 2,300
Add: Sundry Deposits 200
2,500
Schedule 8: Investments ` `
Investment in House Property 10,630
Additions 170
10,800
Less: Depreciation 10,110
690
Other Investments 1,03,500
1,13,610
Schedule 9: Loans `
Mortgage 300
Policies 6,500
6,800
In our country some private Companies have come to play: some of them are: Reliance General Insurance
Company, Bajaj Alliance General Insurance Co. Ltd. Tata AIG, General Insurance, HDFC - Chubb General
Insurance etc.
EXPLANATION OF SPECIAL TERMS PECULIAR TO INSURANCE BUSINESS
Nature of business of an insurance company is different from that of a manufacturing, a trading or a banking
company. Because of this, types and sources of expenses and incomes of such a company are different from
those usually found in other business concerns. In order to explain these incomes and expenses some new terms
are used. It is thus necessary for a student to understand these terms first.
Claims. The business of an insurance company is to cover the risk of the insured for a consideration called premium.
If the risk falls on the insured then he makes a claim on the insurance company. This is the first item which appears
on the debit side of revenue account. Claim is shown after deducting the Re-insurance claim and also after
adjusting it in the light of information given in the problem. It may be noted that it is not the actual amount paid
but the actual loss borne which is important for revenue account. In order to calculate the loss on account of claim
the claim outstanding at the end is added and claim outstanding in the beginning is deducted. It should be noted
that in keeping with the convention of conservatism, the claim intimated is taken at par with the claim intimated
and accepted but not paid. Thus while calculating the claim outstanding at the end the claim intimated as well
as the claim intimated and accepted both are considered. The adjustment entry required for this will be as follows:
Debit Claims account
Credit Claims intimated and accepted but not paid account
Credit Claims intimated but not accepted and paid account
At the commencement of the next period a reverse entry is passed, so that when these claims intimated are paid,
they may not influence the claims account of next year. However, if company rejects any claim, such amount
should be transferred to the insurance fund account and not to the claims account.
Illustration 23.
From the following, you are required to calculate the loss on account of claim to be shown in the revenue account
for the year ending 31st December, 2012 :
Claims:
Notes:
1. It may be seen that the column for ‘admitted in’ is useless for calculating loss on account of claim. This is a
mere information.
2. No. 3 item ‘intimated in 2010, admitted in 2011, paid in 2011 ` 5,000 is useless as the amount paid in 2011 is not
included in the amount paid in 2012.
Claims must include all expenses directly incurred in relation to assessment of claims. For examples expenses like
survey fees, fees of Police Reports, Legal fees, Court expenses and other similar charges should be included under
the head claims. However, it should not include any establishment or administrative expenses except in so far
as they relate to any employee, exclusively employed or surveyor assessment of losses [Note (a) to the revenues
account] When the account is furnished under the Provision of Sec. 11 of the Insurance Act, 1938, separate figures
for claims paid to claimants in India and claimants paid outside India should be given [Note (d) to the revenue
account].
Bonus:
In the case of life policies with profits, policyholders are given the right to participate in the profits of the business.
After nationalization, policyholders are given 95% of profits of L.I.C. by way of bonus. Bonus can be paid in cash,
adjusted against the future premiums due from the policy holders or it can be paid on the maturity of the policy,
together with the policy amount. Bonus paid in the end along with the policy amount is called Reversionary Bonus.
Re-insurance:
Sometimes the insurer considers a particular risk too much for his capacity and may re-insure a part of the risk with
some other insurer. Such an arrangement between two insurers is referred to as reinsurance. In such a case the
first insurer cannot retain all the premium on the policy for himself. Depending on the share of risk undertaken by
the second insurer, proportionate premium must be ceded by the first insurer. Likewise if such a policy matures,
the claim will have to be shared by both the insurers in the agreed ratio. These adjustments will have to be
shown in the accounts of both the insurers. In the accounts of the first insurer amount of claim recovered from
the second insurer has to be deducted from the total claim payable by him. Similarly, the premium ceded to the
second insurer has to be deducted from the total premium received. In the accounts of the second insurer, claims
paid include claims paid on account of Re-insurance and premiums received include premium received on re-
insurance business.
FORM – B –BS
Name of the Insurer :
Registration No. and Date of Registration with the IRDA
Balance Sheet as at 31st March, 20……..
Contingent Liabilities
Notes:
(a) Incurred But Not Reported (IBNR), Incurred But Not Enough Reported (IBNER)claims should be included in the
amount for Claims.
(b) Claims include Claims Settlement Costs.
(c) The Surveyor Fees, Legal and Other Expenses shall also form part of Claims Cost.
(d) Claims cost should be adjusted for estimated salvage value if there is a sufficient certainty of its realisation.
Schedule 3 - Commission
Notes:
(a) Items of expenses in excess of one per cent of net premium or ` 5,00,000, whichever is higher, shall be shown
as a separate line item.
(b) Under the sub-head “Others”, “Operating Expenses (Insurance Business)” shall include items like foreign
exchange gains or losses and other items.
Schedule 5 - Share Capital
Schedule 5A
Share Capital Pattern of Shareholding
[As certified by the Management]
The Reserves and Surplus (Shareholders) as above shall be further segregated and disclosed as Reserves and
Surplus – (1) In India, and (2) Outside India.
Schedule 7 - Borrowings
Notes:
(a) Investments in subsidiary/holding companies, joint ventures and associates shall be separately disclosed, at
cost.
(i) Holding company and Subsidiary shall be construed as. Significant influence may be exercised in several
ways, for example, by representation on the board of directors, participation in the policy-making
process, material inter-company transactions, interchange of managerial defined in the Companies
Act, 1956.
(ii) Joint venture is a contractual arrangement whereby two or more parties undertake an economic
activity, which is subject to joint control.
(iii) Joint control is the contractually agreed sharing of power to govern the financial and operating policies
of an economic activity to obtain benefits from it.
(iv) Associate is an enterprise in which the company has significant int1uence and which is neither a
subsidiary nor a joint venture of the company.
(v) Significant influence (for the purpose of this Schedule) means participation in the financial and
operating policy decisions of a company, but not necessarily control of those policies personnel or
dependence on technical information. Significant influence may be gained by share ownership, statute
or agreement. As regards share ownership, if an investor holds, directly or indirectly through subsidiaries,
20 per cent or more of the voting power of the investee, it is presumed that the investor does have
significant influence, unless it can be clearly demonstrated that this is not the case. Conversely, if the
investor holds, directly or indirectly through subsidiaries, less than 20 per cent of the voting power of
the investee, it is presumed that the investor does not have significant influence, unless such influence
is clearly demonstrated. A substantial or majority ownership by another investor does not necessarily
preclude an investor from having significant influence.
(b) Aggregate amount of company’s investments other than listed equity securities and derivative instruments
and also the market value thereof shall be disclosed.
(c) Investments made out of catastrophe reserve should be shown separately.
(d) Debt securities will be considered as “held to maturity” securities and will be measured at historical cost
subject to amortisation.
(e) Investment property means a property [land or building or part of a building or both] held to earn rental
income or for capital appreciation or for both, rather than for use in services or for administrative purposes.
Schedule 9 - Loans
Current Year Previous Year
Particulars
(`’000) (`’000)
1. Security-Wise Classification:
Secured:
(a) On mortgage of property
(i) In India
(ii) Outside India
(b) Other Shares, Bonds, Govt. Securities
(c) Others (to be specified)
Unsecured:
Total
2. Borrower-Wise Classification:
(a) Central and State Governments
(b) Banks and Financial Institutes
(c) Subsidiaries
(d) Others (to be specified)
Total
3. Performance-Wise Classification:
(a) Loans classified as standard
(i) In India
(ii) Outside India
(b) Non-performing loans less provisions
(i) In India
(ii) Outside India
Total
4. Maturity-Wise Classification:
(a) Short Term
(b) Long Term
Total
Notes:
(a) Short-term loans shall include those, which are repayable within 12 months of the balance sheet date. Long-
term loans shall be the loans other than short-term loans.
(b) Provisions against non-performing loans shall be shown separately.
(c) The nature of the security in case of all long-term secured loans shall be specified in each case. Secured
loans for the purpose of this schedule, means secured wholly or partially against an asset of the company.
(d) Loans considered doubtful and the amount of provision created against such loans shall be disclosed.
Note : Assets included in land, building and property above exclude Investment Properties as defined in Note (e)
to Schedule 8.
Schedule 10 - Fixed Assets
(specify)
Land-Freehold
Leasehold Property
Buildings
Information Technology
Equipment
Vehicles
Office Equipment
Notes:
(a) The items under the above heads shall not be shown net of provisions for doubtful amounts.
Schedule-15
Miscellaneous Expenditure
(To the extent not written off or adjusted)
Notes:
1. No item shall be included under the head “Miscellaneous Expenditure” and carried forward unless:
(a) some benefit from the expenditure can reasonably be expected to be received in future, and
(b) The amount of such benefit is reasonably determinable.
2. The amount to be carried forward in respect of any item included under the head “Miscellaneous Expenditure”
shall not exceed the expected future revenue/other benefits related to the expenditure.
Computation of “premium income,” “claims expense” and “commission expense” in the case of an insurance
company:
Premium Income: The payment made by the insured as consideration for the grant of insurance is known as
premium. The amount of premium income to be credited to revenue account for a year may be computed as:
(`)
Premium received on risks undertaken during the year
(direct & re-insurance accepted) –
Add : Receivable at the end of year (direct & re-insurance accepted) –
Less : Receivable at the beginning of year (direct & re-insurance accepted) –
Premium on re-insurance ceded:
Claims expenses: A claim occurs when a policy falls due for payment. In the case of a life insurance business, it will
arise either on death or maturity of policy that is, on the expiry of the specified term of years. In the case of general
insurance business, a claim arises only when the loss occurs or the liability arises.
Commission expenses : Insurance Regulatory and Development Authority Act, 1999 regulates the commission
payable on policies to agents. Commission expense to be charged to revenue account is computed as follows :
(`)
Commission paid (direct & re-insurance accepted) –
Add : Commission payable at the end of the year –
(Direct & re-insurance accepted)
Less: Commission payable at the beginning of the year –
(direct & re-insurance accepted)
Commission expense –
Illustration 24.
Khush Raho Insurance Co. Ltd. furnishes you the following information:
(i) On 31.3.2013 it had reserve for unexpired risks to the tune of `100 crore. It comprised of ` 37.5 crore in respect
of machine insurance business; `50 crore in respect of fire insurance business and `12.5 crore in respect of
miscellaneous insurance business.
(ii) It is the practice of Khush Raho Insurance Co. Ltd. to create reserve at 100% of net premium income in
respect of marine insurance policies and at 50% of net premium in respect of fire and miscellaneous insurance
business.
(iii) During the year 31st March, 2014 the following business was conducted :
Solution:
Journals Dr. Cr.
Working Notes :
Required closing balance in Unexpired Risks Reserve Account:
For Marine business = ` (45 +17.5 –16.75)= ` 45.75
For Fire business = [(107.5 + 12.5 – 10.75)/2 ] = ` 54.63
For miscellaneous business = [(30 + 10 – 17.5)/2 ] = ` 11.25
Date Particulars Marine Fire Misc. Date Particulars Marine Fire Misc.
2014 To, Revenue A/c — — 1.25 2014 By, Balance b/d 37.5 50.00 12.5
To, Balance c/d 45.75 54.63 11.25 By, Revenue A/c 8.25 4.63 —
45.75 54.63 12.50 45.75 54.63 12.50
Illustration 25.
From the following figures appearing in the books of Fire Insurance division of a General Insurance Company, show
the amount of claim as it would appear in the Revenue Account for the year ended 31st March, 2014 :
Solution:
General Insurance Company
(Abstract showing the amount of claims)
Working Notes :
Illustration 26.
Prepare the Fire Insurance Revenue A/c as per IRDA regulations for the year ended 31st March, 2014 from the
following details:
Particulars `
Claims paid 4,90,000
Legal expenses regarding claims 10,000
Premiums received 13,00,000
Re-insurance premium paid 1,00,000
Commission 3,00,000
Expenses of management 2,00,000
Provision against unexpired risk on 1st April, 2013 5,50,000
Claims unpaid on 1st April, 2013 50,000
Claims unpaid on 31st March, 2014 80,000
Solution:
Name of the Insurer:
FORM B – RA
Registration No. and Date of Registration with the IRDA:
Fire Insurance Revenue Account for the year ended 31st March, 2014
Schedule 3 : Commission `
Commission paid 3,00,000
3,00,000
Working Note:
(i) Sometimes the insurer considers a particular risk too much for his capacity and may ______________ a
part of the risk with some other insurer.
(ii) Bonus paid at the end along with the policy amount to the policy holders is called __________ ____________.
(iii) In the case of a _________insurance business claim will arise either on death or maturity of policy.
(iv) In relation to an Electricity Company the amount of Security Deposit = Load × Load Factor of the
category in which the consumer falls × ______________× Current tariff.
(v) _______________ advance means where a bank grants advance to its customers against any tangible
security.
(vii) The __________ ___________ Fund is available to meet the aggregate liability on all policies outstanding.
(viii) Revenue Account of life Insurance Business is relevant with Form - ________________.
(ix) In case of Insurance Company the date of discharge of claim is mentioned in the register of _____________.
(x) Rebate on Bills Discounted = Amount of Bill × Rate of Discount × __________________.
Answer:
(i) Re-insurance;
(iii) Life;
(v) Secured;
(vi) Burglary;
(viii) A – RA;
(ix) Claims;
(i) Every banking company incorporated in India is required to transfer at least 15% of its profit to the
reserve fund.
(ii) A bank can maintain Cash reserve with itself or by way of a balance in the Current account with the
reserve bank or by way of net balance in current accounts or in one or more of the aforesaid ways.
(iii) Every banking company is required to submit a return in the prescribed form and manner to the Reserve
Bank of India at the end of each calendar year of all accounts in India which could not be operated
for 5 years.
(iv) Non-performing assets bear a little amount of risk like normal risk and they do not create any trouble
regarding their realization.
(vi) The Central Electricity Regulatory Commission shall consist of a chairperson and 3 Members
(vii) In case of Electricity Company, Balance of Security Deposit A/c at the end of the accounting period
should be disclosed as a Non-current liability in the Balance Sheet.
(viii) The value base for the purpose of depreciation for the purpose of Tariff as per Regulation 21 shall be the
historical cost of the asset.
(x) When the same risk and the same subject matter is insured with more than one insurer, i.e., more than
one insurance company, the same is called Re-insurance Insurance.
Answer:
(i) FALSE.
(ii) TRUE.
(iii) FALSE.
(iv) FALSE.
(v) FALSE.
(vi) TRUE.
(vii) TRUE.
(viii) TRUE.
(ix) TRUE.
(x) FALSE.
5.1 Introduction
5.2 AS 11: Accounting for the Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates
5.3 AS 12: Accounting for Government Grants
5.4 AS 15: Account Employee Benefits
5.5 AS 16: Borrowing Costs
5.6 AS 17: Segment Reporting
5.7 AS 18: Relate Party Disclosures
5.8 AS 19: Accounting for Leases
[Corresponding Indian Accounting Standards (Ind AS) are included along with the Accounting Standards (AS)]
5.1 INTRODUCTION
Accounting Standard refers that it is a written and policy document jacketing the features of recognition,
measurement, treatment, presentation and disclosure of accounting transaction in the financial statement which
is issued by the expert accounting body or by Government or other regulatory authorities. Accounting Standard
in India are issued by the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India (ICAI).
So far ICAI has issued 32 accounting standards. However, AS-8 on “Research & Development” was withdrawn
consequent to issue AS-26 “Intangible Assets”.
The main purpose of accounting standard is to standardize the diverse accounting policies with a view to eliminate
to the extent possible the incomparability of information provided in financial statements and add reliability to
such financial statements. To discuss on whether such standards are necessary in present days it will be beneficial
to go through the advantages and disadvantages which they are said to be provide.
Advantages:-
1. It provides the accountancy profession with useful working rules.
2. It assists in improving quality of work performed by accountant.
3. It strengthens the accountant’s resistances against the pressure from directors to use accounting policy
which may be suspect in that situation in which they perform their work.
4. It ensures the various users of financial statements to get complete crystal information on more consistencies.
Disadvantages:-
1. Users are likely to think that said statements prepared using accounting standard are infallible.
2. They have been derived from social pressure which may reduce freedom.
3. The working rules may rigid or bureaucratic to some user of financial statements.
ACOUNTING STANDARD
Accounting Standard – 2, 6, 7, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, Accounting Standard -1, 3, 4, 5, 9, 12, 14, 17, 20, 21, 23,
19, 20, 21, 26, 28 24, 25, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32
5.1 AS 11: ACCOUNTING FOR THE EFFECTS OF CHANGES IN FOREIGN EXCHANGE RATES
Except as stated above (fixed assets) other exchange difference should be recognized as income or expense in
the period in which they arise or spread over to pertaining accounting period.
Depreciation as per AS-6 should be provided on the unamortised carrying amount of depreciable assets (after
taking into account the effect of exchange difference).
Disclosure under AS -11: An enterprise should disclose:
(a) The amount of exchange difference included in the net profit or loss for the period.
(b) The amount of exchange difference adjusted in the carrying amount of fixed assets during the accounting
period.
(c) The amount of exchange difference in respect of forward contracts to be recognized in the profit/ loss for
one or more subsequent accounting period.
(d) Foreign currency risk management policy.
Illustration 1:
Exchange Rate
Goods purchased on 24.3.11 of US $1,00,000 ` 46.60
Exchange rate on 31.3.2011 ` 47.00
Date of actual payment 5.6.12 ` 47.50
Calculate the loss/gain for the financial years 2010-11 and 2011-12.
Solution:
As per AS-11, all foreign currency transactions should be recorded by applying the exchange rate at the date of
transaction. Therefore, goods purchased on 24.03.11 and corresponding creditor would be recorded at ` 46.60
= 1,00,000 × 46.60 = 46,60,000
As per AS-11, at the balance sheet date all monetary items should be reported using the closing rate. Therefore,
the creditors of US $1,00,000 outstanding on 31.3.11 will be reported as:
1,00,000 × 47.00= 47,00,000.
Exchange loss ` 40,000 = (47,00,000 – 46,60,000) should be debited in profit and loss account for 2010-11.
As per AS-11, exchange difference on settlement on monetary items should be transferred to profit and loss
account as gain or loss thereof:
1,00,000 × 47.50 = 47,50,000 - 47,00,000 = ` 50,000 should be debited to profit or loss for the year 2011-12.
Illustration 2:
A Ltd. purchased fixed assets costing ` 5,100 lakhs on 1.1.10 and the same was fully financed by foreign currency
loan (U.S. Dollars) payable in three annual equal installments. Exchange rates were 1 Dollar = ` 42.50 and ` 45.00 as
on 1.1.10 and 31.12.10 respectively. First installment was paid on 31.12.10. The entire difference in foreign exchange
has been capitalized.
You are required to state, how these transactions would be accounted for.
Solution:
As per AS 11 The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates’, exchange differences arising on the settlement
of monetary items or on reporting an enterprise’s monetary items at rates different from those at which they were
initially recorded during the period, or reported in previous financial statements, should be recognized as income
or expenses in the period in which they arise. Thus exchange differences arising on repayment of liabilities incurred
for the purpose of acquiring fixed assets are recognized as income or expense.
Illustration 3:
Yes Limited purchased fixed assets costing ` 5,000 lacs on 1st April 2012 payable in foreign currency on 5th April
2013.
Exchange rate of 1 US Dollar equals to ` 50 and ` 54 as on 1st April 2012 and 31st march 2013 respectivel.y
The company also obtained soft loan of US dollar 100000 on 1st April 2012 payable in three annual equal installments.
First installment was due on 1st May 2013.
You are required to state how these transactions would be accounted for in the books of accounts ending 31st
March 2013.
Solution :
Ministry of Corporate Affairs has given an option for the companies to capitalise the exchange differences arising
on reporting of long term foreign currency monetary items till 31st March 2020.
INDIAN ACCOUNTING STANDARD (IND AS) 21 — THE EFFECTS OF CHANGES IN FOREIGN EXCHANGE RATES
Objective
(a) An entity may carry on foreign activities in two ways. It may have transactions in foreign currencies or it may
have foreign operations. In addition, an entity may present its financial statements in a foreign currency. The
objective of this Standard is to prescribe how to include foreign currency transactions and foreign operations
in the financial statements of an entity and how to translate financial statements into a presentation currency.
(b) The principal issues are which exchange rate(s) to use and how to report the effects of changes in exchange
rates in the financial statements.
Scope
This Standard shall be applied:
(a) in accounting for transactions and balances in foreign currencies, except for those derivative transactions
and balances that are within the scope of Ind AS 109, Financial Instruments;
(b) in translating the results and financial position of foreign operations that are included in the financial
statements of the entity by consolidation or the equity method; and
(c) in translating an entity’s results and financial position into a presentation currency.
This Standard applies to the presentation of an entity’s financial statements in a foreign currency and sets out
requirements for the resulting financial statements to be described as complying with Indian Accounting Standards
(Ind ASs). For translations of financial information into a foreign currency that do not meet these requirements, this
Standard specifies information to be disclosed.
This Standard does not apply to the presentation in a statement of cash flows of the cash flows arising from
transactions in a foreign currency, or to the translation of cash flows of a foreign operation (see Ind AS 7, Statement
of Cash Flows).
This Standard does not also apply to long-term foreign currency monetary items for which an entity has opted for
the exemption. Such an entity may continue to apply the accounting policy so opted for such long-term foreign
currency monetary items.
Definitions
The following terms are used in this Standard with the meanings specified:
Closing rate is the spot exchange rate at the end of the reporting period.
Exchange difference is the difference resulting from translating a given number of units of one currency into
another currency at different exchange rates.
Exchange rate is the ratio of exchange for two currencies.
Fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction
between market participants at the measurement date.
Foreign currency is a currency other than the functional currency of the entity.
Foreign operation is an entity that is a subsidiary, associate, joint arrangement or branch of a reporting entity, the
activities of which are based or conducted in a country or currency other than those of the reporting entity.
Functional currency is the currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates.
A group is a parent and all its subsidiaries.
Monetary items are units of currency held and assets and liabilities to be received or paid in a fixed or determinable
number of units of currency.
Example: pension or provisions that are to be settled in cash etc.
Conversely, the essential feature of a non-monetary item is the absence of a right
Net investment in a foreign operation is the amount of the reporting entity’s interest in the net assets of that
operation.
Presentation currency is the currency in which the financial statements are presented.
Spot exchange rate is the exchange rate for immediate delivery.
Comparison between Ind AS 21 and AS 11
Ind AS -21 AS - 11
1. Forward exchange contracts and other similar Forward exchange contracts and other similar
financial instruments are excluded from the scope of financial instruments are not excluded from the
this standard. scope of this standard.
2. Factors for determining the functional currency of There are two aspects – integral foreign operations
an entity is same as the indicators in existing AS 11 to and non-integral foreign operations for accounting.
determine the non-integral foreign operations.
There is no substantive differences in respect of the
accounting procedure.
3. There is an option to recognise the exchange There is no such permission.
differences arising on translation of any long-term
monetary items from foreign currency to functional
currency and it is permitted.
Accumulated exchange differences are to be
transferred to P& L Account in a appropriate way.
Government refers to Union/State, Govt. Agencies and similar bodies - Local, National or International. Grants
also include subsidies, cash incentive, and duty drawback either in cash or kind/benefits to an enterprise on
recognition of compliance in the past or future compliance with condition attached to it.
The accounting for the grant should be appropriate to reveal the extent of benefit accrued to the enterprise
during the reporting period.
For the purpose of the statement, following are not dealt with.
(a) Effects of changing prices or in supplementary information
(b) Government assistance other than grants.
(c) Ownership participation by government.
In order to recognize the income there should be conclusive evidence that conditions attached to the grant have
been or will be fulfilled to account for such earned benefits estimated on a prudent basis, even though the actual
amount may be finally settled/received after the accounting period. Mere receipt would not suffice for income
recognition.
AS-4 (contingencies etc) and AS-5 (Prior period etc) would be applicable as the case may be. The accounting for
Govt. grants should be based on the nature of the relevant grant:
(a) In the nature of promoter’s contribution as shareholder’s fund (capital approach)
(b) Otherwise as Income Approach to match with related cost recognizing AS-1 accrual concept disclosure.
Government grants in the form of non-monetary assets e.g. land or other resources is accounted for at the
acquisition cost or recorded at nominal value if it is given free of cost.
Grants received specifically for fixed asset is disclosed in the financial statement either
(a) by way of deduction from the gross block of the asset concerned, thus grant is recognized in P/L Account
through reduced depreciation (in case of funding of specific asset Cost entirely, the asset should be stated
at a nominal value in B/S); or
(b) the grant treated as deferred revenue income and charged off on a systematic and rational basis over the
useful life of the asset, until appropriated disclosed as “Deferred Govt. grant under Reserve and Surplus in the
B/S (grants relating to depreciable assets should be credited to Capital Reserve and suitably credited to P/L
Account to offset the cost charged to income).
Illustration 4:
Z Ltd. has set up its business in designated backward area which entitles it to receive as per a public scheme
announced by the Government of India, a subsidy of 25% of the cost of investment. Having fulfilled the conditions
laid down under the scheme, the company on its investment of ` 100 lakhs in capital assets during its accounting
year ending on 31st March,2012, received a subsidy of ` 25 lakhs in January, 2012 from the Government of India.
The Accountant of the company would like to record the receipt as an item of revenue and to reduce the losses
on the Profit and Loss Account for the year ended 31st March, 2012. Is his action justified?
Solution:
As per AS-12, the Government grants related to depreciable fixed assets to be treated as deferred income which
should be recognized in the Profit and Loss Account on a systematic and rational basis over the useful life of the
asset. Such grants should be allocated to income over the periods and in proportions in which depreciation on
those assets is charged.
The company has received ` 25 lakhs subsidy for investment in capital assets which are depreciable in nature. In
view of the provisions under AS-12, the subsidy amount ` 25 lakhs received should not be credited to the Profit and
Loss Account for the year ended 31st March, 2012. the subsidy should be recognized and credited to the Profit
and Loss Account in the proportion of depreciation charge over the life of the subsidized assets.
Illustration 5:
Hero Ltd. belongs to the engineering industry. The Chief Accountant has prepared the draft accounts, taking note
of the mandatory accounting standards.
“The company purchased on 1.4.2012 a special purpose machinery for ` 50 lakhs. It received a Central Government
grant for 20% of the price. The machine has an effective life of 5 years”.
Solution:
AS-12 prescribes two methods in accounting treatment of Government grants for specific fixed assets. Method I:
Government grants related to depreciable fixed assets to be treated as deferred income which is to be recognized
in the Profit and Loss Account in proportion in which depreciation on those assets is charged over the useful life of
the asset.
The deferred income pending its apportionment to Profit and Loss Account to be disclosed in the balance sheet
separately with a suitable description, e.g. Deferred Government Grants, to be shown after “Reserves & Surplus”
but before “ Secured Loans”
Grants received specifically for Fixed Asset may be disclosed in the financial statement by way of deduction from
the gross block of the asset concerned, thus grant is recognised in P/L Account through reduced depreciation.
In this case machinery will be recognised at ` 40 lakhs i.e. after deduction of ` 10 lakh Govt Grants. and depreciation
will be calculated on that ` 40 lakhs.
Illustration 6:
On 1st April 2015 hero Limited received Government grant of ` 300 lakhs for acquisition of a machinery costing
` 1,500 lacs.
The grant was credited to the cost of the asset.
The life of the machinery is 5 years. The machinery is depreciated at 20% on wdv basis.
The company had to refund the grant in May 2018 due to non fulfillment of certain conditions.
How you would deal with the refund of grant in the books of Hero Limited.
Solution :
` in Lakhs
01.04.2015 Cost of machine (adjusting grant)1500-300 1,200
31.03.2016 Depreciation 240
Wdv 960
31.03.2017 Depreciation 192
Wdv 768
31.03.2018 Depreciation 153.60
Revised book value 914.40
Note 1: Depreciation on revised book value will be provided prospectively over the residual life of the asset.
Note 2: The co can also debit the refund amount of ` 300 lakhs to DGG A/c if the same account was credited at
the time of receipt of the grant.
INDIAN ACCOUNTING STANDARD (IND AS) 20 — ACCOUNTING FOR GOVERNMENT GRANTS AND DISCLOSURE OF
GOVERNMENT ASSISTANCE
Scope
This Standard shall be applied in accounting for, and in the disclosure of, government grants and in the disclosure
of other forms of government assistance.
This Standard does not deal with:
The special problems arising in accounting for government grants in financial statements reflecting the effects of
changing prices or in supplementary information of a similar nature.
(a) Government assistance that is provided for an entity in the form of benefits that are available in determining
taxable profit or tax loss, or are determined or limited on the basis of income tax liability. Examples of such
benefits are income tax holidays, investment tax credits, accelerated depreciation.
(b) Government participation in the ownership of the entity.
(c) government grants covered by Ind AS 41, Agriculture.
Definitions
The following terms are used in this Standard with the meanings specified:
Government refers to government, government agencies and similar bodies whether local, national or international.
Government assistance is action by government designed to provide an economic benefit specific to an entity or
range of entities qualifying under certain criteria. Government assistance for the purpose of this Standard does not
include benefits provided only indirectly through action affecting general trading conditions, such as the provision
of infrastructure in development areas or the imposition of trading constraints on competitors.
Government grants are assistance by government in the form of transfers of resources to an entity in return for past
or future compliance with certain conditions relating to the operating activities of the entity.
They exclude those forms of government assistance which cannot reasonably have a value placed upon them
and transactions with government which cannot be distinguished from the normal trading transactions of the
entity.
Grants related to assets are government grants whose primary condition is that an entity qualifying for them should
purchase, construct or otherwise acquire long-term assets. Other conditions restricting the type or location of the
assets or the acquisition or holding period may also be attached.
Grants related to income are government grants other than those related to assets.
Forgivable loans are loans which the lender undertakes to waive repayment of under certain prescribed conditions.
Ind AS – 20 AS – 12
1. Deals with the other forms of government assistance Does not deal with such government assistance.
that do not fall within the definition of government
grants. It requires an indication of other forms of
government assistance from which the entity has
directly benefited, that should be disclosed in the
financial statements.
2. Based on the principle that all government grants Requires that in case the grant is in respect of non-
would normally have certain obligations attached depreciable assets, the amount of the grant should
to them and these grants should be recognised as be shown as capital reserve. If a grant related to
income over the periods which bear the relevant a non-depreciable asset requires the fulfillment of
cost of obligation. It, therefore, specifically prohibits certain obligations, the grant should be credited to
recognition of grants directly in the shareholders’ income over the same period over which the cost of
funds. meeting such obligations is charged to income. Also
gives an alternative to treat the grants as a deduction
from the cost of asset.
3. Does not recognise government grants which is in As per this some government grants have the
the nature of promoters’ contribution. characteristics similar to those of promoters’
contribution. It requires that such grants should be
credited directly to capital reserve.
4. It requires to value non-monetary grants at their Requires that government grants in the form of
fair value, since it results into presentation of more nonmonetary assets, given at a concessional
relevant information. rate, should be accounted for on the basis of their
acquisition cost. If it a non-monetary asset it is given
free of cost, it should be recorded at a nominal value.
The statement applies to benefit usually comprising of Provident Fund, Superannuation/ Pension Fund, Gratuity,
Leave encashment or retirement, Post retirement health and welfare schemes and other benefits provided by an
employer to employees either in pursuance of legal requirement or otherwise, but does not extend to employers’
obligation which cannot be reasonably estimated (e.g. ex-gratia ad-hoc on retirement).
There may be obligation on the part of the employer either against defined contribution plan or defined benefit
schemes as elaborated below:
(a) Defined Contribution Plans (DCP):
(1) Retirement benefit is determined by contribution at agreed/specified rate to the Fund together with
earnings thereof.
(2) Contribution (e.g. PF) whether paid or payable for the reporting period is charged to P/L statement
(3) Excess if any is treated as prepayment
(b) Defined Benefit Plans (DBP):
(1) Amount paid is usually determined with reference to employee’s earnings and/or years of service (if the
basis of contribution are determined, it will be treated as defined contribution scheme)
(2) However, if the employer’s responsibility is subject to specified benefits or a specified level of benefits, it
is defined benefit scheme.
(3) The extent of employer’s obligation is largely uncertain and subject to estimation of future condition
and events beyond control.
Accounting treatment for Gratuity benefit and other defined benefit schemes depends on the arrangement
made by the employer:
(a) No separate fund i.e. out of nonspecific own fund:
(1) Provision for accruing liability in the P/L Account for the accounting period is made.
(2) The provision is based on an actuarial method or some other rational method (assumption that all
employers are eligible at the end of the accounting period)
(b) Own separate/specific fund established through Trust:
The amount required to be contributed on actuarial basis is certified by the Actuary, and the actual
contribution plus and shortfall to meet the actuarial amount is charged to P/L Account for the accounting
period, any excess payment treated as prepayment.
(c) Fund established through Insurer: in the same manner as in (b) above Actual valuation may be carried out
annually (cost can be easily determined for the purpose of contribution as a charge to P/L) or periodically
(say, once in 3 years) where Actuary’s certificate specifies contribution on annual basis during inter-valuation
period.
(d) Leave encashment is an accrued estimated liability based on employers’ past experience as to such benefit
actually availed off and probability of encashment in future and therefore should relate to the period in
which relevant service is rendered in compliance with section 128 - accrual basis and AS-15.
Disclosure under AS-15:
(a) In view of the varying practices, adequate disclosure of method of accounting for an understanding of the
significance of such costs to an employer.
(b) Disclosure separately made for statutory compliance or otherwise the retirement benefit costs are treated as
an element of employee remuneration without specific disclosure.
(c) Financial statements should disclose whether actuarial valuation is made at the end of the accounting
period or earlier (in which case the date of actuarial valuation and the method used for accrual period if not
based on actuary report).
Illustration 7:
ZERO Bank has followed the policies for retirement benefits as under:
(a) Contribution to pension fund is made based on actuarial valuation at the yearend in respect of employees
who have opted for pension scheme.
(b) Contribution to the gratuity fund is made based on actuarial valuation at the year end.
(c) Leave encashment is accounted for on “PAY-AS-YOU-GO” method.
Comment whether the policy is in accordance with AS-15.
Solution:
(a) As the contribution to Pension Fund is made on actuarial basis every year, therefore the policy is as per AS-15,
which is based on actuarial basis of accounting.
(b) As the contribution is being made on annual basis to gratuity fund on actuarial basis, the policy is in
accordance with AS-15.
(c) As regard leave encashment, which is accounted for on PAY-AS-YOU-GO basis, it is not in accordance with
AS-15. It should be accounted for on accrual basis.
Illustration 8:
In the context of relevant Accounting Standards, give your comment on the following matter for the financial year
ending 31st March, 2012:
“Increase in pension liability on account of wage revision in 2011-12 is being provided for in 5 installments
commencing from that year. The remaining liability of ` 300 lakhs as redetermined in actuarial valuation will be
provided for in the next 2 years”
Solution:
As per AS-15, the costs arising from an alteration in the retirement benefits to employees should be treated as
follows:
(i) The cost may relate to the current year of service or to the past years of service.
(ii) In case of costs relating to the current year, the same may be charged to Profit and Loss Account.
(iii) Where the cost relates to the past years of service these should be charged to Profit and Loss Account as
‘prior period’ items in accordance with AS-5.
(iv) Where retirement benefit scheme is amended in a manner which results in additional benefits being provided
to retired employees, the cost of the additional benefits should be taken as “ Prior Period and Extraordinary
Items” as per AS-5.
In view of the above, the method adopted for accounting the increase in pension liability is not in consonance to
the provisions mentioned in AS-15.
INDIAN ACCOUNTING STANDARD (IND AS) 19 — ACCOUNTING FOR EMPLOYEE BENEFITS
Objective
The objective of this Standard is to prescribe the accounting and disclosure for employee benefits. The Standard
requires an entity to recognise:
(a) a liability when an employee has provided service in exchange for employee benefits to be paid in the
future; and
(b) an expense when the entity consumes the economic benefit arising from service provided by an employee
in exchange for employee benefits.
Scope
This Standard shall be applied by an employer in accounting for all employee benefits, except those to which Ind
AS 102, Share-based Payment, applies.
This Standard does not deal with reporting by employee benefit plans.
The employee benefits to which this Standard applies include those provided:
(a) under formal plans or other formal agreements between an entity and individual employees, groups of
employees or their representatives;
(b) under legislative requirements, or through industry arrangements, whereby entities are required to contribute
to national, state, industry or other multi-employer plans; or
(c) by those informal practices that give rise to a constructive obligation.
Employee benefits include:
The following short-term employee benefits , if expected to be settled wholly before twelve months after the end
of the annual reporting period in which the employees render the related services:
(i) wages, salaries and social security contributions;
(ii) paid annual leave and paid sick leave;
(iii) profit-sharing and bonuses; and
(iv) non-monetary benefits (such as medical care, housing, cars and free or subsidised goods or services) for
current employees;
Post-employment benefits, such as the following:
(i) retirement benefits (e.g., pensions and lump sum payments on retirement); and
(ii) other post-employment benefits, such as post-employment life insurance an post-employment medical
care;
Other long-term employee benefits, such as the following:
(i) long-term paid absences such as long-service leave or sabbatical leave;
(ii) jubilee or other long-service benefits; and
(iii) long-term disability benefits; and
Termination benefits:
• Employee benefits include benefits provided either to employees or to their dependants or beneficiaries and
may be settled by payments (or the provision of goods or services) made either directly to the employees, to
their spouses, children or other dependants or to others, such as insurance companies.
• An employee may provide services to an entity on a full-time, part-time, permanent, casual or temporary
basis. For the purpose of this Standard, employees include directors and other management personnel.
Definitions
The following terms are used in this Standard with the meanings specified:
Definitions of employee benefits —
Employee benefits are all forms of consideration given by an entity in exchange for service rendered by employees
or for the termination of employment.
Short-term employee benefits are employee benefits (other than termination benefits) that are expected to be
settled wholly before twelve months after the end of the annual reporting period in which the employees render
the related service.
Post-employment benefits are employee benefits (other than termination benefits and short-term employee
benefits) that are payable after the completion of employment.
Other long-term employee benefits are all employee benefits other than short-term employee benefits, post-
employment benefits and termination benefits.
Termination benefits are employee benefits provided in exchange for the termination of an employee’s
employment as a result of either:
(a) an entity’s decision to terminate an employee’s employment before the normal retirement date; or
(b) an employee’s decision to accept an offer of benefits in exchange for the termination of employment.
Definitions relating to classification of plans
Post-employment benefit plans are formal or informal arrangements under which an entity provides post-
employment benefits for one or more employees.
Defined contribution plans are post-employment benefit plans under which an entity pays fixed contributions into
a separate entity (a fund) and will have no legal or constructive obligation to pay further contributions if the fund
does not hold sufficient assets to pay all employee benefits relating to employee service in the current and prior
periods.
Defined benefit plans are post-employment benefit plans other than defined contribution plans.
Multi-employer plans are defined contribution plans (other than state plans) or defined benefit plans (other than
state plans) that:
(a) pool the assets contributed by various entities that are not under common control; and
(b) use those assets to provide benefits to employees of more than one entity, on the basis that contribution and
benefit levels are determined without regard to the identity of the entity that employs the employees.
Net interest on the net defined benefit liability (asset) is the change during the period in the net defined benefit
liability (asset) that arises from the passage of time.
Remeasurements of the net defined benefit liability (asset) comprise:
(a) actuarial gains and losses;
(b) the return on plan assets, excluding amounts included in net interest on the net defined benefit liability
(asset); and
(c) any change in the effect of the asset ceiling, excluding amounts included in net interest on the net defined
benefit liability (asset).
Actuarial gains and losses are changes in the present value of the defined benefit obligation resulting from:
(a) experience adjustments (the effects of differences between the previous actuarial assumptions and what
has actually occurred); and
(b) the effects of changes in actuarial assumptions.
The return on plan assets is interest, dividends and other income derived from the plan assets, together with
realised and unrealised gains or losses on the plan assets, less:
(a) any costs of managing plan assets; and
(b) any tax payable by the plan itself, other than tax included in the actuarial assumptions used to measure the
present value of the defined benefit obligation.
A settlement is a transaction that eliminates all further legal or constructive obligations for part or all of the benefits
provided under a defined benefit plan, other than a payment of benefits to, or on behalf of, employees that is set
out in the terms of the plan and included in the actuarial assumptions.
Short-term employee benefits
Short-term employee benefits include items such as the following, if expected to be settled wholly before twelve
months after the end of the annual reporting period in which the employees render the related services:
(a) wages, salaries and social security contributions;
(b) paid annual leave and paid sick leave;
(c) profit-sharing and bonuses; and
(d) non-monetary benefits.
An entity need not reclassify a short-term employee benefit if the entity’s expectations of the timing of settlement
change temporarily. However, if the characteristics of the benefit change (such as a change from a non-
accumulating benefit to an accumulating benefit) or if a change in expectations of the timing of settlement is not
temporary, then the entity considers whether the benefit still meets the definition of short-term employee benefits.
Comparison between Ind AS 19 and AS 15
Ind AS – 19 AS – 15
1. It covers employee benefits arising from constructive obligations Not dealt in.
2. Employee Includes whole time Directors. Employee Includes Directors.
3. It deals with the situations where there is a contractual agreement Not dealt in.
between a multi-employer plan and its participants that determines
how the surplus in the plan will be distributed to the participants.
4. Entity to involve a qualified actuary in the measurement of all Entity to involve a qualified actuary
material post-employment benefit obligations in the measurement all material post-
• Encourages, but does not require, an employment benefit obligations
• Neither required nor encouraged.
Borrowing costs are interests and other costs incurred by an enterprise in connection with the borrowing of funds.
A qualifying asset is an asset that necessarily takes substantial period of time to get ready for its intended use or
sale.
Examples of qualifying assets:
• Any tangible fixed assets, which are in construction process or acquired tangible fixed assets, which are not
ready for use or resale. Such as plants and machinery.
• Any intangible assets, which are in development phase or acquired but not ready for use or resale, such as
patent.
• Investment property.
• Inventories that require a substantial period (i.e. generally more than one accounting period) to bring them to
a saleable condition.
The standard is applied in accounting for borrowing costs which include:
1. Interest and commitment charges on bank borrowing and other short term borrowings;
2. Amortization of discounts/premium relating to borrowings;
3. Amortization of ancillary cost incurred in connection with arrangement of borrowings;
4. Finance charges for assets acquired under finance lease or other similar arrangement.
5. Exchange difference in foreign currency borrowing to the extent it relates to interest element;
Borrowing cost incurred on assets, which takes substantial period, is treated as cost of that asset in respect of (1)
above.
As per the Guidance Note on Audit of Miscellaneous Expenditure issued by ICAI, deferment for amortization cost
upto the time the asset is put to use, in respect of (2) and (3), should be capitalized (see below for AS-16 provision).
Finance charges as in (4) can be capitalized upto the time the asset is put to use (AS-19 deals with elaborate
provision)
Conditions for capitalization of borrowing costs:
• Directly attributable costs for acquisition, construction or production of qualifying asset, are eligible for
capitalization. Directly attributable costs are those costs that would have been avoided if the expenditure on
qualifying asset have not been made.
• Qualifying assets will render future economic benefit to the enterprise and the cost can be measured reliably.
Amount of borrowing costs eligible for capitalization (specific borrowing) :
• Amount of borrowing cost eligible for capitalization = Actual borrowing cost incurred during the period less
any income generated on the temporary investment of amount borrowed.
Solution:
Statement showing the Value of the Qualifying Assets
Expenditure Incurred on
Interest Cumulative Expenditure Interest
Year Month Qualifying Assets
` `
`
2013 July 3,00,000 --- 3,00,000
August 4,00,000 3,000 7,03,000
September 6,00,000 7,030 13,10,030
October 5,00,000 13,100 18,23,130
November 4,00,000 18,231 22,41,361
December 3,00,000 22,414 25,63,775
25,00,000 63,775
[Interest to be capitalised @ 12% p.a. i.e. 1% p.m.]
∴ The value of the qualifying asset is ` 25,63,775.
Illustration 10.
On 20.4.2012, M Ltd obtained a loan from the bank for ` 50 lakhs to be utilised as:
Particulars ` (in lakhs)
Construction of a shed 20
Purchase of Machinery 15
Working Capital 10
Advance for purchase of Truck 5
In March 2013, construction of shed was completed and machinery installed. Delivery of truck was not received.
Total interest charged by the bank for the year ending 31.3.2013 was ` 9 lakhs.
Show the treatment of interest under AS 16.
Solution:
As per AS 16, borrowing costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of a
qualifying assets should be capitalised as part of the cost of that asset. The amount of borrowing costs eligible for
capitalisation should be determined in accordance with this Standard. Other borrowing cost should be recognised
as an expense in the periods in which they are incurred.
A qualifying asset is an asset that necessarily takes a substantial period of time to get ready for its intended use or
sale. As per AS 16, if an asset is ready for its intended use or sale at the time of acquisition, the same cannot be
treated as a qualifying asset.
Treatment of Interest
Items Nature of Asset Interest to be capitalized Interest to be charged to
` (in lakhs) P&L A/c ` (in lakhs)
Constructions of a shed Qualifying Asset ` 20 ---
` 3.60 × `9
` 50
Purchase of a Machinery Not a qualifying Asset --- `15
` 2.70 × `9
` 50
Working Capital Not a qualifying Asset ___ `10
`1.80 × `9
` 50
Advance in purchase of Truck Not a qualifying Asset ___ `5
` 0.90 × `9
` 50
` 3.60 lakhs ` 5.40 lakhs
Illustration 11.
M Ltd. has obtained an institutional loan of ` 680 lakhs for modernisation and renovation of its Plant and Machinery.
Plant and Machinery acquired under the Modernisation Scheme and installation completed on 31.3.2013
amounted to `520 lakhs. `30 lakhs has been advanced to suppliers for additional assets and the balance loan of
`130 lakhs has been utilised for Working Capital purpose. The total interest paid for the above loan amounted to
` 68 lakhs during 2012-2013.
You are required to state how the interest on the institutional loan is to be accounted for in the year 2012-2013.
Solution:
Interest on borrowed Capital which are used for the purpose of acquisition/construction of fixed asset during the
period up to the completion stage or acquisition should be added to the gross book value of the concerned fixed
assets. As such, the institution loan amounting to ` 520 lakhs together with interest of ` 52 lakhs (shown below)
should be added to the gross book value of the fixed asset.
But, advance to supplier for additional assets amounting to ` 30 lakhs together with interest of ` 3 lakhs (shown
below) may be treated as capital work-in-progress and the same should be capitalised at a subsequent date.
Similarly, loan taken for working capital purpose amounting to ` 130 lakhs and interest on it of ` 13 lakhs (shown
below) should be charged against current year’s Profit and Loss Account.
Thus, the whole matter stands as:
company’s fertiliser project amounting to `1,80,80,000 has been capitalised during the year, which include
approximately `1,70,33,465 capitalised in respect of the utilisation of loan and debenture money for the said
purpose”.
Ascertain the amount of revenue expenditure.
Solution:
As per para 6, AS 16, borrowing costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production
of a qualifying asset should be capitalised as part of the cost of that asset. A qualifying asset is an asset that
necessarily takes a substantial period of time to get ready for its intended use or sale.
The amount of borrowing costs eligible for capitalisation should be determined in accordance with this Statement.
Other borrowing costs should be recognised as an expense in the period in which they are issued.
In the present case, however, M Ltd. incurred ` 1,80,80,000 on account of interest of which ` 1,70,33,465 is directly
attributable to the construction of the project. As per AS 16, the said amount should be capitalised and the
balance ` 10,46,535 (i.e. ` 1,80,80,000 - ` 1,70,33,465), is treated as expense, i.e. revenue in nature, and, as such,
the same should be adjusted against the Profit and Loss Statement.
Illustration 13.
G Ltd. purchased machinery from P Ltd. on 30.9.2012. The price was ` 370.44 lakhs after charging 8% sales-tax
and giving a trade discount of 2% on the Quoted price. Transport charges were 0.25% on the quoted price and
installation charges came to 1% on the quoted price.
A loan of ` 300 lakhs was taken from the bank on which interest at 15% p.a. was to be paid. Expenditure incurred
on the trial run was materials ` 35,000, wages ` 25,000 and overhead ` 15,000. Machinery was ready for use on
1.12.2012. However, it was actually put to use only on 1.05.2013.
Find out the cost of the machine and suggest the accounting treatment for the expenses incurred in the interval
between the dates 1.12.2012 and 01.05.2013. The entire loan amount remain unpaid on 01.05.2013.
Solution:
As per para 6, AS 16, borrowing costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production
of a qualifying asset should be capitalised as part of the cost of that asset. Other borrowing costs should be
recognised as all expense in the period in which they are incurred.
The total cost of the machine is calculated as:
Cost of the Machine
100 100
Quoted Price ` 370.44 × × = 350.000
108 98
(Since the price was given after charging sales tax and trade discount) 7.000
Less: Trade Discount @ 2% on ` 350 lakhs 343.000
Add: Sales-Tax @ 8% on ` 3,43,000 lakhs 27.440
370.440
Add: Transportation cost @ 0.25% on ` 350 lakhs 0.875
371.315
Add: Installation Charges @ 1% on ` 350 lakhs 3.500
374.815
Add: Expenditure to be incurred for Trial run
Materials 0.350
Wages 0.250 0.750
Overheads 0.150
7.500
Add: Cost of borrowing @ 15% on ` 300 lakhs (from 30.9.2012 to 1.12.2012)
Cost of the machine 383.065
As per para 19 and para 20, of AS 16, capitalisations of borrowing costs should cease when substantially all the
activities necessary to prepare the qualifying asset for its intended use or sale are complete.
Similarly, an asset is normally ready for its intended use or sale when its physical construction or production is
complete even though routine administrative work might still continue. Hence, capitalisation of borrowing cost @
15% on ` 300 lakhs for 5 months amounting to ` 18.75 lakhs should be treated as an expense and, as such, should
be adjusted against Profit and Loss Statement.
Illustration 14:
Compute weighted average borrowing cost of Sera Ltd. from the following information. Also calculate the interest
cost to be capitalized.
Total borrowing and interest cost for the year ending 31.3.2015 are as follows
` ‘000
Factory shed 2,500 12 months
Plant – A 1,500 9 months
1,000 7 months
Solution :
Computation of product:
Definitions
Borrowing costs are interest and other costs that an entity incurs in connection with the borrowing of funds. It may
include the following:
(a) Interest expense calculated using the effective interest method under Ind AS 109;
(b) Finance charges in respect of finance lease recognized under Ind AS 17; and
(c) exchange differences arising from foreign currency borrowings to the extent that they are regarded as an
adjustment to interest costs.
Qualifying asset is an asset that necessarily takes a substantial period of time to get ready for its intended use or
sale.
Depending on the circumstances, any of the following may be qualifying assets:
(a) inventories
(b) manufacturing plants
(c) power generation facilities
(d) intangible assets
(e) investment properties
(f) bearer plants.
Examples that are not qualifying assets:
(a) Finance assets;
(b) Inventories that are manufactured, or otherwise produced, over a short period of time;
(c) Assets that are ready for their intended use or sale when acquired.
Recognition
An entity shall capitalise borrowing costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production
of a qualifying asset as part of the cost of that asset. An entity shall recognise other borrowing costs as an expense
in the period in which it incurs them.
Borrowing costs eligible for capitalization
A. Specific Borrowings
When an entity borrows funds specifically for the purpose of obtaining a qualifying asset, then the amount of
borrowing costs eligible for capitalization is the actual borrowing costs incurred on that borrowing during the
period less any investment income on the temporary investment of those borrowings.
B. General Borrowings
When an entity borrows funds generally and uses them for the purpose of obtaining a qualifying asset,
then the amount of borrowing costs eligible for capitalisation is by applying a capitalisation rate to the
expenditures on that asset.
The capitalisation rate should be the weighted average of the borrowing costs applicable to the borrowings
of the entity that are outstanding during the period , other than borrowings made specifically for the purpose
of obtaining a qualifying asset.
The amount of borrowing costs that an entity capitalises during a period should not exceed the amount of
borrowing costs it incurred during that period.
When the carrying amount of the qualifying asset exceeds its recoverable amount or net realisable value,
the carrying amount is written down.
Ind AS - 23 AS – 16
(i) There is a relaxation to the entity to avoid application of There is no such relaxation.
the following – borrowing cost directly attributable to the It is applicable to all inventories that require
acquisition, construction or production of a qualifying substantial period of time to bring them in
asset measured at fair value and inventories that are saleable condition.
manufactured, or otherwise produced in large quantities
on a repetitive basis.
(ii) There is no explanation of the meaning of ‘Substantial There is an explanation of the meaning of
Period of Time’ in relation to qualifying asset. ‘Substantial Period of Time’ in relation to
qualifying asset.
(iii) Interest expense is calculated using the effective interest As per this AS, Borrowing cost includes –
rate method as described in Ind AS 39 (a) Interest and commitment charges on
bank borrowings and other short-term and
long-term borrowings;
(b) Amortisation of discounts or premiums
relating to borrowings;
(c) Amortisation of ancillary costs incurred
in connection with the arrangement of
borrowings.
(iv) Appropriateness is provided for inclusion of all borrowings There is no such provision.
of the parent and its subsidiaries at the time of
computations of weighted average borrowing cost and
for each subsidiary to use a weighted average of the
borrowing costs applicable to its own borrowing in other
circumstances
(v) There is a disclosure requirement for the capitalisation rate There is no such disclosure requirement.
used to determine the amount of borrowing costs eligible
for capitalisation.
In India, disclosures of disaggregated information are required as per Schedule III to the Companies Act, 2013.
A manufacturing company is required to disclose value and quantities of opening and closing stock of goods
produced by each class of goods. Also it has to disclose quantitative information about licensed and installed
capacities and actual production by each class of goods.
Although these disclosure requirements give certain vital information to the users of accounts, they fall short of
segmental reports. It is difficult to link raw materials consumption to sales by each class of goods. Moreover,
information about direct production costs is missing. Hence it can be said that disclosure of segmental financial
information has not become popular in India and the disaggregated quantitative and value disclosures that are
presently required as per the Companies Act, 2013 are not par with the international requirements.
Definitions
A business segment is a distinguishable component of an enterprise that is engaged in providing an individual
product or service or a group of related products or services and that is subject to risks and returns that are different
from those of other business segments. Factors that should be considered in determining whether products or
services are related include:
(a) the nature of the products or services;
(e) total cost incurred during the period to acquire segment assets that are expected to be used during more
than one period (tangible and intangible fixed assets);
(f) total amount of expense included in the segment result for depreciation and amortisation in respect of
segment assets for the period; and
(g) total amount of significant non-cash expenses, other than depreciation and amortisation in respect of
segment assets, that were included in segment expense and, therefore, deducted in measuring segment
result.
Illustration 15.
Following details are given for Lily Ltd. for the year ended 31st March,2014: (` in lakh)
You are required to prepare a statement showing financial information about Lily Ltd.’s operations in different
industry segments.
Solution:
Information about Lily Ltd. operations in different industry segments in furnished in the following statement:
(` in lakh)
Particulars Sports ac- Packaging Health and Fit- Others Inter-segment Consoli-
cessories Materials ness Equipments ` Elimination dated
` ` ` ` `
External Sales 11,190 1,106 624 310 - 13,254
Inter-segment 110 144 42 14 310 -
Total 11,300 1,250 690 324 310 13,254
Segment Expenses 6,670 850 444 400 244 8,120
Operating Profit 4,630 400 246 (76) 66 5,134
General Corporate Expenses (1,124)
Income from Investments 264
Interest (130)
Income from continuing op- 4,144
erations
Identifiable assets 14,640 2,640 2,100 1,330 20,710
Corporate Assets - - - - - 1,444
Total Assets 22,154
Illustration 16.
Information relating to five segments of V Ltd. is as under: (` in lakhs)
Segments A B C D E Total
Segment Revenue 100 300 200 100 300 1,000
Segment Result 40 (60) 90 10 (30) 50
Segment Assets 45 55 140 20 40 300
As a cost accountant of this company management wishes to know from you which company need to be
reported.
Solution: (` in lakh)
Particulars A B C D E Total
1. Segment Revenue 100 300 200 100 300 1,000
2. % of Segment Revenue
10% 30% 20% 10% 30%
3. Segment Result:
Profit 40 90 10 140
Loss (60) (30) (90)
4. % of segment Result, abso-
lute amount of profit/loss 28.57% 42.88% 64.29% 7.14% 21.43%
whichever is higher, i.e. as a
% of 140
5. Segment Assets 45 55 140 20 40 300
6. % of Segment Assets 15% 18.33% 46.67% 6.66% 13.33%
Reportable Segment Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Criteria satisfied Revenue, Revenue, Revenue, Revenue Revenue,
Result & Result & As- Result & Result &
Assets sets Assets Assets
Ind AS - 108 AS – 17
1. Identification of segments is based on ‘management Identification of two sets segments – one
approach’ i.e. identified based on the internal reports based on related products and services,
regularly reviewed by the entity’s chief operating decision
maker.
Objectives
Generally business transactions between related parties lose the feature and character of the arms length
transactions. Related party relationship affects the volume and decision of business of one enterprise for the benefit
of the other enterprise one. Hence, it is necessary to disclose the related transaction for proper understanding of
financial performance and financial position of an enterprise.
Related Party
A related party is essentially any party that controls or can significantly influence the management or operating
policies of the company during the reporting period.
Related party transactions means a transfer of resource or obligations between related parties regardless of
whether or not a price is charged.
Example:
♦ Purchase or sales of goods (finished or unfinished)
♦ Purchase or sales of fixed assets
♦ Rendering or receiving of services
♦ Leasing or hire purchase or licence arrangements
♦ Transfer of research and development
♦ Finance (including loan and equity contributions)
♦ Guarantees and collaterals
♦ Management contracts including for deputation of employees.
Disclosure
For the purpose of disclosure related parties relationship can be categorized as under:
When the existence of relationship is due to the concept of the control -even when there are no transactions
between the related parties, still the following disclosure is needed :
♦ Name of the related party should be disclosed and
♦ Nature of the related party relationship should be disclosed.
Accordingly, by virtue of the above quoted paragraph of AS-18 also, the company would not be required to
make any disclosures in its financial statements as regards related relationships and transactions with IDBI, which is
also a ‘state-controlled enterprise’.
Illustration 17.
Ankur Limited has two associates, Bankur Limited and Chakor Limited, and owns 25% of voting power of Bankur
Limited and 30% of voting power of Chakor Limited. Would Bankur Limited is considered a related party in the
financial statements of Chakor Limited?
Solution:
Both Bankur Limited and Chakor Limited are associates of Aankur Limited. Co-associates cannot be regarded
as related parties only by virtue of this relationship. As per AS-18 “associates and joint ventures of the reporting
enterprise and the investing party or venture in respect of which the reporting enterprise is an associate or a joint
venture” are related parties. As Bankur Limited is not an associate of Chakor Limited nor is it being controlled,
directly or indirectly, by Chakor Limited or is not so controlling Chakor Limited, it is not a related party of Chakor
Limited.
Illuatrstion 18.
Please identify the related parties in respect of all the enterprises mentioned under AS-18, if —
Momo Limited holds 51% of Yummy Limited
Yummy Limited holds 51% of Top Limited
Tasty Limited holds 49% of Top Limited
Solution:
Momo Limited, Yummy Limited and Top Limited are related to each other. Tasty Limited and Top Limited are also
related to each other by virtue of associate relationship. However, neither Momo nor Yummy Limited is related to
Tasty Limited and vice versa.
Illustration 19.
State whether remuneration paid to Key Management Personnel or Non-Executive Directors or Board of Directors,
a related party transaction or not?
Solution:
Key Management Personnel are related parties under AS-18. Hence, remuneration paid to Key Management
Personnel will be a related party transaction requiring disclosure under AS-18.
Non-Executive Directors or the board of directors are not related parties as per Accounting Standard Interpretation
(ASI) 21. Hence, remuneration paid to them will not be considered a related party transaction.
Definitions
A related party is a person or entity that is related to the reporting entity.
(a) A person or a close member of that person’s family is related to a reporting entity if that person:
(i) has control or joint control of the reporting entity;
(ii) has significant influence over the reporting entity; or
(iii) is a member of the key management personnel of the reporting entity or of a parent of the reporting
entity.
(b) An entity is related to a reporting entity if any of the following conditions applies:
(i) The entity and the reporting entity are members of the same group.
(ii) One entity is an associate or joint venture of the other entity (or an associate or joint venture of a
member of a group of which the other entity is a member).
(iii) Both entities are joint ventures of the same third party.
(iv) One entity is a joint venture of a third entity and the other entity is an associate of the third entity.
(v) The entity is a post-employment benefit plan.
(vi) The entity is controlled or jointly controlled by a person identified in (a).
(vii) A person identified in (a)(i) has significant influence.
(viii) The entity or any group member provides key management personnel services.
In considering each possible related party relationship, attention is directed to the substance of the relationship
and not merely the legal form.
Government-related entities
A reporting entity is exempt from the disclosure requirements in relation to related party transactions and
outstanding balances, including commitments, with:
(a) a government that has control or joint control of, or significant influence over, the reporting entity; and
(b) another entity that is a related party because the same government has control or joint control of, or
significant influence over, both the reporting entity and the other entity.
Ind AS - 24 AS - 18
1. A related party in relation to the reporting enterprise is a Parties are related if at any time during
person or entity that is related and includes: the reporting period, one party controls or
• A person or close member of that person’s family if that exercises significant influence over the other
person has control, joint control, significant influence party in taking financial and/or operating
over the reporting enterprises or is a member of Key decisions.
Management Personnel of their reporting enterprises
or of a parent of the reporting enterprises;
• Parent, subsidiary, joint venture, associates of the
reporting enterprise.
2. Close members of the person are the persons defined Only relatives are defined and close member
as ‘relative’ under the Companies Act, 2013 and that has not been mentioned in the AS.
person’s domestic partner, person’s or spouse’s children
and dependants of the person or spouse.
3. Related party includes post-employment benefit plans Post-Employment benefit plans are not
for the benefit of employees of the reporting entity or any considered as related party.
entity that is a related party of the reporting entity.
4. If an entity has transactions with the related party during If an entity has transactions with the related
the reporting period, the reporting entity has to disclose party during the reporting period, the reporting
the transactions value and the outstanding balance with entity has to disclose the transactions value [or
the related party including commitments. appropriate proportions] and the outstanding
balance [or appropriate proportions] with the
related party.
5. Key Management Personnel compensation is disclosed in Total compensation of Key Management
total and aggregate for Personnel is disclosed in aggregate except
(a) Short-term employee benefits; in cases where separate disclosure is more
appropriate
(b) Post-employment benefits;
(c) Other long-term benefits;
(d) Terminating benefits and
(e) Share based payments.
Lease is an arrangement by which the “Lessor” gives the right to use an asset for given period of time to the
“Lessee” on rent.
It involves two parties, a Lessor and a Lessee and an asset which is to be leased. The Lessor, who owns the asset,
agrees to allow to the Lessee to use it for a specified period of time in return for periodic rent payments.
Types of lease
(a) Finance Lease – It is a lease, which transfers substantially all the risks and rewards incidental to ownership of
an asset to the Lessee by the Lessor but not the legal ownership. In following situations, the lease transactions
are called Finance Lease.
• The lessee will get the ownership of leased asset at the end of the lease term.
• The lessee has an option to buy the leased asset at the end of term at price, which is lower than its
expected fair value at the date on which option will be exercised.
• The lease term covers the major part of the life of asset.
• At the beginning of lease term, present value of minimum lease rental covers substantially the initial fair
value of the leased asset.
• The asset given on lease to lessee is of specialized nature and can only be used by the lessee without
major modification.
(b) Operating Lease – It is a lease which does not transfer substantially all the risk and reward incidental to
ownership.
Classification of lease is made at the inception of the lease; if at any time the Lessee and Lessor agree
to change the provision of lease and it results in different category of lease, it will be treated as separate
agreement.
Applicability
The Accounting Standard is not applicable to following types of lease:
• Lease agreement to explore natural resources such as oil, gas, timber, metal and other mineral rights.
• Licensing agreements for motion picture film, video recording, plays, manuscripts, patents and other rights.
• Lease agreement to use land.
Definitions
1. Guaranteed Residual value – (G.R.V.)
• In respect of Lessee: Such part of the residual value (R.V.), which is guarantee by or on behalf of the
lessee.
• In respect of Lessor: Such part of the residual value, which is guaranteed by or on behalf of the lessee or
by an independent third party.
For the Lessor the residual value guaranteed by the third party can arise when the asset is leased to the third
party after the first lease has expired and therefore it can be called the residual value guaranteed by the
third party to the Lessor.
2. Unguaranteed Residual Value (U.R.V) – The difference between residual value of asset and its guaranteed
residual value is unguaranteed residual value. [R.V- G.R.V.]
3. Gross Investment = (MLP+URV) – Gross investment in lease is the sum of the following:
• Minimum lease payment (from the standpoint of Lessor) and
• Any unguaranteed residual value accruing to the Lessor.
4. Interest rate implicit in the lease – When the Lessor gives an asset on lease (particularly on finance lease),
the total amount, which he receives over lease period by giving the asset on lease, includes the element of
interest plus payment of principal amount of asset. The rate at which the interest amount is calculated can
be simply called implicit rate of interest. It can be expressed as under:-
It is the discount rate at which
Fair Value of leased Asset = Present value of [Minimum lease payment (in respect of Lessor)] (At the inception
of lease) + Any unguaranteed residual value accruing to the Lessor.
5. Contingent Rent – Lease Rent fixed on the basis of percentage of sales, amount of usage, price indices,
market rate of interest is called contingent rent. In other words, lease rent is not fixed, but it is based on a
factor other than time.
6. Minimum lease payments [MLP]
For Lessor = Total lease rent to be paid by lessee over the lease terms + any guaranteed residual value
(by or on behalf of lessee) – contingent Rent – cost for service and tax to be paid by the
reimbursed to Lessor + residual value guaranteed by third party.
For Lessee = Total lease rent to be paid by lessee over the lease terms + any guaranteed residual value
(for lessee) – contingent rent – cost for service and tax to be paid by and reimbursed to
Lessor.
7. Lease includes Hire Purchase – The definition of a ‘lease’ includes agreements for the hire of an asset,
which contain a provision giving the hirer an option to acquire title to the asset upon the fulfillment of agreed
conditions. These agreements are commonly known as hire purchase agreements.
Accounting for Finance Lease – In the books of Lessee
• Leased asset as well as liability for lease should be recognized at the lower of –
♦ Fair value of the leased asset at he inception of lease or
♦ Present value of minimum lease payment from the lessee point of view.
• Apportionment of lease payment-Each lease payment is apportioned between finance charge and principal
amount.
• The lessee in its books should charge depreciation on finance lease asset as per AS-6(in this case, straight line
method will be followed)
• initial direct cost for financial lease is included in asset under lease.
- Profit – i.e. carrying amount (=book value or value as per balance sheet) is less than the sale value,
recognize profit immediately.
- Loss – i.e. carrying amount is more than the sale value, recognize loss immediately, provided loss is not
compensated by future lease payment.
- Loss – i.e. carrying amount is more than sale price defer and amortize loss if loss is compensated by future
lease payment.
- If carrying amount is equal to fair value which will result in profit, amortize the profit over lease period.
- Carrying amount less than fair value will result in profit – amortize and defer the profit equal to “sale price
less fair value” and recognize balance profit immediately.
- Carrying amount is more than the fair value – which will result in loss equal to – (carrying amount less than
fair value), should be recognized immediately. Profit equal to – selling price less fair value – should be
amortized.
Illustration 21:
H Ltd. sold machinery having WDV of ` 400 Lakhs to B Ltd. for ` 500 Lakhs and the same machinery was leased
back by B Ltd. to H Ltd. The Lease back is operating lease.
Comment if –
(c) Fair value is ` 450 lakhs and sale price is ` 380 lakhs
(d) Fair value is ` 400 lakhs and sale price is ` 500 lakhs
(e) Fair value is ` 460 lakhs and sale price is ` 500 lakhs
(f) Fair value is ` 350 lakhs and sale price is ` 390 lakhs
Solution:
(a) H ltd. should immediately recognize the profit of ` 100 lakhs in its books.
(c) Loss of ` 20 lakhs to be immediately recognized by H Ltd. in its books provided loss is not compensated by
future lease payment.
(e) Profit of ` 60 lakhs (460-400) to be immediately recognized in its books and balance profit of ` 40 lakhs (500-
460) is to be amortized / deferred over lease period.
(f) Loss of ` 50 lakhs (400-350) to be immediately recognized by H Ltd. in its books and profit of ` 40 lakhs (390-
350) should be amortized / deferred over lease period.
Illustration 22:
Milind Softex Ltd. has taken the assets on lease from ABC Impex Ltd. The following information is given below:
Lease Term = 4 years
Fair value at inception of lease = ` 16,00,000
Lease Rent = ` 5,00,000 p.a. at the end of year
Guaranteed Residual Value = ` 1,00,000
Expected Residual Value = ` 2,00,000
Implicit Interest Rate = 14.97%
Do the accounting in the book of lessee.
Solution:
Present value of minimum lease payment
Year Liability (`) MLP (`) Finance Charge (`) Principal Amount of reduction (`)
0 14,85,590 - - -
1 12,07,983 5,00,000 2,22,393 2,77,607
2 8,88,818 5,00,000 1,80,835 3,19,165
3 5,21,874 5,00,000 1,33,056 3,66,944
4 - 6,00,000 78,125 5,21,875
Illustration 23:
Milind Softex Ltd. has taken the assets on lease from ABC Impex Ltd. The following information is given below:
Lease Term = 4 years
Fair value at inception of lease = `16,00,000
Lease Rent = `5,00,000 p. a. at the end of year
Guaranteed Residual Value = `1,00,000
Expected Residual Value = `2,00,000
Implicit Interest Rate = 14.97%
How the accounting is done in the book of lessor?
Solution:
Lessor should recognize asset given under lease at net investment in lease.
Net investment in lease = Gross investment- unearned finance income
Gross Investment = MLP + Guarenteed residual value + Unguaranteed residual value
= ` 20,00,000 + ` 1,00,000 + ` 1,00,000
= ` 22,00,000
Unearned Finance income = Gross Investment - present value of gross investment
The lease receivable account shown in the books of lessor will not tally with the lease liability account as shown by
the leasee in his book. Difference will remain because of guaranteed residual value from the third party or/ and
unguaranteed residual value from the leasee point of view.
Illustration 24:
Amit purchased a computer for `44,000 and leased out it to Sumit for four years on leases basis, after the lease
period, value of the computer was estimated to be `3,000; whichhe realized after selling it in the second hand
market. Lease amount payable at the beginning of each year is ` 22,000; ` 13,640; ` 6,820 & ` 3,410. Depreciation
was charged @ 40% p.a. You are required to pass the necessary journal entries in the books of both Amit and Sumit.
Solution:
Journals
In the books of Amit
Illustration 25:
Alfa Ltd has taken machinery on lease from Beta Ltd. calculate the value of lease liability for the following
information:
Lease term = 4 years
Fair value at inception of lease = ` 20,00,000
Lease Rent = ` 6,25,000 p.a at the end of the year
Guaranteed residual value = ` 3,75,000
Implicit Interest cost = 15%
Discount factors for first four years are 0.8696, 0.7561, 0.6575 and 0.5718.
Solution :
Computation of PV
(b) licensing agreements for such items as motion picture films, video recordings, plays, manuscripts, patents
and copyrights.
However, this Standard shall not be applied as the basis of measurement for:
(a) property held by lessees that is accounted for as investment property (see Ind AS 40, Investment Property);
(b) investment property provided by lessors under operating leases (see Ind AS 40, Investment Property);
(c) biological assets within the scope of Ind AS 41 Agriculture held by lessees under finance leases; or
(d) biological assets within the scope of Ind AS 41 provided by lessors under operating leases.
This Standard applies to agreements that transfer the right to use assets even though substantial services by the
lessor may be called for in connection with the operation or maintenance of such assets.
This Standard does not apply to agreements that are contracts for services that do not transfer the right to use
assets from one contracting party to the other.
Definitions
A lease is an agreement whereby the lessor conveys to the lessee in return for a payment or series of payments the
right to use an asset for an agreed period of time.
A finance lease is a lease that transfers substantially all the risks and rewards incidental to ownership of an asset.
Title may or may not eventually be transferred.
(c) if the lessee enters into a new lease for the same or an equivalent asset with the same lessor; or
(d) upon payment by the lessee of such an additional amount that, at inception of the lease, continuation of
the lease is reasonably certain.
The lease term is the non-cancellable period for which the lessee has contracted to lease the asset together
with any further terms for which the lessee has the option to continue to lease the asset, with or without further
payment, when at the inception of the lease it is reasonably certain that the lessee will exercise the option.
Minimum lease payments are the payments over the lease term that the lessee is or can be required to make,
excluding contingent rent, costs for services and taxes to be paid by and reimbursed to the lessor, together with:
(a) for a lessee, any amounts guaranteed by the lessee or by a party related to the lessee; or
(b) for a lessor, any residual value guaranteed to the lessor by:
(iii) a third party unrelated to the lessor that is financially capable of discharging the obligations under the
guarantee.
(a) the period over which an asset is expected to be economically usable by one or more users; or
(b) the number of production or similar units expected to be obtained from the asset by one or more users.
Useful life is the estimated remaining period, from the commencement of the lease term, without limitation by the
lease term, over which the economic benefits embodied in the asset are expected to be consumed by the entity.
(a) for a lessee, that part of the residual value that is guaranteed by the lessee or by a party related to the lessee
(the amount of the guarantee being the maximum amount that could, in any event, become payable); and
(b) for a lessor, that part of the residual value that is guaranteed by the lessee or by a third party unrelated to the
lessor that is financially capable of discharging the obligations under the guarantee.
Unguaranteed residual value is that portion of the residual value of the leased asset, the realisation of which by the
lessor is not assured or is guaranteed solely by a party related to the lessor.
Initial direct costs are incremental costs that are directly attributable to negotiating and arranging a lease, except
for such costs incurred by manufacturer or dealer lessors.
(a) the minimum lease payments receivable by the lessor under a finance lease, and
Net investment in the lease is the gross investment in the lease discounted at the interest rate implicit in the lease.
The interest rate implicit in the lease is the discount rate that, at the inception of the lease, causes the aggregate
present value of (a) the minimum lease payments and (b) the unguaranteed residual value to be equal to the sum
of (i) the fair value of the leased asset and (ii) any initial direct costs of the lessor.
The lessee’s incremental borrowing rate of interest is the rate of interest the lessee would have to pay on a similar
lease or, if that is not determinable, the rate that, at the inception of the lease, the lessee would incur to borrow
over a similar term, and with a similar security, the funds necessary to purchase the asset.
Contingent rent is that portion of the lease payments that is not fixed in amount but is based on the future amount
of a factor that changes other than with the passage of time (e.g. percentage of future sales, amount of future
use, future price indices, future market rates of interest).
Classification of leases
The classification of leases adopted in this Standard is based on the extent to which risks and rewards incidental to
ownership of a leased asset lie with the lessor or the lessee. Risks include the possibilities of losses from idle capacity
or technological obsolescence and of variations in return because of changing economic conditions. Rewards
may be represented by the expectation of profitable operation over the asset’s economic life and of gain from
appreciation in value or realisation of a residual value.
A lease is classified as a finance lease if it transfers substantially all the risks and rewards incidental to ownership.
A lease is classified as an operating lease if it does not transfer substantially all the risks and rewards incidental to
ownership.
Because the transaction between a lessor and a lessee is based on a lease agreement between them, it is
appropriate to use consistent definitions. The application of these definitions to the differing circumstances of the
lessor and lessee may result in the same lease being classified differently by them.
Ind AS - 17 AS – 19
1. In this case lease is recognized as operating of finance Land is recorded and classified as fixed one.
lease as per the definition and classification criteria, As
per this standard land has an indefinite economic life
period.
3. In case of Finance leases the initial direct costs are : As per this standard Finance leases related initial
• To be included in measurement of finance lease direct costs are recognized
receivable and the amount of income is reduced • immediately in the statement of profit and loss
• It is to be recognized over the lease term or allocated against the finance income over
the lease term
• Initial lease costs recognized by manufacturer or
dealer lessors are to be recognized as expenditure • to the manufacturers or dealer lessores it is an
when profit on sales is recognised expenditure at the inception .
4. In case of Operating leases the initial direct costs are : • As per this standard Operating leases related
• To be added to the carrying amount of the asset initial direct costs are deferred and allocated
and recognized as expenditure over the lease to the income over the lease term in the
term on the basis as in case of lease income proportion of lease income
• Or it is recognized as expenditure in the
statement of P& L in the period of incurrence
5. Arrangements which do not take any legal form but There is no such guideline Payment under any
fulfillment of which is dependent on the use of any such arrangements are to be recognized in
specific asset and it convey the right to use the assets accordance with the nature of expenditure
- is to be accounted for as a lease incurred
Answer:
(i) Borrowing;
(ii) Foreign;
(iii) Government Grant;
(iv) Employee Benefits;
(v) Segment Revenue.
EVOLUTION OF AUDITING:
In the early days of commerce and business there was no existence of the concept of auditing. This was, may be
due to the small nature of business and day to day personal control of the proprietor.
Audit can be traced back in the period 3600-3200 B.C. Initially, the audit was mainly done that of public accounts
only. From historical records it appears that the ancient Egyptians, Greeks and Romans were used to the government
accounts audit.
The accounts of the corporation of the city of London were audited in 12th Century. Later in Shakespeare’s “Timor
of Athens” the steward Flavins makes the remark “If you suspect my husbandry or falsehood, call me before the
exactest auditor, and set me on the proof” which indicates the existence of an audit in the 14th century also.
In 1314, auditors were officially appointed to check the public accounts in England.
In 1494, Luca Pacioli, a French celebrated mathematician, brought the concept of Double Entry book keeping and
auditing in practice. Gradually and especially after the Industrial Revolution in the 18th century, the nature, type
and size of business organizations changed. The large scale business came into existence causing dilution in the
regular and direct control of the proprietor. This made it necessary to get the transactions made by the staff and
representatives of owners, checked and verified by an independent person and this has given rise to concept of
auditing.
In 1866, the England’s Exchequer and Audit Department was created by Act of Parliament. In 1870, The Institute of
Accountants in the form of a society was formed in England. It got a Royal Charter in 1880 and was turned into
The Institute of Chartered Accountants in England and Wales, but before that in 1854, with a Royal Charter, The
Institute of Accountants and Actuaries in Glasgow.
In India, the sophisticated system of accounting and auditing can be found in the reign of Mauryas, Guptas
and Moughals too. The first legislation relating to companies in India that is the Joint Stock Companies Act,
1857 introduced the provisions of annual audit but was made optional. Latter, The Companies Act, 1913, made
it compulsory. This Act was replaced in 1956 by the Indian Companies Act, 1956, the act and the subsequent
amendments not only made the audit compulsory but sought to ensure that only the independent professionals
with requisites qualifications are appointed as statutory auditors of Companies. In 1965, the amendment in the
Act took place and concept of Cost Audit was introduced, while the amendment in the Income Tax Act, 1961,
took place in 1984 introduced the concept of Tax Audit, Sales Tax (VAT), Trust Act, Co-operative Societies Act
etc. brought the concept of different audits into practice. Provision for Special Valuation audit section 14A and
Section 14AA of Central Excise Act, 1944 regarding valuation and Cenvat respectively introduced in Central
Excise Act, 1944 with effect from 26.05.95 and 14.5.97. In addition there is an Audit by the office of Controller and
Auditor General of India under CAG, DPC (Act). Again the Companies Act has been revised as Companies Act,
2013.
A number of technological, economic changes, social events, globalization, liberalization, privatization etc. have
influenced auditing to a great extent in the course of development of auditing and caused considerable changes
and improvements in the techniques, principles, standards, reporting, professional ethics and responsibilities of
auditor.
DEFINITIONS
The term “audit” has been derived from the Latin words “audire” which means to listen. In those ancient days, the
person appointed to check the accounts, used to hear the explanations required from responsible officers
and that’s why, the person who heard the explanations was called as an “auditor”. However, now a days, due to
drastic changes in business, accounting systems, size and the provisions of different laws, this “hearing” concept
of auditing is considerably changed and become more exhaustive and therefore, different authors have
defined “auditing” differently, few of the important definitions are as under—
(i) Taylor and Perry - “Audit is defined as an investigation of some statements of figures involving examination
of certain evidence, so as to enable an auditor to make a report on the statement.
(ii) F.R.M De Paula- “An audit denotes the examination of Balance Sheet and Profit and Loss Account prepared
by others together with the books of accounts and vouchers relating there to in such a manner that the
auditor may be able to satisfy himself and honestly report that, in his opinion, such Balance Sheet is properly
drawn up so as to exhibit a true and correct view of the state of affairs of the particular concern according to
the information and explanations given to him and as shown by the books”.
(iii) Prof. Montgomerly- “Auditing is a systematic examination of the books and records of business or other
organization, in order to ascertain or verify and to report upon the facts regarding its financial operations and
the result thereof.
(iv) M. L. Shandilya- “Auditing may be defined as inspecting, comparing, checking, reviewing, vouching,
ascertaining, scrutinizing, examining and verifying the books of accounts of a business concern with a view
to have a correct and true idea of its financial state of affairs.
(v) Spicer & Pegler- “Audit such an examination of the books of accounts and vouchers of a business, as will
enable the auditor to satisfy himself that the Balance Sheet is properly drawn up, so as to give a true and fair
view of the state of affairs of the business, and whether the profit and loss account gives a true and fair view
of the profit or loss for the financial period according to the best of his information and explanations given
to him and as shown by the books, and if not, in what respect he is not satisfied”.
(vi) ICAI defines Auditing as- ‘’A systematic and independent examination of data, statement, records,
operation and performances (financial or otherwise) of an enterprise for a stated purpose. In any
auditing situation, the auditor perceives and recognizes the proposition before him for examination,
collects evidence, evaluates the same and on this basis formulates his judgment which is communicated
through his audit report’’. According to them, ‘’…auditing is the accumulation and evaluation of evidence
about information to determine and report on the degree of correspondence between the information and
established criteria. Auditing should be done by a competent independent person’’.
(vii) According to SA 200 on- “Basic Principles Governing an Audit” : - An audit is independent examination of
financial information of any entity, whether profit oriented or not, and irrespective of its size or legal form,
when such examination is conducted with a view to expressing an opinion thereon”.
In the close scrutiny of the different definitions we found that there are different ways of expressing the concept
auditing but having lot of similarity therein.
The meaning of an Audit contains
(i) An intelligent and critical examination of the books of accounts of business.
(ii) It is done by an independent qualified person.
(iii) It is done with the help of vouchers, documents, information and explanations received from the clients.
(iv) The auditor satisfies himself with the authenticity of the financial accounts prepared for a particular period.
(v) The auditor reports that-
(a) The Balance Sheet exhibits a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the concern.
(b) The profit and loss account reveals the true and fair view of the profit or loss for the financial period.
(c) The accounts have been prepared in conformity with the concerned law.
(d) If he is not satisfied then reports in what respect he is not satisfied.
Auditing has generally been associated with only accounting and financial records. Thus, International Auditing and
Assurance Standard Board (IAASB) defines the term ‘audit’ as “The objective of an audit of financial statements is to
enable the auditor to express an opinion whether the financial statements are prepared, in all material respects, in
accordance with an identified financial reporting framework”. Similarly, Mautz defines auditing as being “concerned
with the verification of accounting data, with determining the accuracy and reliability of accounting statements
and reports.” The emphasis is clearly on verification of accounting data with a view to reporting on the
reliability of the accounting statements. Verification of accounting data involves a careful evaluation of evidence
available to the auditor in support of various transactions. Thus, an auditor examines internal evidence, i .e., the
records, vouchers and books of account. To assess the quality of the internal evidence, he also tests and evaluates
the relevant systems in the organization. He also obtains external evidence such as confirmation of bank balances.
In some cases, he may decide to conduct physical counts and surveys or even call for independent expert opinion
regarding technical matters.
Developments in the last few decades have extended the scope of auditing. Auditing today is no longer concerned
only with financial accounting records, it may also involve a review of compliance with law, costing records,
operations and performances. Therefore, a more comprehensive definition is required to describe modern auditing.
ICAI (C.A) has defined auditing as “a systematic and independent examination of data, statements, records,
operations and performances (financial or otherwise) of an enterprise for a stated purpose. In any auditing
situation, the auditor perceives and recognizes the propositions before him for examination, collects evidence,
evaluates the same and on this basis formulates his judgment which is communicated through his audit report.
“This definition does not confine auditing to accounting records. It recognizes that auditing can extend to such
areas as managerial performances, cost data and operations.
Another good description of auditing is given by Arens, Elder and Beasley. According to them, “auditing is the
accumulation and evaluation of evidence about information to determine and report on the degree of
correspondence between the information and established criteria. Auditing should be done by a competent
independent person.” This definition emphasises the following points.
(i) The information under audit need not necessarily be accounting information. However, information must be in
a verifiable form.
(ii) There should be standards or criteria for evaluation of the information.
(iii) The auditor should not only be a competent person but he should also have an independent mental
attitude.
It is thus clear that auditing involves evaluating the relevance, reliability and adequacy of evidence in support of
verifiable information. It is not a process of mechanical comparison of items in the financial statements with the
entries in the books of account. Nor does it involve a mere mechanical ticking of entries in the books of account
with the vouchers or other records. It is a process of collection and critical evaluation of evidence. It is “analytical,
it is critical, investigative. Thus, auditing has its principal roots, not in accounting which it reviews, but in logic on
An auditor collects and evaluates evidence in order to make a report. The audit report is the end product of auditing.
The extent to which an auditor should conduct his examination or the precise audit steps that he should adopt in an
auditing situation depends on the circumstances of each case. Unfortunately, many beginners in the profession
adopt a mechanical attitude in framing audit programmes. They think that the audit steps listed in textbooks for a
particular category of transactions are valid in all auditing situations. For example, if cash receipts have to be
checked, the steps mentioned in textbooks are considered adequate and appropriate, irrespective of whether
one is auditing the accounts of a club or those of a college, or of a dairy with milk booths at various places. It is
often not realised that the audit steps mentioned in textbooks are merely illustrative in character. Therefore, one
has to first grasp the concepts of auditing and then apply them to a particular situation.
Development in the last two decades has extended the scope of auditing. Therefore, a more comprehensive
definition of auditing given by Schlosser may also be considered. According to him, auditing is a “systematic
examination of financial statements, records and related operation to determine adherence to generally accepted
accounting principles, management policies of stated requirements”. The earlier definition of auditing by Mautz
emphasizes the verification of accounting statements. While retaining that emphasis, Scholsser’s definition
extends the scope of auditing by including in it an examination of allied operations. Similarly the purpose of auditing
has been extended to examination of allied operations to ‘management policies or stated requirements’. This, where
as the previous definition mainly covers Mautz independent professional audit, Schlosser’s definition also covers cost
audit, internal audit, Government audit, management audit, operational audit and the like.
The auditor is not supposed to perform the duties which are beyond the scope of his competence. However
he is expected to exercise due diligence and professional care in his work as expected of him. Accounting is
concerned with the recording of the transaction and preparation of statements of account but auditing involves
a detailed and critical examination of accounts prepared by others. In fact, auditing begins where accounting
ends.
Constraints on the scope of the audit of financial statements that impair the auditor’s ability to express an unqualified
opinion on such financial statement should be set out in the report. Qualified opinion or disclaimer of opinion should
be expressed as appropriate.
According to Schlosser, audit now also covers Cost Audit, Management Audit, Internal Audit, Energy Audit, Excise
Audit, VAT audit and Government audit too. Today audit is not confined to the business houses only, but also to
non-business organizations. Auditor is in the nature of a watch-dog and a trustee of the nation’s finances.
As per SA-200A on “Objectives and Scope of Audit of Financial Statements” the scope of an audit of financial
statements will be determined by the auditor having regard to the terms of the engagement, the requirements of
relevant legislations and pronouncement of the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India. Of course the terms of
engagement cannot restrict the scope of an audit in relation to matters which are prescribed by legislation or by
the pronouncement of the institute. The auditor’s work involves exercise of judgment for example, in deciding the
extent of audit procedures and in assessing the reasonableness of the judgments and estimates made by the
management in preparing the financial statements. Furthermore, much of the evidence available to the auditor
can enable him to draw only reasonable conclusion there from. Because of these factors, absolute certainty in
auditing is rarely attainable.
Hence, it becomes quite clear that the scope of audit is widening and there is a change in emphasis in audit
objectives too.
RELATIONSHIP AND DISTINCTION BETWEEN ACCOUNTING & AUDITING
The relationship between accounting and auditing has been explained by kell and Ziegler in “Modern Auditing”
as follows:
Accounting Auditing
i. Analyze events and transactions Review client’s internal control system
ii. Record and summarize data in accounting records Obtain and evaluate evidence on statement assertions
iii. Make financial statement assertions Determine fairness of statements in conformity with rec-
ognized accounting principles
iv. Prepare financial statements as per recognized Prepare audit report on finding
accounting principles
v. Distribute Financial statements and Auditor’s re- Deliver audit report to client
port to shareholders
vi. Accounting is first & after it is done auditing starts Auditing starts where accounting ends
Auditing and Accounting are related. Auditing begins where Accounting ends, but they are distinct from each
other. The basic distinction between Accounting and Auditing is enumerated below;
Accounting Auditing
i. It is the collection, classification and summarization Auditing is an analytical and critical examination of
of data for preparation of books of accounts, and books of accounts, financial records and the financial
to make financial statements. statements prepared thereon.
ii. It is the recording of transactions at the time of It is the post mortem examination of recorded
occurrence. transactions.
iii. It measures the business events in monetary terms, Auditing reviews financial records to form an opinion on
records them, and communicates the financial the authenticity of Financial Statements.
results through Financial Statements.
Iv. The primary responsibility is of the management The auditor is an independent person appointed by the
towards the shareholders/ owners, to maintain the business entity to review the Financial Statements and to
Financial records in such a manner that Financial give his opinion thereon.
Statements can be prepared from the records.
v. An accountant is not expected to review/ report An auditor is required to submit a report with his opinion
on the Financial Statement but to report the on ‘true and fair’ assertions made in the Financial
compilation of records to the management. Statements to the owners.
vi. An accountant works for/ under the management. The auditor is an independent person answerable/
liable to the owners/ shareholders and not just to the
management.
vii. No such liability In certain circumstances, the auditor could be held
liable to third parties also.
viii. Maintenance of accounts may not be mandatory Audit could be exempt for various individuals or small
for small individuals or partnership firms, e. g. under partnerships, e. g. under section 44AB of the Income
section 44AA of the Income Tax Act, but could be tax Act, and even in case where maintaining books
mandatory under other laws, e. g. for companies of accounts is a statutory requirement under section
under the Companies Act. 44AA, but may be mandatory under other laws e. g. for
Companies under the companies Act.
ix. Accounting is done as per the principles set by Auditing is done as per the principal set in standards on
Indian Accounting standards (Ind AS) auditing.
AUDITOR
The person conducting the audit is known as the Auditor. To be an auditor, the person should be professionally
qualified. For example, under the Companies Act, 2013, only Chartered Accountants who are professionally
qualified and possess certificate of practice which is valid and are allowed to conduct the audit of the accounts
of the companies.
A successful auditor must possess the following qualities:
(i) An auditor should have a sound knowledge of various disciplines associated with the audit such as
accountancy, economics, mathematics etc.
(ii) As per SA-200 on Basic Principles Governing an Audit issued by ICAI (CA) an auditor must possess the
integrity and be objective and independent in his approach to the audit work.
(iii) The auditor must have the knowledge of the general principles of the Law governing the auditee enterprise.
For example, while auditing a company the knowledge of the Companies Act, 2013 is necessary. If an
enterprise is governed by some special statue as in case of Banking Companies, the knowledge of that
special statue (Banking Regulation Act in case of Banking Companies) is also imperative.
(iv) An auditor should also have an understanding of the special features which are peculiar to a particular
business. SA 300 (Revised) and SA 310 issued by ICAI (CA) lay down principles in this regard.
(v) Though technical knowledge is necessary to conduct an audit, only those persons whose technical knowledge
is backed by basic human qualities can prove to be successful auditors.
(vi) In the case of London & General Bank, Lord Justice Lindley said that “an auditor must be honest, that is, he
must not certify what he does not believe to be true and must take reasonable care and skill before he
believes that what he certifies is true.
AUDIT AND INVESTIGATION
It is to be noted that both Auditing and Investigation have a fact finding character. Both involve a systematic
and critical examination of the available evidence, yet these are quiet distinct from each other as follows:
(iii) Compliance with the Generally Accepted Accounting Standards and Applicable Statutory Regulations
- The financial statements should be prepared in accordance with the requirements of applicable laws and
should comply with the relevant Indian Accounting Standards, guidance notes issued by ICAI (CA) etc.
For example, a proper distinction should be made between the items of capital and revenue nature, in case
a company declares dividend it should comply with the requirements of the Companies Act and the relevant
Rules made there under.
(iv) Reporting - Once the audit is carried out, the audit findings need be communicated to the appropriate
personal body (e.g. shareholders in case of company). An audit report states the opinion of the auditor as
to the true and fair view of the financial position and operating results of the enterprise.
OBJECTIVES OF AUDITING
According to SA 200 overall objective of the Independent auditor and the conduct of an audit in accordance
with SAs, in conducting an audit of financial statements, the overall objectives of the auditor are:
(a) To obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements as a whole are free from material
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, thereby enabling the auditor to express an opinion on whether
the financial statements are prepared, in all material respects, in accordance with an applicable financial
reporting framework; and
(b) To report on the financial statements, and communicates as required by the SAs, in accordance with the
auditor’s findings’’.
An audit is conducted with two main objectives:
Objective of Auditing
i. Primary Objective: The main objective of an audit is to determine whether the financial statements presents a
‘’true & fair view’’ of the financial position and financial performance of a business during the period. The
Balance Sheet shows the financial position on a particular date (say, the last day of the financial year), and
the profit & loss Accounts shows the financial performance of the business over that period (income and
expenditure during the whole financial year). Section 143 of the companies Act, 2013 requires the auditor
of the company to state if in his opinion the financial statements present ‘’true and fair view’’ of the state of
the company’s affairs at the end of its financial year, and of the profit and loss for its financial year. Such an
opinion by the auditor increases the reliability of the Company’s financial statements.
ii. Secondary Objective: The auditor is also responsible for detecting frauds and errors in the books of accounts and
financial records of the client’s business. Such detection of frauds and errors is called the secondary objective
of audit because the primary responsibility for safeguarding the business assets rests with the management.
If the auditor suspects the presence of material misstatements or defalcations in the records of the business,
he is expected to look into the matter with greater detail by applying various audit procedures to satisfy
himself about their existence or non-existence. He is also to report on the existence of such misstatement
and their magnitude through his audit report.
The problem that has always existed when the manager report to owners is the credibility of the report. The report
may — (a) contain errors, (b) not disclose frauds, (c) be inadvertently misleading, (d) be deliberately misleading,
(e) fail to disclose relevant information, (f) fail to conform to regulations.
The solution to this problem of credibility in reports and accounts lies in appointing an independent person called
an auditor to investigate the report and submit his findings.
A further point is that modern companies can be very large with multi-national activities. The preparation of the
accounts of such groups is a very complex operation involving the bringing together and summarizing of accounts
of subsidiaries with different conventions, legal systems and accounting and control systems. The verification of
such accounts by independent experts trained in the assessment of financial information is beneficial to those
who control and operate such organizations as well as to owners and outsiders.
Many financial statements must conform to statutory and other requirements. The most notable thing is that all
company accounts have to conform to the requirements of the Companies Act 2013. In addition, all accounts
should conform to the requirements of Indian Accounting Standards (Ind AS). It is essential that an audit should be
carried out on financial statements to ensure that they conform to these requirements.
The tasks of an auditor are of great importance to all concerned. The auditor must prepare his audit report
impartially and effectively based on facts and actual figures. The following significance can be expected from
auditing:
From legal Point of View: -
(i) Filing of Income Tax Return — Income Tax authorities generally accept the profit and loss account that has
been prepared by a qualified auditor and they do not go into details of the accounts.
(ii) Borrowing of money from external sources — Money can be borrowed easily on the basis of audited balance
sheet from the external sources. Most of the financial institution sanctions various loans on the basis of audited
financial statements.
(iii) Statement of Insurance Claim — In case of flood, fire, other natural calamities and the like unexpected
happenings the insurance company may settle the claim for loss or damages on the basis of audited accounts
of the previous year.
(iv) Sales tax payments — The audited books of accounts may generally be accepted by the sales tax
authorities.
(v) Action against bankruptcy — The audited accounts serve as a basis to determine action in bankruptcy
and insolvency cases.
From Internal Control Point of View
(i) Quick discovery of errors and frauds — Errors and frauds are located at an early date, so that in future
no attempt is made to commit such frauds as one is rather careful not to commit an error or a fraud as the
accounts are subject to regular audit.
(ii) Moral check on the employees — The auditing of the accounts keeps the accounts clerks and the
accountants regular and vigilant as they know that the auditor would complain against them if the accounts
are not prepared upto date or if there is any irregularity.
(iii) Advice to the management — It may happen that the management may consult the auditor and seek
advice on certain technical points although it is not the duty of the auditor to give advice.
(iv) Uniformity in accounts — If the accounts have been prepared on an uniform basis, accounts of one year
can be compared with other years and if there is any discrepancy, the cause may be enquired into.
From External Affairs Point of View
(i) Settlement of accounts — The audited accounts would facilitate the settlement of accounts of a deceased
partner.
(ii) Valuation of assets and goodwill — If the business is to be sold as a going concern basis, there may not be
much difficulty regarding the valuation of assets and goodwill as the accounts have already been audited
by an independent person.
(iii) Future trend of the business — From the audited books of accounts, the future trend of the business can be
assessed easily with certainty.
ADVANTAGES OF AUDIT
The advantages of audit are as follows:
(i) Audit is a tool, which different stakeholders can use to protect their interests in the enterprise.
(ii) Audit is not only a corrective measure but has a deterrent effect. It serves as a moral check on the employees
from committing defalcations or embezzlements.
(iii) The employees of the organisation remain alert and vigilant as regards the updating of books of accounts
and other records.
(iv) Audited accounts are considered more reliable by different cadres of Government. For example, the tax
audit report filed with the Taxation authorities.
(v) It facilitates detection of wastages and losses and helps in instituting corrective actions.
(vi) Audited accounts are taken to be more reliable and useful during corporate restructuring exercises, valuations
etc.
(vii) Banks, Financial Institutions and Government require audited accounts before granting any financial assistance
to the enterprise.
(viii) Audited accounts are taken to be more helpful in the settlement of accounts between the partners and thus
avoiding any dispute amongst them.
INHERENT LIMITATIONS OF AN AUDIT
There are some inherent limitations of audit:
As per SA 200A on Objective and Scope of Audit, the objective of an audit is to express an opinion as to the true
and fair view of the financial statements. The user should not believe that this option is as assurance as to the
future viability of the enterprise or the efficiency or effectiveness with which the management has conducted
the affairs of the enterprise. Again, the scope of audit is determined by the terms of engagement, requirement
of relevant legislation and pronouncements of ICAI (CA). Thus the appointing authority cannot restrict the scope
of an audit in relation to those matters which are prescribed by the relevant legislation and the pronouncements
of ICAI (CA). While the auditor is responsible for forming and expressing his opinion on the financial statements, the
responsibility for their preparation is that of the enterprise. Management’s responsibility includes the maintenance
of adequate accounting records and internal controls, selection and application of accounting policies and
safeguarding the assets of the enterprise. The audit of financial statements does not relieve the management
of its responsibilities. Despite these guidelines issued by the ICAI (CA), it is very important to note the following
inherent limitations of audit.
(i) An audit does not guarantee that all the material misstatements will be detected because of the following
inherent limitations of audit:
(a) Test nature of the audit;
(b) The audit evidence available to the auditor is persuasive rather than conclusive in nature;
(c) Inherent limitations of internal control, e.g. certain levels of management may be in a position to override
controls.
(ii) Professional skepticism — Professional skepticism means an approach that would ensure that if something
is wrong it is detected. This behavior of auditor helps him in identifying and evaluating (a) matters that increase
the risk of material misstatements resulting from fraud or error, (b) circumstances that make the auditor to
suspect material misstatements, (c) the question of management’s representations reliability. The auditor is
entitled to accept the records and documents as genuine unless there is some evidence to the contrary.
(iii) Materiality is one of basic fundamental concepts in process of Auditing as well as Accounting. Auditor has to
constantly & continuously judge whether transaction is material or not. It is used by him in his Audit Planning.
Materiality means important cost wise, profit wise, effect wise, value wise; which influences economic deci-
sion of user. What is material in one circumstance, may not be material in another circumstances. Therefore,
changes need to be done accordingly.
AUDITOR’S ENGAGEMENT
In case of a statutory audit the objective and scope of an audit is clearly described in the relevant law. However,
in a non-statutory audit it has to be stated with absolute clarity so as to avoid any kind of ambiguity as to the
objective and scope of audit. A misunderstanding may arise about the exact scope of the work. For example, the
client may be under an impression that while the auditor is preparing the accounts, the audit is also being carried
out. Therefore, in order to avoid any kind of misunderstanding or dispute it is in the interests of both the auditor
as well as the client to exactly define the scope of the engagement and reduce the same in writing by way
of audit engagement letter. An auditor’s engagement letter signifies the confirmation by the auditor of his
acceptance of appointment as auditor, the documentation of the objective and scope of audit or other work,
and the extent of his responsibilities to the client and the form of any reports. ICAI (CA) has issued SAS 4410, SRS 4400
and SRE 2400 in this regard. Although the form and content of the engagement letter differs from client to client but
in general the following references should be made in audit engagement letter:
(i) The objective and the scope of the engagement.
(ii) Management’s responsibility for the financial statements.
(iii) The existence of inherent limitations of audit and resulting material misstatements that may remain
undiscovered,
(iv) The need for use of services of internal auditors and/ or other experts that may arise during the course of
the engagement.
(v) The requirement of management confirmation letter as regards representations made by them concerning
audit.
(vi) Restriction of the auditor’s liability, if any.
(vii) Basis for computation of audit fees and billing arrangements.
(viii) The form of reports or other communication of results of the engagement.
The importance of audit engagement letter was highlighted in the case of Leech v Stokes. In this case the auditors were
instructed to prepare the annual profit and loss account of a firm of solicitors for submission to the tax authorities. The
evidence showed that proper books of account were not maintained and though the firm collected large sums
by way of rent on behalf of its clients, no proper cash book and client’s ledger were maintained. On the basis of
record of bills against clients as well as summary of firm’s expenses, the profit and loss account was prepared.
Subsequently, it was found that there was misappropriation of the rents collected and the auditors were sued for
negligence in their work. The judgment, given purely on the basis of facts, held the auditors not guilty, as in their
letter they had clearly indicated the restricted nature of their engagement.
FUNCTIONAL CLASSIFICATION OF AUDIT – COMPARISION BETWEEN EXTERNAL AUDIT AND INTERNAL AUDIT
Functionally, an audit can be classified into external audit and internal audit. The major points of distinction between
the two are as follows:
(i) The external auditors are appointed by the owners of the organisation, e.g., shareholders in case of a
company. When external auditors are appointed under a particular statue, they are called as statutory
auditors. But internal auditors are appointed by the management of the organisation. The internal auditors
may be appointed on contractual basis or they may be appointed as employees of the organisation.
(ii) The scope of work of an external auditor is determined by the particular statue under which they are
appointed but the internal auditors have to work within the scope defined the management which generally
includes review and appraisal of accounting, financial and administrative controls.
(iii) The main concern for an external auditor is to collect the adequate and reliable evidence to support his opinion
as to the truth and fairness of the representations made in the financial statements. The internal auditors,
on the other hand, are concerned with the compliance of various policies, rules and procedures of the
enterprise, compliance with applicable laws and generally accepted accounting principles.
(iv) The external auditors are directly responsible to the owners and in some cases to the third parties but the
internal auditors do not have any freedom to report to the outsiders.
It may be noted that unlike external auditors, internal auditors are generally not considered as independent
of the management. But one of the basic philosophies of audit is that the auditor must be independent. Thus,
in order to derive benefit from audit in its right earnest even internal auditor must be independent to the extent
practicable.
TYPES OF AUDIT
Audits can be of various types. They can be classified on the basis of independence or interference of the client,
and also on the basis of function performed. The basic classification is given as under:
I. Depending on independence and interference of the client
(a) Statutory Special Audit by auditors (investigators) appointed by the Government to report to the
respective government authorities on specific issues. This has the least interference of the client. The
auditor is generally supposed to submit a report to the appropriate authorities on matters and in the
form specified to him, within a specified timeframe. This audit may relate to one or more financial
years.
(b) Statutory Audit, or Cost Audit, or Tax Audit by independent auditors appointed by the Company, or Board
of Directors, or the client. This has high degree of independence. However the level of independence is
specified in the governing statutes. The manner, content, time for submission of the audit report and the
person to whom it is to be reported are governed by the respective statutes.
(c) Internal audit by an auditor, who may or may not be an independent auditor, appointed by the
management depending on the nature and scope defined and mutually decided in the terms of
engagement.
II. Depending on functional classification
(a) Statutory Audit of a Company or a LLP
(b) Statutory cost audit
(iv) Legal Definition: It may be defined or described in law itself. E.g., Schedule III requires separate disclosure
of items of all expenses exceeding 1% of turnover or to write off capital assets purchased for less than ` 5000.
(v) Relative overall impact: It may depend on the relative degree of relevance to the overall accounts or the
group, or class of transactions to which it pertains. E.g., short recoveries from debtors.
(vi) Qualitative: It may be qualitative and not often reckoned with respect to quantitative details alone.
E.g., improper disclosure of an accounting policy in the Notes to the Annual Financial Statements may affect
economic decisions.
(vii) Insignificant quantity but special context: It maybe of an insignificant quantity otherwise, but material in special
circumstances. E.g., rounding off to the nearest rupee the fraction of 0.666 as 0.67 in computer software. It
may be material in future due to cumulative effect even if insignificant now.
DISCLOSURE OF ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Accounting policies refer to the specific accounting principles and the methods of applying those principles
adopted by the enterprise in the preparation and presentation of the financial statements. The view presented
in the financial statements of an enterprise as to its state of affairs and operating results may be significantly
affected by following different accounting policies in the preparation of financial statements. Thus, a adequate
disclosure of accounting policies is very necessary so that the view presented in the financial statements can be
apprehended by the users of the financial statements.
The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India (ICAI-CA) has issued AS-1 on Disclosure of Accounting Policies in
this regard. The purpose of this Accounting Standard is to promote better understanding of the financial statements
by laying down the principles as to the manner of disclosure of accounting policies.
Fundamental Accounting Assumptions
It is generally assumed that the financial statements are prepared on the basis of fundamental accounting assumptions.
AS-1 on Disclosure of Accounting Policies lists the following three fundamental accounting assumptions:
(i) Going Concern - It means that the enterprise has an intention to carry on its operations for the foreseeable
future (i.e. coming 1 or 2 years). There is no intention on the part of the enterprise to discontinue the business
nor has any need arisen as to the liquidation of the organisation. It is because of this fundamental assumption
that depreciation etc. is provided in the books of accounts.
(ii) Consistency - Accounting policies are followed on consistent basis from one period to another. For example,
ABC Ltd. values its inventory on FIFO basis. The same basis of valuation is adopted in subsequent year also as
per the Principle of consistency.
(iii) Accrual - Revenues and cost are accrued, i.e., they are recognised when they are earned or incurred.
Actual receipt or payment is not necessary. In other words, the accounts are maintained on ‘mercantile
system’ only.
The accounting policies should be selected in such a manner that when financial statements are prepared on
the basis of such policies, they reflect a true and fair view of the state of affairs and the operating results of the
enterprise. The accounting policies are selected on the basis of following factors which are enunciated below;
(i) Prudence - lt states to ‘provide for all losses and anticipate no profits.’ At the time of preparation of financial
statements the preparer may face various uncertainties, for example, as to recoverability of receivables,
warranty claims etc. Thus, estimates are made for uncertainties and provided for in the books of accounts.
For example, provision for bad and doubtful debts.
(ii) Substance over Form - The transaction should be accounted for in accordance with its actual happening
and the economic reliability. The legal form is not relevant. For example, in case of hire purchase transaction,
the assets purchased under hire purchase are shown under the asset side of the balance sheet of the hire
purchaser even though he is not the legal owner. The reason being the ultimately the legal ownership of the
asset would be transferred to the hire purchaser.
(iii) Materiality - Financial statements should disclose all the items and facts which are sufficient enough to influence
the decisions of the user of the financial statements.
Ind AS-I further states that any change in accounting policy which has a material effect should be disclosed. The
amount by which any item in the financial statements is affected by such change should also be disclosed to
the extent ascertainable and if it is not ascertainable, either wholly or in part, the fact should be indicated. If a
change is made in accounting policy(s) which has no material effect on the financial statements for the current
period but which is reasonably expected to have a material effect in subsequent periods, the fact of such change
should be appropriately disclosed in the period in which the change is adopted.
Note:-
Some of the areas where different accounting policies may be followed by the management are enumerated
below;
(i) Valuation of inventories - First In First Out (FIFO), Weighted Average, Last In First Out (LIFO) method
(ii) Methods of providing depreciation -Straight Line, WDV,
(iii) Conversion of foreign currency items -Average rate, TT rate,
(iv) Treatment of retirement benefits,
(v) Expenditure during the construction period,
(vi) Government grants, etc.
(iv) Scope
(a) Complete Audit
(b) Partial Audit
(c) Detailed audit
The above broad classification is sometimes inter-locked
E.g: (a) Tax Audit and Cost Audit are statutory audits.
(b) Balance Sheet Audit has defined scope.
(c) Scope of Audits may be decided by the terms of engagement or by the statute governing
the Audit.
VOLUNTARY AUDIT OR PRIVATE AUDIT
‘’ Though audit is not necessary for each form of ownership, yet they go for audit’’.
‘’ Audit of accounts may not be compulsory, yet one may get the books of accounts audited for various reasons’’.
Audit refers to the process of examination of books and records together with the evidence relating to an entity,
whether it is required by law or not, for the purpose of formation of opinion with regard to true and fair view
disclosed by Financial Statements.
Broadly there are two classifications of audits:
(i) Statutory Audit
(ii) Voluntary Audit or Private Audit
(A) Statutory audits are mandatory in nature. Audit of companies is mandatory under the provisions of the
Companies Act, 2013. Audit of insurance companies, banking companies and cooperative societies are also
compulsory under the specific statutes, as applicable.
(B) Voluntary audits are non-statutory audits. There is no statutory requirement for audits of sole trader, partnership
firm (except for a statutory tax audit u/s 44AB required as per the Income Tax Act, 1961, e.g. when such
an entity exceeds the turnover of certain limit). The sole proprietors and partnership firms may get their
accounts audited voluntarily on their own because of certain advantages.
ADVANTAGES OF AUDITING FOR SOLE PROPRIETORS
(i) It evaluates the internal control system and strengthens it by removing weaknesses, if any.
(ii) It increases the reliability and authenticity of Financial Statements.
(iii) It helps in timely finalization of Annual Financial Statements and tax assessments.
(iv) It keeps a moral check on the working of employees.
(v) It helps them in obtaining funds easily from financial institutions, based on more reliable Financial Statements
available to the banks and financial institutions.
(vi) It helps in settling:
- Trade disputes
- Labour disputes
- Insurance claims
ADVANTAGES OF AUDITING FOR PARTNERSHIP FIRMS & OTHERS
The added advantages besides other advantages are enumerated below;
(i) It helps in settlement of accounts among the partners on the basis of more reliable accounting records.
(ii) It protects the interest of minors, sleeping partners/partners who are not involved in day to day operations,
and keeps a check on persons who are working on behalf of others.
(iii) It helps in partnership firms for settlement of goodwill at the time of admission, retirement and death of partners.
(iv) It enables firm to get loans from banks, financial institutions as they rely on audited accounts of firm.
Due to these advantages, even the entities which are not under any statutory obligation of statutory audit get
GOVERMENT AUDIT
Meaning: United Nations (UN)Handbook on Government Auditing in Developing Countries states that “Government
auditing is the objective, systematic, professional and independent examination of financial, administrative and other
operations of a public entity for the purpose of evaluating and verifying them, presenting a report containing
comments, conclusions, recommendations and expressing the appropriate professional opinion in respect of
financial statements.”
Authorization: The Comptroller & Auditor General (CAG) of India is the Supreme Audit Institution.
Types of Government Audit
(a) Transaction audit
i. Expenditure Audit
ii. Receipts Audit
(b) Efficiency cum Performance Audit
Expenditure Audit: The basic standards set for audit of expenditure are to ensure that there is provision of
funds authorized by competent authority fixing the limits within which expenditure can be incurred. Some
standards are briefly explained below;
i. Audit against Rules & Orders: It is also known as Regularity Audit. Under this, the auditor has to see
that the expenditure incurred conforms to the relevant provisions of the statutory enactment and is in
accordance with the financial rules and orders framed by the competent authority.
ii. Audit of Sanctions: The auditor has to ensure that each item of expenditure is covered by a sanction,
either general or special, accorded by the competent authority, authorizing such expenditure. In case
expenditure exceeds the sanctioned limit, objection is raised.
iii. Audit against Provision of Funds: It contemplates that there is a provision of funds out of which
expenditure can be incurred and the amount of such expenditure does not exceed the sanctioned
amount as well as examine whether the money has been spent for the specified purpose.
iv. Audit of financial propriety: The auditor has to ensure that the expenditure incurred are with respect to
the recognized standards of financial propriety i.e. quantity, quality, morality and ethics.
and environmental development simultaneously. A social audit is a way of measuring, understanding, reporting and
improving an organization’s performance towards meeting its social and ethical objectives.
Objectives of Social Audit
i) Assessing the needs of the society and resources available for fulfilling them.
ii) Spreading awareness among beneficiaries about the business’ efforts towards attaining social objectives.
iii) Increasing efficacy and effectiveness of the organization’s Corporate Social Responsibility (CSR) programmes.
iv) Scrutiny of policy decisions, keeping in view the interests of stakeholders.
Advantages of Social Audit
i) Encourages community participation among different business entities.
ii) Ensures continuous efforts towards environmental protection and use of environment friendly production
processes.
iii) Builds customer satisfaction and trust through ethical business practices.
iv) Promotes collective decision making and sharing responsibilities.
v) Develops human resources by working towards improvement of workers’ and the underprivileged persons’
working/ living conditions.
ENVIRONMENTAL AUDIT
Definition and Meaning
According to the United States Environmental Protection Agency (USEPA), environmental audit may be defined
as a systematic, documented, periodic and objective review by a regulated entity of facility operations and
practices related to meeting environmental requirements.” It protects environment from pollution of Air, Water,
Earth etc.
The Confederation of British Industry has defined environmental auditing as “the systematic examination of the
interactions between any business operation and its surroundings.”
Scope and Object
i. All emissions to air, land and water
ii. Legal constraints
iii. The effects on the neighboring community, landscape and ecology
iv. The public’s perception of the operating company in the local area
v. It provides expert opinion on hazards in the environment
vi. Associated risks
vii. The measures that may need to be taken for the management and control of risks.
Different steps of an Environment Audit
The International Chamber of Commerce presents the different steps of an environmental audit as follows:
1. Pre-audit activities:
i. Selection and scheduling of facility to audit.
ii. Selection of audit team.
iii. Contact with facility.
iv. Planning of the audit.
2. Site activities:
i. Understanding of internal controls.
ii. Assessment of internal controls.
iii. Gathering of audit evidence.
iv. Evaluation of audit findings.
v. Report of findings to facility.
3. Post audit activities:
i. Production of a draft report.
i. Economy It ensures that entity has acquired the financial, human and physical resources economically.
Audit It implies that resources have been procured in appropriate quantity, quality and at minimum
cost.
ii. Efficiency It ensures the economical execution of various schemes and policies. It refers to the relationship
Audit between inputs and output i.e. the goods and services produced and resources used to
produce them, yielding the expected results.
iii. Effectiveness It is an appraisal of the performance of schemes and projects with reference to the
overall targeted objectives as well as efficiency of the ways and methods adopted for the
attainment of objectives.
Approach
Various steps undertaken by the auditor while conducting EPA are identification of topic, obtain necessary
information, preliminary study, planning and execution of audit, reviewing internal control system and reporting.
PROPRIETY AUDIT
A propriety audit is not just concerned with the truthfulness and fairness of the Financial Statements and books of
accounts of the client, but also ensures that the transactions entered into by the client, business practices and
activities undertaken are not against public interest. Its objective is to see that the business lives upto standards
of proper conduct. Legal, economic and financial are all equally important aspects that require to be looked
into during the course of the audit.
It is an essential element of a Government Audit. The Comptroller and Auditor General (CAG) examines the propriety
of all government expenditures to ensure that they have been incurred in the interest of the general public, and
are not influenced by personal interests of the government authorities sanctioning it.
Section 143 of the Companies Act, 2013 requires the auditor to look into some specified matters to ensure that the
Directors of the company do not engage in misappropriation and siphoning of funds.
OPERATIONAL AUDIT
Operational Audit involves examination of all the operations and activities of the entity under audit.
Objective
The objects of operational audit include the following:
The examination of the control structure of the entity. The relation of department controls to general policies and
its relation with control of other departments.
It provides an appraisal of whether the department is operating in conformity with prescribed standards and
procedures laid down by the management.
It checks whether standards of efficiency and economy are maintained. It is concerned with formulation of plans
and checking of the implementation of systems and controls in respect of other departments of the entity.
It checks whether capacity utilization in production department and achievement of short term targets in
marketing departments and other activities are so economically performed to achieve the preset overall goals
of the entity.
Scope
Operational audit, in its initial stages, was developed as a branch of internal auditing. Internal audit focuses on
accounting operations of the entity but operational audit has a wider scope of working and covers all other
operations, such as production and marketing too.
Advantages
Operational audit is one of the management tools to get first hand information. It is more useful in an entity
where the management is at a distance from actual operations. It is very useful in large organizations where
management cannot control the actual operations due to layers of delegation of responsibility. The management
information system has various tools like routine performance report from department heads, internal audit reports,
surprise checks, periodic inspections and investigation to control the managers responsible for their departments.
The operational audit is also one of the tools used in large or geographically vast entities to control the operation
at first stage and to fill up the gaps of information provided by department heads through periodic reports.
CONTINUOUS AUDIT
Definition: According to the The Institute of Internal Auditors, USA, continuous auditing is “a method used to
perform control and risk assessments automatically on a more frequent basis. Continuous auditing changes the
audit paradigm from periodic reviews of a sample of transactions to ongoing audit testing of 100 percent of
transactions. It becomes an integral part of modern auditing at many levels...... technology is a key to enabling
such an approach.”
Continuous audit may be defined as the examination and verification of a firm’s financial transactions and their
supporting documents, continuously throughout the year, at regular or irregular intervals.
A continuous audit driven system generates alarm triggers that provide advance notice about anomalies and
errors detected by the system. It is performed usually by the firm’s internal auditors to eliminate the year-end
workload.
The Basic Features of Continuous Audit
i. It is a process conducted throughout the year.
ii. It is conducted at regular or irregular intervals.
iii. It focuses on testing 100% of transactions.
iv. Technology is important to enable it.
v. It provides advance notice about errors and irregularities detected.
vi. Surprise visits by the auditor are involved.
Necessary of Continuous Audit
Continuous audit is necessary where:
i. Internal controls are inadequate.
ii. The transactions run in large numbers.
iii. The management is interested in getting statements of accounts audited periodically for enabling better
management of resources.
The Advantages of Continuous Audit
i. Early location of errors and frauds: It helps in detecting errors and frauds immediately on their occurrence,
and not at the year end when it would become difficult to install corrective control mechanisms.
ii. Quick rectification: rectification of errors at an early stage is possible.
iii. Guidance: Continuous guidance to client.
iv. Finalizations of accounts completion in time: Just at the end of the accounting period.
v. Moral check: Make employees of the client alert and more efficient in conducting their work.
vi. Improves statutory auditor’s focus: It relieves statutory auditors of routine testing and allows them to focus
efforts on more valuable activities.
Objective
While conducting a balance sheet audit, the auditor can rely upon the system of internal controls and internal
checks and also on the reports of the internal auditor. Wherever internal controls and checks are sound, he can
reduce the extent of routine checking of vouching, posting, casting and other routine tests. However, he should
increase the extent of checking to obtain audit assurance if he finds that there are weaknesses in the internal
control systems.
Need
With the development of industries and computerization of accounts, the need for balance sheet audit has
increased. Now, the statutory auditor can reduce the extent of routine checking and concentrate more on
critical examination of the Balance Sheet due to the computerized recording of large number of transactions and
adoption of EDP system controls in data processing.
Procedure
As per the guidelines of national and international accounting bodies, the auditor should follow carefully planned
audit procedures:
i. For identification of areas where sample testing is sufficient.
ii. For performance of certain compliance procedures and substantive procedures in some areas.
iii. For analytical review of Financial Statements.
iv. For verification of assets and liabilities stated in the Financial Statements.
v. For scrutiny of books of accounts to check whether Financial Statements are in conformity with the records.
vi. For evaluation of the internal control system and critical examination of the assertions made in the Financial
Statements.
vii. For ensuring the compliance of all legal requirements relating to adequate disclosure of material facts in the
Financial Statements.
Advantages of Balance Sheet Audit
i. Balance sheet audit commences after the completion of books of accounts. The management prepares
the Balance Sheet, therefore changes in the accounts is not possible once the verification process is started.
ii. No interruption in the accounts department. Checking can be done smoothly without any breaks in
between.
iii. No loose links because audit is conducted in a continuous flow, which reduces the chances of missing the
verification of any aspect.
iv. Sample tests reduce the time involved for routine checking. The saving on account of time results in cost
effectiveness.
COMPLETE, PARTIAL AND DETAILED (IN DEPTH) AUDIT
A complete audit is an audit where the scope of audit is not confined to specific limits, which may be set by
the management or any other authority. The auditor is required to check all the possible aspects of a business,
including manufacturing operations, data flow processes, accounting records and procedures, etc. In general
business practices, it is not feasible to get a complete audit conducted.
A partial audit is a non statutory audit, which restricts the scope of the auditor to checking of certain specific
aspects only. The auditor’s powers to enquiry are restricted by his terms of engagement. He may not be allowed
to obtain information which falls outside the purview of the scope defined for him.
E.g. an auditor may be appointed to check the accuracy of recording of transactions relating to cash sales, or he
may be appointed to conduct an audit for the month of Diwali only.
Detailed audit is also known as audit-in-depth. It involves checking of transactions from the time of their recording
till their final effect on the Financial Statements. Every stage that a transaction goes through in the accounting
process is closely examined by the auditor using various audit evidences.
STATUTORY REPORT
Statutory Audit of a public company implies the audit of the transactions of the company which are the subject-
matter of the report under section 143. The auditor, however, has to certify as correct only as much of the Statutory
Report as relates to the shares allotted by the company, cash received in respect of such shares and other
receipts and payments of the company. The auditor, therefore, must:
(a) Examine the internal check with regard to the control over amounts collected. And
(b) Study the Memorandum, Articles of Association and the Prospectus for ascertaining the amount of authorized
capital, its composition, terms of issue, particulars of any underwriting contract entered in to, the rate of
underwriting commission, shares agreed to be issued for consideration other than cash and particulars of
important agreements entered into by the company.
In addition he should carry out an audit of the issue of shares. The under mentioned steps are also necessary:
i. Vouch the payment of the underwriting commission.
ii. Vouch the brokerage paid on issue of share by examining the application and confirming that they bear
the stamps of the brokers or agents to whom brokerage has been paid. Refer to minutes of the Directors
authorizing the payment of such brokerage. Also see that the provisions of section 40 have not been
contravened.
iii. Vouch the payment of preliminary Expenses and see that the amount paid does not exceed the amount
fixed by the Articles or the prospectus.
iv. Vouch all other receipts and payments of the company up to date within seven days of the report; pay
special attention to receipts and payments on capital account, e.g., sale proceeds of assets acquired from
the vendor of the business, payments made to him, purchase of fixed assets, etc.
Check in detail amounts deposited in the bank and withdrawals thereof with the entries in the bank Pass Book.
Obtain a certificate from the Bank as to the bank balance as at the date up to which the statutory report has
been prepared.
Verify that the amounts receivable and payable which have been adjusted in the books of account but have been
excluded from the balance of receipts and payments.
The statutory audit culminates in the preparation of the statutory report. Its main content, with which the audit is
concerned, is the abstract of Receipts and Payments made up to a date within 7 days of the report, exhibiting
under distinctive heads, receipts of the company from shares, debentures and other sources, payment made
and balance left in hand. The Statutory Report is required to be certified by the auditors of the company, in so far as
the report relates to shares allotted by the company, cash received in respect of which the checking of accounts,
as per details given above, has been carried out.
Self Examination questions
1. Define the term Auditing? State the benefits that accrue out of Auditing?
2. Briefly state the scope of Auditing and various aspects covered in Audit.
3. Distinguish between the following:
A. Audit and Investigation
B. Accounting and Auditing
4. What are the various principles governing an Audit?
5. Write short note on the concept of Materiality in Audit.
6. “Accounting is a necessity but Auditing is a Luxury-Comment.
7. Critically comment on “True and Fair Report of the Auditor on the Financial Statements, ensures the future
viability of the enterprise”.
8. Differentiate between External and Internal Audit.
9. What are the qualities of Auditors?
10. What are the advantages accrue out of audit in a Sole proprietorship and partnership firm?
11. Differentiate between Private and statutory audit.
12. Distinguish between the following;
a. Statutory Audit and Government audit
b. Company and firm
Column A Column B
1 Statutory Audit A Comptroller & Auditor General of India
2 Functional classification of Audit. B Audit against provision of funds
3 Tax Audit limit for a person carrying on profession. C Basic principal governing an audit
4 Primary objective of business D Tax Audit
5 The authority for Government Audit. E Final Audit
6 Scope of work F Determine whether financial statement
presents true and fair view.
7 SA 200 G Audit Engagement
8 Tax Audit limit for a company H External and Internal Audit
9 To ensure that the expenditure is made according to limit. I Twenty five Lakh rupees
10 Annual Audit J Hundred Lakh rupees
[Answer: D, H, I, F, A, G, C,J, B, E]
4. Each of the three parties involved in an audit ......................... plays a role that contributes to its success.
The engagement letter is one firm’s contract with your client. It is the starting point, and oftentimes the ending
point, for the relationship. Most Chartered Accountants firms receive a signed engagement letter and file it away.
An audit engagement refers to an audit that an auditor performs. More specifically, it refers only to the initial
stage of an audit during which the auditor notifies the client he has accepted the audit work and clarifies his
understanding of the audit’s purpose and scope.
The Auditing and Assurance Standards Board of the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India is issuing the
following illustrative formats for engagement letter for audit of Financial Statements under the Companies Act,
2013 and the Rules there under.
Audit Engagement letter is given by Auditor to Company, explaning scope of work duties & responsibilities of
Auditor and that of management of Company. It specifies limits of Liability of Auditor. It avoids mis-under standing
confusion, dispute between client & Auditor at a later stage. Audit engagement letter confirms acceptance of
Audit by Auditor, documentation objective & scope of Audit & Other work and the extent of his responsibilities to
client the forms of report to be given by him;
Every engagement letter as per ICAI should cover following points: -
(a) Objective & scope of engagement
(b) Management responsibility
(c) Existence of inherent limitations
(d) Need for use of Internal Auditor
(e) Management confirmation letter
(f) Restrictions & limitations of Auditor liabilities
(g) Basis of computation of Audit fees
(h) Billing arrangement
(i) Form of report & Other communications of engagement
(j) Validity of report
(k) Limits on submission of report to other authorities
Illustrative formats – 1
Example of an Audit Engagement Letter
Audit of Financial Statements under the companies Act 2013 and the Rules Thereunder
(When Reporting u/s 143(3) (i) is Applicable)
Part A: Audit of Financial Statements
To, the Board of Directors of ………………………………… (Name of the Entity)
(Address)
Dear Sirs,
I/We refer to the letter dated…………….informing me/us about my /our (re) Appointment/ratification as the
auditors of the Company. You have requested that I / we audit the financial statements of the Company as
defined in Section 2(40) of the Companies Act, 2013 (‘2013 Act’), for the financial year(s) beginning April 1, 20XX
and ending March 31, 20YY. The financial statements of the Company include, where applicable, consolidated
financial statements of the Company and of all its subsidiaries, associate companies and joint ventures. I am / we
are pleased to confirm my/ our acceptance and my / our understanding of this audit engagement by means of
this letter.
My / Our audit will be conducted with the objective of me / our expressing an opinion if the aforesaid financial
statements give the information required by the 2013 Act in the manner so required, and give a true and fair view
in conformity with the applicable accounting principles generally accepted in India, of the state of affairs of the
Company as at 31st March, 20YY, and its profit/loss and its cash flows for the year ended on that date which, inter
alia, includes reporting in conjunction whether the Company has an adequate internal financial controls system
over financial reporting in place and the operating effectiveness of such controls. In forming my / our opinion on
the financial statements, I / we will rely on the work of branch auditors appointed by the Company and my / our
report would expressly state the fact of such reliance.
I / We will conduct my / our audit in accordance with the Standards on Auditing (SAs), issued by the Institute of
Chartered Accountants of India (ICAI) and deemed to be prescribed by the Central Government in accordance
with Section 143(10) of the 2013 Act. Those Standards require that I / we comply with ethical requirements and
plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free from
material misstatements. An audit involves performing procedures to obtain audit evidence about the amounts
and the disclosures in the financial statements. The procedures selected depend on the auditor’s judgment,
including the assessment of the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to fraud or
error. In making those risk assessments, the auditor considers internal financial control relevant to the Company’s
preparation of the financial statements that give a true and fair view in order to design audit procedures that are
appropriate in the circumstances.
The terms of reference for my / our audit of internal financial controls over financial reporting carried out in
conjunction with our audit of the Company’s financial statements will be as stated in the separate engagement
letter for conducting such audit and should be read in conjunction with this letter.
An audit also includes evaluating the appropriateness of the accounting policies used and the reasonableness of
accounting estimates made by the Management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial
statements.
Because of the inherent limitations of an audit, including the possibility of collusion or improper management
override of controls, there is an unavoidable risk that material misstatements due to fraud or error may occur
and not be detected, even though the audit is properly planned and performed in accordance with the SAs.
Also, projections of any evaluation of the internal financial controls over financial reporting to future periods are
subject to the risk that the internal financial control over financial reporting may become inadequate because of
changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
My / Our audit will be conducted on the basis that the Management and those charged with governance (Audit
Committee / Board) acknowledge and understand that they have the responsibility:
(a) For the preparation of financial statements that give a true and fair view in accordance with the applicable
Financial Reporting Standards and other generally accepted accounting principles in India. This includes:
• Compliance with the applicable provisions of the 2013 Act;
• Proper maintenance of accounts and other matters connected therewith;
• The responsibility for the preparation of the financial statements on a going concern basis;
• The preparation of the annual accounts in accordance with, the applicable accounting standards and
providing proper explanation relating to any material departures from those accounting standards;
• Selection of accounting policies and applying them consistently and making judgments and estimates
that are reasonable and prudent so as to give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Company
at the end of the financial year and of the profit and loss of the Company for that period;
• Taking proper and sufficient care for the maintenance of adequate accounting records in accordance
with the provisions of the 2013 Act for safeguarding the assets of the Company and for preventing and
detecting fraud and other irregularities;
• Laying down internal financial controls to be followed by the Company and that such internal financial
controls are adequate and were operating effectively; and
• Devising proper systems to ensure compliance with the provisions of all applicable laws and those
systems were adequate and operating effectively.
(b) Identifying and informing me / us of financial transactions or matters that may have any adverse effect on
the functioning of the Company.
(c) Identifying and informing me / us of:
• All the pending litigations and confirming that the impact of the pending litigations on the Company’s
financial position has been disclosed in its financial statements;
• All material foreseeable losses, if any, on long term contracts including derivative contracts and the
accrual for such losses as required under any law or accounting standards; and
• Any delay in transferring amounts, required to be transferred, to the Investor Education and Protection
Fund by the Company.
(d) Informing me / us of facts that may affect the financial statements, of which Management may become
aware during the period from the date of my / our report to the date the financial statements are issued.
(e) Identifying and informing me / us as to whether any director is disqualified as on March 31, 20YY from being
appointed as a director in terms of Section 164 (2) of the 2013 Act. This should be supported by written
representations received from the directors as on March 31, 20YY and taken on record by the Board of
Directors.
(f) To provide me / us, inter alia, with:
(i) Access, at all times, to all information, including the books, accounts, vouchers and other records
and documentation of the Company, whether kept at the Head Office or elsewhere, of which the
Management is aware that are relevant to the preparation of the financial statements such as records,
documentation and other matters. This will include books of account maintained in electronic mode;
(ii) Access, at all times, to the records of all the subsidiaries (including associate companies and joint
ventures as per Explanation to Section 129(3) of the 2013 Act) of the Company in so far as it relates to
the consolidation of its financial statements, as envisaged in the 2013 Act;
(iii) Access to reports, if any, relating to internal reporting on frauds (e.g., vigil mechanism reports etc.),
including those submitted by cost accountant or company secretary in practice to the extent it relates
to their reporting on frauds in accordance with the requirements of Section 143(12) of the 2013 Act;
(iv) Additional information that I / we may request from the Management for the purposes of my / our
audit;
(v) Unrestricted access to persons within the Company from whom I / we deem it necessary to obtain
audit evidence. This includes my / our entitlement to require from the officers of the Company such
information and explanations as I / we may think necessary for the performance of my / our duties as
the auditors of the Company; and
(vi) All the required support to discharge my / our duties as the statutory auditors as stipulated under the
Companies Act, 2013/ ICAI standards on auditing and applicable guidance.
As part of my / our audit process, I / we will request from the Management written confirmation concerning
representations made to me / us in connection with my / our audit.
My / Our report prepared in accordance with relevant provisions of the 2013 Act would be addressed to the
shareholders of the Company for adoption of the accounts at the Annual General Meeting. In respect of other
services, my / our report would be addressed to the Board of Directors. The form and content of my / our report
may need to be amended in the light of my / our audit findings.
In accordance with the requirements of Section 143(12) of the 2013 Act, if in the course of performance of my /
our duties as auditor, I / we have reason to believe that an offence involving fraud is being or has been committed
against the Company by officers or employees of the Company, I / we will be required to report to the Central
Government, in accordance with the rules prescribed in this regard which, inter alia, requires me / us to forward
my / our report to the Board or Audit Committee, as the case may be, seeking their reply or observations, to
enable me / us to forward the same to the Central Government.
As stated above, given that I am / we are required as per Section 143(12) of the Act to report on frauds, such
reporting will be made in good faith and, therefore, cannot be considered as breach of maintenance of client
confidentiality requirements or be subject to any suit, prosecution or other legal proceeding since it is done in
pursuance of the 2013 Act or of any rules or orders made thereunder.
I / We also wish to invite your attention to the fact that our audit process is subject to ‘peer review’ / ‘quality
review’ under the Chartered Accountants Act, 1949. The reviewer(s) may inspect, examine or take abstract of my
/ our working papers during the course of the peer review/quality review.
I / We may involve specialists and staff from our affiliated network firms to perform certain specific audit procedures
during the course of my / our audit.
In terms of Standard on Auditing 720 - “The Auditor’s Responsibility in Relation to Other Information in Documents
Containing Audited Financial Statements” issued by the ICAI and deemed to be prescribed by the Central
Government in accordance with Section 143(10) of the 2013 Act , I / we request you to provide to me / us a Draft
of the Annual Report containing the audited financial statements so as to enable me / us to read the same and
communicate material inconsistencies, if any, with the audited financial statements, before issuing the auditor’s
report on the financial statements.
{Other relevant Information}
{Insert Other information, such as fee arrangements, billings and other specific terms, as appropriate.}
This letter should be read in conjunction with my / our letter dated _ _ for the Audit of Internal Financial Controls
Over Financial Reporting under the 2013 Act, in respect of which separate fees have been fixed/will be mutually
agreed.
I / We look forward to full cooperation from your staff during my / our audit.
Please sign and return the attached copy of this letter to indicate your acknowledgement of, and agreement
with, the arrangements for my / our audit of the financial statements including our respective responsibilities.
Yours faithfully,
(Signature)
(Name of the Member)
(Designation)
(Name of the Firm)
Date:
Place:
An audit programme is a detailed plan of the auditing work to be performed, specifying the procedures to be
followed in verification of each item and the financial statements and the estimated time required. To be more
comprehensive, an audit programme is written plan containing exact details with regard to the conduct of a
particular audit. It is a description or memorandum of the work to be done during an audit. Audit programme
serves as a guide in arranging and distributing the audit work as well as checking against the possibility of the
omissions.
As per SA 300, the auditor should prepare a written audit programme setting forth the procedures that are needed
to be implemented while carrying out the audit plan. He may take into account the reliance to be placed on internal
controls. The auditor has some flexibility in deciding when to perform audit procedures. But, sometimes he may
have no discretion as to timing, such as, observing the stock taking by the client’s personnel. The audit programme
should consider previous year’s audit programmes and these may be modified, if necessary.
Audit working papers are the record of the planning and execution of the audit engagement. Auditors retain a set
of working papers for each audit engagement for each year. The audit working papers for the current year are
referred to as the current working papers. Working papers that are relevant to more than one audit engagement
are often kept separately in a file referred to as permanent working papers. The audit working papers (current and
permanent) for a client audit engagement are sufficiently detailed to enable another appropriately experienced
and competent auditor that is not familiar with the client to obtain an overall understanding of the engagement.
SA 230 on ‘Documentation’ issued by ICAI (CA) deals with the ‘working papers’. As per this Standards an Audit
documentation refers to the working papers prepared or obtained and retained by the auditors for his audit
work. Working papers (or documentation) serve three purposes
(i) aid in planning and performance of the audit;
(ii) aid in supervision and review of the audit work; and
(iii) these papers serve as an evidence of the audit work performed by the auditor to support his opinion.
Further, as per SA 230, working papers are the momentous records of the auditor which help in establishing that the
reasonably logical and verifiable conclusions were reached on the basis of relevant audit evidence. These
working papers also facilitate audit planning and supervision of the audit work. The form and content of working
papers vary from audits to audits, but they are affected by the following matters:
Working papers are the property of the auditor, the portions or extracts of which can be had at his discretion.
These working papers should kept in safe custody and in confidential manner for such time as is sufficient to meet
the requirements of his practice or to satisfy any related legal or professional requirement of record retention.
However, if required by some legislation, the auditor has to make working papers available to the regulatory
authority(s). In case of Chantery Martin & Co, it was held that the audit working papers are the property of the
auditor and he is entitled to retain them.
ICAI has prescribed that the members have to retain the working papers for a period of 7 years (as per SQC 1),
otherwise, the member is guilty of professional misconduct.
An audit book is usually a bound book in which a large variety of maters observed during the course of audit are
recorded. The audit note book is a permanent record of the auditor. For each individual audit, the auditor usually
maintains a separate audit note book. The audit note book should be maintained clearly, completely and
systematically. An audit note book is a great evidential tool available as a defence with the auditors in the event
of any charge is brought against them. In case of City Equitable Fire Insurance Company, the auditors were relieved
because they have maintained record of the audit work performed at each stage.
Contents of Audit Note Book
i. Name of the business enterprise.
ii. Organisation structure.
iii. Important provisions of Memorandum of Association (MOA) and Articles of Association (AOA).
iv. Communication with the previous auditor, if any.
v. Management representations and instructions.
vi. List of books of accounts maintained by the enterprise.
vii. Accounting methods, internal control systems followed by the enterprise, applicable laws etc.
viii. Key managerial personnel.
ix. Errors and fraud discovered.
x. Matters requiring explanations or clarifications.
xi. Special points that need attention in the audit report.
AUDIT RISK
In very broad terms, audit risk is the risk of a material misstatement of a financial statement item that is or
should be included in the audited financial statements of an entity. In theory, audit risk ranges anywhere from
zero, where there is complete certainty of no material misstatement, to one, where there is complete certainty of
a material misstatement. In practice, however, audit risk is always greater than zero. There is always some risk of
material misstatement as it is not possible, (except for the audit of the simplest of financial statements), due to the
limitations inherent in both accounting and auditing, to be absolutely certain that a material misstatement will not
exist.
“Audit risk” is the risk that the auditor gives an inappropriate audit opinion when the financial statements are
materially misstated. Such misstatements can result from either fraud or error.
i. Inherent risk – It is the susceptibility of a account balance or class of transaction to misstatements that could
be material, either individually or when taken together with misstatements in other balance or classes,
assuming that there were no internal controls.
ii. Control risk- It is the risk that misstatement, that could occur in an account balance or class of transactions
and that could be material, either individually or when taken together with misstatements in other
balances or classes, will not be prevented/detected/corrected on timely basis by the accounting and
internal control systems.
iii. Detection risk -It is the risk that an auditor’s substantive procedures (the procedures designed to obtain
evidence as to the completeness, accuracy and validity of the data produced by the accounting system)
will not detect a misstatement that exists in account balance or class of transactions that could be material,
either individually or when taken together with misstatements in other balances or classes.
SURPRISE CHECKS
Auditor and his staff have to visit the client’s place for carrying out the audit. Normally, the visit is given to understand
the accounting system, to evaluate the system of internal controls, stock taking etc. It is well accepted that the
audit constitutes a moral check on the employees of the client and thus have a deterrent effect. But at the same
time, if the auditor or his staff visits at regular intervals, the client or his staff may get time to be well prepared in
advance for the audit queries. This may impair the deterrent effect. Thus, there is a need of element of surprise.
An element of surprise can significantly improve the effectiveness of an audit and therefore, wherever practicable,
an element of surprise should be incorporated into the audit programme. The Council of ICAI has made the
following recommendations in this regard:
i. Surprise checks should be considered as a desirable part of each audit.
ii. The areas over which surprise checks should be employed would depend upon the circumstances of each
audit but should normally include:
• Verification of cash and investments.
• Test verification of stores and stocks and the records relating thereto.
• Verification of books of prime entry and statutory registers normally required to be examined for the
purposes of audit.
iii. The frequency of surprise checks may be determined by the auditor in the circumstances of each audit but
should normally be at least once in the course of an audit.
iv. The results of the surprise checks should be communicated to the management if they reveal weakness
in the internal control system or the existence of fraud or error.
v. The auditor should satisfy himself that adequate action is taken by the management on the matters
communicated by him.
vi. The results of surprise checks should be included in the audit report if they are material and affect the true
and fair view of the accounts on which the reporting is done.
While auditing, the auditor come across various assertions of the management. The auditor has to evaluate
these assertions so that he would be able to express his opinion on the financial statements. This evaluation
can be made in the light of some facts and reasons. These facts and reasons are called Audit Evidence’. The
auditor should evaluate whether he has obtained sufficient appropriate audit evidence so that reasonable
conclusions can be drawn there from. It is to be noted that sufficiency an appropriateness are interrelated and
apply to evidence obtained from both substantive and compliance procedures. Sufficiency refers to the quantum of
audit evidence obtained and appropriateness relates to its relevance and reliability. The following factors influence
auditor’s judgement while obtaining audit evidence:
(a) the nature of the item;
(b) the adequacy of internal controls;
(c) the nature and size of the business carried on by the entity;
(d) Situations which may exert an unusual influence on the management;
(e) The financial position of the entity;
(f) The materiality of the item;
(g) The experience gained during the previous audits;
(h) The results of auditing procedures, including fraud or error which may have been found;
(i) The type of information available;
(j) The trend indicated by accounting ratios and analysis.
Need for Audit Evidence
Audit evidence provides the auditor a reasonable assurance in respect of the assertions made by the management.
While obtaining evidence through substantive procedures, the different assertions made by the management can
be as follows:
(a) Existence – that an asset or a liability exists at a given date;
(b) Rights and Obligations - that an asset is a right of the entity and a liability is an obligation of the entity at a
given date;
(c) Occurrence -that a transaction or event took place which pertains to the entity during the relevant period;
(d) Valuation - that an asset or liability is recorded at an appropriate carrying value;
(e) Measurement -that a transaction is recorded in the proper amount and revenue or expense is allocated
to the proper period;
(f) Presentation and Disclosure - an item is disclosed, classified and described in accordance with recognized
accounting policies and practices and relevant statutory requirements, if any.
While obtaining evidence through compliance procedures, the different assertions made by the
management can be as follows:
(i) Existence -that the internal controls exist;
(ii) Effectiveness - that the internal controls are operating effectively;
(iii) Continuity - that the internal controls have been so operated throughout the period of intended
reliance.
Reliability of Audit Evidence
The reliability of audit evidence depends on its source - internal or external and on its nature - visual, documentary
or oral. While the reliability of audit evidence is dependent on the circumstances under which it is obtained, the
following generalizations may be useful in assessing the reliability of audit evidence:
(a) External evidence (e.g. confirmation received from a third party) is generally more reliable than internal
evidence;
(b) Internal evidence is more reliable when related internal control is satisfactory;
(c) Evidence in the form of documents and written representation is usually more reliable than oral
representations;
(d) Evidence obtained by the auditor himself is more reliable than that obtained through the entity.
Methods to Obtain Audit Evidence
Auditor obtains evidence in performing compliance and substantive procedures by any one or more of the
following methods –
(a) Inspection - It consists of examining records, documents, or tangible assets. Inspection of records and
documents provides evidence of varying degrees of reliability depending on their nature, source and the
effectiveness of internal controls over their processing.
(b) Observation - It consists of witnessing a process or procedure being performed by others.
(c) Inquiry and Confirmation - Inquiry consists of seeking appropriate information from a knowledgeable person
inside or outside the entity, Confirmation consists of the response to an inquiry to corroborate information
contained in the accounting records.
(d) Computation - It consists of checking the arithmetical accuracy of source documents and accounting
records or performing independent calculations.
(e) Analytical Review - It consists of studying significant ratios and trends and investigating unusual fluctuations
and items.
Compliance procedures or Tests of controls
Tests of control are those activities performed by the auditor during the control testing stage that gather evidence
as to the operational effectiveness of internal control procedures upon which the auditor has planned reliance.
Management impliedly asserts that internal control procedures are effective as to both their design and
operation. If controls are effective, then the auditor can plan reliance on the controls and reduce the time spent
in gathering audit evidence. This is because the objective of an audit is similar in many respects to the objectives
of internal control procedures. One of the primary objectives of a financial statement audit is to gather evidence
as to whether account balances and classes of transaction are materially complete, valid and accurate. This is
very similar to the primary objective of internal control procedures - to provide management with assurance that
account balances and classes of transaction are complete, valid and accurate. Thus, if controls are effective, the
auditor can plan reliance on the controls and reduce the amount of evidence that he would otherwise gather as
to the completeness, validity and accuracy of account balances and classes of transaction.
In the audit planning stage, the auditor gathers evidence as to the effectiveness of design of control procedures
and decides which control procedure, if any, upon which he will plan reliance. In the control testing stage, the
auditor gathers evidence as to the effectiveness of operation of those controls upon which the auditor has planned
reliance. The activities that the auditor employs to gather this evidence are referred to collectively as tests of control
(sometimes referred to as compliance tests or compliance procedures.
Tests of control include observation of an internal control procedure being performed, inspection of evidence
that the control procedure was performed (and performed at the appropriate time), and inquiry about how
and when the procedure was performed. Where the information system is computerized, evidence may also
be gathered using CAATs (Computer Assisted Audit Technique) such as a generalized audit software or an
embedded audit module.
Substantive procedures
Substantive procedures (or substantive tests) are those activities which are performed by the auditor during the
substantive testing stage of the audit that gather evidence as to the completeness, validity and/ or accuracy of
account balances and underlying classes of transactions.
Management impliedly asserts that account balances and underlying classes of transaction do not contain any
material misstatements. In other words, that they are materially complete, valid and accurate. Auditors gather
evidence about these assertions by undertaking activities referred to as substantive procedures.
For example, an auditor may:
(i) physically examine inventory on balance date as evidence that inventory shown in the accounting records
actually exists (validity assertion);
(ii) arrange for suppliers to confirm in writing the details of the amount owing at balance date as evidence
that accounts payable is complete (completeness assertion); and
(iii) make inquires of management about the collectibility of customers’ accounts as evidence that trade
debtors is accurate as to its valuation (accuracy assertion).
Evidence that an account balance or class of transaction is not complete, valid or accurate is evidence of a
substantive misstatement.
There are two categories of substantive procedures - analytical procedures and tests of detail. Analytical procedures
generally provide less reliable evidence than the tests of detail. It may be noted that analytical procedures are
applied in several different audit stages, whereas tests of detail are only applied in the substantive testing stage.
(b) The Report should include a Statement that the Financial Statements are the responsibility of the
entity’s management and a Statement that the responsibility of the Auditor is to express an opinion on
the Financial Statements based on the audit.
iv. Scope Paragraph:
(a) The Auditor’s Report should describe the scope of the audit by stating that the audit was conducted in
accordance with auditing Standards generally accepted in India.
(b) The Report should include a statement that the audit was planned and performed to obtain
reasonable assurance whether the Financial Statements are free of material misstatement.
(c) The Auditor’s Report should describe the Audit as including examining, on a test basis, evidence to
support the amounts and disclosures in Financial Statements, assessing the accounting principles
used in the preparation of the Financial Statements, assessing significant estimates made by
management, in the preparation of Financial Statements, & evaluating the overall position of
Financial Statements.
(d) The Report should include a statement by the Auditor that the audit provides a reasonable basis for his
opinion.
v. Opinion Paragraph: The Opinion paragraph of the Report should indicate the Financial Reporting framework
used to prepare the Financial Statements. It should state the Auditor’s opinion as to whether the Financial
Statements give a true and fair view in accordance with the financial reporting framework and, where
appropriate, whether the Financial Statements comply with the statutory requirements.
vi. Date of the Report: The date of an Auditor’s Report is the date on which the Auditor signs the Report expressing
an opinion on the Financial Statements. The Auditor should not date the Report earlier than the date on
which the Financial Statements are signed or approved by Management.
vii. Place of Signature: The Report should name the specific location, which is ordinarily the city where the Audit
Report is signed.
viii. Auditor’s Signature: The Report should be signed by the Auditor in his personal name. Where a Firm is appointed
as the Auditor, the Report should be signed in the personal name of the Auditor and in the name of the Audit
Firm. The Partner / Proprietor signing the Report should mention his ICAI Membership Number.
Note: Where the governing statute requires the Auditor to include certain matters in his Report or prescribe the form
in which the Auditor should issue his Report, such additional matters should be included in addition to the
requirements of SA 700.
A. Significance of Opening Paragraph:
(a) The Opening or Introductory Paragraph identifies the Financial Statements of the entity that have
been audited, including the date of and period covered by the Financial Statements.
(b) The ‘Opening Paragraph’ seeks to bring to the notice of the Users of Financial Statements, that
preparation of the accounts is the responsibility of the Management of the enterprise, whereas the
responsibility of the Auditor is to express an opinion on the said accounts based on the audit carried
out by him.
(c) Through the Opening Paragraph, the Auditor communicates the basic message that the preparation
of Financial Statements requires Management to make significant accounting estimates and
judgements, as well as to determine the appropriate accounting principles and methods used in
preparation of the said Financial Statements.
B. Significance of Scope Paragraph:
(a) The ‘Scope Paragraph’ seeks to inform the Users about the practices and procedures followed in the
conduct of audit by the Auditor.
(b) In the Scope Paragraph, the Auditor states that the audit was planned and performed in accordance with
Auditing Standards generally accepted in India, and also that the audit provides a reasonable basis for
his opinion.
(c) The significance of the Scope Paragraph lies in the fact that the Auditor intends to convey to the
readers of his report, about the scope of audit by highlighting the nature and progress of audit. The
test check approach of audit adopted by the Auditor in performing his audit work as also the significant
aspect of evaluation of accounting principles and accounting estimates is also clarified.
(d) The basic objective of auditing that the Auditor provides only “reasonable assurance” is emphasized in
the Scope Paragraph. Thus, this paragraph signifies the inherent limitations of audit.
Column A Column B
1 SA 210 A Audit Note Book
2 SA 230 B Audit Sampling
3 Detailed of audit work to be performed C Opinion on Financial Statement
4 Copies of Management letters D Audit Working Papers
5 Analysis of significant ratios & trends E Audit Planning
6 SA 530 F Current Audit File
7 Detail about the name and organisation structure. G Permanent Audit File
8 Property of Auditor H Audit Programme
9 SA 300 I Agreeing the terms of Audit Engagements
10 Objective of an audit J Audit Documentation
[Answer: I, J, H, F, G, B, A, D, E, C]
The accounting of transactions has a number of steps such as posting to the concerned books of accounts,
recording receipts and payments of cash etc. These processes involve a various number of staffs. Thus in an
internal check system, practically a continuous internal audit is carried on by the staff itself. The work of one
individual is checked by the other in the staff. Internal check is a valuable part of the internal control. According
to Spicer and Pegler, internal check is an arrangement of staff duties where none is allowed to carry through
and record every aspect of a transaction so that, without collusion between any two or more persons, fraud is
prevented and at the same time the possibilities of errors and frauds are reduced to the minimum.
For example, at the time of cashing a cheque at any bank, the cheque is produced at the counter from where
customers get a token. The token number is entered into the token book as well as at the back of the cheque
by the attending clerk. The cheque is then passed on to the ledger clerk who verifies the credit balance in the
customer’s account and makes a debit entry. The cheque is then sent for verifying the signature of the customer
and then it is passed for payment to the customer. The cashier makes the payment to the cashier. The cashier
makes the payment against the token and records it in the cash register.
Auditor’s Duty In Regard to Internal Check System
In the case of a big concern where there is a good internal check system the auditor may, to a great extent,
presume the accuracy of the accounting. But he must not be negligent. He should apply a few test checks, i.e. he
should check a few transactions here and there at random or check fully the accounts for a few months, and carry
out a thorough check of the whole of a certain class of transactions taking place during that particular period,
e.g. cash sales, or cash received or credit purchases during that period. In selecting certain transactions are
representative and true specimens the auditor should see that such sample transactions are representative and true
specimens of such entries throughout the year.
If he finds that there is no mistake and there is nothing to arouse his suspicion, he may presume that the accounts
are correct. It must be remembered that in such a case, the auditor is not relieved of his responsibility. Therefore, it
would be better for him to probe the matter thoroughly if there is the slightest suspicion. If later on, it is found that
a fraud had been committed which the auditor failed to detect as he had not checked all the transactions, he
would be held liable. The existence of a good internal check system reduces to a great extent the work of the
auditor but does not reduce his liability. To what extent an auditor should depend upon the internal check system
will depend upon his tact, skill, experience and judgment.
The internal check is said to have the following fundamental aims:
i. To pin down to definite persons responsibility for particular acts, default or omission, by the segregation
of tasks.
ii. To obtain confirmation of facts and entries, physical and financial, by the creation and preservation of
necessary records.
iii. To facilitate the “breakdown” of routine procedures so as to avoid bottlenecks and to establish an even flow
of work.
iv. To reduce to a minimum the possibility of fraud and error.
Check list is usually a questionnaire set, designed to draw attention to important aspects of the system of internal
check. The question should be phased in such a way that an affirmative answer would normally reveal a
satisfactory position. If the answer is negative, enquiry should be made to see if there is a satisfactory substitute for
the procedure referred to in the questionnaire. A negative answer always merits further examination. All the items
on the questionnaire cannot be of the same importance and an unhealthy position might be revealed either by a
single negative answer or by a number of such answers.
No questionnaire for the appraisal of a system of internal check can ever be considered to be complete. Although
every effort should be made to make such a questionnaire as comprehensive as possible, it is primarily stimulation
to thinking along recognized channels.
12. Is the opening of bank accounts authorized by the Board of Directors (BOD)?
13. Are sundry items, such as, dividends, interest, rent, commissions etc. regularly checked by responsible
official to satisfy that correct amount are received?
14. Is there a procedure to ensure that Hundi borrowing as only by cheques crossed “Account Payee”?
15. Is the cash balance verified frequently (incoming money orders. VPP receipts etc.).
16. Are they listed immediately?
17. Are such lists compared with the Cash Book regularly?
18. Is there an arrangement with the postal authorities to receive cheques instead of cash?
19. Are the cashier’s duties taken over for a few days, by someone else, occasionally?
20. If rough cash book is maintained:
(a) Is a fair cash book written up promptly?
(b) Is the fair cash book checked with the rough cash book, by a person other than the cashier?
The internal control system comprises all the methods and procedures adopted to assist in achieving the objective of
efficient conduct of business, ensure adherence to management policies, safeguarding of assets, prevention and
detection of frauds and errors, and checking the accuracy and completeness of the accounting records. Internal
checks and internal audit are integral parts of the overall internal control system.
Internal control refers to a process that is designed for helping the organization to accomplish goals and objectives
through people of the organization and IT (information Technology) systems, whereas internal check is a part
of internal control. It refers to the accounting procedure that acts as a safeguard against frauds and losses.
On the other hand, internal Auditing is an activity that devises ways for organizations for better achievement of
objectives.
Essentials of an Internal Control System
An efficient internal control system should provide the followings;
i. For proper division of functional responsibilities.
ii. For proper authorization and assignment of duties to perform and record the transactions.
iii. For adoption of proper practices for adherence with management policies.
iv. For proper review and authorization of all transactions before they are recorded in the books of accounts
and safeguard all business assets.
v. Proper internal checks
vi. Proper internal audit system.
Objectives of Internal Control
Each organization must have a system of internal control in place for achieving the preset goals. Other than
accomplishing the desired goals and objectives of the organization, this system plays a very important role in
any organization. The main objectives of internal control are enumerated below:
i) Compliance: To have compliance with law and the accounting practices generally accepted and
followed in the country. The accounting process also needs to be in compliance with these.
ii) Reliance: To increase the reliance on the internal systems, people and accounting practices followed by
the organization, so that the chances of frauds are reduced.
iii) Safeguarding: To safeguard the organization’s accounts, employees and assets by formation of fool-proof
policies, rules and regulations.
iv) Security: To provide security to customers, employees and property of the organization. Physical security
systems like security guards, locks and anti-theft devices are used for providing protection.
v) Increased efficiency: To assist in human resource and performance management, and to keep proper
control over business activities to achieve maximum levels of efficiency.
vi) Evaluation: To evaluate the accounting system for proper authorization of transactions.
vii) Review and correction: To review the working of the business, locate weak points in operations and to take
corrective measures for proper working.
viii) Authorization: To provide proper authority for purchase, sale, valuation, verification and possession of assets.
ix) Delegation: To provide for division of duties among the employees where all staff members work cohesively.
x) Accurate planning: To ensure that the auditors and the accountants of the organization make all the
financial reports correctly and to ensure that financial planning is done accurately.
xi) Conformity with accounting principles: To conform to the basic accounting concepts, and principles that was
governing an organization.
xii) Resource utilization: To ensure that all the resources: Man, Material, Money and Machines of the organization
are optimally used.
xiii) Safeguarding of resources: To protect the resources of the organization against mismanagement or fraud
and to ensure that the company’s activities are in accordance with laws and regulations.
xiv) Setting future Corporate Goals: An efficient system of internal control helps the organization in goal setting.
However, the organization should have certain policies, rules and regulations in place to achieve the preset
goals.
Advantages of Internal Controls
(i) Efficiency, effectiveness and economy: A good internal control system ensures that the resources are utilized
only for their intended purposes and helps to overcome the risk associated with the misuse of organization’s
funds and other resources.
(ii) Prevention of errors and irregularities: It prevents errors and irregularities by detecting them in a timely
manner, thereby promoting reliable and accurate accounting records.
(iii) Safeguard from irregularities or misappropriations: A good internal control system errors the protection of
organisation resources from misappropriation and do safeguard from any irregularities.
(iv) Employees’ satisfaction: It protects the interests of employees by segregation of duties and delegation of
responsibilities.
Types of Internal Control Systems
The type of internal control system to be employed in an organization depends upon the requirements and nature
of the business. Generally, there are two types of Internal Control in an Organisation: preventive and detective
controls. Both types of controls are essential to an effective internal control system. From a quality standpoint,
preventive controls are essential because they are proactive and emphasize quality. However, detective controls
play a critical role by providing evidence that the preventive controls are functioning as intended.
i) Preventive Controls are designed to discourage errors or irregularities from occurring. They are proactive
controls that help to ensure departmental objectives are being met. Examples of preventive controls are:
• Segregation of Duties: Duties are segregated among different people to reduce the risk of error
or inappropriate action. Normally, responsibilities for authorizing transactions (approval), recording
transactions (accounting) and handling the related asset (custody) are divided.
• Approvals, Authorizations, and Verifications: Management authorizes employees to perform certain
activities and to execute certain transactions within limited parameters. In addition, management
specifies those activities or transactions that need supervisory approval before they are performed
or executed by employees. A supervisor’s approval (manual or electronic) implies that he or she has
verified and validated that the activity or transaction conforms to established policies and procedures.
• Security of Assets (Preventive and Detective): Access to equipment, inventories, securities, cash and
other assets is restricted; assets are periodically counted and compared to amounts shown on control
records.
ii) Detective Controls are designed to find errors or irregularities after they have occurred. Examples of detective
controls are:
• Reviews of Performance: Management compares information about current performance to budgets,
forecasts, prior periods, or other benchmarks to measure the extent to which goals and objectives are
being achieved and to identify unexpected results or unusual conditions that require follow-up.
Reconciliations: An employee relates different sets of data to one another, identifies and investigates
differences, and takes corrective action, when necessary.
• Physical Inventories
• Audits
iii) Corrective Controls target at the correction of errors and irregularities as soon as they are detected.
Steps in Internal Control
An effective internal control system consists of certain important steps:
(i) Control Environment: Establish Integrity & ethical value.
(ii) Assessment of Risk: Establishment of plan to prevent risks.
(iii) Control Activities: Formulating policies & procedures.
(iv) Information & communication: Evaluation of employee performance.
(v) Monitoring: Assessing overall performance of the Organisation.
Control Environment
Assessment of Risk
Control Activities
Monitoring
‘Control procedures’ are the policies and procedures that the management has established to achieve the entity’s
specific objectives, e.g. physical verification of assets, periodical review and reconciliation of accounts, specific
controls on computer generated data.
The scope of internal control, as per the above definition, extends beyond mere accounting controls. Thus
operational controls such as quality control, work standards, budgetary control, periodic reporting, policy appraisals,
quantitative controls, etc. are all parts of the internal control system.
Basic Elements of Internal Control
An effective system of internal control should have the following basic elements:
Financial and other organization plans
Competent Personnel
Division of Work
Separation of Operational responsibility from record keeping
Separation of the custody of assets from accounting
Authorization
Managerial supervision and review
1. Financial and other Organizational Plans: This may take the form of manual suitably classified by flow charts.
It should specify the various duties and responsibilities of both management and staff, stating the powers of
authorisation that reside with various members. This is important as in the event of staff absence or otherwise
the correct flow of work and the internal control system could be vitiated by any wrong implementation of
procedures by staff either unintentionally or willfully.
2. Competent Personnel: In any internal control system, personnel are the most important element.
When the employees are competent and efficient in their assigned work, the internal control system can be
worked and operated efficiently and effectively even if some of the other elements of the internal control
system are absent.
3. Division of Work: This refers to the procedure of division of work properly among the employees of the
organization. Each and every work of the organization. Each and every work of the organization should be
divided in different stages and should be allocated to the employees in accordance with quality and skill.
4. Separation of operational responsibility from record keeping: If each department of an organization is being
assigned to prepare its own records and reports, there may be a tendency to manipulate results for showing
better performance. So in order to ensure reliable records and information, record- keeping function is
separated from the operational responsibility of the concerned department.
5. Separation of the custody of assets from accounting: To protect against misuse of assets and their
misappropriation, it is required that the custody of assets and their accounting should be done by separate
persons. When a particular person performs both the functions, there is a chance of utilizing the organisation’s
assets for his personal interest and adjusting the records to relieve himself from the responsibility of the assets.
6. Authorization: In a internal control system, all the activities must be authorized by a proper authority.
The individual or group which can grant either specific or general authority for transaction s should hold a
position commensurate with the nature and significance of the transactions and the policy for such authority
should be established by the top management.
7. Managerial supervision and review: The internal control system should be implemented and maintained
in conformity with the environmental and elemental changes of the concern. By adapting any specific
control system permanently, the extent to which the procedures of flexible controls have been followed in
real practice should be observed and re-examined.
Important of Internal Controls: The various benefits accrue out of the Internal control system are enumerated
below;
i) Attainment of goal & Objectives: - A sound internal control helps the entity towards the attainment of goal
& objective of the business.
ii) Reliable financial Information: A sound internal control helps the organization to set reliable financial
information for managerial decision making.
iii) Compliance with law & Regulations: Sound Internal control system ensures various compliance with laws &
regulation prevailing in the country
iv) Efficient & Effective operation: - A sound internal control system ensures efficient and effective operations
that accomplish the goals of the organizations and protect employees and assets of the business.
v) Prevention of fraud & errors: - A sound internal control system prevents and detects frauds and errors and
ensures timely preparations of financial statements and various reports for decision making.
Limitations of Internal Control
i. Organizational Structure: Deficiencies in organizational structure make internal control ineffective.
ii. Size of the Organization: Small organizations have very low levels of internal control, which are almost
negligible due to more interference by owners and management.
iii. Unusual Transactions: The internal control procedures normally fail to keep a check on unusual transactions.
iv. Costly: The implementation of internal control procedures and processes involves incurring costs in terms of
time, effort and resources.
v. Abuse of Power: Members at the top-level management may override/interfere with control.
vi. Collusion of two or more People: It may lead to internal controls being over- ridden.
vii. Obsolescence: Control system may become redundant with passage of time if not updated with change in
the size and nature of business.
viii. Potential for human error: Due to misunderstanding of the concept of internal control human errors may
occur while carrying out Internal Control System.
ix. Frequent follow-up measures: Follow-up procedures need to be frequent to ensure its effectiveness, which is
extremely time-consuming.
Responsibilities of Management Vis-A-Vis Auditors
(a) Primary Responsibility of Management: The prime responsibility for maintaining an adequate accounting
system and incorporating various internal controls rests with the management. The responsibility of closely
monitoring the system to ensure that it is in place, so as to facilitate the basic objectives of installing it, also rests
with the management.
(b) Auditor’s Responsibility: To safeguard his own interests, the auditor might resort to examination and evaluation
of the internal controls that exist in the organization. He formulates an audit programme only after satisfying
himself that such internal control systems are adequate and in consonance with the requirements of the
business. The auditor should bring the weaknesses of the internal control system, if any, to the management’s
notice through a “letter of weakness” or “management letter”.
Evaluation of Internal Control By The Auditor
A. Understanding the System
This can be done in the following ways:
i. Discussions with personnel at various levels of the organization.
ii. Reference to organization charts, procedure manuals, information flow channels, etc.
iii. Inquiries using a brief, but complete questionnaire
Techniques
i. Narrative Record: It is a complete and exhaustive description of the system. It is appropriate in circumstances
where a formal control system is lacking, like in the case of small businesses. Gaps in the control system are
difficult to identify using a narrative record.
ii. Check List: It is a series of instructions that a member of the audit staff is required to follow. They have to be
signed/ initialed by the audit assistant as proof for having followed the instructions given. A specific statement
is required for every weakness area.
iii. Flow Chart: It is a pictorial representation of the internal control system depicting its various elements such
as operations, processes and controls, which help in giving a concise and comprehensive view of the
organization’s working to the auditor. A complete flow chart would depict the process of raising documents,
personnel involved in doing so, the flow of documents through various departments, maintenance of
records, flow of goods and consideration, and dealing with results.
The internal control evaluation process becomes easier through a flow chart as a broad picture of all the
controls involved can be gauged in a glimpse.
iv. Internal Control Questionnaire: This is the most widely used method for collecting information regarding the
internal control system and involves asking questions to various people at different levels in the organization.
The questionnaire is in a pre-designed format to ensure collection of complete and all relevant information.
The questions are formed in a manner that would facilitate obtaining full information through answers in
“Yes” or “No’’.
Internal audit is an independent appraisal activity within the organization by the staff of the entity or by an
independent professional appointed for that purpose, for review of accounting, financial and other operations
and controls established within an organization as a service to the organization. The objective of internal audit is to
furnish the analysis, appraisals, suggestions and information concerning the activities reviewed to the management
for promoting effective control at reasonable cost.
According to the Institute of Internal Auditors New York, “Internal audit is an independent appraisal activity
within the organization for the review of financial, accounting and other operations done as a basis of service
to the management. It is a managerial control which functions by measuring and evaluating the effectiveness
of other controls”.
According to Prof. Walter B. Meigs, “Internal auditing consists of a continuous, critical review of financial and
operating activities by a staff of auditors functioning as full time salaried employees.”
Internal Audit under section 138 of Companies Act, 2013:
Internal Audit is required by –
(1) Such class or classes of companies as may be prescribed shall be required to appoint an internal auditor, who shall
either be a chartered accountant or a cost accountant, or such other professional as may be decided by the
Board to conduct internal audit of the functions and activities of the company.
(2) The Central Government may, by rules, prescribe the manner and the intervals in which the internal audit shall
be conducted and reported to the Board.
According to the Institute of Internal Auditors, internal audit involves five areas of operations:
i. Reliability and integrity of financial and operating information: Internal auditors should review the reliability
and integrity of financial and operating information and the means used to identify, measures, classify
and report such information.
ii. Compliance with laws, policies, plans, procedures and regulations: Internal auditor should review the systems
established to ensure compliance with those policies, plan and procedures, law and regulations which
could have a significant impact on operations and reports and should determine whether the organization is
in compliance thereof.
iii. Safeguarding of Assets: Internal auditors should verify the existence of assets and should review the means of
safeguarding assets.
iv. Economic and efficient use of resources: Internal auditor should ensure the economic and efficient use of
resources available.
v. Accomplishing of established objectives and goals for operations: Internal auditor should review operation
or programmes to ascertain whether results are consistent with established objectives and goals and
whether the operations or programmes are being carried out as planned.
Features of Internal Audit
i. It is an independent appraisal activity within the organization.
ii. It can be conducted by the staff of the entity or by an independent professional appointed for that
purpose.
iii. It is conducted for review of accounting, financial and other operations and controls established within an
organization.
iv. It is conducted as a service to the organization and is not a part of the organization.
v. It intends to furnish the analysis, appraisals, suggestions and information concerning the activities reviewed
to the management.
vi. Internal auditing functions as a continuous effort for promoting effective control at reasonable cost.
Functions of Internal Audit
Very large organizations and some small and medium size organizations also have found the need for internal
audit in addition to the external audit. Internal auditors are employees of the organization and work exclusively for
the organization. Their functions partly overlap those of the external auditors and in part are quite different.
The functions of internal auditors can be described as follows:
1. An appraisal function: The internal auditor’s job is to appraise the activity of others, not to perform a specific
part of data processing. For example, a person who spends his time checking employee expense claims is
not performing an internal audit function. But an employee who spends some times reviewing the system of
checking employee expense claims may be performing an internal audit function.
2. As a service to the organization: The management requires that the auditor ensures the following:
Voucher- meaning
A voucher is a piece of substantiating evidence, in the form of a written record of expenditure, disbursement,
or completed transaction.
Examples of types of vouchers: Cash Memo, Sale Invoice, Purchase Requisition Slip, Purchase Invoice, Gate
Keeper’s Note, Bank Paying Slip, Bank Statements, Minutes Book, etc.
Types of Vouchers
i. Original and Collateral Vouchers:
Original vouchers are called primary vouchers, and their copies or supporting documents are called collateral
vouchers.
ii. Internal and External Vouchers:
Vouchers may generate inside the company (internal vouchers) or outside the company (external vouchers).
iii. Missing Vouchers:
(a) A missing voucher can be any of the following: missing Cash Memo, missing page in a Cash Collection
Statement, missing inward challan for goods received, missing Inspection Report for material, missing TDS
Certificate for tax deductions at source, missing Resolution to authorize increase in borrowing power by the
company, missing Bank Statement for a day or a month, etc.
(b) A voucher could become missing due to:
i. Wrong or careless filing of document. E.g., missing Bank Statement for a day or a month, missing
TDS Certificate.
ii. Unintentional non-awareness of statutory requirements. E.g., missing Resolution to authorize
increase in borrowing power by the company, or accidental fire, or lost otherwise.
iii. Intention to hide the misappropriation by a person. E.g., non-recording of Purchas Invoices received
later for goods received and taken in stocks, missing Cash Memo, etc.
(c) The auditor should be careful and should carry out cross verification processes from other sources
and documents to be able to form a firm opinion in the case of missing vouchers.
(d) The auditor should qualify his report or give a Disclaimer of Opinion in this case, or may give an adverse
report with reasoning on a particular issue depending upon the materiality of the missing voucher as
necessary evidence on the issue.
VOUCHING
“Vouching is the examination by the auditor of all documentary evidences, which are available to support the
authenticity of the transaction entered in the client’s record.” - Spicer and Pegler.
The act of examining all documentary evidences (vouchers) is referred to as vouching. Its basic objective is to establish
the authenticity of the transactions recorded in the primary books of account.
Vouching is said to be “the essence of auditing” or may be termed as the “backbone of auditing”
TEEMING & LADING/ LAPPING
Teeming & Lading is a commonly followed method of misappropriation of cash by concealing cash shortages and
covering them through recoveries from another customer. It is not uncommon in case of cash collections if the
internal check and internal control on cash transactions are not proper. E.g., a salesman recovers `10,000 from
customer C and misappropriates the same, but to conceal the misappropriation, he declares `10,000 received
later from another customer D as received from C so that the balance of C confirms to the client’s debtor list, and
so on for recovery from E of same amount declared as from D.
Teeming and lading may not amount to fraud, but negligence on the part of the management and weaknesses in
internal checks or controls may lead to substantial amounts being misappropriated by the cashier. This may result
in a huge loss if he is not in a position to clear the debts when caught.
The auditor has to follow the following procedure for timely detection of teeming and lading:
i. Ascertain if the Cash Memos are consecutively numbered, and the dates, name and amount as per the
Daily Summary reconcile with relevant cash receipt records.
ii. Reconcile individual cash amounts as per receipts with records in the Rough Cash Book.
iii. Reconcile the receipts as recorded in the Rough Cash Book, main Cash Book, pre-numbered Cash Memos,
with counterfoils of the pay-in-slips.
iv. Ensure whether cash receipts are deposited in the bank on a timely basis.
v. Examine the Debtors Ledger, especially entries showing part payments, to satisfy that the debtors concerned
have indeed made part payments.
vi. Confirmations may be obtained from the debtors from time to time.
AUDIT OF RECEIPTS
(1) Cash sales
i. Ensure that the entity internal control is in place over receipt from sales. Examine authorisation
level for making cash sales and receiving the amount.
ii. Examine few bills in order to check the accuracy of rate, amount, discount and tax computations.
iii. Examine the cash sales summary book if the volume of cash sales is voluminous .
iv. Cash sales need to be verified with carbon copy of cash memos.
v. Examine with the entry made in cash book with reference to date on memos.
vi. Examine the system followed by the entity to deposit the cash sales in bank account. It needs to be
verified with the bank statement.
vii. Examine the cancelled cash memos with its original copy to prevent misappropriation.
(2) Sale of Assets
i. Ensure that the entity internal control is in place in respect of authorisation for making the sale.
ii. Ensure the means to sale the assets, is it is a direct sale or by means of agent. If it is a direct sale
then check the amount collected with reference of copy of receipt issued and if it is by agent then
examines terms with them.
iii. Ensure the sale value of assets is reasonable.
iv. Check that the amount of sale proceeds is duly accounted for.
v. The profit or loss arising from the sale of assets is duly reflected in the financial statement.
AUDIT OF EXPENDITURE
(1) Transactions with Directors
i. Compliance with Sec 188 of Co. Act, 2013: Check that any contract entered into by the director or his
relatives etc. with the company is in accordance with the provisions of section 188 of the Companies
Act, 2013.
ii. Disclosure of interest by Director: Every director of a company who is directly or indirectly, concerned
or interested in a contract or agreement entered or proposed to be entered into with the company,
must disclose his interest to the company at the Board meeting (Section 184).
iii. Compliance with Sec 197 of Co. Act, 2013: The remuneration paid to the directors of public companies
or the private companies which are the subsidiaries of public companies should be in accordance with
the provisions of section 197 of the Companies Act, 2013.
(2) Payment for Acquisition of Assets
i. Authorization: The payment for acquisition of assets should be made under proper authorization and be
duly supported by receipt for amount paid.
ii. Ownership: Check the title deeds in case of purchase of immovable properties. Also ensure that the
ownership in case of the moveable asset has been registered in the name the purchaser.
iii. Existence: The auditor should also verify the existence, value and the title of the assets acquired.
iv. Compliance with Sec 179 of Co. Act, 2013: In case of a company, ensure that the provisions of section
179 of the Companies Act, 2013 have been complied with.
v. Capitalization of Assets: Check that the cost of the asset purchased has been properly capitalized in
the books of account. Thus, the amounts paid to bring the asset to their present condition or location
and incurred upto the asset being put into use should be capitalized. Further such taxes (e.g.
CENVAT) which are recoverable from the authorities shall not form the part of cost of the asset.
VERIFICATION OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
Only the vouching to ascertain the arithmetical accuracy is not enough, the auditor is supposed to go beyond that
while doing audit. In all types of transactions vouching is must, but in case of capital items the auditor is required
to go beyond that and verify the physical existence and evaluate the assets and liabilities to arrive at true and fair
view of the state of affairs of business. Now a day it is statutory liability of the auditor to verify assets & liabilities and
if he fails he is held liable for negligence. e.g. in London Oil Storage Co. Ltd., Vs. Seear Husluck and Co., (1904),
Acct. L.R. 30-93, it was held that an auditor, who fails to verify the existence of assets as shown in the balance sheet
of the company, is liable. In another case, Arthur E. Green & Company Vs. The Controller, Advances & Discount
Corporation (1920) Act, LR xiii, it was held that an auditor is guilty of negligence, if he fails to detect time barred
debts within the schedule of debts.
Verification, as defined by Spicer and Pegler, is “An enquiry into the Value, Ownership, Title, Existence, possession
and presence of any charge on the assets”, while according to Lan Caster, “The verification of assets is a process
by which the auditor substantiates the accuracy of the right hand side of the balance sheet, and must be
considered as having three distinct objects –
(a) the verification of the existence of assets
(b) the valuation of assets and
(c) the authority of their acquisition.
Meaning – Verification means “Proving the truth”. An auditor has not only to see the arithmetical accuracy
and bonafides of the transactions in the books of accounts by vouching only, but has also to see that the assets
as recorded in the balance sheet actually exist. The fact that there is an entry regarding purchases of an asset
and has been found to be currently recorded, is not a proof that the asset is in the possession of the concern at
the date of balance sheet. It is possible that after the asset had been acquired and the necessary entries made
in the books of accounts, the asset might have been disposed of or pledged or mortgaged and no entry had
been made regarding these facts in the books of accounts before the closing of the financial year. He has also
to see whether a particular asset as appearing in the balance sheet exists or not. Verification of liabilities is also
as important as the verification and assets. If the liabilities are overstated or understated, the balance sheet will not
represent a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Company.
In short, verification is a function of examining assets & liabilities to check (i) Value (ii) Ownership (iii) Title (iv) Existence
(v) Possession and (vi) to see whether the assets are free from any charge or encumbrance etc.
Importance of Verification – Verification is very important function from view point of both, the auditor and the client
as it gives clear idea as to true and fair view of balance sheet. The importance of verification may be described
as under –
(a) True and fair view of Balance Sheet – verification of assets and liabilities enables the auditor to comment
on true and fair state of affairs of the business.
(b) Valuation – verification enables the auditor to determine whether the assets or liabilities are overstated
or understated.
(c) Omissions – verification facilitates the act of confirming the omission of any asset or liability in the balance
sheet.
Scope of Verification – Verification includes confirming of whether the assets were in existence on the date of
balance sheet, whether assets had been acquired for the purpose of business only, whether the assets had been
acquired under a proper authority, whether the right of ownership of the assets vested in the enterprise, whether
the assets were free from any charge and whether, the assets were properly valued and disclosed in the balance
sheet.
Objects of Verification – Verification of assets and liabilities is done with the following objects
i. To know whether the Balance-Sheet exhibits a true and fair view of the State of affairs of the business.
ii. To find out whether the assets were in existence
iii. To find out the ownership and title of the assets
iv. To show correct valuation of assets and liabilities
v. To verify the arithmetical accuracy of the books of accounts
vi. To ensure that the assets have been recorded properly
vii. To detect frauds & errors, if any
viii. To find out whether there is an adequate internal control regarding acquisition, utilization and disposal of
assets.
Advantages of Verification – Careful verification of assets fetches the following advantages to the client –
(a) It avoids manipulation of accounts
(b) It guards against improper use of assets
(c) It ensures Proper recording and valuation of assets.
(d) It exhibits true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Company.
Technique of Verification – Auditor may adopt the following techniques for verification of assets & liabilities.
(i) Inspection – This means physical inspection of the assets like counting cash in hand, measuring inventory,
inspection of securities, share certificate etc.,
(ii) Observation – The auditor may observe or witness the inspection of assets done by others.
(iii) Confirmation – This means obtaining written evidence from outside parties regarding existence of assets like,
confirmation from Debtors and Creditors about the balance outstanding etc.
How to conduct the verification work
i) Examine the documentary evidence and see that the assets are properly recorded in the books of accounts.
ii) Verify the opening balance from the schedule of fixed assets, ledger or register.
iii) Verify acquisition on the basis of orders, invoices, title deeds etc.,
iv) Verify the self constructed assets on the basis of contractors bill, work order etc.,
v) Ensure that the fully written off fixed assets are properly recorded.
vi) See the authority of disposal of fixed assets.
vii) Follow a proper procedure to ascertain the omissions, if any.
viii) Verify ownership of the fixed assets on the basis of title deeds.
ix) Verify existence of assets by physical verification. He should ensure that the physical verification of assets is
carried out by the management.
x) Test check the records of fixed assets with physical verification reports and see that discrepancies, if any, are
properly dealt with.
xi) See whether the assets are charged. He should verify the Loan Agreements, Register of charge, Board
Resolution, Share Holders Resolution etc.,
xii) He should keep in mind the following points while verifying the assets & liabilities –
a. Whether the assets and liabilities are properly traced from ledger to Balance Sheet
b. Whether the assets are acquired for the business and liabilities got created for the purpose of business
and are clearly stated in the Balance Sheet.
c. Whether the assets and liabilities are properly grouped under specified heads in the balance Sheet.
d. Whether the assets & liabilities are in actual existence on Balance Sheet date.
e. Whether along with ownership the possession of assets lies with the client.
f. Whether the assets are properly valued in the Balance Sheet
g. Whether the liabilities stated in the Balance Sheet tallies with the confirmation certificate.
Column A Column B
1 GAR 7 challan A Excise Duty
2 Ind As 37 B Contingent Liability
3 SA 265 C Communication deficiencies in Internal Control to those
charged with Governance and Management.
4 Proving the Truth D Verification
5 Section 138 of the Companies Act E Intangible Assets
[Answer: A, B, C, D, E]
7.1 Auditor’s qualifications, disqualifications, appointment, remuneration, removal, powers and duties
7.2 Cost Audit, Secretarial Audit
7.3 Reporting requirements under Companies Act, Report vs. Certificate, contents of the reports and
qualifications in the report.
7.4 Miscellaneous Audit
(i) Branch Audit, Joint Audit
(ii) Audit of Shares and debentures
(iii) Audit of divisible Profits and dividends
(iv) Statutory Auditors Vs. Internal Auditors
(v) Auditing and Assurance Standards relating to Audit of Inventories and Audit of fixed assets.
(vi) Auditing of different types of undertaking – Education, Hospitals, Co- operative Societies,
Banks, Trusts, Municipalities, Panchayats.
Introduction
The Companies Act 2013 has made the audit of accounts of companies in India compulsory.
Section 139 to 148 provide for the qualifications, disqualifications, appointment, removal, rights, duties &
liabilities of company auditors.
(3) Subject to the provisions of sub-rule (1), where a company is required to constitute the Audit
Committee, the committee shall recommend the name of an individual or a firm as auditor to
the Board for consideration and in other cases, the Board shall consider and recommend an
individual or a firm as auditor to the members in the annual general meeting for appointment.
(4) If the Board agrees with the recommendation of the Audit Committee, it shall further
recommend the appointment of an individual or a firm as auditor to the members in the annual
general meeting.
(5) If the Board disagrees with the recommendation of the Audit Committee, it shall refer back the
recommendation to the committee for reconsideration citing reasons for such disagreement.
(6) If the Audit Committee, after considering the reasons given by the Board, decides not to
reconsider its original recommendation, the Board shall record reasons for its disagreement
with the committee and send its own recommendation for consideration of the members in
the annual general meeting; and if the Board agrees with the recommendations of the Audit
Committee, it shall place the matter for consideration by members in the annual general
meeting.
(7) The auditor appointed in the annual general meeting shall hold office from the conclusion of
that meeting till the conclusion of the sixth annual general meeting, with the meeting wherein
such appointment has been made being counted as the first meeting:
Provided further that before such appointment is made, the written consent of the auditor to
such appointment, and a certificate from him or it that the appointment, if made, shall be in
accordance with the conditions as prescribed in rule 4 of chapter X under the act, shall be
obtained from the auditor.
Provided also that the certificate shall also indicate whether the auditor satisfies the criteria provided
in section 141.
Provided also that the company shall inform the auditor concerned of his or its appointment, and also
file a notice of such appointment with the Registrar within fifteen days of the meeting in which the
auditor is appointed.
(2) No listed company or a company belonging to such class or classes of companies as prescribed in
(a) an individual as auditor for more than one term of five consecutive years; and
(b) an audit firm as auditor for more than two terms of five consecutive years:
For the purposes of sub-section (2) of section 139, the class of companies shall mean the following
classes of companies excluding one person companies and small companies:-
(a) all unlisted public companies having paid up share capital of rupees ten crore or more;
(b) all private limited companies having paid up share capital of rupees 1[fifty] crore or more;
(c) all companies having paid up share capital of below threshold limit mentioned in (a) and (b)
above, but having public borrowings from financial institutions, banks or public deposits of rupees
fifty crores or more.
Provided that—
(i) an individual auditor who has completed his term under clause (a) shall not be eligible for re-
appointment as auditor in the same company for five years from the completion of his term;
(ii) an audit firm which has completed its term under clause (b), shall not be eligible for re-appointment
as auditor in the same company for five years from the completion of such term.
Provided further that as on the date of appointment no audit firm having a common partner or partners
to the other audit firm, whose tenure has expired in a company immediately preceding the financial
year, shall be appointed as auditor of the same company for a period of five years.
Provided also that every company, existing on or before the commencement of this Act which is
required to comply with provisions of this sub-section, shall comply with the requirements of this sub-
section within a period which shall not be later than the date of the first annual general meeting of the
company held, within the period specified under sub-section (1) of section 96, after three years from
the date of commencement of this Act.
Provided also that, nothing contained in this sub-section shall prejudice the right of the company to
remove an auditor or the right of the auditor to resign from such office of the company.
(3) Subject to the provisions of this Act, members of a company may resolve to provide that—
(a) in the audit firm appointed by it, the auditing partner and his team shall be rotated at such
intervals as may be resolved by members; or
(b) the audit shall be conducted by more than one auditor.
(4) The Central Government may, by rules 6 of chapter X, prescribe the manner in which the
companies shall rotate their auditors in pursuance of sub-section (2).
(1) The Audit Committee shall recommend to the Board, the name of an individual auditor or of an
audit firm who may replace the incumbent auditor on expiry of the term of such incumbent.
(2) Where a company is required to constitute an Audit Committee, the Board shall consider the
recommendation of such committee, and in other cases, the Board shall itself consider the matter of
rotation of auditors and make its recommendation for appointment of the next auditor by the members
in annual general meeting.
Explanation. I - For the purposes of these rules the term “same network” includes the firms operating or
functioning, hitherto or in future, under the same brand name, trade name or common control.
Explanation.— For the purposes of this Chapter, the word “firm” shall include a limited liability partnership
incorporated under the Limited Liability Partnership Act, 2008.
(5) Notwithstanding anything contained in sub-section (1), in the case of a Government company or
any other company owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by the Central Government, or by any
State Government or Governments, or partly by the Central Government and partly by one or more
State Governments, the Comptroller and Auditor-General of India shall, in respect of a financial year,
appoint an auditor duly qualified to be appointed as an auditor of companies under this Act, within
a period of one hundred eighty days from the commencement of the financial year, who shall hold
office till the conclusion of the annual general meeting.
(6) Notwithstanding anything contained in sub-section (1), the first auditor of a company, other than a
Government company, shall be appointed by the Board of Directors within thirty days from the date
of registration of the company and in the case of failure of the Board to appoint such auditor, it shall
inform the members of the company, who shall within ninety days at an extraordinary general meeting
appoint such auditor and such auditor shall hold office till the conclusion of the first annual general
meeting.
(7) Notwithstanding anything contained in sub-section (1) or sub-section (5), in the case of a Government
company or any other company owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by the Central Government,
or by any State Government, or Governments, or partly by the Central Government and partly by one
or more State Governments, the first auditor shall be appointed by the Comptroller and Auditor-General
of India within sixty days from the date of registration of the company and in case the Comptroller and
Auditor-General of India does not appoint such auditor within the said period, the Board of Directors
of the company shall appoint such auditor within the next thirty days; and in the case of failure of the
Board to appoint such auditor within the next thirty days, it shall inform the members of the company
who shall appoint such auditor within the sixty days at an extraordinary general meeting, who shall hold
office till the conclusion of the first annual general meeting.
(i) in the case of a company other than a company whose accounts are subject to audit by an auditor
appointed by the Comptroller and Auditor-General of India, be filled by the Board of Directors within
thirty days, but if such casual vacancy is as a result of the resignation of an auditor, such appointment
shall also be approved by the company at a general meeting convened within three months of the
recommendation of the Board and he shall hold the office till the conclusion of the next annual general
meeting;
(ii) in the case of a company whose accounts are subject to audit by an auditor appointed by the
Comptroller and Auditor-General of India, be filled by the Comptroller and Auditor-General of India
within thirty days.
Provided that in case the Comptroller and Auditor-General of India does not fill the vacancy within the
said period, the Board of Directors shall fill the vacancy within next thirty days.
(9) Subject to the provisions of sub-section (1) and the rules made thereunder, a retiring auditor may be
re-appointed at an annual general meeting, if—
(10) Where at any annual general meeting, no auditor is appointed or re-appointed, the existing
auditor shall continue to be the auditor of the company.
(11) Where a company is required to constitute an Audit Committee under section 177, all appointments,
including the filling of a casual vacancy of an auditor under this section shall be made after taking into
account the recommendations of such committee.
Summary at Glance
First Auditor
First auditor of the company, other than a Government company, shall be appointed by the BOD
within 30 days from the date of registration of the company;
If BOD fails to appoint, by the member of the company within 90 days at an extraordinary general
meeting appoint the first auditor;
In case of Government company, first auditor shall be appointed by CAG within 60 days from the date
of registration;
If CAG fails to appoint, by the BOD of the company within next 30 days;
If again BOD fails to appoint the first auditor of the company, by the member of the company within
60 days at an extraordinary general meeting;
Tenure of the first auditor of the company in both the above cases till the conclusion of the first annual
general meeting;
Sub-Sequent Auditor
At the first annual general meeting, appoint an individual or a firm as an auditor who shall hold office
from the conclusion of that meeting till the conclusion of its sixth annual general meeting;
Before such appointment, the written consent of the auditor to such appointment and a certificate
from him shall be in accordance with the condition as may be prescribed;
Within 15 days of the meeting the company shall file a notice of such appointment with the registrar;
No listed company or a company belonging to such class or classes of companies as may be prescribed,
shall appoint or re-appoint—
(a) an individual as auditor for more than one term of five consecutive years; and
(b) an audit firm as auditor for more than two terms of five consecutive years:
Cooling Period
an individual auditor who has completed his term under clause (a) shall not be eligible for re-
appointment as auditor in the same company for five years from the completion of his term;
an audit firm which has completed its term under clause (b), shall not be eligible for re- appointment
as auditor in the same company for five years from the completion of such term.
At the time of rotation of auditors, incoming audit firms/ auditor having common partner/s with the
erstwhile audit firm shall not be eligible for appointment;
Firm shall include a limited liability partnership incorporated under the Limited Liability Partnership Act,
2008;
In the case of Government company, CAG in respect of a financial year, appoint an auditor duly
qualified to be appointed as an auditor of the company within a period of 180 days from the
commencement of the financial year who shall hold the office till the conclusion of the AGM;
Re-appointment
he has not given the company a notice in writing of his unwillingness to be re-appointed; and
a special resolution has not been passed at that meeting appointing some other auditor or providing
expressly that he shall not be re-appointed;
Where at any annual general meeting, no auditor is appointed or re-appointed, the existing auditor
shall continue to be the auditor of the company;
Where provision of section 177 is applied, all appointments, including the filling of a casual vacancy of
an auditor shall be made after taking into account the recommendations of such committee.
Clarification with Regard to Applicability of Provisions of Section 139(5) and 139(7) of the Companies
Act, 2013
It is clarified that the new Act does not alter the position with regard to audit of such deemed
Government companies through C&AG and thus such companies are covered under sub-section (5)
and (7) of section 139 of the Companies Act, 2013.
Clarification has also been sought about the manner in which the information about incorporation of
a company subject to audit by an auditor to be appointed by the C&AG is to be communicated to
the C&AG for the purpose of appointment of first auditors under section 139(7) of the Companies Act
2013. It is hereby clarified that such responsibility rests with both, the Government concerned and the
relevant company. To avoid any confusion it is further clarified that it will primarily be the responsibility
of the company concerned to intimate to the C&AG about its incorporation along with name, location
of registered office, capital structure of such a company immediately on its incorporation. It is also
incumbent on such a company to share such intimation to the relevant Government so that such
Government may also send a suitable request to the C&AG.
The Audit Committee shall recommend to the Board, the name of an individual auditor or of an audit
firm who may replace the incumbent auditor on expiry of the term of such incumbent.
Where a company is required to constitute an Audit Committee, the Board shall consider the
recommendation of such committee, and in other cases, the Board shall itself consider the matter of
rotation of auditors and make its recommendation for appointment of the next auditor by the members
in annual general meeting.
in case of an auditor (whether an individual or audit firm), the period for which the individual or the
firm has held office as auditor prior to the commencement of the Act shall be taken into account for
calculating the period of five consecutive years or ten consecutive years, as the case may be;
the incoming auditor or audit firm shall not be eligible if such auditor or audit firm is associated with the
outgoing auditor or audit firm under the same network of audit firms.
Explanation. I - For the purposes of these rules the term “same network” includes the firms operating or
functioning, hitherto or in future, under the same brand name, trade name or common control.
a break in the term for a continuous period of five years shall be considered as fulfilling the requirement
of rotation;
if a partner, who is in charge of an audit firm and also certifies the financial statements of the company,
retires from the said firm and joins another firm of chartered accountants, such other firm shall also be
ineligible to be appointed for a period of five years.
(1) The auditor appointed under section 139 may be removed from his office before the expiry of his
term only by a special resolution of the company, after obtaining the previous approval of the Central
Government in that behalf in the manner prescribed in rule 7 of chapter X under the act.
(1) The application to the Central Government for removal of auditor shall be made in eForm ADT-2
and shall be accompanied with fees as provided for this purpose under the Companies (Registration
Offices and Fees) Rules, 2014.
(2) The application shall be made to the Central Government within thirty days of the resolution
passed by the Board.
(3) The company shall hold the general meeting within sixty days of receipt of approval of the Central
Government for passing the special resolution.
Provided that before taking any action under this sub-section, the auditor concerned shall be given a
reasonable opportunity of being heard.
(2) The auditor who has resigned from the company shall file within a period of thirty days from the
date of resignation, a statement in the prescribed form with the company and the Registrar, and in
case of companies referred to in sub-section (5) of section 139, the auditor shall also file such statement
with the Comptroller and Auditor-General of India, indicating the reasons and other facts as may be
relevant with regard to his resignation.
(3) If the auditor does not comply with the provision of sub-section (2), he or it shall be liable to a
penalty of fifty thousand rupees or an amount equal to the remuneration of the auditor, whichever is
less, and in case of continuing failure, with further penalty of five hundred rupees for each day after the
first during which such failure continues, subject to a maximum of five lakh rupees.
(4) (i) Special notice shall be required for a resolution at an annual general meeting appointing as
auditor a person other than a retiring auditor, or providing expressly that a retiring auditor shall not be
re-appointed, except where the retiring auditor has completed a consecutive tenure of five years or,
as the case may be, ten years, as provided under sub-section (2) of section 139.
(ii) On receipt of notice of such a resolution, the company shall forthwith send a copy thereof to the
retiring auditor.
(iii) Where notice is given of such a resolution and the retiring auditor makes with respect thereto
representation in writing to the company (not exceeding a reasonable length) and requests its
notification to members of the company, the company shall, unless the representation is received by
it too late for it to do so,—
(a) in any notice of the resolution given to members of the company, state the fact of the representation
having been made; and
(b) send a copy of the representation to every member of the company to whom notice of the
meeting is sent, whether before or after the receipt of the representation by the company, and if a
copy of the representation is not sent as aforesaid because it was received too late or because of the
company’s default, the auditor may (without prejudice to his right to be heard orally) require that the
representation shall be read out at the meeting.
Provided that if a copy of representation is not sent as aforesaid, a copy thereof shall be filed with the
Registrar.
Provided further that if the Tribunal is satisfied on an application either of the company or of any other
aggrieved person that the rights conferred by this sub-section are being abused by the auditor, then,
the copy of the representation may not be sent and the representation need not be read out at the
meeting.
(5) Without prejudice to any action under the provisions of this Act or any other law for the time being
in force, the Tribunal either suo motu or on an application made to it by the Central Government or by
any person concerned, if it is satisfied that the auditor of a company has, whether directly or indirectly,
acted in a fraudulent manner or abetted or colluded in any fraud by, or in relation to, the company or
its directors or officers, it may, by order, direct the company to change its auditors.
Provided that if the application is made by the Central Government and the Tribunal is satisfied that
any change of the auditor is required, it shall within fifteen days of receipt of such application, make
an order that he shall not function as an auditor and the Central Government may appoint another
auditor in his place.
Provided further that an auditor, whether individual or firm, against whom final order has been passed
by the Tribunal under this section shall not be eligible to be appointed as an auditor of any company
for a period of five years from the date of passing of the order and the auditor shall also be liable for
action under section 447.
Explanation I.— It is hereby clarified that the case of a firm, the liability shall be of the firm and that of
every partner or partners who acted in a fraudulent manner or abetted or colluded in any fraud by, or
in relation to, the company or its director or officers.
Explanation II.— For the purposes of this Chapter the word “auditor” includes a firm of auditors.
Summary at Glance
Removal
By a special resolution of the company and after obtaining the previous approval of the central
Government, the auditor appointed under section 139 may be remove from his office before the
expiry of his term;
Resignation
The auditor shall file within 30 days from the date of resignation, a statement in prescribed form with
the company and the registrar;
In case of Government company, the auditor shall send such statement with the CAG, indicating the
reason and other facts with regards to his resignation;
If fails to comply with sub-section (2), punishable with fine not less than ` 50,000 but may extend to
`5,00,000;
Special notice
Special notice for resolution at an annual general meeting for appointment of auditor other than a
retiring auditor;
On receipt of notice of such a resolution, the company shall forthwith send a copy thereof to the
retiring auditor;
Where notice is given of such a resolution and the retiring auditor makes with respect thereto
representation in writing to the company and requests its notification to members of the company, the
company shall, unless the representation is received by it too late for it to do so,—
in any notice of the resolution given to members of the company, state the fact of the representation
having been made; and
send a copy of the representation to every member of the company to whom notice of the meeting
is sent, whether before or after the receipt of the representation by the company,
If a copy of the representation is not sent as aforesaid because it was received too late or because
of the company’s default, the auditor may require that the representation shall be read out at the
meeting.
(1) A person shall be eligible for appointment as an auditor of a company only if he is a chartered
accountant.
Provided that a firm whereof majority of partners practicing in India are qualified for appointment as
aforesaid may be appointed by its firm name to be auditor of a company.
(2) Where a firm including a limited liability partnership is appointed as an auditor of a company, only
the partners who are chartered accountants shall be authorised to act and sign on behalf of the firm.
(3) The following persons shall not be eligible for appointment as an auditor of a company, namely:—
(a) a body corporate other than a limited liability partnership registered under the Limited Liability
Partnership Act, 2008;
(c) a person who is a partner, or who is in the employment, of an officer or employee of the company;
(i) is holding any security of or interest in the company or its subsidiary, or of its holding or associate
company or a subsidiary of such holding company.
Provided that the relative may hold security or interest in the company of face value not exceeding
one thousand rupees or such sum as prescribed in rule 10 of chapter X under the act;
(1) For the purpose of proviso to sub-clause (i) of clause (d) of sub-section (3) of section 141, a relative
of an auditor may hold securities in the company of face value not exceeding rupees one lakh:
Provided that the condition under this sub-rule shall, wherever relevant, be also applicable in the
case of a company not having share capital or other securities:
Provided further that in the event of acquiring any security or interest by a relative, above the
threshold prescribed, the corrective action to maintain the limits as specified above shall be taken
by the auditor within sixty days of such acquisition or interest.
(2) For the purpose of sub-clause (ii) of clause (d) of sub-section (3) of section 141, a person who
or whose relative or partner is indebted to the company or its subsidiary or its holding or associate
company or a subsidiary of such holding company, in excess of rupees five lakh shall not be eligible
for appointment.
(3) For the purpose of sub-clause (iii) of clause (d) of sub-section (3) of section 141, a person who
or whose relative or partner has given a guarantee or provided any security in connection with
the indebtedness of any third person to the company, or its subsidiary, or its holding or associate
company or a subsidiary of such holding company, in excess of one lakh rupees shall not be eligible
for appointment.
(4) For the purpose of clause (e) of sub-section (3) of section 141, the term “business relationship” shall
be construed as any transaction entered into for a commercial purpose, except -
(i) commercial transactions which are in the nature of professional services permitted to be rendered
by an auditor or audit firm under the Act and the Chartered Accountants Act, 1949 and the rules or
the regulations made under those Acts;
(ii) commercial transactions which are in the ordinary course of business of the company at arm’s
length price - like sale of products or services to the auditor, as customer, in the ordinary course of
business, by companies engaged in the business of telecommunications, airlines, hospitals, hotels
and such other similar businesses.
(ii) is indebted to the company, or its subsidiary, or its holding or associate company or a subsidiary of
such holding company, in excess of such amount as prescribed in rule 10 of chapter X under the act; or
(iii)has given a guarantee or provided any security in connection with the indebtedness of any third
person to the company, or its subsidiary, or its holding or associate company or a subsidiary of such
holding company, for such amount as prescribed in rule 10 of chapter X under the act;
(e) a person or a firm who, whether directly or indirectly, has business relationship with the company, or
its subsidiary, or its holding or associate company or subsidiary of such holding company or associate
company of such nature as prescribed in rule 10 of chapter X under the act;
(f) a person whose relative is a director or is in the employment of the company as a director or key
managerial personnel;
(g) a person who is in full time employment elsewhere or a person or a partner of a firm holding
appointment as its auditor, if such persons or partner is at the date of such appointment or reappointment
holding appointment as auditor of more than twenty companies;
(h) a person who has been convicted by a court of an offence involving fraud and a period of ten
years has not elapsed from the date of such conviction;
(i) A person who, directly or indirectly, renders any service referred to in section 144 to the company or
its holding company or its subsidiary company.
Explanation.— For the purposes of this clause, the term “directly or indirectly” shall have the meaning
assigned to it in the Explanation to section 144.
Where a person appointed as an auditor of a company incurs any of the disqualifications mentioned
in sub-section (3) after his appointment, he shall vacate his office as such auditor and such vacation
shall be deemed to be a casual vacancy in the office of the auditor.
(1) The remuneration of the auditor of a company shall be fixed in its general meeting or in such
manner as may be determined therein.
Provided that the Board may fix remuneration of the first auditor appointed by it.
(2) The remuneration under sub-section (1) shall, in addition to the fee payable to an auditor, include
the expenses, if any, incurred by the auditor in connection with the audit of the company and any
facility extended to him but does not include any remuneration paid to him for any other service
rendered by him at the request of the company.
(1) Every auditor of a company shall have a right of access at all times to the books of account and
vouchers of the company, whether kept at the registered office of the company or at any other place
and shall be entitled to require from the officers of the company such information and explanation as
he may consider necessary for the performance of his duties as auditor and amongst other matters
inquire into the following matters, namely:—
(a) whether loans and advances made by the company on the basis of security have been properly
secured and whether the terms on which they have been made are prejudicial to the interests of the
company or its members;
(b) whether transactions of the company which are represented merely by book entries are prejudicial
to the interests of the company;
(c) where the company not being an investment company or a banking company, whether so much
of the assets of the company as consist of shares, debentures and other securities have been sold at a
price less than that at which they were purchased by the company;
(d) whether loans and advances made by the company have been shown as deposits;
(f) where it is stated in the books and documents of the company that any shares have been allotted
for cash, whether cash has actually been received in respect of such allotment, and if no cash has
actually been so received, whether the position as stated in the account books and the balance sheet
is correct, regular and not misleading.
Provided that the auditor of a company which is a holding company shall also have the right of access
to the records of all its subsidiaries and associates companies in so far as it relates to the consolidation
of its financial statements with that of its subsidiaries and associates companies.
(2) The auditor shall make a report to the members of the company on the accounts examined by
him and on every financial statements which are required by or under this Act to be laid before the
company in general meeting and the report shall after taking into account the provisions of this Act, the
accounting and auditing standards and matters which are required to be included in the audit report
under the provisions of this Act or any rules made thereunder or under any order made under sub-
section (11) and to the best of his information and knowledge, the said accounts, financial statements
give a true and fair view of the state of the company’s affairs as at the end of its financial year and
profit or loss and cash flow for the year and such other matters as prescribed in rule 11 of chapter X
under act.
The auditor’s report shall also include their views and comments on the following matters, namely:-
(a) whether the company has disclosed the impact, if any, of pending litigations on its financial position
in its financial statement;
(b) whether the company has made provision, as required under any law or accounting standards, for
material foreseeable losses, if any, on long term contracts including derivative contracts;
(c) whether there has been any delay in transferring amounts, required to be transferred, to the Investor
Education and Protection Fund by the company.
d) whether the company had provided requisite disclosures in its financial statements as to holdings as
well as dealings in Specified Bank Notes during the period from 8th November, 2016 to 30th December,
2016 and if so, whether these are in accordance with the books of accounts maintained by the
company.
(a) whether he has sought and obtained all the information and explanations which to the best of his
knowledge and belief were necessary for the purpose of his audit and if not, the details thereof and
the effect of such information on the financial statements;
(b) whether, in his opinion, proper books of account as required by law have been kept by the company
so far as appears from his examination of those books and proper returns adequate for the purposes
of his audit have been received from branches not visited by him;
(c) whether the report on the accounts of any branch office of the company audited under sub-
section (8) by a person other than the company’s auditor has been sent to him under the proviso to
that sub-section and the manner in which he has dealt with it in preparing his report;
(d) whether the company’s balance sheet and profit and loss account dealt with in the report are in
agreement with the books of account and returns;
(e) whether, in his opinion, the financial statements comply with the accounting standards;
(f) the observations or comments of the auditors on financial transactions or matters which have any
adverse effect on the functioning of the company;
(g) whether any director is disqualified from being appointed as a director under sub-section (2) of
section 164;
(h) any qualification, reservation or adverse remark relating to the maintenance of accounts and other
matters connected therewith;
(i) whether the company has adequate internal financial controls with reference to financial statements
in place and the operating effectiveness of such controls;
(4) Where any of the matters required to be included in the audit report under this section is answered
in the negative or with a qualification, the report shall state the reasons therefor.
(5) In the case of a Government company or any other company owned or controlled, directly or
indirectly, by the Central Government, or by any State Government or Government, or partly by the
Central Government and partly by one or more State Government, the Comptroller and Auditor-
General of India shall appoint the auditor under sub-section (5) or sub-section (7) of section 139 and
direct such auditor the manner in which the accounts of the company are required to be audited
and thereupon the auditor so appointed shall submit a copy of the audit report to the Comptroller
and Auditor-General of India which, among other things, include the directions, if any, issued by the
Comptroller and Auditor-General of India, the action taken thereon and its impact on the accounts
and financial statement of the company.
(6) The Comptroller and Auditor-General of India shall within sixty days from the date of receipt of the
audit report under sub-section (5) have a right to,—
(a) conduct a supplementary audit of the financial statement of the company by such person or
persons as he may authorise in this behalf; and for the purposes of such audit, require information or
additional information to be furnished to any person or persons, so authorised, on such matters, by such
person or persons, and in such form, as the Comptroller and Auditor- General of India may direct; and
Provided that any comments given by the Comptroller and Auditor-General of India upon, or
supplement to, the audit report shall be sent by the company to every person entitled to copies of
audited financial statements under sub section (1) of section 136 and also be placed before the annual
general meeting of the company at the same time and in the same manner as the audit report.
(7) Without prejudice to the provisions of this Chapter, the Comptroller and Auditor- General of India
may, in case of any company covered under sub-section (5) or sub-section (7) of section 139 of
Companies Act, 2013, if he considers necessary, by an order, cause test audit to be conducted of the
accounts of such company and the provisions of section 19A of the Comptroller and Auditor- General’s
(Duties, Powers and Conditions of Service) Act, 1971, shall apply to the report of such test audit.
(8) Where a company has a branch office, the accounts of that office shall be audited either by the
auditor appointed for the company (herein referred to as the company’s auditor) under this Act or by
any other person qualified for appointment as an auditor of the company under this Act and appointed
as such under section 139, or where the branch office is situated in a country outside India, the accounts
of the branch office shall be audited either by the company’s auditor or by an accountant or by any
other person duly qualified to act as an auditor of the accounts of the branch office in accordance
with the laws of that country and the duties and powers of the company’s auditor with reference to
the audit of the branch and the branch auditor, if any, shall be such as prescribed in rule 12 of chapter
X under the act.
Rule 12 : Duties and Powers of the Company’s Auditor with Reference to the Audit of the Branch and
the Branch Auditor
(1) For the purposes of sub-section (8) of section 143, the duties and powers of the company’s auditor
with reference to the audit of the branch and the branch auditor, if any, shall be as contained in sub-
sections (1) to (4) of section 143.
(2) The branch auditor shall submit his report to the company’s auditor.
(3) The provisions of sub-section (12) of section 143 read with rule 12 hereunder regarding reporting of
fraud by the auditor shall also extend to such branch auditor to the extent it relates to the concerned
branch.
Provided that the branch auditor shall prepare a report on the accounts of the branch examined by
him and send it to the auditor of the company who shall deal with it in his report in such manner as he
considers necessary.
(10) The Central Government may prescribe the standards of auditing or any addendum thereto, as
recommended by the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India, constituted under section 3 of the
Chartered Accountants Act, 1949, in consultation with and after examination of the recommendations
made by the National Financial Reporting Authority.
Provided that until any auditing standards are notified, any standard or standards of auditing specified
by the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India shall be deemed to be the auditing standards.
(11) The Central Government may, in consultation with the National Financial Reporting Authority,
by general or special order, direct, in respect of such class or description of companies, as may be
specified in the order, that the auditor’s report shall also include a statement on such matters as may
be specified therein.
Provided that until the National Financial Reporting Authority is constituted under section 132, the
Central Government may hold consultation required under this sub- section with the Committee
chaired by an officer of the rank of Joint Secretary or equivalent in the Ministry of corporate Affairs and
the committee shall have the representatives from the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India and
Industry Chambers and also special invitees from the National Advisory Committee on Accounting
Standards and the office of the Comptroller and Auditor-General.
(12) Notwithstanding anything contained in this section, if an auditor of a company in the course of
the performance of his duties as auditor, has reason to believe that an offence of fraud involving
such amount or amounts as prescribed in rule 13 of chapter X under the act, is being or has been
committed in the company by its officers or employees the auditor shall report the matter to the Central
Government within such time and in such manner as prescribed in rule 13 of chapter X under the act:
Provided that in case of a fraud involving lesser than the specified amount, the auditor shall report the
matter to the audit committee constituted under section 177 or to the Board in other cases within such
time and in such manner as prescribed in rule 13 of chapter X under the act:
Provided further that the companies, whose auditors have reported frauds under this sub-section to the
audit committee or the Board but not reported to the Central Government, shall disclose the details
about such frauds in the Board’s report in such manner as prescribed in rule 13 of chapter X under the
act.
(1) If an auditor of a company, in the course of the performance of his duties as statutory auditor, has
reason to believe that an offence of fraud, which involves or is expected to involve individually an
amount of rupees one crore or above, is being or has been committed against the company by its
officers or employees, the auditor shall report the matter to the Central Government.
(2) The auditor shall report the matter to the Central Government as under:-
(a) the auditor shall report the matter to the Board or the Audit Committee, as the case may
be, immediately but not later than two days of his knowledge of the fraud, seeking their reply or
observations within forty-five days;
(b) on receipt of such reply or observations, the auditor shall forward his report and the reply
or observations of the Board or the Audit Committee along with his comments (on such reply or
observations of the Board or the Audit Committee) to the Central Government within fifteen days from
the date of receipt of such reply or observations;
(c) in case the auditor fails to get any reply or observations from the Board or the Audit Committee
within the stipulated period of forty-five days, he shall forward his report to the Central Government
along with a note containing the details of his report that was earlier forwarded to the Board or the
Audit Committee for which he has not received any reply or observations;
(d) the report shall be sent to the Secretary, Ministry of Corporate Affairs in a sealed cover by
Registered Post with Acknowledgement Due or by Speed Post followed by an e-mail in confirmation of
the same;
(e) the report shall be on the letter-head of the auditor containing postal address, e-mail address
and contact telephone number or mobile number and be signed by the auditor with his seal and shall
indicate his Membership Number; and
(f) The report shall be in the form of a statement as specified in Form ADT-4.
(3) In case of a fraud involving lesser than the amount specified in sub-rule (1), the auditor shall
report the matter to Audit Committee constituted under section 177
or to the Board immediately but not later than two days of his knowledge of the fraud and he shall
report the matter specifying the following:-
(a) Nature of Fraud with description;
(b) Approximate amount involved; and
(c) Parties involved.
(4) The following details of each of the fraud reported to the Audit Committee or the Board under
sub-rule (3) during the year shall be disclosed in the Board’s Report:-
(a) Nature of Fraud with description;
(b) Approximate Amount involved;
(c) Parties involved, if remedial action not taken; and
(d) Remedial actions taken.
(5) The provision of this rule shall also apply, mutatis mutandis, to a Cost Auditor and a Secretarial
Auditor during the performance of his duties under section 148 and section 204 respectively.”]
(13) No duty to which an auditor of a company may be subject to shall be regarded as having been
contravened by reason of his reporting the matter referred to in sub-section (12) if it is done in good
faith.
(14) The provisions of this section shall mutatis mutandis apply to—
(a) the cost accountant in practice conducting cost audit under section 148; or
(b) the company secretary in practice conducting secretarial audit under section 204.
(15) If any auditor, cost accountant or company secretary in practice do not comply with the provisions
of sub-section (12), he shall be punishable with fine which shall not be less than one lakh rupees but
which may extend to twenty-five lakh rupees.
The auditor’s report shall also include their views and comments on the following matters, namely:-
whether the company has disclosed the impact, if any, of pending litigations on its financial position in
its financial statement;
whether the company has made provision, as required under any law or accounting standards, for
material foreseeable losses, if any, on long term contracts including derivative contracts;
whether there has been any delay in transferring amounts, required to be transferred, to the Investor
Education and Protection Fund by the company.
DUTIES AND POWERS OF THE COMPANY’S AUDITOR WITH REFERENCE TO THE AUDIT OF THE BRANCH AND
THE BRANCH AUDITOR
For the purposes of sub-section (8) of section 143, the duties and powers of the company’s auditor
with reference to the audit of the branch and the branch auditor, if any, shall be as contained in sub-
sections (1) to (4) of section 143.
The branch auditor shall submit his report to the company’s auditor.
The provisions of sub-section (12) of section 143 read with rule 12 hereunder regarding reporting of
fraud by the auditor shall also extend to such branch auditor to the extent it relates to the concerned
branch.
(1) For the purpose of sub-section (12) of section 143, in case the auditor has sufficient reason to believe
that an offence involving fraud, is being or has been committed against the company by officers or
employees of the company, he shall report the matter to the Central Government immediately but
not later than sixty days of his knowledge and after following the procedure indicated herein below.
auditor shall forward his report to the Board or the Audit Committee, as the case may be, immediately
after he comes to knowledge of the fraud, seeking their reply or observations within forty-five days;
on receipt of such reply or observations the auditor shall forward his report and the reply or observations
of the Board or the Audit Committee along with his comments (on such reply or observations of the
Board or the Audit Committee) to the Central Government within fifteen days of receipt of such reply
or observations;
in case the auditor fails to get any reply or observations from the Board or the Audit Committee within
the stipulated period of forty-five days, he shall forward his report to the Central Government along
with a note containing the details of his report that was earlier forwarded to the Board or the Audit
Committee for which he failed to receive any reply or observations within the stipulated time.
The report shall be sent to the Secretary, Ministry of Corporate Affairs in a sealed cover by Registered
Post with Acknowledgement Due or by Speed post followed by an e-mail in confirmation of the same.
The report shall be on the letter-head of the auditor containing postal address, e-mail address and
contact number and be signed by the auditor with his seal and shall indicate his Membership Number.
The provision of this rule shall also, mutatis mutandis, to a cost auditor and a secretarial auditor during
the performance of his duties under section 148 and section 204 respectively.
An auditor appointed under this Act shall provide to the company only such other services as are
approved by the Board of Directors or the audit committee, as the case maybe, but which shall not
include any of the following ser-vices (whether such services are rendered directly or indirectly to the
company or its holding company or subsidiary company, namely:—
Provided that an auditor or audit firm who or which has been performing any non-audit services on
or before the commencement of this Act shall comply with the provisions of this section before the
closure of the first financial year after the date of such commencement.
Explanation.—For the purposes of this sub-section, the term “directly or indirectly” shall include rendering
of services by the auditor,—
(i) In case of auditor being an individual, either himself or through his relative or any other person
connected or associated with such individual or through any other entity, whatsoever, in which such
individual has significant influence or control, or whose name or trade mark or brand is used by such
individual;
(ii) In case of auditor being a firm, either itself or through any of its partners or through its parent,
subsidiary or associate entity or through any other entity, whatsoever, in which the firm or any partner
of the firm has significant influence or control, or whose name or trade mark or brand is used by the firm
or any of its partners.
The person appointed as an auditor of the company shall sign the auditor’s report or sign or certify
any other document of the company in accordance with the provisions of sub-section (2) of section
141, and the qualifications, observations or comments on financial transactions or matters, which have
any adverse effect on the functioning of the company mentioned in the auditor’s report shall be
read before the company in general meeting and shall be open to inspection by any member of the
company.
All notices of, and other communications relating to, any general meeting shall be forwarded to the
auditor of the company, and the auditor shall, unless otherwise exempted by the company, attend
either by himself or through his authorised representative, who shall also be qualified to be an auditor,
any general meeting and shall have right to be heard at such meeting on any part of the business
which concerns him as the auditor.
(1) If any of the provisions of sections 139 to 146 (both inclusive) is contravened, the company shall
be punishable with fine which shall not be less than twenty-five thousand rupees but which may
extend to five lakh rupees and every officer of the company who is in default shall be punishable with
imprisonment for a term which may extend to one year or with fine which shall not be less than ten
thousand rupees but which may extend to one lakh rupees, or with both.
(2) If an auditor of a company contravenes any of the provisions of section 139, section 143, section
144 or section 145, the auditor shall be punishable with fine which shall not be less than twenty-five
thousand rupees but which may extend to five lakh rupees or four times the remuneration of the
auditor, whichever is less.
Provided that if an auditor has contravened such provisions knowingly or wilfully with the intention to
deceive the company or its shareholders or creditors or tax authorities, he shall be punishable with
imprisonment for a term which may extend to one year and with fine which shall not be less than fifty
thousand rupees but which may extend to twenty-five lakh rupees or eight times the remuneration of
the auditor, whichever is less.
(3) Where an auditor has been convicted under sub-section (2), he shall be liable to—
(ii) pay for damages to the company, statutory bodies or authorities or to any other persons for loss
arising out of incorrect or misleading statements of particulars made in his audit report.
(4) The Central Government shall, by notification, specify any statutory body or authority or an officer
for ensuring prompt payment of damages to the company or the persons under clause (ii) of sub-
section (3) and such body, authority or officer shall after payment of damages to such company or
persons file a report with the Central Government in respect of making such damages in such manner
as may be specified in the said notification.
(5) Where, in case of audit of a company being conducted by an audit firm, it is proved that the
partner or partners of the audit firm has or have acted in a fraudulent manner or abetted or colluded
in any fraud by, or in relation to or by, the company or its directors or officers, the liability, whether civil
or criminal as provided in this Act or in any other law for the time being in force, for such act shall be of
the partner or partners concerned of the audit firm and of the firm jointly and severally.
Provided that in case of criminal liability of an audit firm, in respect of liability other than fine, the
concerned partner or partners, who acted in a fraudulent manner or abetted or, as the case may be,
colluded in any fraud shall only be liable.
As per the Rule 6 of the Companies (Meetings of the Board and its Power) Rules, 2014 following class of
the companies have been prescribed for this purpose;
• All Public Companies having in aggregate, outstanding Loans, or borrowings and debentures
or deposits exceeding R 50 Crore or more.
An Audit committee shall have minimum 3 Directors majority of them should be Independent Director.
Majority of the member of the Audit Committee able to read & understand the financial statement.
Function of Audit Committee: The various Functions of the Audit Committee is enumerated below;
● Evaluation of the internal financial control and risk management system of the entity.
Powers of the Audit Committee: The powers of the Audit Committee are enumerated below;
● Audit Committee has the power to call for comments of the Auditor about Internal Control
Systems and the scope of the Audit including its observation.
● Before submission of the report to the Board the Audit Committee have the power to review the
Financial Statement.
● Power to discuss any issues with the Statutory & Internal Auditor and the Management of the
Company in relation to matter contained in the Financial Statement.
1. Is an auditor entitled to attend the general meetings? Discuss the rights of an auditor while he is
present in general meeting?
3. State the procedure of for removal of statutory auditor before the expiry of his term.
5. Who are qualified to act as auditor of the company? Discuss the person who is disqualified to
become as an auditor of a company.
6. State the provision relating to audit of branch office of a company in India and Abroad.
8. List down the certain services which are not to be rendered by the Auditor of the Company.
10. Why Central Government permission is required, when the auditor is to be removed before the
expiry of their term?
1. In case of Government Company auditor is appointed by the CAG within 182 Days from the
commencement of Financial Year.
3. The first auditor appointed shall hold office till the conclusion of first AGM.
4. Government Company means a company where 21% of shares are hold by the Central
government or State Government or partly by Central Government or State Government.
6. The auditor shall have access at all times to the books of account and voucher of the company.
8. The auditor report shall be signed only by the person appointed as an auditor of the company.
9. All notices of the general meeting shall be forwarded to the auditor of the company.
[Answer: False, False, True, False, False, True, False, True, True, False]
2. Audit committee formation is mandatory for a public company having ________ paid up share
capital.
3. Cost Audit is mandatory only when specific order is issued by the _______________.
4. Cost Audit report is submitted to the Central Government within ________ days.
5. First auditor is appointed by the BOD of the company within ____ days.
[Answer: 3, 10 Crore or more, Central Government, 30 days, 30 days, Cost Accountants, 1 crore, Heard,
25000, Comptroller and Auditor General of India. ]
Column A Column B
1 Maximum term of Firm as Auditor A 2 Consecutive terms of 5 years
2 Minimum fees for contravention of section B BOD
139
3 Maximum fees for contravention of section C A company which is a subsidiary of
139 Government Company.
4 Independent Directors D Section 145 of the Companies Act 2013
5 First auditor appointment is done by E 1 term of 5 years
6 Auditor Remuneration is to be fixed at F Special Resolution
7 Government Company G ` 25,000
8 Maximum term of Individual Auditor H ` 5,00,000
9 Resolution for removal of auditor before I General Meeting
expiry of term
10 Signing of audit report J Audit Committee
[Answer: E, G, H, J, B, I, C, A, F, D]
(a) 15 days
(b) 30 days
(c) 45 days
(d) 60 days
(a) BOD
(d) CAG
[Answer: B, B, A, D, C]
148. (1) Notwithstanding anything contained in this Chapter, the Central Government may, by order,
in respect of such class of companies engaged in the production of such goods or providing
such services as may be prescribed, direct that particulars relating to the utilisation of material
or labour or to other items of cost as may be prescribed shall also be included in the books of
account kept by that class of companies:
Provided that the Central Government shall, before issuing such order in respect of any class
of companies regulated under a special Act, consult the regulatory body constituted or
established under such special Act.
(2) If the Central Government is of the opinion, that it is necessary to do so, it may, by order, direct
that the audit of cost records of class of companies, which are covered under subsection
(1) and which have a net worth of such amount as may be prescribed or a turnover of such
amount as may be prescribed, shall be conducted in the manner specified in the order.
(3) The audit under sub-section (2) shall be conducted by a Cost Accountant in practice who
shall be appointed by the Board on such remuneration as may be determined by the members
in such manner as may be prescribed:
Provided that no person appointed under section 139 as an auditor of the company shall be
appointed for conducting the audit of cost records:
Provided further that the auditor conducting the cost audit shall comply with the cost auditing
standards.
Explanation.—For the purposes of this sub-section, the expression “cost auditing standards”
mean such standards as are issued by the Institute of Cost Accountants of India, constituted
under the Cost and Works Accountants Act, 1959, with the approval of the Central Government.
(4)An audit conducted under this section shall be in addition to the audit conducted under
section 143.
(5) The qualifications, disqualifications, rights, duties and obligations applicable to auditors under
this Chapter shall, so far as may be applicable, apply to a cost auditor appointed under this
section and it shall be the duty of the company to give all assistance and facilities to the cost
auditor appointed under this section for auditing the cost records of the company:
Provided that the report on the audit of cost records shall be submitted by the cost accountant
in practice to the Board of Directors of the company.
(6)A company shall within thirty days from the date of receipt of a copy of the cost audit report
prepared in pursuance of a direction under sub-section (2) furnish the Central Government with
such report along with full information and explanation on every reservation or qualification
contained therein.
(7) If, after considering the cost audit report referred to under this section and the information
and explanation furnished by the company under sub-section (6), the Central Government
is of the opinion that any further information or explanation is necessary, it may call for such
further information and explanation and the company shall furnish the same within such time
as may be specified by that Government.
(a) The company and every officer of the company who is in default shall be punishable in the
manner as provided in sub-section (1) of section 147;
(b) The cost auditor of the company who is in default shall be punishable in the manner as
provided in sub-sections (2) to (4) of section 147.
PROCEDURE FOR COST AUDIT AND APPOINTMENT OF COST AUDITOR (FOR FINANCIAL YEAR COMMENCING
ON OR AFTER 1st APRIL, 2014 ONWARDS)
Pursuant to Companies Act 2013 and in supersession of Cost Accounting Records Rules 2011 and
Companies (Cost Audit Report) Rules 2011, the Ministry of Corporate Affairs notified Companies
(Cost Records and Audit) Rules 2014 on 30th June 2014 which were amended vide Companies (Cost
Records and Audit) Amendment Rules 2014 on 31st December 2014. The mechanism with respect to
maintenance of cost records, cost audit and appointment of cost auditors has been changed and
shall be in accordance with Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules 2014 as amended.
The applicability of maintenance of Cost Records and Cost Audit shall be for those sectors which are
mentioned in the Tables ‘A’ and ‘B’ to the Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Amendment Rules
2014 dated 31st December 2014 notified by the Government vide GSR 1/2015(E) dated 1st January
2015.
The Rules state that cost records are to be maintained in Form CRA-1, which provides principles to
be followed for different cost elements. The principles are in sync with the cost accounting standards
issued by the Institute of Cost Accountants of India. Since the Rules are principle based, no format has
been prescribed for maintenance of cost accounting records like pre-2011 industry specific rules. It is
opened for industry to maintain cost accounting records according to its size and nature of business
so long as it determines a true and fair view of the cost of production, cost of sales and margin of the
products/services.
The cost audit report is required to be in conformity with the “cost auditing standards” as referred to in
Section 148 of the Companies Act, 2013.
It may be noted that the Council of the Institute of Cost Accountants of India has made it mandatory
for cost ac-countants in practice to follow and conform to the Cost Accounting Standards issued by it
and it is incumbent on the cost auditors to report any deviations from cost accounting standards.
The Rules have classified sectors/industries under Regulated and Non-Regulated sectors. The sectors/
industries covered under Table A of the Rules are under the Regulated Sector and sectors/industries
covered under Table B are under the Non-Regulated Sector.
Every company, including foreign companies defined in clause (42) of section 2 of the Act, engaged
in the production of the goods or providing services, specified in Tables A and B, having an overall
turnover from all its products and services of rupees thirty five crore or more during the immediately
preceding financial year, shall be required to maintain cost accounting records.
However, foreign companies having only liaison office in India and engaged in production, import and
supply or trading of medical devices listed in Sl. 33 of Table B are exempted. Further, companies which
are classified as a micro enterprise or a small enterprise including as per the turnover criteria under sub-
section (9) of section 7 of the Micro, Small and Medium Enterprises Development Act, 2006 (27 of 2006)
are also excluded from the purview of the Rules.
The Rules are effective from April 1, 2014 in respect of certain class of companies and for the others it is
effective from April 1, 2015 as detailed below:
Explanation. - For the purposes of this sub-clause, any company which 8901 to 8908
is engaged in any item or items supplied exclusively for use under this
clause, shall be deemed to be covered under these rules.
Turbo jets and turbo propellers; 8411
Arms and ammunitions; 3601 to 3603; 9301 to
9306
Construction Industry as per para No.(5) (a) as specified in Schedule VI Not applicable
of the Companies Act, 2013 (18 of 2013)
Health services, namely functioning as or running hospitals, Not applicable
diagnostic centres, clinical centres or test laboratories;
Education services, other than such similar services falling under Not applicable
philanthropy or Production, import and supply or trading of following
medical devices, namely:
Cardiac Stents, Drug Eluting Stents, Catheters, Intra Ocular Lenses, 9018 to 9022
Bone Cements, Heart Valves, Orthopedic Implants, Internal Prosthetic
Replacements, Scalp Vein Set, Deep Brain Stimulator, Ventricular
peripheral Shod, Spinal Implants, Automatic Impalpable Cardiac
Deflobillator, Pacemaker (temporary and permanent), patent ducts
arteriosus, atrial septal defect and ventricular sepal defect closure
device, Cardiac Re-synchronize Therapy, Urethra Spinicture Devices,
Sling male or female, Prostate occlusion device, Urethral Stents
Procedure
The cost auditor is to be appointed by the Board of Directors (BOD) on the recommendation of the Audit
Committee, where the company is required to have an Audit Committee. The cost auditor proposed to
be appointed is required to give a letter of consent to the Board of Directors. The company shall inform
the cost auditor concerned of his or its appointment as such and file a notice of such appointment with
the Central Government within a period of thirty days of the Board meeting in which such appointment
is made or within a period of one hundred and eighty days of the commencement of the financial
year, whichever is earlier, through electronic mode, in form CRA-2 along with the fee as specified in
Companies (Registration Offices and Fees) Rules, 2014
Any casual vacancy in the office of a cost auditor, whether due to resignation, death or removal, shall
be filled by the Board of Directors (BOD) within thirty days of occurrence of such vacancy and the
434 THE INSTITUTE OF COST ACCOUNTANTS OF INDIA
Provision Relating to Audit under Companies Act
company shall inform the Central Government in Form CRA-2 within thirty days of such appointment
of cost auditor.
Only a Cost Accountant, as defined under section 2(28) of the Companies Act, 2013, can be appointed
as a cost auditor.
Clause (b) of sub-section (1) of section 2 of the Cost and Works Accountants Act, 1959 defines “Cost
Accountant”. It means a Cost Accountant who holds a valid certificate of practice under sub-section
(1) of section 6 of the Cost and Works Accountants Act, 1959 and is in whole-time practice. Cost
Accountant includes a Firm of Cost Accountants and a LLP of cost accountants.
Eligibility Criteria under Section 141 of the Companies Act, 2013 read with Rule 10 of the Companies
(Audit and Auditors) Rules, 2014 and Section 148 of the Companies Act, 2013. The following persons are
not eligible for appointment as a cost auditor:
A body corporate. However, a Limited Liability partnership registered under the Limited Liability
Partnership Act, 2008 can be appointed. [Section 141(3)(a)].
A person who is a partner, or who is in the employment, of an officer or employee of the company.
[Section 141(3)(c)].
A person who, or his relative or partner is holding any security of or interest in the company or any of
its subsidiary or of its holding or associate company or a subsidiary of such holding company. [Section
141(3) (d)(i)].
Relatives of any partner of the firm holding any security of or interest in the company of face value
exceeding ` 1 lakh. [Section 141(3)(d)(i) and Rule 10(1) of Companies (Audit and Auditors) Rules, 2014].
A person who is indebted to the company or its subsidiary, or its holding or associate company or a
subsidiary or such holding company, for an amount exceeding ` 5 lakhs. [Section 141(3)(d)(ii) and Rule
10(2) of Companies (Audit and Auditors) Rules, 2014].
A person who has given any guarantee or provided any security in connection with the indebtedness
of any third person to the company or its subsidiary, or its holding or associate company or a subsidiary
of such holding company, for an amount exceeding ` 1 lakh. [Section 141(3)(d)(iii) and Rule 10(3) of
Companies (Audit and Auditors) Rules, 2014].
A person or a firm who, whether directly or indirectly, has business relationship with the company or
its subsidiary, or its holding or associate company or subsidiary of such holding company or associate
company. [Section 141(3)(e) and Rule 10(4) of Companies (Audit and Auditors) Rules, 2014].
“Business Relationship” is defined in Rule 10(4) of Companies (Audit and Auditors) Rules, 2014 and
the same shall be construed as any transaction entered into for a commercial purpose, except
commercial transactions which are in the nature of professional services permitted to be rendered by
a cost auditor or a cost audit firm under the Act and commercial transactions which are in the ordinary
course of business of the company at arm’s length price - like sale of products or services to the cost
auditor, as customer, in the ordinary course of business, by companies engaged in the business of
telecommunications, airlines, hospitals, hotels and such other similar businesses.
A person whose relative is a director or is in the employment of the company as a director or key
managerial personnel of the company. [Section 141(3)(f)].
A person who is in the full time employment elsewhere or a person or a partner of a firm holding
appointment as its auditor if such person or persons is at the date of such appointment or reappointment
holding appointment as auditor of more than twenty companies. [Section 141(3)(g)].
A person who has been convicted by a court for an offence involving fraud and a period of ten years
has not elapsed from the date of such conviction. [Section 141(3)(h)].
Any person whose subsidiary or associate company or any other form of entity, is engaged as on date
of appointment in consulting and providing specialised services to the company and its subsidiary
companies: [Section 141(3)(i) and Section 144].
The provisions for maintenance of cost accounting records and cost audit are governed by Section
148 of the Companies Act, 2013. The provisions of Section 148 clearly states that no person appointed
under Section 139 as an auditor of the company shall be appointed for conducting audit of cost
records of the company. Section 148 also provides that qualifications, disqualifications, rights, duties
and obligations applicable to auditors (financial) shall apply to a cost auditor appointed under this
section. The eligibility, qualifications and disqualifications are provided in Section 141 of the Act and
powers and duties are provided in Section 143. Section 143(14) specifically states that the provisions of
Section 143 shall mutatis mutandis apply to a cost auditor appointed under Section 148. There are no
other provisions governing the appointment of a cost auditor.
Section 139(3) of the Act, applicable to appointment of auditors (financial), and Rule 6 of Companies
(Audit and Auditors) Rules, 2014 deals with the provision of rotation of auditors and these provisions are
applicable only to appointment of auditors (financial). The Act does not provide for rotation in case
of appointment of cost auditors and the same is not applicable to a cost auditor. It may, however, be
noted that though there is no statutory provision for rotation of cost auditors, individual companies may
do so as a part of their policy, as is the practice with Public Sector Undertakings.
Rule 14 of the Companies (Audit and Auditors) Rules, 2014 has laid down the procedure of appointment
and fixing the remuneration of a cost auditor. It states as follows:
Remuneration of the Cost Auditor: For the purpose of sub-section (3) of section 148-
the Board shall appoint an individual, who is a cost accountant in practice, or a firm of cost
accountants in practice, as cost auditor on the recommendations of the Audit committee, which shall
also recommend remuneration for such cost auditor;
the remuneration recommended by the Audit Committee under (i) shall be considered and approved
by the Board of Directors and ratified subsequently by the shareholders;
in the case of other companies which are not required to constitute an audit committee, the Board shall
appoint an individual who is a cost accountant in practice or a firm of cost accountants in practice as
cost auditor and the remuneration of such cost auditor shall be ratified by shareholders subsequently.
Sub-rule (7) of Rule 6 of the Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules 2014 states that “the provisions
of sub-section (12) of section 143 of the Act and the relevant rules made thereunder shall apply mutatis
mutandis to a cost auditor during performance of his functions under section 148 of the Act and these
rules”.
As per sub-section (12) of section 143 of the Companies Act 2013, extract of which is given above, it is
obligatory on the part of cost auditor to report offence of fraud which is being or has been committed in
the company by its officers or employees, to the Central Government as per the prescribed procedure
under the Rules.
As per the proviso to above sub-section, it has been stated that in case of a fraud involving lesser than
the specified amount, the auditor shall report the matter to the audit committee constituted under
section 177 or to the Board in other cases within such time and in such manner as may be prescribed.
As per sub-rule (4) of Rule 6 of the Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules 2014 as amended, a Cost
Auditor is required to submit the Cost Audit Report along with his or its reservations or qualifications or
observations or sugges-tions, if any, in form CRA-3 to Board of Directors of the company within a period
of one hundred and eighty days from the closure of the financial year to which the report relates.
Form for filing Cost Audit Report with the Central Government
As per sub-rule (6) of Rule 6 of the Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules 2014 as amended, every
company to whom cost auditor submits his or its report shall, within a period of thirty days from the date
of receipt of a copy of the cost audit report, furnish the Central Government with such report along
with full information and explanation on every reservation or qualification contained therein, in form
CRA-4 along with fees specified in the Companies (Registration Offices and Fees) Rules, 2014.
It is to be noted that the cost audit report is required to be filed in XBRL format.
SECRETARIAL AUDIT
Extract of Provision of Section 204 of the Companies Act 2013 Section 204.
(1) Every listed company and a company belonging to other class of companies as may be prescribed
in rule 9 of chapter XIII under the act, shall annex with its Board’s report made in terms of sub-section
(3) of section 134, a secretarial audit report, given by a company secretary in practice, in such form as
may be prescribed in rule 9 of chapter XIII under the act,.
(1) For the purposes of sub-section (1) of section 204, the other class of companies shall be as under-
(a) Every public company having a paid-up share capital of fifty crore rupees or more; or
(b) Every public company having a turnover of two hundred fifty crore rupees or more.
(2) The format of the Secretarial Audit Report shall be in Form No. MR.3.
(2) It shall be the duty of the company to give all assistance and facilities to the company secretary in
practice, for auditing the secretarial and related records of the company.
(3) The Board of Directors, in their report made in terms of sub-section (3) of section 134, shall explain
in full any qualification or observation or other remarks made by the company secretary in practice in
his report under sub-section (1).
(3) If a company or any officer of the company or the company secretary in practice, contravenes
the provisions of this section, the company, every officer of the company or the company secretary
in practice, who is in default, shall be punishable with fine which shall not be less than one lakh rupees
but which may extend to five lakh rupees.
As per section 204(1) of Companies Act, 2013 read with rule 9 of the Companies (Appointment and
Remuneration of Managerial Personnel) Rules, 2014, the following companies are required to obtain
Secretarial Audit Report:
Every public company having a paid-up share capital of fifty crore rupees or more; or-
Every public company having a turnover of two hundred fifty crore rupees or more.
However the “Turnover” means the aggregate value of the realisation of amount made from the Sale,
Supply or Distribution of goods or on account of services rendered, or both, by the company during a
financial year [Section 2(91)].
The Secretarial Audit Report is required to be provided in the format prescribed in Form MR-3 (Rule 9 of
the Companies (Appointment and Remuneration of Managerial Personnel) Rules, 2014).
As per Rule 8 of the Companies (Meetings of Board and its powers) Rules, 2014, Secretarial Auditor
is required to be appointed by means of resolution passed at a duly convened Board meeting. It is
advisable for the Secretarial Audi-tor to get a letter of engagement from the company. Secretarial
Auditor should accept the letter of engagement. However, it is advisable that any changes in the
Secretarial Auditor during the financial year are to be reported to the members in the Board’s Report.
1. Which Rules govern maintenance of cost accounting records and cost audit as per Section 148
of the Companies Act, 2013?
2. What is the applicability of the Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules, 2014 and what is the
date on which it becomes effective and applicable?
3. The Rules state that cost records are to be maintained in Form CRA-1. However, CRA-1 does
not prescribe any format but only provides principles to be followed for different cost elements.
What are the role and status of Cost Accounting Standards/GACAP and its applicability vis-à-vis
CRA-1?
4. What is the procedure for appointment of cost auditor under the Companies Act, 2013?
7. The Companies Act, 2013 has introduced provision regarding rotation of auditors. Is the provision
of rotation of auditors applicable to cost auditors also?
8. What is the procedure to be followed for fixing the remuneration of a cost auditor?
9. Who can conduct the Secretarial Audit and which company have to undergo such?
● The Cost Auditor has to follow the Cost Auditing Standards while conducting Cost Audit.
● Cost Accounting Standards is mandatory as per section 143 of the companies Act 2013.
● CRA-2 is used to intimate the appointment of Cost Auditor to the Central Government.
● Chartered Accountants are eligible to conduct Secretarial Audit having valid certificate of
practice.
● Company Secretaries are eligible to conduct Cost Audit having valid certificate of practice.
[Answer: T, T, F, T, F, F, F, T, T, T]
● Secretarial Audit is applicable to public companies having paid up share capital of _____________
crore or more.
● Secretarial Audit is covered under Section ______ of the companies Act 2013.
● Cost Audit is covered under Section ______ of the companies Act 2013.
[Answer: Listed, Cost Accountant, Company Secretary, CRA-1, MR-3, 50 crore, 200 crore, 204, 148,
Board of Directors]
Column A Column B
1 Secretarial Audit Report A CRA-1
2 Sec 204 of the companies Act B Cost Audit
3 Secretarial Audit C Board of Directors
4 Intimation for appointment of cost auditor D CRA-4
to Central Government
5 Casual vacancy in the office of a Cost E Cost Audit report by the Auditor to Company
Auditor is filled by-
6 Form for filing Cost Audit Report with the F MR-3
Central Government
7 Sec 148 of the companies Act G 1 Lakh rupees which can extend to 5 Lakh
rupees
8 CRA 3 H Secretarial Audit
9 Cost Accounting Records I Listed Companies
10 Penalty for non compliance of Sec 204 J CRA-2
[Answer: F, H, I, J, C, D, B, E, A, G]
4 Secretarial Audit is applicable to the public sector company having the paid up share capital
of-
(a)50 crore
(b)75 crore
(c)100 crore
(d)200 crore
5. Secretarial Audit is applicable to the public sector company having the turnover of-
(a)100 crore
(b)200 crore
(c)250 crore
(d)300 crore
(a)MR-2
(b)MR-3
(c)MR-4
(d)MR-5
(a)Audit Committee
(b)BOD
(c)BOD on recommendation Audit Committee
(d)None of the above
[Answer: B, C, A, A, C, B, C]
Therefore, Audit Report is called as the ultimate and final product of every audit.
The meaning of Audit Report can be well understood from the following selected definitions.
Lancaster – “A Report is a statement of collected & considered facts, so drawn up as to give clear and
concise infor-mation to persons who are not already in possession of the full facts of the subject matter
of the report.”
J. B. Ray – “The Report shall either contain as expression of opinion regarding the financial statements,
taken as a whole or an assertion to the effect that an opinion cannot be expressed when an overall
opinion cannot be expressed, the reason therefore should be stated. In all cases, where auditor’s
name is associated with financial statements the report should contain a clear cut indication of the
character of the auditor’s examination, if any, and the degree of responsibility he is taking.”
In short, the Audit Report is nothing but a statement of observation gathered & considered while
proving conclusive evidence of company’s financial position. It is a medium through which an auditors
expresses his opinion on the financial statement under audit. It is an important part of the audit as it
provides the results of the audit conducted by the auditor.
An Audit report is the end product of the auditing & concluding part of the audit process.
Audit report gives the auditor’s opinion on the accounts & record of the company, as examined by
him.
Audit report is the instrument which, measures the auditors responsibility in regard to the true & fairness
of the financial statement of the company.
Audit Report indicates the real position of the financial status of the company & which is used by
different people as a reliable document.
Title: The Auditor’s Report should have an appropriate title i.e. “Auditor’s Report”. It should be
distinguished from other Reports, e.g. reports of officers of the entity, Board of Directors.
Addressee: The Auditor’s Report should be appropriately addressed as required by the circumstances
of the engagement and applicable laws and regulations. Ordinarily, the Auditor’s Report is addressed
to the authority appointing the Auditor.
The Auditor’s Report should identify the Financial Statements of the entity that have been audited,
including the date of and period covered by the Financial Statements.
The Report should include a Statement that the Financial Statements are the responsibility of the
entity’s management and a Statement that the responsibility of the Auditor is to express an opinion on
the Financial Statements based on the audit.
Scope Paragraph:
The Auditor’s Report should describe the scope of the audit by stating that the audit was conducted
in accordance with standards on auditing generally accepted in India.
The Report should include a statement that the audit was planned and performed to obtain reasonable
assurance whether the Financial Statements are free of material misstatement.
The Auditor’s Report should describe the Audit as including examining, on a test basis, evidence to
support the amounts and disclosures in Financial Statements, assessing the accounting principles used
in the preparation of the Financial Statements, assessing significant estimates made by management,
in the preparation of Financial Statements, & evaluating the overall position of Financial Statements.
The Report should include a statement by the Auditor that the audit provides a reasonable basis for
his opinion.
Opinion Paragraph: The Opinion paragraph of the Report should indicate the Financial Reporting
framework used to prepare the Financial Statements. It should state the Auditor’s opinion as to whether
the Financial Statements give a true and fair view in accordance with the financial reporting framework
and, where appropriate, whether the Financial Statements comply with the statutory requirements.
Date of the Report: The date of an Auditor’s Report is the date on which the Auditor signs the Report
expressing an opinion on the Financial Statements. The Auditor should not date the Report earlier than
the date on which the Financial Statements are signed or approved by Management.
Place of Signature: The Report should name the specific location, which is ordinarily the city where the
Audit Report is signed.
Auditor’s Signature: The Report should be signed by the Auditor in his personal name. Where a Firm is
appointed as the Auditor, the Report should be signed in the personal name of the Auditor and in the
name of the Audit Firm. The Partner / Proprietor signing the Report should mention his ICAI Membership
Number.
Note: Where the governing statute requires the Auditor to include certain matters in his Report or
prescribe the form in which the Auditor should issue his Report, such additional matters should be
included in addition to the requirements of SA 700 on “Forming an opinion and reporting on financial
statements.”
The Opening or Introductory Paragraph identifies the Financial Statements of the entity that have been
audited, including the date of and period covered by the Financial Statements.
The ‘Opening Paragraph’ seeks to bring to the notice of the Users of Financial Statements, that
preparation of the accounts is the responsibility of the Management of the enterprise, whereas the
responsibility of the Auditor is to express an opinion on the said accounts based on the audit carried
out by him.
Through the Opening Paragraph, the Auditor communicates the basic message that the preparation of
Financial Statements requires Management to make significant accounting estimates and judgements,
as well as to determine the appropriate accounting principles and methods used in preparation of the
said Financial Statements.
The ‘Scope Paragraph’ seeks to inform the Users about the practices and procedures followed in the
conduct of audit by the Auditor.
In the Scope Paragraph, the Auditor states that the audit was planned and performed in accordance
with Standards on Auditing generally accepted in India, and also that the audit provides a reasonable
basis for his opinion.
The significance of the Scope Paragraph lies in the fact that the Auditor intends to convey to the
readers of his report, about the scope of audit by highlighting the nature and progress of audit. The test
check approach of audit adopted by the Auditor in performing his audit work as also the significant
aspect of evaluation of accounting principles and accounting estimates is also clarified.
The basic objective of auditing that the Auditor provides only “reasonable assurance” is emphasized in
the Scope Paragraph. Thus, this paragraph signifies the inherent limitations of audit.
UNQUALIFIED OPINION
An opinion is said to be unqualified, when the Auditor concludes that the Financial Statements give a
true and fair view in accordance with the financial reporting framework used for the preparation and
presentation of the Financial Statements. Or,
The Auditor gives a Clean or Unqualified Report, when he does not have any significant reservation in
respect of matters contained in the Financial Statements.
The Financial Statements have been prepared using the Generally Accepted Accounting Principles,
which have been consistently applied,
The Financial Statements comply with relevant statutory requirements and regulations, and
There is adequate disclosure of all material matters relevant to the proper presentation of the financial
information, subject to statutory requirements, where applicable.
Any changes in the accounting principles or in the method of their application, and the effects thereof,
have been properly determined and disclosed in the Financial Statements. For issuing an Unqualified
Audit Report, the Auditor has to satisfy himself that -
Standards: Accounting entries passed in the books of account are in conformity with the generally
applicable accounting principles and Indian Accounting Standards followed consistently.
True and Fair: The Financial Statements prepared represent a true and fair summary of the transactions
that took place during the year.
Classification: The process of classification and aggregation followed in the preparation of the Financial
Statements is fair and it does not hide a material fact nor does it highlight something, which may distort
the real state of affairs.
Format: The form of Financial Statements is in accordance with the form prescribed by law, if any.
Free of Misstatements: There are no material misstatements in the Financial Statements. No material
transaction recorded in the books of account is illegal or beyond the legal competence of the
Company.
Disclosure: All the disclosures statutorily required or otherwise relevant have been made appropriately.
When the Auditor issues any Report other than unqualified, his Report is said to be modified. As per SA
750, an Audi-tor’s Report is considered to be modified when it includes –
● Matters That Do Not Affect the Auditor’s Opinion - with Emphasis of Matter Paragraph.
Qualified Opinion,
Adverse Opinion.
Going Concern Not Resolved: The Auditor should modify the Auditor’s Report by adding a paragraph
to highlight a material matter regarding a going concern problem where the going concern question
is not resolved and adequate disclosures have been made in the Financial Statements.
Significant Uncertainty: The Auditor should consider modifying his Report by adding a paragraph if there
is a significant uncertainty (other than going concern problem), the resolution of which is dependent
upon future events and which may affect the Financial Statements.
Multiple Uncertainties: In extreme cases, e.g. multiple uncertainties that are significant to the Financial
Statements, the Auditor may consider it appropriate to express a Disclaimer of Opinion instead of
Impact of Paragraph: The addition of an emphasis of matter paragraph does not affect the Auditor’s
opinion. The paragraph would preferably be included preceding the Opinion Paragraph and would
ordinarily refer to the fact that the Auditor’s opinion is not qualified in this respect.
Example:
“Without qualifying our opinion, we draw attention to Note X of Schedule to the Financial Statements.
The entity is the defendant in a lawsuit alleging infringement of certain patent rights and claiming
royalties and punitive damages. The entity has filed a counter action, and preliminary hearings and
discovery proceedings on both actions are in progress. The ultimate outcome of the matter cannot
presently be determined, and no provision for any liability that may result has been made in the
Financial Statements.
In our opinion and to the best of our information and according to the explanations given to us, the
Financial State-ments give a true and fair view in conformity with the accounting principles generally
accepted in India - in the case of the Balance Sheet, of the state of affairs of as at 31st March 2XXX,
and in the case of the Profit and Loss Account, of the Profit / Loss for the year ended on that date.”
An Auditor may not be able to express an Unqualified Opinion when any of the following circumstances
exist and in the Auditor’s judgement, the effect of the matter is or may be material to the Financial
Statements. [SA 700]
Limitation on Scope: Limitation on scope of Auditor’s work may be imposed by the clients or imposed
by circumstances. It may lead to situations where the Auditor may have to issue a Qualified Opinion or
a Disclaimer of Opinion.
Disagreement with management: The Auditor may disagree with the Management as to - (a) the
acceptability of the accounting policies selected, or the method of their application, (b) the
adequacy of disclosure in the Financial Statements, or (c) the compliance of the Financial Statements
with relevant regulations and statutory requirements. In such cases, he may have to give an Adverse
Opinion or a Qualified Opinion.
Significant Uncertainty: If there is a significant uncertainty affecting the Financial Statements (other
than Going Concern problem), for example, litigation involving legal claims, etc. the result of which
is dependent upon the resolution of the future events, the Auditor may have to quality his opinion or
disclaim an opinion. However, where such significant uncertainty is not material, the Auditor may issue
an Unqualified Opinion, by adding an “Emphasis of Matter” paragraph, without qualifying his opinion.
Whenever the Auditor expresses an opinion other than unqualified, a clear description of all the
substantive reasons should be included in the report and, unless impracticable, a quantification of the
possible effect(s), individually and in aggregate, on the Financial Statements should be mentioned in
the Auditor’s Report.
Where it is not practicable to quantify the effect of modifications made in the Audit Report accurately,
the Auditor may do so on the basis of estimates made by the Management, after carrying out possible
audit tests. He should clearly indicate the fact that the figures are based on Management estimates.
This information would be set out in a separate paragraph preceding the opinion or disclaimer of
opinion and may include a reference to a more extensive discussion, if any, in a note to the Financial
Statements.
A Qualified Audit Report is one where an Auditor gives an opinion on the truth and fairness of Financial
Statements, subject to certain reservations.
The Auditor’s Reservation is generally stated as: “Subject to the above, we report that the Balance
Sheet shows a true and fair view.”
The overall impact of all reservations or qualification taken together is not material enough to vitiate
the overall true and fair view of Financial Statements, but it is important that such a matter(s) should be
brought to the attention of the shareholders.
The Report should also give detailed reasons along with quantitative impact on the qualifications on
Financial Statements.
The effect of any disagreement with Management is not so material and pervasive as to require an
Adverse Opinion, or
The Limitation on scope is not so material and pervasive as to require a Disclaimer of Opinion.
Clarity: The Auditor must express the nature of qualification, in a clear and unambiguous manner.
Explanation: Where the Auditor answers any of the statutory affirmations in the negative or with a
qualification, his Report shall state the reasons for such answer.
Placement: All qualifications should be contained in the Auditor’s Report. When there are Notes, which
are subject matter of a qualification, the same should preferably he annexed to the Auditors’ Report.
However a reference to the Notes to Accounts in the Auditors’ Report does not automatically become
a qualification.
Subject to: The words “subject to” are essential to state any qualification. The qualification should
be preceded by words such as “Subject to” or “Except that” to make it clear that he is making an
exception.
Nature of Qualification: Vague statements, the effect of which on accounts cannot be ascertained,
like, The debtors balances are subject to confirmation’, No provision for taxation has been made in
view of the loss during the year’, etc. should be avoided.
Violation of Law: Where the Company has committed an irregularity resulting in a breach of law, the
Auditor should bring the same to the notice of the shareholders by properly qualifying his report.
Quantification: The Auditors should quantify, wherever possible, the effect of these qualifications on the
Financial Statements if the same is material. Where the effect of qualification cannot be accurately
quantified, the Auditor may reflect the effect on the basis of Management estimates, after carrying out
necessary audit tests on such estimates.
Notes -
Report Relationship: Where notes of a qualificatory nature appear in the accounts, the Auditors should
state all qualifications independently in their report so that the user can assess the significance of these
qualifications.
Draft Report: The Auditor may discuss matters of qualification with the Management of the Company
to acquire their views. It is not necessary that the Auditor should accept the Management’s view and
modify his opinion. But it would enable the Auditor to accurately draft the qualifications in his Final
Report.
Examine whether the Auditors are in active disagreement with something which has been done by the
Company, or they are merely unable to form an opinion, say, for lack of adequate information about
an item.
Establish whether the matters in question are so material as to affect the presentation of a true and fair
view of the whole of the affairs of the Company, or they are of such a nature as to affect on particular
item disclosed in the ac-counts.
See whether the matters constituting the qualification involve a material contravention of any
requirements of the Companies Act, which have a bearing on the accounts.
Illustrations:
Where the Auditors are unable to obtain all the information and explanations which they consider
necessary for the purposes of their audit, e.g. -
Absence of satisfactory documentary evidence of the existence of ownership of the material assets,
such as, title deeds in respect of land,
Non-availability of books and records owing to unavoidable circumstances, such as books and records
of a foreign branch with which no communication is possible.
Where proper books of accounts have not been kept in accordance with the law.
Where the Balance Sheet and P&L Account are not in agreement with the hooks of account and
returns.
When the accounts do not disclose a true and fair view like -
Where the accounting practices followed by the Company are not considered appropriate to the
circumstances and nature of the business e.g. treatment of HP Sales as outright sales,
Where there has been a change in accounting principles or procedures in relation to material
items, such, valuation of stock, depreciation, treatment of by-product cost, etc. without adequate
explanation and disclosure of effect of the change,
Where difference of opinion with management has arisen regarding valuation or realisability of assets,
such as Stock-in-Trade, Debtors, Loans & Advances or the extent of liabilities, contingent or otherwise,
Where income or expenditure is not properly reflected so as to show a fair figure of profit for the year,
Where information is not required by law to be disclosed but the disclosure of which is considered
essential by the Auditors in order to show a true and fair view,
Where there is a contravention of the provisions of the Companies Act having a bearing upon the
accounts and transactions of the Company e.g. donations to political parties or for political purposes
in contravention of Section 182, or contributions to charitable or other funds in excess of the limitation
specified in Section 181;
Where the Company has contravened the provisions of its Memorandum and Articles of Association.
DISCLAIMER OF OPINION
A Disclaimer of Opinion Report is given when the Auditor is unable to form an overall opinion about the
matters con-tained in the Financial Statements.
A Disclaimer of Opinion should be expressed when the possible effect of a limitation on scope is so
material and pervasive that the Auditor has not been able to obtain sufficient appropriate audit
evidence and is, accordingly, unable to express an opinion on the Financial Statements.
It may happen in situations such as -- (a) when books of account of the Company seized by Income-
Tax Authorities, (b) when it is not possible for the Auditor to obtain certain information or (c) when
scope of audit work is restricted.
The Auditor will state in his Report that he is unable to term an opinion on the Financial Statements.
Such Report is called as “Disclaimer of Opinion Report”.
PIECEMEAL OPINION
The Auditor, may in some cases, find that the Financial Statements he has examined present only a
partial true and fair view. In such cases, he may report that he is unable to express an opinion, limited
to certain items in the statement, with which he is satisfied. Such a situation would warrant a Piecemeal
Opinion.
As the name suggests, the Auditor gives a divided opinion on matters with which he is satisfied and with
which he is not. The Auditor should state the reasons for having given a Piecemeal Opinion.
An Adverse or Negative Report is given when the Auditor concludes that based on his examination, he
does not agree with the affirmations made in the Financial Statements / Financial Report.
The Auditor states that the Financial Statements do not present a true and fair view of the state of
affairs and the working results of the organisation.
The Auditor should state the reasons for issuing such a report.
An Adverse Opinion should be expressed when the effect of a disagreement is so material and
pervasive to the Financial Statements, that the Auditor concludes that a qualification of the report is
not adequate to disclose the misleading or incomplete nature of the Financial Statements.
Meaning: Statements or Observations which are not qualificatory in nature may exist in the Auditor’s
Report. Some requirements under CARO or inquiry U/S 143 are of this non-qualificatory character.
The matter is of such importance in relation to the Balance Sheet as a whole that it should be brought
to the notice of the members, and
The point is not clearly brought out on the face of the accounts, as they stand by the note or otherwise,
and
The point does not affect the true and fair character of the accounts.
Example:
“The properties abroad shown in the Balance Sheet at are in the course of being but have not yet
been, registered in the Company’s name.” (The Opinion Paragraph should not have any reference to
the above remark).
These are usually shown under “Notes to These notes are included in the Auditors’ Report
Accounts”. All Notes, wherever shown, including before the Opinion Paragraph. The reader’s
those required by the Schedule III constitute an attention is drawn to the Qualification paragraph
integral part of the accounting statement. by use of the word “Subject to”.
Since significant events may take place from the date of Financial Statements, date of completing
audit field work and date of Audit Report, the date of the Audit Report should be the actual date of
completion of audit.
Any event coming to be known after the date of the Audit Report is not the responsibility of the Auditor
even though it may have a highly significant effect on the Financial Statements reported upon.
Even though the Audit Report may be actually prepared at a date later than the date of actual
completion of the audit work, it is desirable that it should be made as on the former date to limit the
Auditors’ responsibility.
In relation to reporting on Company Accounts, it is possible for the Auditor to report on the same day
on which the Financial Statements are approved by the Board of Directors.
Significance of the phase ‘’to the best of our Information and according to the explanations given to
us’’ which is generally found in the Auditors’ Reports.
Narrow Interpretation:
The Statement “to the best of our information and according to the explanations given to us” is an
expression of opinion by the Auditors.
Such opinion is a matter of professional judgement to be exercised by the Auditors under the given
situations.
Auditors will not be held responsible if they acted on information and explanations, which they be ‘eve
to be bonafide, but which are as a matter of fact untrue or incorrect. They have to exercise reasonable
care and skill in the evaluation of information made available to them.
As a narrow interpretation of the phrase, the Auditors may state that they have acted on the basis
of explanations given to them. To that extent this phrase definitely restricts the scope of enquiry to be
made by an Auditor.
Broad Interpretation:
The Auditors should apply professional judgment to obtain all that information and explanations, which
are necessary for the performance of conducting the audit.
Under the Chartered Accountants (CA) Act 1959, a (CA) Chartered Accountant is guilty of professional
misconduct if he fails to obtain sufficient information which is necessary for the expression of an opinion
or its exceptions are sufficiently material to negate the expression of an opinion.
the Balance Sheet shows the correct position as per books but other information indicate that the
books themselves were incorrect,
the Financial Statements do not reflect proper position which could have been revealed had the
Auditor obtained necessary information during the course of audit.
At a wider interpretation level, the Auditor should obtain all information and explanations, which he
deems necessary, for the expression of an opinion. If he does not obtain all such information, he is
entitled to issue a Disclaimer of Opinion Report.
Conclusion: Hence, the given phrase is a double-edged sword, which may be interpreted either to
restrict the scope of enquiry or to stretch responsibilities beyond a limit.
Legal Recognition: Legal recognition is given to the process of obtaining information as part of the
whole auditing process. The provisions of the Companies Act in this regard are -
(a) Where any particulars or information is required to be given in the Balance Sheet or P&L Account
of a Company or in any document required to be annexed or attached thereto, it shall be the duty
of the concerned Officer of the Company to furnish without delay, to the Company, and also to the
Company’s Auditor, whenever he so requires, those particulars or that information in as full a manner
as possible.
The Company Auditor should state whether he has obtained all the information and explanations
which to the best of his knowledge and belief, were necessary for the purpose of his audit. [Section
143]
Auditors cannot be expected to know all the technicalities and the complexities of the business deals.
Further, the relevant papers and documents to explain the transactions may not be really available to
the Auditor and, even if they are available they may still need to be explained so that one can clearly
understand the impact of the transactions on the accounts.
The Management, which actually enters into transactions on behalf of the Company, is expected
to have thoroughly understood the implications of all material transactions, and hence Auditors are
empowered to obtain explanations from the management.
Auditors’ Responsibility:
If any vital information is deliberately withheld from the Auditor in the ordinary course of audit, and he
had no means to know the existence of such information, in case the accounts turn to be wrong for
that reason, the Auditor should not be held guilty or negligent.
If however, the Auditor has means to know of the existence of such vita] information but he ignored it,
he would be held guilty on that account.
Where the Auditor has not been able to obtain all information and explanations as required he should
issue a Modified Audit Report (i.e. other than an Unqualified Report)
Forwarding of Branch Audit Reports: Where the branch audit carried out by a person other than the
Statutory Auditor, the Branch Auditor shall prepare a report on the accounts of the branch office
examined by him and forward the same to the Company’s Auditor who shall deal with the same in
such manner as he considers necessary. [Section 143]
Qualifications in Branch Audit Reports: If the Branch Auditor’s Report contains any qualification, the
Statutory Auditors should normally include it in their own report unless they are satisfied that either -
Objections raised by the Branch Auditor have been met while preparing the Company’s accounts or
during the conduct of the Company’s audit, or
The matter on which the qualification is made is not material in the context of the Company’s Accounts
as a whole, or
In the light of information and explanations given to them, which were not available to the Branch
Auditor, they are satisfied that the qualification is not called for.
Inquiry: Every auditor of the company should inquire into the following matters, namely:—
whether loans and advances made by the company on the basis of security have been properly
secured and whether the terms on which they have been made are prejudicial to the interests of the
company or its members;
whether transactions of the company which are represented merely by book entries are prejudicial to
the interests of the company;
where the company not being an investment company or a banking company, whether so much of
the assets of the company as consist of shares, debentures and other securities have been sold at a
price less than that at which they were purchased by the company;
whether loans and advances made by the company have been shown as deposits;
where it is stated in the books and documents of the company that any shares have been allotted
for cash, whether cash has actually been received in respect of such allotment, and if no cash has
actually been so received, whether the position as stated in the account books and the balance sheet
is correct, regular and not misleading.
Provided that the auditor of a company which is a holding company shall also have the right of access
to the records of all its subsidiaries in so far as it relates to the consolidation of its financial statements
with that of its subsidiaries.
Report:
whether he has sought and obtained all the information and explanations which to the best of his
knowledge and belief were necessary for the purpose of his audit and if not, the details thereof and
the effect of such information on the financial statements;
whether, in his opinion, proper books of account as required by law have been kept by the company
so far as appears from his examination of those books and proper returns adequate for the purposes
of his audit have been received from branches not visited by him;
whether the report on the accounts of any branch office of the company audited under sub-section
(8) by a person other than the company’s auditor has been sent to him under the proviso to that sub-
section and the manner in which he has dealt with it in preparing his report;
whether the company’s balance sheet and profit and loss account dealt with in the report are in
agreement with the books of account and returns;
whether, in his opinion, the financial statements comply with the accounting standards;
the observations or comments of the auditors on financial transactions or matters which have any
adverse effect on the functioning of the company;
whether any director is disqualified from being appointed as a director under sub-section (2) of section
164;
any qualification, reservation or adverse remark relating to the maintenance of accounts and other
matters connected therewith;
whether the company has adequate internal financial controls system in place and the operating
effectiveness of such controls;
CARO – COMPANIES (AUDITOR’S REPORT) ORDER, 2016 issued by the Central Government as per the
power granted under section 143(11) of the Companies Act, 2013.
According to Sec 143, the auditor is required to report on certain matters only if he is not satisfied
after his examina-tion of the accounts but after this new order, the auditor has to make a statement
on each of the specified matters likewise in case of Govt. companies, this order is in addition to the
directions of the Comptroller and Auditor General in India.
a banking company as defined in clause (c) of section 5 of the Banking Regulation Act, 1949 (10 of
1949);
a One Person Company as defined under clause (62) of section 2 of the Companies Act and a small
company as defined under clause (85) of section 2 of the Companies Act; and a private limited
company, not being a subsidiary or holding company of a public company, having a paid up capital
and reserves and surplus not more than rupees one crore as on the balance sheet date and which
does not have total borrowings exceeding rupees one crore from any bank or financial institution at
any point of time during the financial year and which does not have a total revenue as disclosed in
Scheduled III to the Companies Act, 2013 (including revenue from discontinuing operations) exceeding
rupees ten crore during the financial year as per the financial statements.
Auditor’s report to contain matters specified in paragraphs 3 and 4. - Every report made by the auditor
under section 143 of the Companies Act, 2013 on the accounts of every company audited by him, to
which this Order applies, for the financial years commencing on or after 1st April, 2015, shall in addition,
contain the matters specified in paragraphs 3 and 4, as may be applicable:
Provided the Order shall not apply to the auditor’s report on consolidated financial statements.
Matters to be included in the auditor’s report. - The auditor’s report on the accounts of a company to
which this Order applies shall include a statement on the following matters, namely:-
(a) whether the company is maintaining proper records showing full particulars, including quantitative
details and situation of fixed assets;
whether these fixed assets have been physically verified by the management at reasonable intervals;
whether any material discrepancies were noticed on such verification and if so, whether the same
have been properly dealt with in the books of account;
whether the title deeds of immovable properties are held in the name of the company. If not, provide
the details thereof;
whether physical verification of inventory has been conducted at reasonable intervals by the
management and whether any material discrepancies were noticed and if so, whether they have
whether the company has granted any loans, secured or unsecured to companies, firms, Limited
Liability Partnerships or other parties covered in the register maintained under section 189 of the
Companies Act, 2013. If so,
whether the terms and conditions of the grant of such loans are not prejudicial to the company’s
interest;
whether the schedule of repayment of principal and payment of interest has been stipulated and
whether the repayments or receipts are regular;
if the amount is overdue, state the total amount overdue for more than ninety days, and whether
reasonable steps have been taken by the company for recovery of the principal and interest;
in respect of loans, investments, guarantees, and security whether provisions of section 185 and 186 of
the Companies Act, 2013 have been complied with. If not, provide the details thereof.
in case, the company has accepted deposits, whether the directives issued by the Reserve Bank of
India and the provisions of sections 73 to 76 or any other relevant provisions of the Companies Act,
2013 and the rules framed there under, where applicable, have been complied with? If not, the nature
of such contraventions be stated; If an order has been passed by Company Law Board or National
Company Law Tribunal or Reserve Bank of India or any court or any other tribunal, whether the same
has been complied with or not?
whether maintenance of cost records has been specified by the Central Government under sub-
section (1) of section 148 of the Companies Act, 2013 and whether such accounts and records have
been so made and maintained.
(a) whether the company is regular in depositing undisputed statutory dues including provident fund,
employees’ state insurance, income-tax, sales-tax, service tax, duty of customs, duty of excise, value
added tax, cess and any other statutory dues to the appropriate authorities and if not, the extent of
the arrears of outstanding statutory dues as on the last day of the financial year concerned for a period
of more than six months from the date they became payable. shall be indicated;
where dues of income tax or sales tax or service tax or duty of customs or duty of excise or value added
tax have not been deposited on account of any dispute, then the amounts involved and the forum
where dispute is pending shall be mentioned. (A mere representation to the concerned Department
shall not be treated as a dispute).
Whether the company has defaulted in repayment of loans or borrowing to a financial institution,
bank, Government or dues to debenture holders? If yes, the period and the amount of default to be
reported (in case of defaults to banks, financial institutions, and Government, lender wise details to be
provided).
Whether moneys raised by way of initial public offer or further public offer (including debt instruments)
and term loans were applied for the purposes for which those are raised. If not, the details together
with delays or default and subsequent rectification, if any, as may be applicable, be reported;
whether any fraud by the company or any fraud on the Company by its officers or employees has been
noticed or reported during the year; If yes, the nature and the amount involved is to be indicated;
Whether managerial remuneration has been paid or provided in accordance with the requisite
approvals mandated by the provisions of section 197 read with Schedule V to the Companies Act? If
not, state the amount involved and steps taken by the company for securing refund of the same;
Whether the Nidhi Company has complied with the Net Owned Funds to Deposits in the ratio of 1: 20
to meet out the liability and whether the Nidhi Company is maintaining ten per cent unencumbered
term deposits as specified in the Nidhi Rules, 2014 to meet out the liability;
Whether all transactions with the related parties are in compliance with sections 177 and 188 of
Companies Act, 2013 where applicable and the details have been disclosed in the Financial Statements
etc., as required by the applicable accounting standards;
Whether the company has made any preferential allotment or private placement of shares or fully or
partly convertible debentures during the year under review and if so, as to whether the requirement
of section 42 of the Companies Act, 2013 have been complied with and the amount raised have
been used for the purposes for which the funds were raised. If not, provide the details in respect of the
amount involved and nature of non-compliance;
Whether the company has entered into any non-cash transactions with directors or persons connected
with him and if so, whether the provisions of section 192 of Companies Act, 2013 have been complied
with;
Whether the company is required to be registered under section 45-IA of the Reserve Bank of India Act,
1934 and if so, whether the registration has been obtained.
Where the auditor is unable to express any opinion on any specified matter, his report shall indicate
such fact together with the reasons as to why it is not possible for him to give his opinion on the same.
There may be instances, where the Management of a Company amends its audited accounts, and
re-approves it and then requests the Statutory Auditors to make a Report once again on the amended
accounts. The Auditors’ du-ties in this regard are enumerated below;
Return: Ensure that all copies of the Original Accounts and Report are returned to the Auditor.
Disclosure: Ensure that the fact of Revision of accounts already approved by the Board and reported
upon by the Statutory Auditors, appears as a specific Note on the amended accounts.
Adequate Disclosure: If the Statutory Auditor is satisfied that the disclosure made by the Company in
the Notes on Accounts is adequate, there is no further need for the Auditor to refer to the revision of
the Balance Sheet and/ or the Profit and Loss Account in his report.
Inadequate Disclosure: If the Notes on Accounts do not contain any note on the revision or if such Note
is not considered as adequately comprehensive by the Auditor, the Auditor should refer to the fact of
Qualified Report: Where past accounts have been re-opened and revised on technical grounds, and
the Company has asked the Auditor to give his report u/s 143 on the revised accounts, he should issue
a Qualified Report only.
Format: The Report should indicate that the Company has re-opened the accounts contrary to the
opinion of ICAI (CA) The relevant paragraph of the Report may appear as under -
“As per the opinion of the ICAI (CA) a Company cannot re-open and revise the accounts once
adopted by the Shareholders at an Annual General Meeting (AGM). However, the Department of
Company Affairs vide Circu-lar dated 28.07.1987, has opined that for meeting technical requirements
of taxation laws, the accounts can be re-opened. The Board of Directors of the Company, contrary
to the aforesaid opinion of the ICAI, has re-opened and revised the aforesaid accounts for adjusting
(the matter for meeting the technical requirements of taxation laws regarding which accounts are re-
opened may be specified here).”
Revision of Financial Statements: The Auditor should issue a fresh report on the revised Financial
Statements in accordance with - (a) Guidance Note on Auditor’s Report on Revised Accounts of
Companies before circulation to Shareholders, and (b) Guidance Note on Revision/Rectification of
Financial Statements.
Revision of Audit Report:
When the Auditor considers that amendment in Financial statements is not warranted, or When the
Auditor advises amendment to Financial Statements, but the Management does not intend to revise
the same, or
When the Management agrees for revision in the Financial Statements but is unable to do so despite
its bonafide intention, but Management extends its co-operation to the Auditor and agrees to ensure
that anyone in receipt of there previously issued Financial Statements together with the Audit Report
thereon is informed of the situation and would be issued the revised Audit Report.
Auditor’s Duties: In the above situations, the Auditor should - (i) issue a Revised Report in which he
should refer to the earlier report, and (ii) state the reasons for revising the report.
Timing: For corporate entities, the Audit Report may be revised till the accounts are adopted at the
AGM. For entities where such adoption is not required, the Auditor may consider revising the Audit
Report within a reasonable time, but in any case not later than the issuance of the Audit Report for the
immediately succeeding accounting period.
Subsequent Financial Statements: A Continuing Auditor may consider that the revision of Financial
Statements and issuance of a Revised Report is not necessary if appropriate disclosures are made in
the Financial Statements of the immediately succeeding accounting period.
If the management neither agrees to revise the Financial Statements nor agrees to circulate the
proposed Revised Audit Report to the recipients of the earlier report, the Auditor should notify the
persons ultimately responsible for the overall direction of the entity that action will be taken by him to
prevent reliance on the Audit Report.
Notify the client that the Audit Report must no longer be associated with the Financial Statements.
Notify the regulatory agencies (ROC / Income Tax Department / SERI / RBI / IRDA etc.) having
jurisdiction over the client that the Audit Report should be no longer be relied upon. Make an
appropriate statement at the AGM, if requested by the Chairman.
Withdrawal from Engagement: When the Management neither agrees to revise the Financial Statements
nor agrees to ensure that anyone in receipt of the previously issued Financial Statements and Audit
Report thereon will be informed of the situation and would be issued Devised Audit Report, the Auditor
may conclude that withdrawal from the further engagement with the entity is necessary.
Signature: Where a Firm is the Auditor, the Partner who signed the Original Audit Report, should also sign
the Revised Report or the letter indicating preventing reliance on the Audit Report, as the case may
be. In case of signing by any other Partner, the reasons thereof should be stated.
Legal Requirements: The Auditor should examine whether the requirements relating to Abridged Balance
Sheet and Abridged Profit & Loss Account as laid down in Section 136 have been duly complied with.
Subsequent Events: If the Audit Report on Abridged Financial Statements is issued on a date subsequent
to the issuance of the Audit Report on Annual Accounts as per Schedule III, the Auditor’s responsibility
in relation to events occurring after the Balance Sheet date is limited to the events occurring up to the
date of his report on the annual accounts.
Unqualified Report: If the Auditor is satisfied that the Abridged Financial Statements are proper in all
respects, he should issue an Unqualified Audit Report.
Qualified Report: The Auditor should express a Qualified Opinion or an Adverse Opinion, as appropriate,
if he has certain reservations about the Abridged Financial Statements, e.g. if a material piece of
information has not been disclosed in the Abridged Financial Statements or has been disclosed in an
inappropriate manner.
When a Company does not provide for an amount for Proposed Dividend, the attention of Shareholders
should he drawn to the fact that no appropriation has been made.
The fact that provision for Proposed Dividend has not been made should be disclosed by means of a
Note in the Accounts.
The Auditor should refer to the Note in his Report and make his Report subject thereto.
Skills: The professional skill and audit procedures to be applied for an audit u/s 348 are similar to that
used during a normal audit of a Company.
Report: There should be a fair measure of uniformity in the Reports submitted by Auditors conducting
an audit u/s 348 of the Companies Act, 2013. The Auditor’s Report may be on the following lines -
Whether he has obtained all the information and explanations, which to the best of his knowledge and
belief, were necessary for the purposes of his audit,
Whether in his opinion, proper books of account as required by the Companies Act, 2013 and Companies
(Court) Rules, 1959 have been kept by the Liquidator, so far as appears from his examination of these
books,
Whether the Liquidator’s Account relating to realisations and disbursements is in agreement with the
books and records produced before him,
Whether in his opinion, and to the best of his information and according to the explanations given to
him, the Liquidator’s Account including Annexures give the information required by the Companies
Act, 2013, and the Companies (Court) Rules, 1959 in the manner so required and give a true and
correct view of the realisations and disbursements of the Liquidator.
The aggregate of the amount contributed in any financial year should not exceed 5% of the average
net profits during three immediately preceding financial years.
Expenditure incurred on printing and distribution of posters and leaflets, either directly concerned or
connected with elections or otherwise for a political purpose.
Contribution made directly to a political party whether in cash or in other form for running an educational
institution or for undertaking philanthropic activities.
Donation, Contribution, or other form of support to a Trust, Society or Association in any of the under
noted circumstances -
If the Trust, Society, or Association has any political objectives either wholly or even partially. If the Trust,
Society, or Association is formed for any political purpose either wholly or even partially.
If the Trustees or Governing Council or Committee of the Trust, Society, Association have the discretion
of using the funds wholly or partially for a political purpose or in furtherance of a political objective. On
the other hand, the mere fact that some of the objects of a particular Trust, Society, or Association are
similar to the objects of a particular political party but are not of a political nature should not act as
disqualification.
Making available vehicles owned by the Company to any political party or to any candidate seeking
election to any local authority, assembly, Parliament, etc. either free of cost, or at less than market rate.
Donation, Subscription or payment by a Company to any person which can be regarded as likely to
affect public support for a Political Party shall be deemed as contribution for a political purpose.
Disclosure: Every Company should disclose in its P&L Account, the amount contributed by it during the
financial year to any political party or for any political purpose, giving the particulars of the name of
the recipient party or person.
Auditor’s Duties:
The Auditor should qualify his Audit Report under the following circumstances, if he is satisfied - that
the political contribution has been made in excess of the limit prescribed. (He should also indicate the
amount involved.) that facts regarding such contributions are not properly disclosed.
If the Auditor is in doubt about applicability of Section 182, he should disclose this fact in his report.
The Auditor should obtain a certificate from the Board stating the following
That all amounts of contributions to Political Parties have been properly recorded;
No amounts of such nature other than those so included in the books have been paid / given directly
or indirectly.
The Auditor need not make any special inquiry to unearth cases of unauthorized political contributions
if they are not readily apparent from the examination of the accounts made in the normal course of
audit.
Where the Auditor fails to discover cases of contraventions of Section 182, he would be responsible
only to the extent it can be established that in the conduct of the audit he acted without reasonable
is care and skill.
Parent Company: The Parent Company (i.e. Holding Company) has the following responsibilities -
(a) Identifying components, and including the financial information of the components to be included
in the Consolidated Financial Statements,
(b) Identifying reportable segments for segmental reporting,
(c) Identifying related parties and related party transactions for reporting,
(d) Obtaining accurate and complete financial information from components, and
(e) Making appropriate consolidation adjustments.
To satisfy that the CFS have been prepared as per the requirements of Ind AS - 27, 18 & 31.
To enable the Auditor to express an opinion on the true and fair view presented by the CFS(Consolidated
Financial Statement).
Features of CFS:
CFS are prepared using the Separate Financial Statements of the Parent, Subsidiaries, Associates and
Joint Ventures and also other financial information, which might not be covered by the Separate
Financial Statements of these entities.
The ‘other financial information’ would include disclosures to be made in the CFS about the Subsidiaries,
Associates and joint Ventures, proportion of items included in the CFS to which different accounting
policies have been applied, adjustments made for the effects of significant transactions or other
events that occur between the Financial Statements of Subsidiaries, Associates or Joint Ventures and
the Parent, as the case may be, etc.
The Auditor of the CFS has to use the work of other Auditors i.e. the Auditor of Financial Statements of
the components, as required under SA 600.
Verification Procedures:
• His working papers for the prior years for known Subsidiaries, Associates and JVs,
• Joint Ventures and other relevant agreements entered into by the Parent,
• Statutory records maintained by the Parent, e.g. Registers u/s 190 / 186.
Control Since control of the composition of the Board of Directors/ Governing Body of
an enterprise also results in a Parent-Subsidiary Relationship, the Auditor should
examine the minutes of Board Meetings, Shareholder Agreements with entities to
which technology or know-how might have been provided, etc.
Exclusion • Where a Subsidiary’/ Associate /Jointly Controlled Entity is excluded from the
CFS, the Auditor should examine the reasons for the exclusion.
• If it is argued that the reason for exclusion from consolidation is that the relationship
of the entity with the Parent is temporary, the Auditor should examine whether
the Parent had the intention to dispose of its interest at the time of making the
investment.
Permanent Consolidation Adjustments: The Auditor should see whether the following adjustments have
been made appropriately –
Capital Reserve / Goodwill: Determination of excess / deficit of the cost to the Parent of its investment
in a Subsidiary over the Parent’s portion of Equity of the Subsidiary, at the date on which investment in
the Subsidiary is made (determination of Goodwill or Capital Reserve).
Minority Interest: Determination of the amount of equity attributable to minorities at the date on which
investment in Subsidiary is made.
Other Verification: The Auditor should review the Memorandum Records to verify the adjustments
entries made in the preparation of CFS including the following -
● Intra-group interest paid and received, or management fees, etc.
● Intra-group indebtedness.
● Adjustments related to harmonising the different accounting policies being followed by the Parent
enterprise and its Subsidiaries.
● Adjustments made for the effects of significant transactions or other events that occur between the
date of the Financial Statements of the Parent and one or more of the components, if the Financial
Statements to be used for consolidation arc not drawn up to the same reporting date; and
● Determination of movement in equity attributable to the minorities since the date of acquisition of
the Subsidiary.
AUDIT CERTIFICATE
Sometimes apart from an audit report for general use, an auditor is often called upon to give a
certificate for special purpose. The certificate should include the following: —
● Auditor should see that there is a suitable declaration by the management about the subject
matter.
● Auditor should give the certificate on his letter head or on stationary carrying his name and address
to avoid misunderstanding.
● Auditor should clearly state his limitations and indicate the extent to which he has relied upon a
technical expert if any.
● Auditor should mention the manner in which the audit was conducted.
● Auditor should indicate in the certificate if he has made certain fundamental assumptions. Auditor
should make a reference to the information and explanations obtained. Auditor should give clear
title to it, indicating whether it is a report or a certificate.
● Auditor should mention whether he has used any general purpose statement like Profit & Loss
Account for his investigation and also, state whether that general purpose statement has been
audited by other auditors.
● Auditor should be careful while interpreting any law related matter, he should clearly mention that
he is expressing merely his own opinion.
● Auditor should see that the certificate should be self contained documents. Auditor should clearly
mention the responsibility assumed by him.
● Auditor should, if he has referred the audited statements, clearly mention that the figures are used
from the audited statements and relied upon.
● Auditor should address the certificate to the client or the Public Authority or the person requiring it
as the case may be. In appropriate circumstances it may be issued by using the words as “to whom
so ever it may concern“.
There are many more circumstance, where for, auditor is called for issuing a certificate, e.g.,
Deposits Return Certificate: As provided under rule 10(1)of the Companies (Acceptance of Deposits),
Rules, a non banking, non financial company has to file periodical return in prescribed form containing
the information about deposits accepted and the copy of the return is required to be filed with the
R.B.I. (Reserve Bank of India). This return is to be certified by the Company Auditor.
CERTIFICATE
We certify that to the best of our knowledge and according to the information and explanation given
to us and as shown by the records examined by us, the figures of deposits and interest rates under parts
A, B and C of the return of the ……………… Co. Ltd. are correct.
We further certify the correctness of the particulars of the paid up capital and free reserves etc. given
in the manager’s certificate.
Ability to Refund Deposits Certificate: As per the provisions of the Non Banking Financial
Companies(Reserve Bank)Directions, issued from time to time every non banking financial company
is required to furnish to the RBI a certificate from its auditor to the effect that, the full liabilities to the
depositor of the company including interest are properly reflected in the Balance Sheet and that the
company is in a position to meet the amount of such liability to the depositors. As prescribed by the RBI,
the certificate shall be in following format—
CERTIFICATE
We certify that, on the basis of the checks carried out by us and the information and explanations
given to us I am of the opinion that full liabilities to the depositors of the company including interest
payable thereon have been reflected in the financial statements as on 31st March of the company,
as per the said financial statements and on a going concern basis and based on information and
explanation given to me, is in a position to meet the liabilities to the depositors, as on that date.
Also, an auditor is required to give certificate under various provisions of the Companies Act 2013, for
example, u/s 26 for matters in the prospectus, U/s 73 for public deposits, etc.
In short, Audit Certificate is a written confirmation of the accuracy of the information stated therein but
does not involve any opinion.
1. Describe the procedure of submission of Cost Audit report by the Auditor of the Company.
6. Write short notes on Qualification of Company Auditor under section 141 of the Companies Act
2013.
7. Explain the matters that do and do not affect the auditor’s opinion.
9. What consideration should an auditor bear in mind when he is drafting a certificate for a special
purpose? Discuss the scope and contents of such reports.
10. What are the various types of opinion that an auditor can express as a result of his audit? Under
what circumstances should an auditor express an adverse opinion or disclaimer of opinion?
11. Explain the nature of verification the auditor should conduct before issuing report or certificate
on financial information in offer documents.
4. The auditor gives a clean report when he doesn’t have any significant reservation in respect
of matters contained in the Financial Statements.
5. A disclaimer of opinion is issued by the auditor when he cannot form an overall opinion about
the matters contained in the Financial Statements.
6. A piecemeal opinion is issued when whole of the matters contained in the financial statement
is true and fair.
7. An adverse report s given when the auditor concludes that based on his examination he does
not agree with the affirmations made in the financial report.
[Answer: T, F, T, T, T, F, T, F, ]
3. The audit report shall either contain as ______________ of regarding financial statements.
6. The audit report should be signed in the personal name of the _____________.
[Answer: 1 Lakh Rupees, Collected and Considered, Expression of opinion, Shareholders, Auditor,
Auditor]
Column A Column B
1 True and Fair Audit Report A Forming an opinion and Reporting on Financial
Statements.
2 Audit report with certain reservations B Audit Report
3 SA 700 C Unable to form overall opinion on Financial
Statement
4 Negative report E One Lakh Rupees.
5 Fine for violation of sec143 (12) F Four times.
6 SA 600 G Unqualified Opinion.
7 Expression of opinion on Financial H Using the work of another Auditor
Statement
8 Disclaimer of opinion I Does not agree with affirmation made by the
management in the books.
9 Scope paragraph J Qualified Report.
[Answer: G, J, A, I, E, H, B, C, D]
(A)4
(B)5
(C)3
(D)2
(A)3
(B)2
(C)1
(D)4
(A)Employee
(B)Auditor
(C)Company Secretary
(D)Chairman
(A)3
(B)2
(C)1
(D)4
(A)Main
(B)Final
(C)Semi final
[Answer: A, A, C, A, B]
“Branch office”, in relation to a company, means any establishment described as such by the company
- section 2(14) of the 2013 Act.
Audit of Branch Office by company’s auditor or branch auditor - Where a company has a branch office,
the accounts of that office shall be audited either by the company’s auditor (i.e. auditor appointed for
the company in AGM) or by any other person qualified for appointment as an auditor of the company
under the 2013 Act. Such ‘branch auditor’ shall be appointed as such under section 139 of the 2013
Act - first part of section 143(8) of the 2013 Act.
Audit of branch offices outside India - Where the branch office is situated in a country outside India, the
accounts of the branch office shall be audited either by the company’s auditor or by an accountant
or by any other person duly qualified to act as an auditor of the accounts of the branch office in
accordance with the laws of that country. The duties and powers of the company’s auditor with
reference to the audit of the branch and the branch auditor, if any, shall be as may be prescribed
second part of section 143(8) of the 2013 Act.
Report by Branch Auditor to company’s auditor - The branch auditor shall prepare a report on the ac-
counts of the branch examined by him and send it to the company’s auditor. The company’s auditor
shall deal with the report of branch auditor in his report in such manner as he considers necessary
proviso to section 143(8) of the 2013 Act.
Duties and powers of company’s auditors in connection with branch audit - Duties and powers of
com-pany’s auditor (main auditor) with reference audit of branch and branch auditor shall be as
contained in section 143(1) to 143(4) of the 2013 Act and Rule 12(1) of Companies (Audit and Auditors)
Amendment Rules, 2015. Thus, the company’s auditor is responsible even if branch auditor is appointed.
Branch auditor’s responsibility to report fraud - Responsibility to report fraud, as applicable to company’s
auditor applies to branch auditor.
Joint Audit
In big corporate more than one persons or firm of Chartered Accountants are appointed as a Joint
Auditor for conducting the audit of the company. This practice of appointing joint auditor accrues great
advan-tages to the company. In a big organisation the task of carrying audit cannot be accomplished
with single individual so for overcoming such situation joint auditor wheres appointed.
Advantages of Joint Audit: The various advantages that accrue out of Joint Audit are enumerated
below;
● Lower workload
● Sharing of expertise
● Healthy competition
● Quality of performance
Disadvantages of Joint Audit: The disadvantages of Joint Audit are enumerated below;
● Psychological problem
SA 299 issued by The Institute of Cost Accountants of India on “Responsibility of Joint Auditor” lay down
the responsibilities on joint auditors. The responsibilities of joint auditor’s
Normally, the joint auditors are able to arrive at an agreed report. However, where the joint auditors
are in disagreement with regard to any matters to be covered by the report, each one of them should
express his own opinion through a separate report. A joint auditor is not bound by the views of the
majority of the joint auditors regarding matters to be covered in the report and should express his
opinion in a separate report in case of a disagreement.
In respect of audit work divided among the joint auditors, each joint auditor is responsible only for the
work allocated to him, whether or not he has prepared a separate report on the work performed by
him. On the other hand, all the joint auditors are jointly and severally responsible -
● in respect of the audit work which is not divided among the joint auditors and is carried out by all
of them;
● in respect of decisions taken by all the joint auditors concerning the nature, timing or extent of the
audit procedures to be performed by any of the joint auditors. It may, however, be clarified that all
the joint auditors are responsible only in respect of the appropriateness of the decisions concerning
the nature,
● timing or extent of the audit procedures agreed upon among them; proper execution of these
audit procedures is the separate and specific responsibility of the joint auditor concerned;
● in respect of matters which are brought to the notice of the joint auditors by any one of them and
on which there is an agreement among the joint auditors;
● for examining that the financial statements of the entity comply with the disclosure requirements of
the relevant statute; and
● for ensuring that the audit report complies with the requirements of the relevant statute.
“Securities” means the securities as defined in clause (h) of section 2 of the Securities Contracts (Regu-
lation) Act, 1956.
● Study of the contract pursuant to which the issue is made to determine how many shares are
agreed to be issued and for what value and the nature and other details of the consideration.
● Examination of the prospectus to see the substance of the contract and the relevant terms of the
issue including the mode of payment of the purchase consideration in case of an issue to a vendor
of the business or payability of commission to the underwriters or payability of the preliminary
expenses.
● To check whether minimum amount has been subscribed or not as stated in the prospectus.
● To check whether the sums payable on application for the amount so stated have been paid to
and received by the company by cheque or other instrument.
● To check whether the amount payable on application on every security shall not be less than five
per cent. of the nominal amount of the security or such other percentage or amount, as may be
specified by the Securities and Exchange Board by making regulations in this behalf.
● Examine the Board minute’s for the purpose for which securities is issued and utilized for the same.
● Check whether the amount is refund to the applicant within prescribed time period in case of
minimum amount has not been subscribed and the sum payable on application is not received
within a period of thirty days from the date of issue of the prospectus.
● To check whether the company has file with the Registrar a return of allotment or not, where the
Company having a share capital makes any allotment of securities.
● To check whether the Company has defaulted under sub-section (3) or sub-section (4). In case the
company is found default under above provision then the same should be reported by the auditor
in his report.
● Verify the minutes of the Board meeting and ordinary resolution passed in the general meeting in
which the approval of members is obtained.
● Verify that alteration had been effected in copies of Memorandum, Articles, etc.
● Obtain the reasons for which the memorandum of the company is altered.
● Check whether there is any change in the voting percentage of shareholders due to consolidate
and divide all or any of its share capital into shares of a larger amount than its existing shares.
● To confirm that the alter share capital’s denomination should be more than R1.
● Verify that proper accounting entries have been passed. Register of members may also be checked
to see that the necessary alteration have been effected therein.
● Verify the minutes of the Board meeting and ordinary resolution passed in the general meeting in
which the approval of members is obtained.
● Check that the company has issue fully paid-up bonus shares to its members only.
● Confirm that the issue of bonus shares shall not be made by capitalising reserves created by the
revaluation of assets.
● Check whether the company has made any default in payment of interest or principal in respect
of fixed deposits or debt securities issued by it.
● Check whether the company has made any default in payment of statutory dues of the employees,
such as, contribution to provident fund, gratuity and bonus.
● Check whether the bonus shares shall not be issued in lieu of dividend.
● Verify the minutes of the Board meeting and special resolution passed in the general meeting in
which the approval of members is obtained.
● Where the buy-back has been authorised by the Board by means of a resolution passed at its
meeting then check that the buy-back is not more than ten per cent. or less of the total paid-up
equity capital and free reserves of the company.
● Check that the no buy-back of any kind of shares or other specified securities shall be made out of
the proceeds of an earlier issue of the same kind of shares or same kind of other specified securities.
● To check that the buy-back shall not be more than twenty-five per cent. of the aggregate of paid-
up capital and free reserves of the company. In case of buy-back of equity shares in any financial
year, the reference to twenty-five per cent. in this clause shall be construed with respect to its total
paid-up equity capital in that financial year.
● To check that the ratio of the aggregate of secured and unsecured debts owed by the company
after buy-back is not more than twice the paid-up capital and its free reserves.
● To check that all the shares or other specified securities for buy-back should be fully paid-up.
● To check whether the buy-back is made as per SEBI regulations in case of buy-back of the shares
or other specified securities listed on any recognized stock exchange.
● To check that no offer of buy-back under this sub-section shall be made within a period of one year
reckoned from the date of the closure of the preceding offer of buy-back.
● To ensure that buy-back shall be completed within a period of one year from the date of passing
of the special resolution, or as the case may be, the resolution passed by the Board under clause
(b) of sub-section (2).
● Ensure that the buy-back has been done only out of the company’s free reserves or its securities
premium account or out of the proceeds of any shares or other specified securities other than
out of the proceeds of an earlier issue of the same kind of shares or same kind of other specified
securities.
● Ascertain that declaration of solvency was filed with the SEBI and/or the Registrar of Companies
before making buy-back but subsequent the passing of the special resolution.
● To ensure that company shall extinguish and physically destroy the shares or securities so bought
back within seven days of the last date of completion of buy-back.
● To ensure that the company shall not make a further issue of the same kind of shares or other
securities including allotment of new shares or other specified securities within a period of six months
except by way of a bonus issue.
● Whether the company has maintained any register of the shares or securities so bought.
● Check whether that the after the completion of the buy-back under this section the company
file with the Registrar and the Securities and Exchange Board a return containing such particulars
relating to the buy-back within thirty days of such completion.
● Verify the minutes of the Board meeting and ordinary resolution passed in the general meeting in
which the approval of members is obtained.
● Verify that alteration had been effected in copies of Memorandum, Articles, etc.
● Verify that proper accounting entries have been passed. Register of members may also be checked
to see that the necessary alteration have been effected therein.
The following aspects are required to be examined by the auditor in conducting the share transfer
audit:
i. Inspection of the Articles of Association regarding the prescribed form of transfer and other
provisions, particularly the time limits laid down by the Articles or law.
ii. Notification by transferor of the lodgement made by the transferee and inspect the objections
received, if any. Also see, where calls due or not paid, whether transfer can be refused under the
articles and whether any transfer was so refused.
iii. Examining in the case of particularly partly-paid shares, where the application for registration was
made by the transferor, a notice was sent to the transferee and registration was effected only on
receipt of ‘non-objection’ received from him.
● That in every case, the application for transfer was made in the prescribed form and the
prescribed authority had stamped the date on which it was presented to it; also that it was
delivered to the company within 60 days exaction.
● That each transfer form is properly executed and bears the proper stamp duty.
● That where the consideration for transfer appears to be inadequate, an inquiry was made
by the company for ascertaining the reasons therefor. (This is not necessary if the transfer
form bears the seal of the Collector of Stamps.)
● That the name and address of the transferee have been recorded completely and fully for
purposes of correspondence.
(v) Comparison of the signatures of each transferor on the transfer form with his signature on the
original application for shares or on the transfer form (if the shares were acquired on a transfer).
(vi) Ascertaining that none of the transferees is disqualified from holding shares in the company.
(vi) Vouching the entries in the Shares Transfer Journal by reference to the transfer forms, noting in
each case:
(vii) Verification of postings from the Share Journal to the Register of Members.
(viii) Inspection of each transfer as to names, addresses, occupations, form of document, description,
number (in words), distinctive number of shares, stamp, date, signature, witnesses, etc.
(ix) Check whether the transfer to firms, etc. have been rejected or not and whether notes of trust has
been entered in the share register.
(x) Noting transferor’s name, etc. and class, number and distinctive number of shares, as stated in the
transfers, with old certificates and Register of Members. See that old certificates were cancelled.
(ix) Inspection of the power of attorney and specimen signatures if transfer executed by an agent.
(x) Inspection of letters of indemnity for lost certificates and ensuring that duplicate certificates have
been issued on proper authority.
(xi) Where part of the shares have been transferred, the issue of balance certificates to the transferors
should be seen and confirm that the distinctive number of shares have been correctly stated.
(xii) Refer to the minutes book to ensure that all transfers recorded in the share transfer journal have
been approved by the Board.
(xiv) Reconciliation of the amount of transfer fees collected with the total number of transfers lodged
and verifying that the amount of transfer fees have been accounted for.
(xv) Reconciliation of the total number of shares of different classes issued by the company with
the total amount of capital issue and its sub-divisions by extracting balances of shares held by
different members from the Register of members.
(xvi) Ensuring that, in case of any share transactions by directors, corresponding entries have been
made in the Register of Directors’ shareholding.
i. The auditor should ascertain that the board of directors has the authority under the Articles of
Association of the company to reissue forfeited shares. Check the relevant resolution of the Board
of Directors.
ii. Vouch the amounts collected from persons to whom the shares have been allotted and verify
the entries recorded from re-allotment. Auditor should check the total amount received on the
shares including received prior to forfeiture, is not less than the par value of shares.
iii. Verify that computation of surplus amount arising on the reissue of shares credited to Capital
Reserve Account and
iv. Where partly paid shares are forfeited for non-payment of call, and re-issued as fully paid, the
reissue is considered as an allotment at a discount and compliance of the provisions of Section
53 is essential.
“Debenture” includes debenture stock, bonds or any other instrument of a company evidencing a
debt, whether constituting a charge on the assets of the company or not;
Issue of Debenture
A company may issue debentures with an option to convert such debentures into shares, either wholly
or partly at the time of redemption. Provided that the issue of debentures with an option to convert such
deben-tures into shares, wholly or partly, shall be approved by a special resolution passed at a general
meeting. No company shall issue any debentures carrying any voting rights. Secured debentures may
be issued by a company subject to such terms and conditions as may be prescribed.
Where debentures are issued by a company under this section, the company shall create a debenture
redemption reserve account out of the profits of the company available for payment of dividend and
the amount credited to such account shall not be utilised by the company except for the redemption
of debentures. Appointment debenture trustee is mordatary for the following –
The purpose of appointment of debenture trustee is for the protection of interest L & redden grievances
of debenture holders.
Auditor’s Duty:
● The auditor should verify that the prospectus had been duly filed with the registrar before the
date of allotment of debentures.
● He should check the amount collected in the cash book with the counterfoils of receipts issued to
the applicants and also cross check the amount into the application and allotment book.
● He should examine the debenture trust deed and note the conditions contained therein as to
issue and repayment.
● If the debentures are covered by a mortgage of a charge, it should be verified that the charge
has been correctly recorded in the register of mortgage and charges and it has also been
registered with the registrar of the companies.
● Where debentures have been issued as fully paid up to vendors as a part of the purchase
consideration, the contract in this regard should be checked.
Interest on Debentures:
A predetermined fixed rate of interest is payable on debentures irrespective of the fact that company
has earned the profit or not. Debenture holders are creditors of the company, they are not the owners.
They have no voting powers and cannot influence the management but their claim of interest rank
ahead of the claims of the shareholders.
Auditor’s Duty:
i. The payment of interest should be vouched by the auditor with the acknowledgement of the
debenture-holders, endorsed warrants and in case of bearer debentures with the coupons
surrendered.
ii. The auditor should reconcile the total amount paid with the total amount due and payable with
the amount of interest outstanding for payment.
iii. He should ensure that the interest paid on debenture like that on other fixed loans, must be
disclosed as a separate item in the profit & loss account.
Redemption of Debentures:
A company may issue debentures with an option to convert such debentures into shares, either wholly
or partly at the time of redemption. If debentures are redeemable it can be redeemed in any of the
follow-ing way:
Auditor’s Duty:
i. The auditor should inspect the debentures or trust deed for the terms and conditions regarding
redemption of debentures.
ii. He should see the Director’s minute book authorizing the redemption of debentures.
iii. He should also vouch the redemption with the help of debenture bonds cancelled and the cash
book.
If the debentures are issued as collateral security to the banks or creditors then auditor needs to ensure
that such issue is approved by Board of Directors and very by the term as per loan agreement.
Final dividend is declared in the general meeting. Board of Directors have to recommend a dividend.
Declaration of dividend is ‘Ordinary Business” in general meeting.
No dividend shall be declared or paid by a company for any financial year except—
● out of the profits of the company for that year arrived at after providing for depreciation in
accordance with the provisions of sub-section (2), or out of the profits of the company for any
previous financial year or years arrived at after providing for depreciation in accordance with the
provisions of that sub-section and remaining undistributed, or out of both; or
● out of money provided by the Central Government or a State Government for the payment of
dividend by the company in pursuance of a guarantee given by that Government.
Provided that a company may, before the declaration of any dividend in any financial year, transfer
such percent-age of its profits for that financial year as it may consider appropriate to the reserves of
the company.
Provided further that where, owing to inadequacy or absence of profits in any financial year, any
company proposes to declare dividend out of the accumulated profits earned by it in previous years
and transferred by the company to the reserves, such declaration of dividend shall not be made
except in accordance with such rules as may be prescribed in this behalf.
Provided also that no dividend shall be declared or paid by a company from its reserves other than
free reserves.
Provided also that no company shall declare dividend unless carried over previous losses and
depreciation not pro-vided in previous year or years are set off against profit of the company for the
current year.
For the purposes of clause (a) of sub-section (1), depreciation shall be provided in accordance with
the provisions of Schedule II.
Interim Dividend:
The Board of Directors of a company may declare interim dividend during any financial year out of
the surplus in the profit and loss account and out of profits of the financial year in which such interim
dividend is sought to be declared.
Declaration of interim dividend if company has incurred losses in current financial year:
In case the company has incurred loss during the current financial year up to the end of the quarter
immediately preceding the date of declaration of interim dividend, such interim dividend shall not
be declared at a rate higher than the average dividends declared by the company during the
immediately preceding three financial years.
The amount of the dividend, including interim dividend, shall be deposited in a scheduled bank in a
separate ac-count within five days from the date of declaration of such dividend.
Entitlement of Dividend:
No dividend shall be paid by a company in respect of any share therein except to the registered
shareholder of such share or to his order or to his banker and shall not be payable except in cash.
Provided that nothing in this sub-section shall be deemed to prohibit the capitalisation of profits or
reserves of a company for the purpose of issuing fully paid-up bonus shares or paying up any amount
for the time being unpaid on any shares held by the members of the company.
Provided further that any dividend payable in cash may be paid by cheque or warrant or in any
electronic mode to the shareholder entitled to the payment of the dividend.
Consequences on non-compliance:
A company which fails to comply with the provisions of sections 73 and 74 shall not, so long as such
failure continues, declare any dividend on its equity shares.
Unpaid Dividend Account [Section 124] Transfer of unpaid dividend to separate account:
Where a dividend has been declared by a company but has not been paid or claimed within thirty
days from the date of the declaration to any shareholder entitled to the payment of the dividend, the
company shall, within seven days from the date of expiry of the said period of thirty days, transfer the
total amount of dividend which remains unpaid or unclaimed to a special account to be opened by
the company in that behalf in any scheduled bank to be called the Unpaid Dividend Account.
The company shall, within a period of ninety days of making any transfer of an amount under sub-
section (1) to the Unpaid Dividend Account, prepare a statement containing the names, their last
known addresses and the unpaid dividend to be paid to each person and place it on the website
of the company, if any, and also on any other website approved by the Central Government for this
purpose, in such form, manner and other particulars as may be prescribed.
Effect of non-transfer:
If any default is made in transferring the total amount referred to in sub-section (1) or any part thereof
to the Unpaid Dividend Account of the company, it shall pay, from the date of such default, interest
on so much of the amount as has not been transferred to the said account, at the rate of twelve per
cent. per annum and the interest accruing on such amount shall enure to the benefit of the members
of the company in proportion to the amount remaining unpaid to them.
● Any money transferred to the Unpaid Dividend Account of a company in pursuance of this
section which remains unpaid or unclaimed for a period of seven years from the date of such
transfer shall be transferred by the company along with interest accrued, if any, thereon to the
Fund established under sub-section (1) of section 125 and the company shall send a statement in
the prescribed form of the details of such transfer to the authority which administers the said Fund
and that authority shall issue a receipt to the company as evidence of such transfer.
● All shares in respect of which dividend has not been paid or claimed for seven consecutive
years or more under sun-section (5) shall also be transferred by the company in the name of
Investor Education and Protection Fund along with a statement containing such details as may
be prescribed.
● Provided that any claimant of shares transferred above shall be entitled to claim the transfer of
shares from Investor Education and Protection Fund in accordance with such procedure and on
submission of such documents as may be prescribed.
● If a company fails to comply with any of the requirements of this section, the company shall be
punishable with fine which shall not be less than five lakh rupees but which may extend to twenty-
five lakh rupees and every officer of the company who is in default shall be punishable with fine
which shall not be less than one lakh rupees but which may extend to five lakh rupees.
The Central Government shall establish a Fund to be called the Investor Education and Protection
Fund (herein referred to as the Fund).
● the amount given by the Central Government by way of grants after due appropriation made by
Parliament by law in this behalf for being utilised for the purposes of the Fund;
● donations given to the Fund by the Central Government, State Governments, companies or any
other institution for the purposes of the Fund;
● the amount in the Unpaid Dividend Account of companies transferred to the Fund under sub-
section (5) of section 124;
● the amount in the general revenue account of the Central Government which had been
transferred to that account under sub-section (5) of section 205A of the Companies Act, 1956,
as it stood immediately before the commencement of the Companies (Amendment) Act, 1999,
and remaining unpaid or unclaimed on the commencement of this Act;
● the amount lying in the Investor Education and Protection Fund under section 205C of the
Companies Act, 1956;
● the interest or other income received out of investments made from the Fund;
● the application money received by companies for allotment of any securities and due for refund;
● sale proceeds of fractional shares arising out of issuance of bonus shares, merger and
amalgamation for seven or more years;
● redemption amount of preference shares remaining unpaid or unclaimed for seven or more
years; and
Provided that no such amount referred to in clauses (h) to (j) shall form part of the Fund unless such
amount has remained unclaimed and unpaid for a period of seven years from the date it became
due for payment.
● the refund in respect of unclaimed dividends, matured deposits, matured debentures, the
application money due for refund and interest thereon; promotion of investors’
● distribution of any disgorged amount among eligible and identifiable applicants for shares or
debentures, shareholders, debenture-holders or depositors who have suffered losses due to
wrong actions by any person, in accordance with the orders made by the Court which had
ordered disgorgement;
● reimbursement of legal expenses incurred in pursuing class action suits under sections 37 and 245
by members, debenture-holders or depositors as may be sanctioned by the Tribunal; and
● any other purpose incidental thereto, in accordance with such rules as may be prescribed:
Provided that the person whose amounts referred to in clauses (a) to (d) of sub-section (2) of section
205C trans-ferred to Investor Education and Protection Fund, after the expiry of the period of seven
years as per provisions of the Companies Act, 1956, shall be entitled to get refund out of the Fund in
respect of such claims in accordance with rules made under this section.
● The Central Government shall constitute, by notification, an authority for administration of the
Fund consisting of a chairperson and such other members, not exceeding seven and a chief
executive officer, as the Central Government may appoint.
● Any person claiming to be entitled to the amount referred in sub-section (2) may apply to the
authority constituted under sub-section (5) for the payment of the money claimed.
i. The manner of administration of the Fund, appointment of chairperson, members and chief
executive officer, holding of meetings of the authority shall be in accordance with such rules as
may be prescribed.
ii. The Central Government may provide to the authority such offices, officers, employees and other
resources in accordance with such rules as may be prescribed.
iii. The authority shall administer the Fund and maintain separate accounts and other relevant
records in relation to the Fund in such form as may be prescribed after consultation with the
Comptroller and Auditor-General of India.
iv. It shall be competent for the authority constituted under sub-section (5) to spend money out of
the Fund for carrying out the objects specified in sub-section (3).
Books of Accounts:
● The accounts of the Fund shall be audited by the Comptroller and Auditor- General of India at
such intervals as may be specified by him and such audited accounts together with the audit
report thereon shall be forwarded annually by the authority to the Central Government.
● The authority shall prepare in such form and at such time for each financial year as may be
prescribed its annual report giving a full account of its activities during the financial year and
forward a copy thereof to the Central Government and the Central Government shall cause the
annual report and the audit report given by the Comptroller and Auditor-General of India to be
laid before each House of Parliament.
Statutory Audit is the act of checking books of accounts as per the provision of Companies Act,
whereas Internal Audit is conducted by the either be a chartered accountant or a cost accountant,
or such other professional as may be decided by the Board of the Company to detect weakness in
internal control system and for their improvement. However both of these types of audit check books
of accounts, detect frauds & errors however they differ from each other which is reproduced below;
Inventories are tangible property held for sale in the ordinary course of business, or in the process of
production for such sale, or for consumption in the production of goods or services for sale, including
maintenance supplies and consum-able stores and spare parts meant for replacement in the normal
course. Inventories normally comprise raw materials including components, work-in-process, finished
goods including by-products, maintenance supplies, stores and spare parts, and loose tools.
Inventories normally constitute a significant portion of the total assets, particularly in the case of
manufacturing and trading entities as well as some service rendering entities. Audit of inventories,
therefore, assumes special importance.
The following features of inventories have an impact on the related audit procedures:
● Inventories are susceptible to obsolescence and spoilage. Further, some of the items of inventory
may be slow-moving while others may follow a seasonal pattern of movement.
● Inventories are normally movable in nature, although there may be some instances of immovable
inventories also, e.g., in the case of an entity dealing in real-estate.
● All the items of inventory may not be located at one place but may be held at different locations
such as factories and warehouses, or with third parties such as selling agents.
● The individual items of inventory may not be significant in value, but taken together, they normally
constitute a significant proportion of total assets and current assets of manufacturing, trading and
certain service entities.
● Physical condition (e.g., stage of completion of work-in-process in certain industries) and existence
of certain items of inventories may be difficult to determine.
● Valuation of inventories may involve varying degrees of estimation, including expert opinions,
e.g., in the case of jewelry.
Introduction
i. The term Property, plant and equipment in respect of those entities which are required to comply
with the relevant Revised AS refers to such tangible items that:
● are held for use in the production or supply of goods or services, for rental to others, or for
administrative purposes; and
ii. An asset can be classified as a PPE or otherwise, depending upon the use to which it is put or
intended to be put. For example, assets which are classified as PPE in one type of business may
be considered as current assets in another. Similarly, the same asset may be classified differently
in an entity at different points of time. The recognition of Property, Plant and Equipment should be
done as per the principles laid down in the “relevant applicable AS”.
EDUCATION INSTITUTION
The special steps involved in the audit of an educational institution are the following:
● Examine the Trust Deed, or Regulations in the case of school or college and note all the provisions
affecting accounts. In the case of a university, refer to the Act of Legislature and the Regulations
framed thereunder.
● Read through the minutes of the meetings of the Managing Committee or Governing Body,
noting resolutions affecting accounts to see that these have been duly complied with, specially
the decisions as regards the operation of bank accounts and sanctioning of expenditure.
● Check names entered in the Students’ Fee Register for each month or term, with the respective
class registers, showing names of students on rolls and test amount of fees charged; and verify
that there operates a system of internal check which ensures that demands against the students
are properly raised.
● Check fees received by comparing counterfoils of receipts granted with entries in the cash book
and tracing the collections in the Fee Register to confirm that the revenue from this source has
been duly accounted for.
● Total up the various columns of the Fees Register for each month or term to ascertain that fees
paid in advance have been carried forward and the arrears that are irrecoverable have been
written off under the sanction of an appropriate authority.
● Check admission fees with admission slips signed by the head of the institution and confirm that
the amount had been credited to a Capital Fund, unless the Managing Committee has taken a
decision to the contrary.
● See that free studentship and concessions have been granted by a person authorised to do so,
having regard to the prescribed Rules.
● Confirm that fines for late payment or absence, etc., have either been collected or remitted
under proper authority.
● Confirm that hostel dues were recovered before students’ accounts were closed and their
deposits of caution money refunded.
● Verify rental income from landed property with the rent rolls, etc.
● Vouch income from endowments and legacies, as well as interest and dividends from investment;
also inspect the securities in respect of investments held.
● Verify any Government or local authority grant with the relevant papers of grant. If any expense
has been disallowed for purposes of grant, ascertain the reasons and compliance thereof.
● Report any old heavy arrears on account of fees, dormitory rents, etc, to the Managing Committee.
● Confirm that caution money and other deposits paid by students on admission have been shown
as liability in the balance sheet and not transferred to revenue.
● See that the investments representing endowment funds for prizes are kept separate and any
income in excess of the prizes has been accumulated and invested along with the corpus.
● Verify that the Provident Fund money of the staff has been invested in appropriate securities.
● Vouch donations, if any, with the list published with the annual report. If some donations were
meant for any specific purpose, see that the money was utilised for the purpose.
● Vouch all capital expenditure in the usual way and verify the same with the sanction for the
Committee as contained in the minute book.
● Vouch in the usual manner all establishment expenses and enquire into any unduly heavy
expenditure under any head.
● See that increase in the salaries of the staff have been sanctioned and minuted by the Committee.
● Ascertain that the system ordering inspection on receipt and issue of provisions, foodstuffs, clothing
and other equipment is efficient and all bills are duly authorised and passed before payment.
● Verify the inventories of furniture, stationery, clothing, provision and all equipment, etc. These
should be checked by reference to Stock Register and values applied to various items should be
test checked.
● Confirm that the refund of taxes deducted from the income from investment (interest on securities,
etc.) has been claimed and recovered since the institutions are generally exempted from the
payment of income-tax.
● Verify the annual statements of accounts and while doing so see that separate statements of
account have been prepared as regards Poor Boys Fund, Games Fund, Hostel and Provident
Fund of Staff, etc.
AUDIT OF HOSPITAL
The following points are to be considered necessary for conducting an audit of Hospital.
● Study the Charter or Trust Deed under which the hospital has been set up and take a special note
of the provisions affecting the accounts.
● Examine, evaluate and verify the system of internal check, internal control and determine the
nature, timing and the extent of the audit procedures.
● Vouch the entries in the Patient’s Bill Register with a copies of bill issued. Test check the selected
bills to see that these have been correctly prepared taking into consideration the period of stay
of each patient as recorded in the Attendance Schedule.
● Vouch the collection from patients with copies of bills and entries in Bills Register. Arrears of dues
should be properly carried forward and where these are deemed to be irrecoverable, they should
be written off under due authorizations.
● Interest and/ or dividend income should be vouched with reference to the Investment Register
and Interest and Dividend warrants.
● In case of legacies and donations which are received for specific purposes, it should be ensured
that any income therefrom is not utilized for any other purposes.
● Where receipts of subscription show a significant deviations from budgeted figures, it should be
thoroughly inquired into and the matter be brought to the notice of the trustees or the Managing
Committee.
● Government grants or grants from local bodies should be verifies with the reference to the
correspondence with the concerned authorities.
● Clear distinction should be made between the items of capital and revenue nature.
● The capital expenditure should be incurred under proper authorization by a valid resolution of the
trustees or the Managing Committee.
● Verify the system of internal check as regards purchases and issue of stores, medicines etc.
● Examine that the appointment of the staff, payment of salaries etc. are duly authorized.
● Check that adequate depreciation has been provided on all the depreciable assets.
Definition: A Co-operative society may broadly be defined as an association of persons who have
voluntarily joined together to achieve a common economic objective through the formation of a
democratically-controlled business organization, making equitable contributions to the capital as
required, and accepting a fair share of risks and benefits of the undertaking. Elimination of middlemen
and sharing of gains of economic activities seems to be the hallmark of a co-operative society.
A co-operative society may be formed for different purposes. Accordingly, there may be consumers’
co-operative societies, housing co-operative societies, industrial co-operative societies , urban and
rural co-operative banks, etc.
● The Registrar shall audit or cause to be audited by some person authorised by him by general
or special order in writing in this behalf the accounts of every registered society once at least in
every year.
● The audit under sub-section (1) shall include an examination of overdue debts, if any, and a
● The Registrar, the Collector or any person authorised by general or special order in writing in
this behalf by the Registrar shall at all times have access to all the books, accounts, papers and
securities of a society, and every officer of the society shall furnish such information in regard to
the transactions and working of the society as the person making such inspection may require.
The following points should be kept in mind where awains of an Co-operative society;
● Qualifications of auditor: generally, only a chartered accountant within the meaning of the
Chartered Accountants Act 1949, can be appointed as the auditor of a co-operative society.
However, in certain State Co-operative societies Act, a person holding a government diploma
in co-operative accounts, or in co-operation and accounts, or a reason who has served as an
auditor in the Co-operative Department of Government, may also be appointed as the auditor.
The auditor should ensure that he is duly qualified to act as auditor of the society.
Appointment of the Auditor: An auditor of a co-operative society is appointed by the Registrar of Co-
operative Societies-and the auditor so appointed conducts the audit on behalf of the Registrar and
submits his report to him as also to the society. The audit fees are paid by the society on the basis of
statutory scale of fees prescribed by the Registrar, according to the category of the society audited.
For example, the audit fees of co-operative credit society and Urban Co-operative Banks are to be
calculated with reference to working capital at the prescribed rates. ‘Working Capital’ here means
funds at the disposal of the society inclusive of paid up share capital, funds built up out of profits and
monies raised by borrowing and by other means.
Books of accounting records: Under section 43(h) of the Co-operative Societies Act, a state government
can frame rules prescribing the books and accounts to be kept by a co-operative society.
For example In Maharashtra the co-operative societies are required to maintain cash book, general
ledger, personal ledger, stock register, property register, etc.
Cash book. It may be maintained to record particulars regarding cash receipts and expenses under
suitable heads, with clear distinction between capital and revenue items of receipts and expenses.
Stock register. It may contain detailed information as regards receipts, issues and balances of stock-in-
trade, date-wise. In a producers’ co-operative society, perpetual inventory records may be maintained
based on an appropriate costing method.
Register of assets and investments. It will contain detailed particulars regarding the various immovable
and movable assets belonging to the society, such as, types of assets, location, date of acquisition,
cost, depreciation provided, and so on.
Register of fixed deposits. In the case of a co-operative credit society, or a co-operative bank, or any
other society which is authorised by its bye-laws to accept deposits from members/non-members,
a register of fixed deposits may be maintained giving details as regards the dates of acceptance,
maturity, interest accrual, repayment, etc.
Register of sureties. In the case of a co-operative credit society, loans are given against personal
security of members as also surety (guarantee) provided by two other members. The Register of Sureties
will give particulars about the number of borrowers in respect of which a member has stood surety, and
show whether it is within the overall limit of surety-ship that may.
The auditor should see that the provision regarding shareholding is duly followed.
Restriction on Loan: As per section 29 A registered co-operative society can only grant loans to its
members though, with prior approval of the Registrar, it may grant loans to other registered co-
operative societies. The auditor should see that the loans granted by the society are in conformity with
this provision.
Restriction on Borrowing: Subject to the restrictions imposed by its bye-laws, a co-operative society
may accept loans and deposits from its members as well as non-members. It is the, auditor’s duty to
ascertain that the restrictions, if any, laid down by the bye-laws are carefully observed
Investment of Funds: There are restrictions on investment of funds belonging to a co-operative society.
Accordingly, a society may invest its funds in any of the following (Sec.32 of the Central Co-operative
Societies Act):
● Any shares, securities, bonds or debentures of any other Co-operative society with limited liability.
● Any bank, or person carrying on banking business or a Co- operative bank, other than a Central
or State co-operative bank, as duly approved by the Registrar;
Auditor’s duty: The auditor should ascertain whether the requirement as to investment of the society
funds are being observed.
Appropriation of profits: According to the Central Co-operatives Societies Act, 25% of the profits of
a co-operatives society should be transferred to a Reserve Fund before distribution of dividend or
payment of bonus to its members. However, the Registrar may, having regard to the financial position
of the society, reduce the percentage of profits to be transferred to the Reserve Fund. But in any case,
he cannot reduce it to less than 10% of the profits of the society.
Apart from the above mandatory provision, a co-operative society may, subject to the provisions
of its bye-laws, appropriate its profits by way of transfer to other reserves, distribution of dividends to
members, etc. However, appropriation of profits must be duly approved by the members of the society
in the general meeting called for the purpose.
Contributions to charitable Purposes: According to Section 34, a registered society may, with the
sanction of the Registrar, contribute an amount not exceeding 10% of the net profits remaining after
the compulsory transfer to the reserve fund for any charitable purpose as defined in section 2 of the
Charitable Endowments Act, 1890.
General Points: - In general while conducting audit of Co-operative society ‘The auditor need to look
into the followings: -
● The auditor should carefully go through the bye-laws of the society and see that they are being
observed both in letter and spirit.
● He should examine the Register of Members of the society and individual shareholdings.
● He should test-check the internal check and control system operated by the society and model
his audit examination based on its strengths and weaknesses.
Audit of income: He should carefully vouch the receipt of cash. Cash receipts on account of share
capital should be vouched with the Register of Members. Cash received against sales should be
vouched with the cash memos and invoices issued to customers as also Sales Account. Receipt of
cash in respect of payment of interest and repayment of loans advanced by the society should be
vouched with the loan agreements. Cash received from members towards construction of houses or
their maintenance, should be vouched with the Register of Members, demands made by the society
from time to time, and money receipts.
Audit of Expenditure:
● He should vouch all expenditure with reference to authorisation from the Managing Committee,
particularly in the case of large capital expenditure, as also the bills received from individual
parties, the money receipts obtained from them, and entries in the Bank Pass Book along with
counter-foils of cheques.
● He should vouch the payment of loans from the loan agreements entered into with borrower-
members.
● He should vouch establishment expenses with reference to the resolutions of the Managing
Committee, agreements with the persons concerned, and money rec( :pts obtained from them.
● He should appropriately classify overdue debts for a period from six months to five years and
more, and report them to the members, with a note regarding the effects these might have
on the financial position of the society. He should also put a note regarding the probability of
recovery of such debts.
● Similarly, he should make a special reference to the overdue amount of interest from members.
Generally, interest on overdue debts should not be credited to Interest Account but to the
Overdue Interest Reserve Account.
● Writing off of bad debts should be after prior authorisation from the Managing Committee of the
society. According to the Maharashtra Co-operative Societies Rules, a bad debt can be written
off only when it is certified to be irrecoverable by the auditor. This casts a special obligation on
the auditor to ascertain whether the debt in question was created within the Rules of the society,
and whether it has now really become bad and irrecoverable.
BANK AUDIT
Introduction:
The banking industry is the pivot of any economy and its financial system. Banks are one of the
foremost agents of financial intermediation in an economy like India and, therefore, development of
a strong banking system is of utmost importance. The banking institutions in the country are working
in a competitive environment and their regu-latory framework is aligned with the international best
practices. Thus, financial deepening has taken place in India and continues to be in progress with a
focus on orderly conditions in financial markets while sustaining the growth momentum.
The Reserve Bank of India (hereinafter referred to as RBI) acts as the monetary authority and the central
bank of the country.
● Commercial banks;
● Co-operative banks;
As per the Third Schedule to the Banking Regulation Act, 1949, the Balance Sheet of a Bank should be
presented in the following manner, with comparative figures for previous financial year –
Advances: In relation advances made by bank an auditor need to review the followings:
● To scrutining the overdue account and scheme for recovery of such amount.
● Cash balance with RBI and other bank and money at call and short Notice.
Cash in hand:
● Visit the bank branch and inspects physical cash and ensure that it will tallies withs the banks cash
book balance.
● To verity the amount of foreign currency held by bank and its transalation at make rate on the
date at which financial statement is prepared.
● Inspect the ledger balance in each account with (a) bank confirmation certificates from Reserve
Bank of India and (b) Reconciliation Statement.
Inspection of reconciliation statement to ensure that no debit or credit for interest have been taken to
Revenue account to the year. To examines the large transition and balances with banks outside India.
Ensure that they are converted at market rate as on financial statement preparation
● Examinees the system of autharisation for unding money at short and call notice
● The call loan made by bank are not nettled off against call loan received by it.
● Ensure that money market lending’s for more than 6th days are not classified under this head but
as a deposit or advance based on their nature of learning.
The auditor has to ensure the following while audit of F .A (Fixed Assets) held by banks
● Ownership document
● To examine with reference to schedule of fixed assets to find neew assets acquired.
Barrowings:
● Verity whether the barrowings of maney at call and short notice are property authorized.
Deposits: -
● To ensure the interest accered but not due on deposits is not under other liabilities and provision
Capital:
● Examine with special resolution of shareholder or MOA about increase in authorized capital
durig the year.
● Examine with Government notification for any fresh contribution from them.
The auditor may verify the various items under the head “other liabilities and provisions’ in the
following manner.
Bills Payable
The auditor should evaluate the existence, effectiveness and continuity of internal controls over bills
payable. Such controls should usually include the following:
● Drafts, mail transfers, traveller’s cheques, etc., should be made out in standard printed forms.
● Unused forms relating to drafts, traveller’s cheques, etc., should be kept under the custody of a
responsible officer.
● The bank should have a reliable private code known only to the responsible officers of its branches
coding and decoding of the telegrams should be done only by such officers.
● The signatures on a demand draft should be checked by an officer with the specimen signature
book.
● AW the telegraphic transfers and demand drafts issued by a branch should be immediately
confirmed by advices to the branches concerned. On payment of these instruments, the paying
branch should send a debit advice to the originating branch.
● If the paying branch does not receive proper confirmation of any telegraphic transfers or demand
draft from the issuing branch, it should take immediate steps to ascertain the reasons.
● In case an instrument prepared on a security paper, e.g., draft, has to be cancelled (say, due
to error in preparation), it should be examined whether the manner of cancellation is such that
the instrument cannot be misused. (For example, in the case of drafts, banks generally cut the
distinctive serial number printed on the form and paste it in the book in which drafts issued are
entered.) Cases of frequent cancellation and reissuance of drafts, pay orders, etc., should be
carefully looked into by a responsible official.
It may be noted that the figure of advances and investments in the balance sheet of a bank excludes
provisions in respect thereof made to the satisfaction of auditors. The issue of determining the adequacy
of provision for doubtful advances is discussed in detail under advances chapter of this Guidance
Note. The auditor should examine other provisions and other items of liabilities in the same manner
as in the case of other entities. Specifically, in case of tax deducted by the bank and payable to the
government authorities before the due date, this function may be centralized or decentralized. While
verifying this, the auditor must check whether tax has been correctly deducted from payments as per
the provisions of the Income Tax /Act, 1961 and paid on or before the due date as specified under the
/Act or Rules therefore. Many a times in case of branch audit, reporting has to be done before the due
date of paying tax deducted at source for the month of March. In such cases the auditor should report
delays observed till the date of his verification and clearly bring out the fact that he has not verified the
payment of tax, due date of which would be after the date of the audit report.
In respect of contingent liabilities, the auditor is primarily concerned with seeking reasonable assurance
that all contingent liabilities are identified and properly valued. To this end, the auditor should, generally
follow the audit procedures given below:
● The auditor should verify whether there exists a system whereby the non fund based facilities to
parties are extended only to their regular constituents, etc.
● Ascertain whether there are adequate internal controls to ensure that transactions giving rise to
contingent liabilities are executed only by persons authorised to do so and in accordance with
the laid down procedures.
● The auditor should also examine whether in case of LCs for import of goods, as required by the
abovementioned Master Circular on guarantees and co-acceptances, the payment to the
overseas suppliers is made on the basis of shipping documents and after ensuring that the said
documents are in strict conformity with the terms of LCs.
● Ascertain whether the accounting system of the bank provides for maintenance of adequate
records in respect of such obligations and whether the internal controls ensure that contingent
liabilities are properly identified and recorded.
● Performs substantive audit tests to establish the completeness of the recorded obligations. Such
tests include confirmation procedures as well as examination of relevant records in appropriate
cases.
● Review the reasonableness of the year-end amount of contingent liabilities in the light of previous
experience and knowledge of the current year’s activities.
● Review whether comfort letters issued by the bank has been considered for disclosure of
contingent liabilities.
● The auditor should examine whether the bills drawn on other branches of the bank are not
included in bills for collection.
● Inward bills are generally available with the bank on the closing day and the auditor may inspect
them at that time. The bank dispatches outward bills for collection soon after they are received.
They are, therefore, not likely to be in hand at the date of the balance sheet. The auditor may
verify them with reference to the register maintained for outward bills for collection.
● The auditor should also examine collections made subsequent to the date of the balance sheet
to obtain further evidence about the existence and completeness of bills for collection.
● In regard to bills for collection, the auditor should also examine the procedure for crediting
the party on whose behalf the bill has been collected. The procedure is usually such that the
customer’s account is credited only after the bill has actually been collected from the drawee
either by the bank itself or through its agents, etc. This procedure is in consonance with the nature
of obligations of the bank in respect of bills for collection.
● While innovative products and ways of trading create new possibilities for earnings for the bank,
they also introduce novel and sometimes unfamiliar risks that must be identified and managed.
Failure to do so can result losses entailing financial and reputational consequences that linger
long after the loss has been recognized in financial statements. Hence, auditor should assess
controls as part of audit work.
● It is imperative that an auditor obtains a complete overview of the treasury operations of a bank
before the commencement of the statutory audit. After conducting appropriate risk assessment
of the treasury processes, the audit program needs to be designed in a manner that it dovetails
into not just the control assessments of the treasury process but there is an assurance that the
figures appearing in the financial statements as well as the disclosures are true and reflect fairly
the affairs of the bank treasury.
● The Auditors’ Report should state whether the Balance Sheet, Profit and Loss Account and Cash
Flow Statement of the Bank, show a true and fair view of the financial position / result of operations
/ cash flows respectively, for the period under audit. This is applicable in respect of Nationalised
Banks, as well as Banking Companies.
● Additional Matters: Sec.30 (3) of Banking Regulation Act requires the Auditor to state the following-
● Whether or not the information and explanations required by him have been found to be
satisfactory,
● Whether or not transactions of the Company fall within the powers of a Banking Company,
● Whether or not the returns received from the Branch Offices of the Company have been found
adequate for the purposes of his audit,
● Whether the Profit & Loss Account shows a true balance of Profit or Loss for the period covered by
such account, &
● Any other matter, which the Auditor considers should be brought to the notice of Shareholders of
the Company.
● LFAR: Auditors of Public Sector Banks, Private Sector Banks & Foreign Banks (as well as their
Branches), are required to submit Long Form Audit Report (LFAR) on various matters specified by
RBI.
● Certificates: In addition to Reports, the Auditors of Bank Branches as well as Central Statutory
Auditors of Banks, have to furnish / issue various “Certificates” as required by RBI and other
Regulations.
AUDIT OF TRUSTs
When conducting the audit of a charitable institution, the auditor should consider the following matters:
● Constitution: The auditor should study the constitution of the charitable institution, for example,
whether it is set up under the Societies Registration Act or as per section 8 of the Companies Act
or as a trust.
● Interest of members: Obtain a list of members of the governing body. This will help the auditor in
identifying whether any of the members of the governing body has any interest in the charitable
institution.
● Budget: The auditor should obtain a copy of the budget sanctioned or the financial statement.
This would enable him to acquaint himself with the different heads of income and expenditures
of incomes and expenditures of the institution.
● Internal Check: Examination of the system of internal check, especially as regards the accounting
of the amounts collected.
● Collection & Deposit of income: Check that the amounts received towards income have been
duly collected, received and deposited into the bank regularly and promptly.
● Subscription and donation: These institutions receive subscriptions and donations which form the
major part of their collections. Therefore the auditor should check the following:
► Adequacy of internal controls existing as regards unused receipt books, counter foils, etc.
► Where subscriptions are received in advance these should be properly dealt with in the
accounts.
● Income from Investment: Where the institution has made any investments or given loans, the
amount of dividend and interest should be properly vouched with reference to the counterfoils or
dividend warrants received. It should be ensured that such loans or grants are given under proper
authorizations.
● Rent: If some property is given or taken on rent, then the auditor should check the tenancy
agreement, the rent slips and the authorized person for the collection or payment, as the case
may be, of the rent.
● Expenditure-a major area of concern: The expenditure of charitable institution is also one of the
major areas of concern. Thus the auditor should verify that the expenditure is made only for the
charitable purpose. If the expenditure is not for the charitable purpose, then the auditor should
examine the implications of applicable law and document for the same.
● Physical verification: The auditor should physically verify the cash in hand, inventories and fixed
assets.
The major objective of audit of Municipalities and Panchayats are enumerated below;
The following points are to be considered necessary for carrying on audit of Municipalities and
panchayats (Local Bodies);
● To ensure that the expediters incurred conform to the relevant provision of the law and is in
accordance with the financial Rules and regulation formed by the compliant authority.
● To encase that sanction is accorded by the competent authority either special or general.
● To encase that there is provision of funds for expenditure and is authorized by competent Authority.
● To ensure that where huge financial expenditure is made is run economically and is expected to
contribute growth.
2. What are the factors to be considered while carrying on audit of Share and Debentures?
3. Precautions to be taken care of while carrying on audit of divisible profits and dividends.
7. What are the points which you as an Auditor would look into while auditing the accounts of a
Hospital?
9. While carrying an audit of a Bank what are the special factors considered by you.
1. “Branch office”, in relation to a company, means any establishment described as such by the
company.
2. Where a company has a branch office, the accounts of that office shall be audited by auditor
appointed at EGM.
3. Where the branch office of a company is situated in a country outside India, the accounts of the
branch office shall be audited either by the company’s auditor or by an accountant or by any
other person duly qualified to act as an auditor.
4. The branch auditor shall prepare a report on the accounts of the branch examined by him and
send it to the Audit committee.
5. In big corporate more than one persons or firm of Chartered Accountants are appointed as a
Joint Auditor for conducting the audit of the company.
6. “Debenture” includes debenture stock, bonds or any other instrument of a company evidencing
a debt, whether constituting a charge on the assets of the company or not.
10. If the debentures are issued as collateral security to the banks or creditors then auditor needs to
ensure that such issue is approved by debenture trustee.
[Answer: True, False, True, False, True, True, True, True, True, False.]
2. If the debentures are issued as collateral security to the banks or creditors then auditor needs to
ensure that such issue is approved by ___________________.
5. Where debentures are issued by a company, then company shall create a __________________
account out of the profits of the company.
6. For protecting the interest of debenture holders the company is bound to form ________________.
9. A company may issue debentures with an option to convert such debentures into ____________.
[Answer: General Meeting, BOD, Rate, Creditors, Debenture Redemption Reserve, Debenture Trustee,
Branch, AOA, Shares, General]
Column A Column B
1 More than one persons or firm of Chartered A Branch Audit
Accountants are appointed
2 Section 68 of the Co. Act 2013 B Alteration of Share Capital
3 Section 63 the Co. Act 2013 C Power of company to Purchase its Own
Securities
4 Section 61 of the Co. Act 2013 D Joint Audit
5 Section 139 of the Companies Act 2013. E Issue of Bonus Shares
[Answer: D, C, E, B, A]
INTERMEDIATE EXAMINATION
June 2019 P-12 (CCA)
Syllabus 2016
The figures in the margin on the right side indicate the full marks.
Where considered necessary, suitable assumptions may be made and
clearly indicated in the answers.
The Question paper has two sections, A and B. Both sections are to be
answered as per instructions given against each.
Section-A
(Company Accounts)
Answer Questions No. 1 and any three from Question Nos. 2, 3, 4 and 5.
(ii) In a Balance Sheet prepared under Schedule III of Companies Act, 2013, ‘Share application money
pending allotment’ shall be shown
(A) under Shareholder’s Fund
(B) under Non-current Liabilities
(C) under Current Liabilities
(D) as a separate line item.
(iii) In case of Cash Flow Statement prepared under Direct Method, decrease in current liabilities is
(A) added to cash flow from operating activities
(iv) For calculation of depreciation, Central Electricity Regulatory Commission has recommended
(A) Straight Line Method
(B) Optimized Depreciated Replacement Cost Method
(C) Written Down Value Method
(D) Both (A) and (B)
(v) In case of Electricity Company while calculating depreciation for the purpose of tariff as per
Regulation 21, the salvage value of the Asset shall be considered as
(A) 3%
(B) 5%
(C) 10%
(D) None of the above
(vi) As per Section 52 of Companies Act 2013, Securities Premium A/c cannot be used
(A) to issue fully paid up bonus shares
(B) to pay interim dividend
(C) to write off the discount on issue of debentures
(D) to write off the premium on redemption of preference shares
(b) Match the following items in Column ‘A’ with items shown in Column ‘B’: 1x4=4
(c) State whether the following statements are True or False: 1x4=4
(i) Buy-back of shares can also be made out of the proceeds of the earlier issues of the same kind of
shares.
(ii) Transfer to Capital redemption reserve account is not allowed from Dividend Equalization Fund.
(iii) Operating Lease is a lease which transfers substantially all the risks and rewards incidental to
ownership.
(iv) Machinery purchased by issuing shares is shown under Cash Flow from Investments Activities in Cash
Flow Statement.
2. (a) A company issued 1,50,000 shares of ` 10 each at a premium of ` 10. The entire issue was underwritten as
follows:
A - 90000 shares (Firm underwriting 12000 shares)
B - 37500 shares (Firm underwriting 4500 shares)
C - 22500 shares (Firm underwriting 15000 shares)
Total applications received by the company (excluding firm underwriting and marked applications) were
22500 shares.
The marked applications (excluding firm underwriting) were as follows:
A - 15000 shares; B - 30000 shares; C - 7500 shares
Commission payable to underwriters is at 5% of the issue price. The underwriting contract provides that
credit for unmarked applications be given to the underwriters in proportion to the shares underwritten and
benefit of firm underwriting is to be given to individual underwriters.
(i) Determine the liability of each underwriter (number of shares)
(ii) Compute the amount payable or due to underwriters.
(b) A Ltd. has taken the assets on lease from X Ltd. The following information is given below:
Lease Term = 3 years
Fair value at inception of lease = ` 14,00,000
Lease Rent = ` 6,00,000 p.a. at the end of each year
Guaranteed Residual Value = ` 44,000
Implicit Interest Rate = 15% p.a.
Calculate the value of the asset to be considered by A Ltd. and the interest (finance charges) in each
year.
Present value of ` 1.00 at 15% is given below:
Year 1 2 3
PVIF (15%) 0.869 0.756 0.657
(5+2)+5=12
3. (a) Prepare the fire Insurance Revenue Account of Agni Fire Insurance Ltd. as per IRDA regulations for the year
ended 31st March, 2019 from the following details:
(b) From the following information find out the amount of provisions required to be made in the Profit & Loss
Account of a Commercial Bank for the year ended 31st March, 2019:
(i) Credit outstanding for ` 80 lakhs against which the Bank holds securities worth ` 20 lakhs. 50% of the
above advance is covered by ECGC. The above advance has remained doubtful for more than 3
years.
(ii) Other advances:
Additional information:
(i) 2000 equity shares were issued for consideration other than cash.
(ii) Trade Receivables of ` 52,000 are due for more than six months.
(iii) (a) The cost of assets: 31.03.2019 (b) Depreciation till 31.03.2019
Building — ` 4,00,000 Building — ` 50,000
Plant & Machinery — ` 7,00,000 Plant & Machinery — ` 1,75,000
Furniture — ` 62,500 Furniture & Fittings — ` 50,000
(iv) The balance of ` 1,50,000 in the loan account with State Financial Corporation is inclusive of ` 7,500 for
interest accrued but not due. The loan is secured by hypothecation of the Plant & Machinery.
(v) Balance at bank includes ` 2,000 with Perfect Bank Ltd., which is not a Scheduled Bank.
(vi) The company had contract for the erection of machinery at ` 1,50,000 which is still incomplete.
You are required to prepare Pioneer Limited’s Balance Sheet as at 31.03.2019 as per Schedule III in accordance
with the Companies Act, 2013 in the Vertical Form along with the Notes to Accounts. Ignore previous years’
figures. 12
Section-B
(Auditing)
Answer Questions No. 6 and any three from Question Nos. 7, 8, 9 and 10.
6. (a) Choose the correct answer from the four alternatives given: 1×6=6
(i) A nomination and remuneration committee should have _____________ directors.
(A) 5
(B) 10
(C) 2
(D) 3
(ii) An individual auditor who has completed his term shall not be eligible for reappointment as auditor
in the same company for
(A) Next 3 Years
(B) Next 5 Years
(C) Next 7 Years
(D) Next 8 Years
(iv) Secretarial Audit is applicable to the Public Company having the paid-up share capital of
`_____________ .
(A) 50 crore
(B) 75 crore
(C) 100 crore
(D) 200 crore
(v) Internal Control Questionnaire contains the questions which need to be followed by the _____________.
(A) Employer of the organisation
(B) Employee of the organisation
(C) Auditor of the entity
(D) Banker to the organisation
(vi) Declaration of dividend is covered under section _____________ of the Companies Act, 2013.
(A) 122
(B) 123
(C) 124
(D) 125
(b) Match the following items in Column ‘A’ with items shown in Column ‘B’ 1x4=4
(c) State whether the following statements are true or false: 1x4=4
(i) An Audit notebook is a bound book in which a large variety of matters observed during the course
of audit are recorded.
(ii) The concept of true and fair is a fundamental concept in auditing.
(iii) First auditor of the company is appointed by the Board of Directors within 45 days from the date of
first AGM.
(iv) A Statutory Audit is an official investigation into alleged wrong doing.
7. (a) What do you mean by Audit Programme? Discuss the various advantages of an Audit Programme.
(b) Discuss different types of internal control systems with example. (1+5)+6=12
8. (a) Discuss the rights of an auditor according to the Companies Act, 2013.
(b) How can an auditor, who is appointed under section 139 of the Companies Act, 2013, be removed from
his office before the expiry of his term? 8+4=12
9. (a) With reference to the Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules, 2014 as amended, discuss the following:
(i) Submission of cost audit report to the Board of Directors by the Cost Auditor
(ii) Applicability of rotation to Cost Auditors
(iii) Remuneration of a Cost Auditor
(b) “Disclaimer of Opinion and Adverse Report do not serve the same purpose”. Discuss. (2+2+3)+5=12
INTERMEDIATE EXAMINATION
December 2018 P-12 (CCA)
Syllabus 2016
The figures in the margin on the right side indicate the full marks.
Where considered necessary, suitable assumptions should be made and
clearly indicated in the answers.
The Question paper has two sections, A and B. Both sections are to be answered
as per instruction given against each.
Section-A
(Company Accounts)
Answer Questions No. 1 and any three from Question Nos. 2, 3, 4 and 5.
(iii) Instalment of principal amount of long−term loan payable within next 12 months is shown under
Balance Sheet of a company under the heading
(A) Non−current Assets
(B) Non−current Liabilities
(C) Current Assets
(D) Current Liabilities
(A) Both fully and partly paid-up securities can be bought back.
(D) Buy-back should be completed within 1 year from the date of passing of special resolution.
(v) A banking company is required to maintain ________ provision on unsecured portion of doubtful
advances.
(A) 25%
(B) 40%
(C) 50%
(D) 100%
(C) Unmarked applications are those applications that bear the stamp of the underwriter.
(D) Except as provided in Section 54, a company shall not issue shares at a discount.
(b) Match the following items in Column ‘A’ with items shown in Column ‘B’: 1×4=4
(c) State whether the following statements are True or False: 1×4=4
(i) The profit on forfeiture and re-issue of equity shares are credited to Capital Redemption Reserve.
(ii) As per Companies Act 2013, companies are not permitted to buy back their own shares out of
securities premium.
(iii) Bonus is the share of profit which is payable by the insurance company to the policyholders.
(iv) Interest on loan is included in ‘other operating expenses’ under the Statement of Profit and Loss.
2. (a) Following is the extract of the Balance Sheet of Xeta Ltd. As at 31st March, 2017:
Authorised Capital:
50,000 12% Preference shares of `10 each 5,00,000
4,00,000 Equity shares of `10 each 40,00,000
45,00,000
Issued and Subscribed Capital:
24,000 12% Preference shares of `10 each fully paid 2,40,000
2,70,000 Equity shares of `10 each, `8 paid up 21,60,000
Reserves and Surplus:
General Reserve 3,60,000
Securities Premium 1,00,000
Profit and Loss Account 6,00,000
On 1st April, 2017, the Company has made final call @ 2 each on 2,70,000 Equity shares. The call money
was received by 20th April, 2017. Thereafter, the company decided to capitalize its reserves by way of
bonus at the rate of one share for every four shares held.
Show necessary journal entries in the books of the company and prepare the extract of the Balance Sheet
as on 30th April, 2017 after bonus issue. 7
(b) An enterprise operates through six segments, namely, A, B, C, D, E and F. The relevant information about
these segments are given in the following table (amounts in ` ’000):
A B C D E F Total (segment)
1. Segment Revenue
(a) External Sales -- 550 250 150 50 50 1050
(b) Inter Segment Sales 100 100 50 200 -- 50 500
1. Segment Results-Profit/(Loss) (90) 25 (5) (15) 5 10 --
2. Segment Assets 30 50 10 20 10 5
Identify the reportable segments under (i) segment revenue criterion, (ii) segment result criterion and (iii)
segment asset criterion as per AS17. 5
Additional Information:
(i) Dividend paid during the year `46,000.
(ii) Net profit for the year `1,32,200.
(iii) Depreciation written-off on building `20,000 and on machinery `28,000.
(iv) Income tax paid during the year `56,000.
(v) The following assets of another company were purchased for a consideration of ` 1,00,000 and paid
in shares.
Assets were: Inventory `40,000 and Machinery `50,000.
(vi) Further machinery was purchased for `50,000 during the year. There was a sale of Machinery.
Your are required to prepare a Cash Flow Statement as per AS 3. 9
(b) From the following information calculate return on equity as per Regulation 21 of the Central Electricity
Regulatory Commission (Terms and Conditions of Tariff) Regulation 2004: 3
(i) Date of commercial operation of COD = 01.04.2014
(ii) Approved opening capital cost as on 01.04.2014 = ` 30,00,000
(iii) Details of allowed additional capital expenditure:
Year 1 2 3 4
Additional Capital Expenditure (`) 2,00,000 60,000 40,000 20,000
Debit Credit
Land at cost 220 Equity Capital (Shares of ` 10 each) 300
Plant and Machinery at cost 770 10% Debentures 200
Trade Receivables 96 General Reserve 130
Inventories (31.03.2018) 86 Profit & Loss A/c 72
Bank 20 Securities Premium 40
Adjusted Purchases 320 Sales 700
Factory Expenses 60 Trade Payables 52
Administration Expenses 30 Provision for Depreciation 172
Selling Expenses 30 Suspense Account 4
Debenture Interest 20
Interim Dividend Paid 18
1,670 1,670
Additional Information:
(i) The Authorized Share Capital of the Company is 40,000 shares of `10 each.
(ii) The Company on the advice of independent valuer wish to revalue the land `3,60,000.
(iii) Declared final dividend @10% (over Interim Dividend of `18,000).
(iv) Suspense account of `4,000 represents cash received for the sale of some of the machinery on 01.04.2017.
The cost of the machinery was `10,000 and the accumulated depreciation thereon being `8,000.
Section-B
(Auditing)
Answer Questions No. 6 and any three from Question Nos. 7, 8, 9 and 10.
6. (a) Identify the correct alternative in each of the following cases: 1×6=6
(i) Internal Auditor is appointed by
(A) Audit Committee
(B) Shareholders in General Meeting
(C) Extraordinary General Meeting
(D) Board of Directors
(b) Match the following items in Column ‘A’ with items shown in Column ‘B’ 1×4=4
(c) State whether the following statements are True or False: 1×4=4
(i) The Branch Auditor shall prepare report on the Accounts of the Branch examined by him and send it
to Audit Committee.
(ii) Maintenance of Cost Accounting Standards is mandatory as per Section 143 of Companies Act.
(iii) Routine checking is a substitute of vouching.
(iv) Casual vacancy in the office of Cost Auditor is filled by Board of Directors.
9. (a) Discuss the relevant provisions of Companies (Cost Records and Audit) Rules 2014 on applicability of Cost
Audit to different sectors. 6
(b) What is a qualified Audit Report? Discuss the circumstances when an Auditor shall qualify his report.
2+4=6
10. Write short notes (any three): 4×3=12
(a) Auditor’s duty regarding unclaimed dividend
(b) Physical verification of Inventory and Auditor’s responsibility thereof
(c) Audit of Co-operative Society
(d) Difference between Statutory Audit and Internal Audit
INTERMEDIATE EXAMINATION
June 2018 P-12 (CCA)
Syllabus 2016
The figures in the margin on the right side indicate the full marks.
Where considered necessary, suitable assumptions should be made and
clearly indicated in the answers.
The Question paper has two sections, A and B. Both sections are to be answered
as per instruction given against each.
Section-A
(Company Accounts)
Answer Questions No. 1 and any three from Question Nos. 2, 3, 4 and 5.
(iii) The Electricity Act, 2003 replaced which of the following three existing legislations?
(A) The Indian Electricity Act, 1910
(B) The Electricity (Supply) Act, 1948
(C) The Electricity Regulatory Commissions Act, 1998
(D) All of the above
(b) Match the following items in Column ‘A’ with items shown in Column ‘B’: 1x4=4
(c) State whether the following statements are True or False: 1x4=4
(i) Marked applications are those applications which bear the stamp of an underwriter.
(ii) In order to spread the risk of under-subscription, the principal underwriters may enter into subsidiary
agreements with sub-leasees.
(iii) When debentures are issued at discount, it is prudent to write off the loss during the life of debentures.
(iv) Any surplus cash may be utilized by the company for buy-back and avoid the payment of dividend
tax.
2. (a) On 01.01.2017 Jay Ltd. had 2,000, 12% Debentures of ` 100 each. On 01.05.2017 the company purchased
400 own Debentures at ` 97 cum-interest in the open market. Interest on debentures is payable on 30th
June and 31st December each year.
Required: Give the necessary journal entries assuming that the own Debentures purchased were retained
as investments till 31.12.2017, on which date they were cancelled.
Assume that the company follows English Calendar Year. 6
(b) M/s. Ayush Ltd. began construction of a new building on 1st January, 2017. It obtained ` 3,00,000 lakh
special loan to finance the construction of the building on 1st January, 2017 at an interest rate of 12% p.a.
The company’s other outstanding two non-specific loans were:
The expenditure that were made on the building project were as follows:
Amount (`)
Building was completed on 31st December, 2017. Following the principles prescribed in AS 16 on ‘Borrowing
Cost’, calculate the amount of interest to be capitalized and pass one Journal entry for capitalizing the
cost and borrowing in respect of the building. 6
3. (a) The following are the summarized Balance Sheets of ABC Limited as on 31st March, 2016 and 2017:
Additional Information:
(ii) Old Machinery costing ` 24,000 (accumulated depreciation ` 12,000) was sold for ` 8,000.
(iii) 40,000 8% Debenture were redeemed by purchase from open market at ` 96 for a debenture of ` 100
on 31.03.2017.
(b) Given below are details of interest on advance of a Commercial Bank as on 31.03.2017:
Performing Assets
Non-Performing Assets
Term Loan 75 5
Find out the income to be recognized for the year ended 31st March, 2017. 4
4. ABC Limited has an authorized capital of ` 5,00,000 divided into 5000 equity shares of ` 100 each. On 31.03.2018,
2500 shares were fully called up.
The following are the balance extracted from the ledger of the company as on 31.03.2018:
` `
(b) Depreciation to be charged on plant and furniture at 15% and 10% respectively
You are required to prepare Profit and Loss Statement for the year ended 31.03.2018 and the Balance
Sheet as on that date in accordance with the Companies Act, 2013 in the Vertical Form along with the
Notes on Accounts. 12
Section-B
(Auditing)
Answer Questions No. 6 and any three from Question Nos. 7, 8, 9 and 10.
6. (a) Identify the correct alternative in each of the following cases: 1×6=6
(i) If the Debentures are issued as collateral security either to Banks or Creditors the Auditor needs to
ensure that such issue is approved by
(A) Shareholders
(B) Board of Directors
(C) Debenture Trustee
(D) Audit Committee
(ii) As per SQC 1, Audit working papers should be retained for a period of
(A) 2 years
(B) 5 years
(C) 7 years
(D) 10 years
(b) Match the following items in Column ‘A’ with items shown in Column ‘B’: 1x4=4
(c) State whether the following statements are True or False: 1x4=4
8. (a) Discuss the provisions of Companies Act, 2013 as regards reporting of frauds by Company Auditor. 6
(b) Discuss about the manner in which rotation of Auditors may be done by the company on expiry of their
term. 6
9. (a) What is the procedure to be followed for fixing the remuneration of a Cost Auditor? 5